UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K

[X] ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF
THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2005
OR
[   ] TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from _____ to _____
Commission file number 1-10804

XL CAPITAL LTD
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Cayman Islands  98-0191089 
(State or other jurisdiction of  (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) 
incorporation or organization)   
   
XL House, One Bermudiana Road  (441) 292-8515 
Hamilton, Bermuda HM 11  (Registrant’s telephone number, including area code) 
(Address of principal executive offices and zip code)   

SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OF THE ACT:

Title of each class  Name of each exchange on which registered 
Class A Ordinary Shares, Par Value $0.01 per Share  New York Stock Exchange, Inc. 
Series A 8.00% Preference Ordinary Shares, Par Value $0.01 per Share  New York Stock Exchange, Inc. 
Series B 7.625% Preference Ordinary Shares, Par Value $0.01 per Share  New York Stock Exchange, Inc. 
6.50% Equity Security Units  New York Stock Exchange, Inc. 
7.00% Equity Security Units  New York Stock Exchange, Inc. 

SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(g) OF THE ACT:

None

     Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes |X|  No |  |

     Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act. Yes |  |  No |X|

     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes |X|  No |  |

     Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. |  |

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer |X|     Accelerated filer |  |     Non-accelerated filer |  |

     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes |  |  No |X|

     The aggregate market value of the voting common equity of the registrant held by non-affiliates of the registrant on February 27, 2006 was approximately $12.1 billion computed upon the basis of the closing sales price of the Class A Ordinary Shares on that date. For purposes of this computation, ordinary shares held by directors and officers of the registrant have been excluded. Such exclusion is not intended, nor shall it be deemed, to be an admission that such persons are affiliates of the registrant.

     As of February 28, 2006, there were outstanding 179,559,424 Class A Ordinary Shares, $0.01 par value per share, of the registrant.

Documents Incorporated by Reference

     The Registrant’s Definitive Proxy Statement to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to Regulation 14A not later than 120 days after the end of the fiscal year covered by this report relating to the annual meeting of ordinary shareholders to be held on April 28, 2006 is incorporated by reference into Part III of this Form 10-K.


XL CAPITAL LTD

TABLE OF CONTENTS

        Page 

PART I
         
Item 1.    Business    1 
         
Item 1A.    Risk Factors    29 
         
Item 1B.    Unresolved Staff Comments    41 
         
Item 2.    Properties    42 
         
Item 3.    Legal Proceedings    42 
         
Item 4.    Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders    44 
 
PART II
         
Item 5.    Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of     
    Equity Securities    46 
         
Item 6.    Selected Financial Data    48 
         
Item 7.    Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations    50 
         
Item 7A.    Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk    100 
         
Item 8.    Financial Statements and Supplementary Data    109 
         
Item 9.    Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure    180 
         
Item 9A.    Controls and Procedures    180 
         
Item 9B.    Other Information    180 
 
PART III
Item 10.    Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant    181 
         
Item 11.    Executive Compensation    181 
         
Item 12.    Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and     
    Related Stockholder Matters    181 
         
Item 13.    Certain Relationships and Related Transactions    182 
         
Item 14.    Principal Accountant Fees and Services    182 
 
PART IV
         
Item 15.    Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules    182 

     This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains “Forward-Looking Statements” as defined in the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. A non-exclusive list of the important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those in such Forward-Looking Statements is set forth herein under the caption “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.”


PART I


ITEM 1.      BUSINESS

History

     XL Capital Ltd, together with its subsidiaries (the “Company” or “XL”), is a leading provider of insurance and reinsurance coverages, and financial products and services to industrial, commercial and professional service firms, insurance companies and other enterprises on a worldwide basis. XL Capital Ltd was incorporated with limited liability under the Cayman Islands Companies Act on March 16, 1998, as EXEL Merger Company. XL Capital Ltd was formed as a result of the merger of EXEL Limited and Mid Ocean Limited on August 7, 1998, and the Company was named EXEL Limited on that date.

     EXEL Limited and Mid Ocean are companies that were incorporated in the Cayman Islands in 1986 and 1992, respectively. At a special general meeting held on February 1, 1999, the shareholders of the Company approved a resolution changing the name of the Company to XL Capital Ltd.

     On June 18, 1999, XL Capital Ltd merged with NAC Re Corp. (“NAC”), a Delaware corporation organized in 1985, in a stock merger. This merger was accounted for as a pooling of interests under U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”). Following the merger, the Company changed its fiscal year end from November 30 to December 31 as a conforming pooling adjustment.

     On July 25, 2001, the Company acquired certain Winterthur International insurance operations (“Winterthur International”) to extend its predominantly North American-based large corporate insurance business globally. Results of operations of Winterthur International have been included from July 1, 2001, the date from which the economic interest was transferred to the Company.

     Effective January 1, 2002, the Company increased its shareholding in Le Mans Ré from 49% to 67% in order to expand its international reinsurance operations. On September 3, 2003, the Company exercised its option to buy the remaining 33% from MMA for approximately $161 million in cash and changed the name of Le Mans Ré to XL Re Europe. XL Re Europe underwrites a worldwide portfolio comprising most classes of property and casualty reinsurance business, together with a select portfolio of life reinsurance business. See further information under Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8, Note 5 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Segments

     The Company operates through three business segments: Insurance, Reinsurance and Financial Products and Services. These business segments were determined in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standard (“FAS”) No. 131, “Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information” (“FAS 131”). General, life and annuity and financial operations are disclosed separately within each segment.

     Following changes in certain executive management responsibilities in January 2005, the Company changed the reporting segments under which certain business units are reported in order to reflect these changes in responsibilities.

     The following areas have been changed for all periods presented:

  • Results of business structured by XL Financial Solutions Ltd (“XLFS”) are now included entirely within the Financial Products and Services segment whereas previously this unit was reported in all three segments, depending on the nature of individual contracts.

  • Certain blocks of U.S.-based term life mortality reinsurance business previously included in the Financial Products and Services segment are now included in the Reinsurance segment as management of these contracts was transferred to the life reinsurance business units in order to centralize the Company’s management of traditional mortality-based reinsurance business.

1


  • Political risk insurance business units now report to executive management of the Financial Products and Services segment and, as such, future earnings from this business are no longer reported in the Insurance segment but included with financial operations.

  • All operations of business units within the Financial Products and Services segment, including guaranteed investment contracts and funding agreements, are now reported under financial operations in order to consolidate businesses with similar operating characteristics and risks.

  • All net investment income and net income from affiliates generated by assets and interest expense incurred on liabilities of the business units within the Financial Products and Services segment is reported under financial operations. This income and expense is included in financial operations as it relates to interest on portfolios of separately identified and managed assets and deposit liabilities. Management believes this change better reflects the nature of spread focused business.

     The following table sets forth an analysis of gross premiums written by segment for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003. Additional financial information about the Company’s segments, including financial information about geographic areas, is included in Item 8, Note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

   
2005 
2004 
2003 
   
Gross 
Gross 
Gross 
Year ended December 31   
Premiums 
Percentage
Premiums 
Percentage
Premiums 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Written 
Change
Written 
Change
Written 


     

     

     

     

Insurance – General   
$
5,785,750 
  (2.3 )%   
$
5,924,951 
  14.1 %   
$
5,193,287 
Reinsurance – General   
3,411,087 
  (1.3 )%   
3,456,511 
  0.4 %   
3,443,405 
Reinsurance – Life and Annuity   
2,274,520 
  62.8 %   
1,397,516 
  90.5 %   
733,649 
Financial Products & Services   
378,140 
  9.5 %   
345,235 
  (4.2 )%   
360,509 



 


 

   
$
11,849,497 
  6.5 %   
$
11,124,213 
  14.3 %   
$
9,730,850 



 


 


Insurance Operations

     General

     The Company provides commercial property and casualty insurance products on a global basis. Products generally provide tailored coverages for complex corporate risks and are divided into two categories: risk management products and specialty lines products.

     Risk management products comprise global property and casualty insurance programs for large multinational companies and institutions and include umbrella liability, product recall, U.S. workers’ compensation, property catastrophe and primary master property and liability coverages. Risk management products generally provide large capacity on a primary, quota share or excess of loss basis. Risk management products are targeted to large worldwide companies in major industry groups including aerospace, automotive, consumer products, pharmaceutical, pulp and paper, high technology, telecommunications, transportation and basic metals. In North America, casualty business written is generally long-tail, umbrella and high layer excess business, meaning that the Company’s liability attaches after large deductibles, including self insurance or insurance from other companies. Primary casualty programs (including workers’ compensation) generally require customers to take large deductibles or self-insured retentions. Outside of North America, casualty business is also written on a primary basis. Policies are written on an occurrence, claims-made and occurrence reported basis. The Company’s property business written is short-tail by nature and written on both a primary and excess of loss basis. Property business written includes exposures to man-made and natural disasters, and generally, loss experience is characterized as low frequency and high severity. This may result in volatility in the Company’s results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

     Specialty lines products include professional liability insurance, environmental liability insurance, aviation and satellite insurance, marine and offshore energy insurance, equine, and other insurance coverages including program business.

2


     Professional liability insurance includes directors’ and officers’ liability, errors and omissions liability and employment practices liability coverages. Policies are written on both a primary and excess of loss basis. Directors’ and officers’ coverage includes primary and excess directors’ and officers’ liability, employment practices liability, company securities and private company directors’ and officers’ liability. Products are targeted at a variety of different sized companies, with a heavy concentration on small to medium-sized firms when written on a primary basis. Employment practices liability is written primarily for very large corporations and covers those firms for legal liability in regard to the treatment of employees. Errors and omissions coverage is written on a primary and excess basis. Errors and omissions insurance written on a primary basis is targeted to small to medium-sized firms and coverage is provided for various professional exposures, including, but not limited to, insurance brokers, consultants, architects and engineers, lawyers and real estate agents.

     Environmental liability products include pollution and remediation legal liability, general and project-specific pollution and professional liability, commercial general property redevelopment and contractor’s pollution liability. Business is written for both single and multiple years on a primary or excess of loss, claims-made or, less frequently, occurrence basis. Targeted industries include chemical facilities, environmental service firms, contractors, healthcare facilities, manufacturing facilities, real estate redevelopment, transportation and construction. The Company also offers commercial general liability and automobile liability insurance to environmental businesses.

     Aviation and satellite products include comprehensive airline hull and liability, airport liability, aviation manufacturers’ product liability, aviation ground handler liability, large aircraft hull and liability, corporate non-owned aircraft liability, space third party liability and satellite risk including damage or malfunction during ascent to orbit and continual operation, and aviation war. Aviation liability and physical damage coverage is offered for large aviation risks on a proportional basis, while smaller general aviation risks are offered on a primary basis. Satellite risks are generally written on a proportional basis. The target markets for aviation and satellite products include airlines, aviation product manufacturers, aircraft service firms, general aviation operators and telecommunications firms.

     Marine and offshore energy and equine insurance are also provided by the Company. Marine and energy coverage includes marine hull and machinery, marine war, marine excess liability, cargo and offshore energy insurance. Equine products specialize in providing bloodstock, livestock and fish farm insurance.

     The Company exited the surety business in mid-2005. Prior to that time, business was written on a broad range of surety products and services throughout North America, with a focus on contract, commercial and international trade surety bonds, targeting all segments of the construction marketplace. Surety products included bid, performance, payment, maintenance and supply bonds, commercial surety bonds, U.S. customs and international trade surety bonds, license bonds, permit bonds, court bonds, public official bonds and other miscellaneous bonds.

     The Company’s program business specializes in insurance coverages for distinct market segments in North America, including program administrators and managing general agents who operate in a specialized market niche and have unique industry backgrounds or specialized underwriting capabilities. Products encompass automobile extended warranty, intellectual property and trademark infringement, small commercial property catastrophe and other property and casualty coverage.

     The excess nature of many of the Company’s insurance products, coupled with historically large policy limits, results in a book of business that can have losses characterized as low frequency and high severity. As a result, large losses, though infrequent, can have a significant impact on the Company’s results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. The Company attempts to mitigate this risk by, among other things, using strict underwriting guidelines and various reinsurance arrangements, discussed below.

     U.S. Terrorism

     The U.S. Terrorism Risk Insurance Act of 2002, as amended, (“TRIA”) became effective on November 26, 2002 and was a three-year federal program effective through 2005. On December 22, 2005, President George Bush

3


signed a bill extending TRIA for two more years, continuing the program through 2007. TRIA voided in force terrorism exclusions as of November 26, 2002 for certified terrorism acts (i.e., those arising from international, not domestic acts) on all TRIA specified property and casualty business. TRIA requires covered insurers to make coverage available for certified acts of terrorism on all new and renewal policies issued after TRIA was enacted. TRIA allows the Company to assess a premium charge for terrorism coverage and, if the policyholder declines the coverage or fails to pay the buy-back premium, certified acts of terrorism may then be excluded from the policy, subject, however, to state specific requirements. Terrorism coverage cannot be excluded from workers’ compensation policies. Subject to a premium-based deductible and provided that the Company has otherwise complied with all the requirements as specified in TRIA, for each year this program is in effect, the Company is eligible for reimbursement by the Federal Government for up to 90% of its covered terrorism-related losses arising from a certified terrorist attack in 2005 and 2006, and up to 85% of such losses in 2007. Such payment by the government will, in effect, provide reinsurance protection on a quota share basis (with the government absorbing 90%, 90% and 85% of the loss and the applicable insurance company absorbing the remaining 10%, 10% and 15% in 2005, 2006 and 2007, respectively). Entitlement to such reimbursement ends once the aggregated insured losses for the entire insurance industry exceed $100 billion in a single program year. Once this $100 billion loss threshold has been reached for any program year, any insurer covered under TRIA that has met its deductible will not be responsible for any further loss payments in that program year.

     The Company had, prior to the passage of TRIA, underwritten exposures under certain insurance policies that included coverage for terrorism. The passage of TRIA has required the Company to make a mandatory offer of “Certified” terrorism coverage with respect to all of its TRIA covered insurance policies. In addition, the Company underwrites a number of policies providing terrorism coverage that are not subject to TRIA.

     Non-U.S. Terrorism

     The Company provides coverage for terrorism under casualty policies on a case-by-case basis, except with respect to workers’ compensation policies on which no terrorism exclusion of any type is permitted. However, the Company generally does not provide significant limits of coverage for terrorism under first party property policies outside of the U.S. unless required to do so by local law, or as required to comply with any national terrorism risk pool which may be available. Various countries have enacted legislation to provide insurance coverage for terrorism occurring within their borders, to protect registered property, and to protect citizens traveling abroad. The legislation typically requires registered direct insurers to provide terrorism coverage for specified coverage lines and then permits them to cede the risk to a national risk pool. The Company has subsidiaries that participate in terrorism risk pools in various jurisdictions, including Australia, France, Spain, The Netherlands and the United Kingdom.

     Underwriting

     The Company underwrites and prices most risks individually following a review of the exposure and in accordance with the Company’s underwriting guidelines. Most of the Company’s insurance operations have underwriting guidelines that are industry-specific. The Company seeks to control its exposure on an individual insurance contract through terms and conditions, policy limits and sublimits, attachment points, and facultative and treaty reinsurance arrangements on certain types of risks.

     The Company’s underwriters generally evaluate each industry category and subgroups within each category. Premiums are set and adjusted for an insured based, in large part, on the industry group in which the insured is placed and the insured’s perceived risk relative to the other risks in that group. Rates may vary significantly according to the industry group of the insured as well as the insured’s risk relative to the group. The Company’s rating methodology for individual insureds seeks to set premiums in accordance with claims potential as measured by past experience and future expectations, the attachment point and amount of underlying insurance, the nature and scope of the insured’s operations, including the industry group in which the insured operates, exposures to loss, natural hazard exposures,

4


risk management quality and other specific risk factors relevant in the judgment of the Company’s underwriters to the type of business being written.

     Underwriting and loss experience is reviewed regularly for, among other things, loss trends, emerging exposures, changes in the regulatory or legal environment as well as the efficacy of policy terms and conditions.

     As the Company’s insurance products are primarily specialized coverages, underwriting guidelines and policy forms differ by product offering as well as by legal jurisdiction. Liability insurance is written on both a primary and excess of loss basis, on occurrence, occurrence reported and claims-made policy forms. Occurrence reported policies typically cover occurrences causing unexpected and unintended personal injury or property damage to third parties arising from events or conditions that commence at or subsequent to an inception date, or retroactive date, if applicable (but not prior to January 1, 1986), and prior to the expiration of the policy provided that proper notice is given during the term of the policy or the discovery period. Traditional occurrence coverage is also available for restricted classes of risk and is generally written on a follow-form basis where the policy adopts the terms, conditions and exclusions of the underlying policy. Property insurance risks are written on a lead or follow-form basis that usually provides coverage for all risks of physical damage and business interruption. Maximum limits are generally subject to sublimits for coverage in critical earthquake zones, where the Company seeks to limit its liability in these areas.

     Reinsurance Ceded

     In certain cases, the risks assumed by the Company in the insurance segment are partially reinsured with third party reinsurers. Reinsurance ceded varies by location and line of business based on a number of factors, including market conditions. The benefits of ceding risks to third party reinsurers include reducing exposure on individual risks, protecting against catastrophic risks, maintaining acceptable capital ratios and enabling the writing of additional business. Reinsurance ceded does not legally discharge the Company from its liabilities to the original policyholder in respect of the risk being reinsured.

     The Company uses reinsurance to support the underwriting and retention guidelines of each of its subsidiaries as well as to control the aggregate exposure of the Company to a particular risk or class of risks. Reinsurance is purchased at several levels ranging from reinsurance of risks assumed on individual contracts to reinsurance covering the aggregate exposure on a portfolio of policies issued by groups of companies. See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

     Premiums

     Premium rates and underwriting terms and conditions for all lines of business written vary by jurisdiction principally due to local market conditions, competitor product offerings and legal requirements.

     The following table is an analysis of the insurance segment’s gross premiums written, net premiums written and net premiums earned from general operations, by line of business for the year ended December 31, 2005:

   
Gross 
Net 
Net 
   
Premiums 
Premiums 
Premiums 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Written 
Written 
Earned 


          

          

General Operations:   
   
   
 
   Professional liability   
$
1,630,090 
 
$
1,520,642   
$
1,451,183 
   Casualty insurance   
1,678,900 
 
1,139,402   
1,081,994 
   Property catastrophe   
157,492 
 
69,120   
57,027 
   Other property   
907,568 
 
594,433   
557,080 
   Marine, energy, aviation and satellite   
1,018,223 
 
741,050   
739,841 
   Accident and health   
1,266 
 
1,649   
1,692 
   Other (1)   
392,211 
 
181,809   
213,880 






Total   
$
5,785,750 
 
$
4,248,105   
$
4,102,697 








(1)      Other includes political risk, surety, bonding, warranty and other lines.

5


     Additional discussion and financial information about the Company’s insurance segment is set forth in Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8, Note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     Competition

     The Company competes globally in the property and casualty insurance markets. Its competitors include the following companies and their affiliates: The ACE Group of Companies (“ACE”); American International Group, Inc. (“AIG”); Factory Mutual Global (“FMG”) for Property only; Hartford Financial Services (“Hartford”); Lloyd’s of London Syndicates (“Lloyd’s”); Munchener Ruckversicherungs-Gesellschaft Aktiengesellschaft (“Munich Re”); Swiss Reinsurance Company (“Swiss Re”); The Chubb Corporation (“Chubb”); St. Paul/Travelers; and Zurich Financial Services Group (“Zurich”).

     The Company’s major geographical markets for its property and casualty insurance operations are North America, Europe and Bermuda. The Company’s main competitors in each of these markets include the following:

     North America – AIG, ACE, Chubb, FMG, Zurich, St. Paul/Travelers, CNA Financial Corporation, Hartford, Factory Mutual Insurance Company, Liberty Mutual Group and Lloyd’s.

     Europe – Allianz Aktiengesellschaft, AIG, FMG, Zurich, AXA, Munich Re, ACE, Lloyd’s, Swiss Re and Allgemeine Versicherungs-AG.

     Bermuda – ACE, Allied World Assurance Company, Axis Capital Group, Max Re Ltd., Endurance Specialty Insurance Ltd (“Endurance”), Arch Capital Group Ltd and Starr Excess Liability Insurance Co Ltd.

     See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations –Executive Overview” for further discussion.

     Marketing and Distribution

     Clients (insureds) are referred to the Company through a large number of international, national and regional brokers, acting as their agents, and captive managers who receive from the insured or ceding company a set fee or brokerage commission usually equal to a percentage of gross premiums. In the past, the Company has also entered into contingent commission arrangements with some intermediaries that provide for the payment of additional commissions based on such variables as production of new and renewal business or the retention of business. In general, the Company has no implied or explicit commitments to accept business from any particular broker and neither brokers nor any other third party have the authority to bind the Company, except in the case where underwriting authority may be delegated contractually to selected program administrators. Such administrators are subject to a financial and operational due diligence review prior to any such delegation of authority and ongoing reviews and audits are carried out as deemed necessary by the Company with the goal of assuring the continuing integrity of underwriting and related business operations. See Item 8, Note 18(a) to the Consolidated Financial Statements for information on the Company’s major brokers.

     Claims Administration

     Claims management for the insurance operations includes the review of initial loss reports, administration of claims databases, generation of appropriate responses to claims reports, identification and handling of coverage issues, determination of whether further investigation is required and, where appropriate, retention of claims counsel, establishment of case reserves, payment of claims and notification to reinsurers. With respect to the establishment of case reserves, when the Company is notified of insured losses, claims personnel record a case reserve as appropriate for the estimated amount of the exposure at that time. The estimate reflects the judgment of claims personnel based on general reserving practices, the experience and knowledge of such personnel regarding the nature of the specific claim

6


and, where appropriate, advice of counsel. Reserves are also established to provide for the estimated expense of settling claims, including legal and other fees and the general expenses of administering the claims adjustment process.

     Claims in respect of business written by the Company’s Lloyd’s syndicates are primarily notified by various central market bureaus. Where a syndicate is a “leading” syndicate on a Lloyd’s policy, its underwriters and claims adjusters will deal with the broker or insured on behalf of itself and the following market for any particular claim. This may involve appointing attorneys or loss adjusters. The claims bureaux and the leading syndicate advise movement in loss reserves to all syndicates participating on the risk. The Company’s claims department may adjust the case reserves it records from those advised by the bureaux as deemed necessary.

     Certain of the Company’s product lines have arrangements with third party administrators (“TPAs”) to provide claims handling services to the Company in respect of such product lines. These agreements set forth the duties of the TPA, limits of authority and various procedures that are required. These arrangements are also subject to audit review by the Company’s claim departments.

Reinsurance Operations

     General

     The Company provides casualty, property, property catastrophe, marine, aviation, accident and health, and other specialty reinsurance and life and annuity products on a global basis with business being written on both a proportional and non-proportional basis. Business written on a non-proportional basis generally provides for an indemnification by the Company of the ceding company for a portion of the losses on policies in excess of a specified loss amount. For business written on a proportional or “quota share” basis, the Company receives an agreed percentage of the premium and is liable for the same percentage of the incurred losses. The ceding company receives a commission based upon premiums ceded and may also, under certain circumstances, receive a profit commission. Reinsurance may be written on a treaty or facultative basis.

     The Company’s casualty reinsurance includes general liability, professional liability, automobile and workers’ compensation. Professional liability includes directors’ and officers’, employment practices, medical malpractice, and environmental liability. Casualty lines are written as treaties or programs on both a proportional and a non-proportional basis as well as individual risk business written on a facultative basis. The treaty business includes clash programs which cover a number of underlying policies involved in one occurrence or a judgment above an underlying policy’s limit, before suffering a loss. The treaty business is mainly written using reinsurance intermediaries while the individual risk business is generally sold directly to the ceding companies.

     The Company’s property business, primarily short-tail in nature, is written on both a treaty and facultative basis and includes property catastrophe, property excess of loss and property proportional. A significant portion of the property business underwritten consists of large aggregate exposures to man-made and natural disasters and, generally, loss experience is characterized as low frequency and high severity. This may result in volatility in the Company’s results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

     The Company seeks to manage its reinsurance exposures to catastrophic events by limiting the amount of exposure in each geographic or peril zone worldwide, underwriting in excess of varying attachment points and requiring that its property catastrophe contracts provide for aggregate limits. The Company also seeks to protect its aggregate exposures by peril and zone through the purchase of reinsurance programs. See “– Risk Management” for further information.

     The Company’s property catastrophe reinsurance account is generally “all risk” in nature. As a result, the Company is exposed to losses from sources as diverse as hurricanes and other windstorms, earthquakes, freezing, riots, floods, industrial explosions, fires, and many other potential disasters. In accordance with market practice, the Company’s policies generally exclude certain risks such as war, nuclear contamination or radiation. Following the

7


terrorist attacks at the World Trade Center in New York City, in Washington, D.C. and in Pennsylvania on September 11, 2001 (collectively, “the September 11 event”), terrorism cover, including nuclear, biological and chemical, has also been excluded in many territories and classes. The Company’s predominant exposure under such coverage is to property damage.

     Property catastrophe reinsurance provides coverage on an excess of loss basis when aggregate losses and loss adjustment expenses from a single occurrence of a covered event exceed the attachment point specified in the policy. Some of the Company’s property catastrophe contracts limit coverage to one occurrence in any single policy year, but most contracts generally enable one reinstatement to be purchased by the reinsured.

     The Company also writes property risk excess of loss reinsurance. Property risk excess of loss reinsurance covers a loss to the reinsured on a single risk of the type reinsured rather than to aggregate losses for all covered risks on a specific peril, as is the case with catastrophe reinsurance. The Company’s property proportional account includes reinsurance of direct property insurance. The Company seeks to limit the catastrophe exposure from its proportional and per risk excess business through extensive use of occurrence and cession limits.

     Other specialty reinsurance products include energy, fidelity, trade credit and political risk.

     The Company had, prior to the passing of TRIA, underwritten reinsurance exposures in the U.S. that included terrorism coverage. Since the passage of TRIA in the U.S., the Company has underwritten a very limited number of stand-alone terrorism coverage policies in addition to coverage included within non-stand-alone policies. In the U.S., in addition to nuclear, biological and chemical (“NBC”) acts, the Company generally excludes coverage included under TRIA from the main catastrophe exposed policies. In other cases, both within and outside the U.S., the Company generally relies on either a terrorism exclusion clause, which does not include personal lines, excluding NBC, or a similar clause that excludes terrorism completely. There are a limited number of classes underwritten where no terrorism exclusion exists.

     The Company’s accident and health products include accidental death, medical, hospital indemnity and income protection coverage.

     The Company underwrites a small portfolio of contracts covering political risk and trade credit. Exposure is assumed from a limited number of trade credit contracts and through Lloyd’s quota shares. In addition, there are runoff exposures from discontinued writings in the Company’s marine portfolio.

     Life and Annuity

     The Company’s reinsurance segment also currently includes life reinsurance primarily in respect of European lives, and is developing a U.S. platform. This includes term assurances, group life, critical illness cover, immediate annuities and disability income business. The majority of the business written is on a proportional basis. The Company has also written a few large contracts comprising portfolios of closed blocks of U.K. and European annuities. In relation to certain of these contracts, the Company receives cash and investment assets at the inception of the contract relating to future policy benefit reserves assumed. These contracts are long-term in nature where the expected claims payout period can span thirty to forty years.

     Underwriting

     Underwriting risks for the general and life and annuity reinsurance business are evaluated using a number of factors including, but not limited to, the type and layer of risk to be assumed, the actuarial evaluation of premium adequacy, the cedent’s underwriting and claims experience, the cedent’s financial condition and claims paying rating, the exposure and/or experience with the cedent, and the line of business to be reinsured.

     Other factors assessed by the Company include the reputation of the proposed cedent, the geographic area in which the cedent does business and its market share, a detailed evaluation of catastrophe and risk exposures, and historical loss data for the cedent where available and for the industry as a whole in the relevant regions, in order to

8


compare the cedent’s historical loss experience to industry averages. On-site underwriting reviews are performed where it is deemed necessary to determine the quality of a current or prospective cedent’s underwriting operations, with particular emphasis on proportional and working excess of loss placements.

     For property catastrophe reinsurance business, the Company’s underwriting guidelines generally limit the amount of exposure it will directly underwrite for any one reinsured and the amount of the aggregate exposure to catastrophic losses in any one geographic zone. The Company believes that it has defined geographic and peril zones such that a single occurrence, for example an earthquake or hurricane, should not affect more than one peril zone. While the exposure to multiple zones is considered remote for events such as a hurricane, the Company does manage its aggregate exposures for such a scenario where the Company considers it appropriate to do so. The definition of the Company’s peril zones is subject to periodic review. The Company also generally seeks an attachment point for its property catastrophe reinsurance at a level that is high enough to produce a low frequency of loss. The Company seeks to limit its aggregate exposure in the proportional business through extensive use of occurrence and cession limits.

     Reinsurance Retroceded

     The Company uses third party reinsurance to support the underwriting and retention guidelines of each reinsurance subsidiary as well as to seek to limit the aggregate exposure of the Company to a particular risk or class of risks. Reinsurance is purchased at several levels ranging from reinsurance of risks assumed on individual contracts to reinsurance covering the aggregate exposures. The benefits of ceding risks to other reinsurers include reducing exposure on individual risks, protecting against catastrophic risks, maintaining acceptable capital ratios and enabling the writing of additional business. Reinsurance ceded does not legally discharge the Company from its liabilities in respect of the risk being reinsured. Reinsurance ceded varies by location and line of business based on factors including, among others, market conditions.

     A full review of the Company’s property catastrophe exposures was completed in the spring of 2004 to optimize the economics against the management of such risks. A traditional program incepting between May and July 2004 and renewing annually was put in place to cover these exposures. These covers give protection in various layers and excess of varying attachment points according to territorial exposure. The Company has co-reinsurance retentions within this program. The program was renewed with June and July 2005 inception dates providing similar amounts of total coverage and an additional structure was purchased with restricted territorial scope with an August 2005 inception date.

     A new reinsurance program was purchased incepting at January 2005 to provide additional protection for the Company’s marine and offshore energy exposures. These covers provide protection in various layers and excess of varying attachment points according to the scope of cover provided. The Company has co-reinsurance participations within this program.

     The Company’s casualty reinsurance program includes cover for multiple claims arising from three or more risks from a single occurrence or event. This layer was renewed in October 2004 and again in October 2005 with limits of $25 million excess of $20 million and covers all business written out of the Company’s London and Sydney branches as well as XL Re Europe.

     The Company also buys specific reinsurance on its property and aviation portfolios to manage its net exposures in these classes.

     See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8, Note 10 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.

9


     Premiums

     The following table is an analysis of the reinsurance segment’s gross premiums written, net premiums written and net premiums earned from general and life and annuity operations, by line of business for the year ended December 31, 2005:

   
Gross 
Net 
Net 
   
Premiums 
Premiums 
Premiums 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Written 
Written 
Earned 


          

          

General Operations:   
   
   
 
   Professional liability   
$
346,758 
$
343,562 
$
356,937 
   Casualty   
861,113 
810,971 
858,651 
   Property catastrophe   
481,765 
309,293 
302,291 
   Other property   
1,008,333 
724,837 
701,459 
   Marine, energy, aviation and satellite   
241,045 
192,445 
194,646 
   Accident and health   
23,919 
24,293 
31,399 
   Other (1)   
448,154 
370,605 
325,558 






   Total general operations   
3,411,087 
2,776,006 
2,770,941 
Life and annuity operations   
2,274,520 
2,236,903 
2,237,721 






Total   
$
5,685,607 
$
5,012,909 
$
5,008,662 








(1)      Other includes political risk, surety, bonding, warranty and other lines.

     Additional discussion and financial information about the reinsurance segment is set forth in Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8, Note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     Competition

     The Company competes globally in the property and casualty markets. Its competitors include the following companies and their affiliates: ACE Tempest Reinsurance, Ltd (“Tempest”); Lloyd’s; Munich Re; St. Paul/Travelers; Swiss Re; PartnerRe Ltd; ERC; Transatlantic Reinsurance Company (“Transatlantic Re”); and Everest Re.

     The Company’s major geographical markets for its property and casualty general reinsurance operations are North America, Europe and Bermuda. The main competitors in each of these markets include the following:

     

North America – General Re Corporation, American Re Corporation, Swiss Re America Corporation, Transatlantic Re, Everest Re Group Ltd, GE Reinsurance Corp., Endurance, and PartnerRe Ltd.

Europe – Munich Re, Swiss Re, Lloyd’s, General Cologne Re, SCOR Reinsurance Company, PartnerRe Ltd and ERC Frankona.

Bermuda – ACE Tempest Reinsurance Ltd, AXIS Specialty Limited, Arch Reinsurance Limited, Renaissance Reinsurance Limited, Montpelier Reinsurance Ltd, Platinum Underwriters Bermuda Ltd and Partner Reinsurance Company Ltd.

     The Company’s major geographical market for its life reinsurance operations is Europe and the main competitors in this market include Reinsurance Group of America, Inc., Munich Re, ERC, General Cologne Re, Swiss Re and Hannover Life Re.

     See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations –Executive Overview” for further discussion.

     Marketing and Distribution

     See Insurance Operations – “Marketing and Distribution” and Item 8, Note 18(a) to the Consolidated Financial Statements for information in the Company’s marketing and distribution procedures and information on the

10


Company’s major brokers. In addition, for life reinsurance operations the majority of business is written directly with the ceding company rather than through a broker.

     Claims Administration

     Claims management for the reinsurance operations includes the receipt of loss notifications, review and approval of claims through a claims approval process, establishment of loss reserves and approval of loss payments. Case reserves for reported claims are generally established based on reports received from ceding companies with additional case reserves being established when deemed appropriate. Additionally, claims audits are conducted for specific claims and claims procedures at the offices of selected ceding companies, particularly in the U.S. and U.K.

Financial Products and Services Operations

     General

     Financial Products and Services provides (i) credit protection through the issuance of financial guaranty insurance policies and credit default swaps, as well as the reinsurance thereof, (ii) a wide range of structured financial and alternative risk transfer products, (iii) guaranteed investment contracts and funding agreements, (iv) political risk insurance and (v) weather and energy risk management products. Many of the products offered by the Financial Products and Services segment are unique and tailored to the specific needs of the insured or user.

     Financial guaranty insurance provides an unconditional and irrevocable guaranty to the holder of a debt obligation of full and timely payment of principal and interest. In the event of a default under the obligation, the insurer has recourse against the issuer and/or any related collateral (which is more common in the case of insured asset-backed obligations or other non-municipal debt) for amounts paid under the terms of the policy. Credit default swaps are derivative contracts which offer credit protection relating to a particular security or pools of specified securities. Under the terms of a credit default swap, the seller of credit protection makes a specified payment to the buyer of credit protection upon the occurrence of one or more specified credit events with respect to a referenced security. Credit derivatives typically provide protection to a buyer rather than credit enhancement of an issue as in traditional financial guaranty insurance. The Company’s underwriting policies restrict the provision of credit protection to obligations or referenced securities that it determines would be of investment-grade quality without the benefit of credit enhancement provided by the Company through the issuance of its insurance policies and credit default swaps. The Company classifies the financial guaranty policies underwritten in four broad categories: asset-backed structured finance, public finance obligations, essential infrastructure project finance transactions and future flow obligations. Each category contains risks and structures that are unique to the underlying obligation. Asset-backed obligations insured or reinsured by the Company are generally issued in structured transactions backed by pools of assets of specified types, such as residential mortgages, auto loans and other consumer receivables, equipment leases and corporate debt obligations, having an ascertainable cash flow or market value. Public finance obligations insured or reinsured consist mainly of general or special obligations of state and local governments, supported by the issuer’s ability to charge taxes or fees for specified services or projects. Essential infrastructure project finance obligations underwritten by the Company include projects such as bridges, toll roads, airports and power plants. Future flow obligations are backed by receivables from the future sales of commodities or the processing of payments received by financial institutions.

     Structured financial and alternative risk transfer products cover complex financial risks, including property, casualty, mortality insurance and reinsurance and business enterprise risk management products. Refer to XL Financial Solutions below.

     Guaranteed investment contracts are customized financial products that offer a guaranteed investment return to the purchaser, generally a municipal entity that raises funds for a particular project and invests such funds pending their drawdown to complete the project. Funding agreements are investment contracts sold to institutional investors. The Company sells funding agreements either directly to qualified institutional buyers or to special purpose entities which, in turn, issue medium term notes to fixed income investors. Municipal investment contracts and funding agreements provide users guaranteed rates of interest on amounts deposited with the Company. The Company has investment risk related to its ability to generate sufficient investment income to enable the total invested assets to cover the payment of its estimated ultimate liability on such agreements.

11


     Political risk insurance generally covers risks arising from expropriation, currency inconvertibility, contract frustration, non-payment and war on land or political violence (including terrorism) in developing regions of the world. Political risk insurance is typically provided to financial institutions, equity investors, exporters, importers, export credit agencies and multilateral agencies in connection with investments and contracts in emerging market countries. Through December 31, 2005, the majority of such insurance has been written through a managing general agent, Sovereign Risk Insurance Ltd. (“Sovereign”), in which the Company is a joint venture partner. On January 23, 2006, the Company announced that it would be selling its interest in Sovereign and no longer writing the business produced by it effective February 1, 2006. This transaction is subject to execution of final documentation and regulatory approvals. The in force business written by the Company through January 31, 2006 will be run-off by the Company. The Company’s own political risk underwriting team will continue to underwrite such business subsequent to February 1, 2006.

     The Company’s weather and energy risk management products are customized solutions designed to assist corporate customers, primarily energy companies and utilities, manage their financial exposure to variations in underlying weather conditions and related energy markets. Weather risk management contracts generally average one season (five months) in duration. The Company uses the capital markets to hedge portions of the risks it has underwritten. The Company continued to grow its contingent power generator outage insurance business. The outage insurance product protects utilities so that in the event of a generator failure, the cost of purchasing replacement electricity above a previously established strike price in the power markets is covered. The Company utilizes markets in electricity, but does not actively trade weather or energy derivatives.

     Underwriting

     The Company has underwriting guidelines for the various products and asset classes comprising its credit enhancement business, which include single and aggregate risk limitations on specified exposures. A credit committee provides final underwriting approval. The Company’s underwriting policy is to credit enhance obligations and exposures that would otherwise be rated in lower investment grade categories. The Company’s other activities may occasionally structure and underwrite non-investment grade risks.

     For the weather and energy business, the Company has seasonal value at risk (“VaR”) limits for weather and electricity generator outage exposures.

     Individual funding agreements are issued in the context of the overall cash flow structure of the asset/liability portfolio, taking into consideration the impact of each new funding agreement offering on the overall risk position of the Company.

     With respect to the guaranteed investment contract business, the Company underwrites the cash flow risks associated with each contract and continually monitors each contract’s performance. The Company utilizes underwriting guidelines to assess risks and internal cash flow and asset liability models to price each contract. The Company focuses on reinvestment opportunities associated with municipal bond issuers.

     Reinsurance Ceded

     Similar to the Company as a whole, the financial products and services operations utilize outwards reinsurance for single risk and portfolio management purposes. The Company has retroceded risks on a facultative basis to third party reinsurers to provide greater flexibility to manage large single risks and reduce concentrations in specific bond sectors or geographic regions. For the weather and energy risk management business, the Company more often uses derivatives rather than reinsurance to hedge or mitigate its primary exposure, but will use reinsurance as well, if deemed appropriate. For the political risk and structured and alternative risk management businesses, the Company has retroceded certain risks on a facultative basis to reduce overall exposure to large market events.

12


     Premiums

     The following table provides a line of business breakdown of the Financial Products and Services segment’s net premiums earned:

   
Year ended December 31 





(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005 
2004 
2003 


          

          

Financial Guaranty   
$
173,133   
$
183,422   
$
154,133 
Political Risk    25,906    27,938    28,886 
Other (1)    55,097    17,538    12,325 






    254,136    228,898    195,344 
 







(1)      Includes structured property and casualty and alternative risk transfer products and weather and energy risk management products.

     Additional discussion and financial information about the financial products and services segment is set forth in Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8, Note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     Competition

     The principal competitors in the municipal and asset-backed insured markets include other triple-A rated and, to a lesser extent, double-A rated monoline financial guarantors and multiline insurance companies and banks. The principal triple-A monoline insurers include MBIA Inc. (“MBIA”), Ambac Financial Group, Inc. (“Ambac”), Financial Guaranty Insurance Company (“FGIC”) and Financial Security Assurance Holdings Ltd (“FSA”). There are also many means by which issuers may borrow money without using third party credit enhancement. For example, structured financings may be executed by issuing senior and subordinated tranches of debt that effectively substitute for third party enhancement. Additionally, issuers may raise debt financing by issuing corporate debt or by borrowing from banks. Such alternatives effectively constitute a form of competition for financial guaranty insurance companies.

     With respect to the structured and alternative risk management business, competition is encountered from a broad range of multiline reinsurers. Other political risk reinsurers include AIG, Zurich, Chubb and ACE.

     With respect to the Company’s weather and energy risk management business, competition is encountered in both the U.S. and on a worldwide basis from companies within the energy, insurance and, to an increasing extent, the financial services sector. Among the principal competitive factors affecting the Company’s weather and energy business are its financial strength ratings, its capability in originating, marketing, structuring and executing innovative products and services, its relative pricing and its ability and willingness to hedge all or a portion of such risks.

     With respect to the Company’s guaranteed investment contract business, competitors include financial institutions in the banking, investment banking, life insurance and financial guaranty industries. These include Aegon, AIG, Bayerische Landesbank (“BLB”), Caisse des Depots et Consignations, FSA and MBIA.

     Marketing and Distribution

     Marketing of the Company’s financial guaranty business is targeted based on the type and stage of completion of the transaction. Targeted parties include investment bankers, issuers of and investors in credit-enhanced transactions and concessionaires in certain transactions. Other financial guaranty insurers or reinsurers or other counterpar-ties may also be a source of new business, particularly with respect to reinsurance.

     With respect to the Company’s weather and energy risk management business, new clients are acquired through direct marketing but may also be referred through a number of brokers who receive a fee that is based on the size of the transaction. The Company’s main clients are in the energy and financial services sector.

13


     Structured and alternative risk management business is principally originated through specialist intermediaries. Clients are the risk managers for corporations as well as the outwards reinsurance teams for a range of geographically diverse insurers. Origination for the political risk book is also primarily through specialist brokers while the client base is financial institutions, equity investors, exporters, importers, export credit agencies and multilateral agencies.

     The guaranteed investment contract business is mainly originated through specialized brokers. Funding agreements are typically sold through and distributed by investment banks.

     Claims Administration

     Claims management for the financial guaranty business includes the identification of potential claims through systematic surveillance of the insured portfolio, the establishment of reserves for losses that are both probable and estimable, the accounting for loss adjustment expenses, the receipt of claims, the approval of claim payments and the notification to reinsurers. Surveillance also involves proactive efforts to prevent or mitigate potential claims once they are identified. If a claim is paid, recoveries will be sought based on the security pledged under the policy.

     With respect to the Company’s weather and energy business, claims management includes the identification of potential claims through review of underlying weather conditions and unit outages within the insured portfolio, the establishment of reserves for losses that are probable and estimable, loss adjustment expenses, the receipt of claims, the approval of claim payments and the notification of claims to reinsurers.

     The majority of the claims management of the political risk business has been handled by Sovereign, with the balance administered internally using the same guidelines as detailed within the Insurance segment operations.

     Claims administration and notification for structured and alternative risk business is principally handled by third party administrators, and claims are settled following a review of the claim detail and verification of its validity.

     XL Financial Solutions

     Structured financial and alternative risk transfer products are structured and managed through the Company’s financial solutions operations (“XLFS”). XLFS structures a wide range of structured financial products and alternative risk transfer transactions, including property and casualty insurance and reinsurance, asset backed securitizations and market risk management transactions. Most transactions originated through XLFS have multi-year exposures, with many transactions having durations in excess of ten years.

Geographic Areas

     See Item 8, Notes 3 and 24 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Risk Management

     The Company seeks to manage all of its risks on an enterprise wide basis. The Company’s senior management takes an active role in the enterprise risk management process and has developed and implemented policies and procedures that require specific administrative and business functions to assist in the identification, assessment and management of all current and emerging risks pertaining to the Company’s activities including market, credit, underwriting, operational and legal risks. The Company has a Risk Management Committee which in conjunction with the Executive Management Board, acts to ensure major risks are being managed with an “enterprise wide” perspective. Due to the changing nature of the risk landscape and global marketplace, the Company’s risk management policies, procedures and methodologies are constantly evolving and are subject to ongoing review and modification. Senior management provides regular updates on major risk exposures to the Finance and Audit Committee’s of the Board of Directors. See Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk” for further discussion.

     Aggregate exposures to potential catastrophic events, including natural catastrophes are managed at an entity level and also at the corporate level. In addition to internal controls designed to mitigate the Company’s exposure to a

14


specific event or class of business, the Company maintains various reinsurance programs that help protect the Company against foreseeable catastrophic and other types of risks.

     Under its reinsurance security policy, the Company seeks to cede business to reinsurers generally rated “A” or better by Standard & Poor’s, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. (“S&P”), or, in the case of Lloyd’s syndicates, “B+” from Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”). The Company’s Chief Risk Officer considers reinsurers that are not rated or do not fall within the above rating categories and may grant exceptions to the Company’s general policy on a case-by-case basis. See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8, Note 10 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.

     As part of risk management, the Company also has several credit committees and underwriting/transaction committees that meet regularly to review the terms and conditions of certain proposed new transactions.

Unpaid Losses and Loss Expenses

     Certain aspects of the Company’s business have loss experience characterized as low frequency and high severity. This may result in volatility in the Company’s results of operations, financial condition and liquidity.

     Loss reserves are established due to the significant periods of time that may lapse between the occurrence, reporting and payment of a loss. To recognize liabilities for unpaid losses and loss expenses, the Company estimates future amounts needed to pay claims and related expenses with respect to insured events. The Company’s reserving practices and the establishment of any particular reserve reflect management’s judgment concerning sound financial practice and do not represent any admission of liability with respect to any claim. Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves are established for reported claims (“case reserves”) and incurred but not reported (“IBNR”) claims.

     The nature of the Company’s high excess of loss liability and catastrophe business can result in loss payments that are both irregular and significant. Similarly, adjustments to reserves for individual years can be irregular and significant. Such adjustments are part of the normal course of business for the Company. Conditions and trends that have affected development of liabilities in the past may not necessarily occur in the future. Accordingly, it is inappropriate to extrapolate future redundancies or deficiencies based upon historical experience. See generally, Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.”

     The tables below present the development of unpaid losses and loss expense reserves related to the Company’s general and financial operations on both a net and gross basis. The cumulative redundancy (deficiency) calculated on a net basis differs from that calculated on a gross basis. As different reinsurance programs cover different underwriting years, net and gross loss experience will not develop proportionately. The top line of the tables shows the estimated liability, net of reinsurance recoveries, as at the year end balance sheet date for each of the indicated years. This represents the estimated amounts of losses and loss expenses, including IBNR, arising in the current and all prior years that are unpaid at the year end balance sheet date of the indicated year. The tables show the re-estimated amount of the previously recorded reserve liability based on experience as of the year end balance sheet date of each succeeding year. The estimate changes as more information becomes known about the frequency and severity of claims for individual years. The cumulative redundancy (deficiency) represents the aggregate change with respect to that liability originally estimated. The lower portion of the first table also reflects the cumulative paid losses relating to these reserves. Conditions and trends that have affected development of liabilities in the past may not necessarily occur in the future. Accordingly, it may not be appropriate to extrapolate redundancies or deficiencies into the future, based on the tables below. See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.”

15


Analysis of Consolidated Losses and Loss Expense Reserve Development
Net of Reinsurance Recoveries
                                                         
(U.S. dollars in millions)   
1995 
1996 
1997 
1998 
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2004
2005 










 

 

 

 

 

 

ESTIMATED LIABILITY FOR UNPAID                                             
   LOSSES AND LOSS EXPENSES,                                             
   NET OF REINSURANCE RECOVERABLES    $ 2,899    $ 3,166    $ 3,609    $ 4,303    $ 4,537     $ 4,207     $ 7,004     $ 8,313     $ 10,721     $ 12,875     $ 17,355 
LIABILITY RE-ESTIMATED AS OF:                                             
One year later    2,885    2,843    3,354    4,016    4,142     4,382     7,404     9,250     10,989     13,989      
Two years later    2,546    2,704    3,038    3,564    4,085     4,345     8,423     9,717     12,032          
Three years later    2,445    2,407    2,737    3,580    4,120     5,118     8,653     10,723              
Four years later    2,214    2,227    2,658    3,461    4,624     5,294     9,727                  
Five years later    2,050    2,144    2,505    3,742    4,747     5,435                      
Six years later    2,010    2,026    2,663    3,774    4,858                          
Seven years later    1,915    2,115    2,704    3,872                             
Eight years later    1,983    2,146    2,793                                 
Nine years later    1,981    2,198                                     
Ten years later    2,020                                         
CUMULATIVE REDUNDANCY                                             
   (DEFICIENCY) (1)    879    968    816    431    (321 )    (1,228 )    (2,723 )    (2,410 )    (1,311 )    (1,114 )     
CUMULATIVE PAID LOSSES, NET OF                                             
   REINSURANCE RECOVERIES, AS OF:                                             
One year later    $ 445    $ 234    $ 458    $ 812    $ 1,252     $ 1,184     $ 2,011     $ 2,521     $ 1,985     $ 2,008      
Two years later    667    576    932    1,594    1,828     1,920     3,984     3,800     2,867          
Three years later    934    932    1,404    1,928    2,306     2,683     4,703     4,163              
Four years later    1,143    1,235    1,525    2,249    2,824     3,038     4,641                  
Five years later    1,356    1,313    1,732    2,555    3,035     3,290                      
Six years later    1,408    1,466    1,903    2,741    2,807                          
Seven years later    1,485    1,603    2,085    2,856                             
Eight years later    1,601    1,749    2,187                                 
Nine years later    1,674    1,826                                     
Ten years later    1,716                                         

(1)      See Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” for further discussion.      
 
Analysis of Consolidated Losses and Loss Expense Reserve Development
Gross of Reinsurance Recoverables
 
(U.S. dollars in millions)   
1995 
1996 
1997 
1998 
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2004
2005 










 

 

 

 

 

 

ESTIMATED GROSS LIABILITY FOR UNPAID                                             
   LOSSES AND LOSS EXPENSES    $ 3,238    $ 3,623    $ 3,972    $ 4,897    $ 5,369     $ 5,668     $ 11,807     $ 13,333     $ 16,763     $ 19,838     $ 23,768 
LIABILITY RE-ESTIMATED AS OF:                                             
One year later    3,244    3,221    3,763    4,735    5,266     6,118     12,352     15,204     18,399     20,209      
Two years later    2,872    3,164    3,496    4,352    5,147     6,105     14,003     16,994     18,730          
Three years later    2,793    2,902    3,243    4,316    5,176     6,909     15,377     17,210              
Four years later    2,572    2,753    3,139    4,232    5,663     7,086     15,441                  
Five years later    2,415    2,663    2,979    4,508    5,798     7,240                      
Six years later    2,379    2,564    3,132    4,568    5,890                          
Seven years later    2,327    2,650    3,181    4,658                             
Eight years later    2,393    2,673    3,266                                 
Nine years later    2,379    2,714                                     
Ten years later    2,397                                         
CUMULATIVE REDUNDANCY                                             
   (DEFICIENCY)    841    909    706    239    (521 )    (1,572 )    (3,634 )    (3,877 )    (1,967 )    (371 )     

16


     The following table presents an analysis of paid, unpaid and incurred losses and loss expenses for the Company’s general and financial operations and a reconciliation of beginning and ending unpaid losses and loss expenses for the years indicated:

Reconciliation of Unpaid Losses and Loss Expenses

(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
Unpaid losses and loss expenses at beginning of year   
$
19,837,669    
$
16,763,124    
$
13,332,502  
Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable    (6,962,131 )    (6,042,505 )    (5,019,311 ) 


 

 

 
Net unpaid losses and loss expenses at beginning of year    12,875,538     10,720,619     8,313,191  
Increase (decrease) in net losses and loss expenses incurred in respect             
   of losses occurring in:             
   Current year    6,351,281     4,643,894     3,759,142  
   Prior years    1,113,720     267,594     937,285  


 

 

 
Total net incurred losses and loss expenses    7,465,001     4,911,488     4,696,427  
Exchange rate effects    (375,749 )    309,768     394,121  
Net loss reserves acquired            199,164  
Less net losses and loss expenses paid in respect of losses occurring in:             
   Current year    602,153     1,081,547     360,767  
   Prior years    2,007,613     1,984,790     2,521,517  


 

 

 
       Total net paid losses    2,609,766     3,066,337     2,882,284  
Net unpaid losses and loss expenses at end of year    17,355,024     12,875,538     10,720,619  
Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable    6,412,648     6,962,131     6,042,505  


 

 

 
Unpaid losses and loss expenses at end of year   
$
23,767,672    
$
19,837,669    
$
16,763,124  


 

 

 

     The Company’s net unpaid losses and losses expense reserves broken down by operating segment at December 31, 2005 and 2004 was as follows:

(U.S. dollars in millions) 
December 31, 2005 
 
December 31, 2004 








Insurance   
$
9,860       
$
6,975   
Reinsurance   
7,212       
5,695   
Financial products and services   
283       
205   




 
Net unpaid loss and loss expense reserves   
$
17,355       
$
12,875   




 

Current year net losses incurred

     Current year net losses incurred in 2005 increased from 2004 due primarily to the impact of Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma being greater than that of the 2004 Atlantic hurricanes. There was a relatively low level of catastrophic events affecting the Company in 2003.

     Collectively, Hurricanes Katrina, Rita, Wilma and other smaller natural catastrophes in the third and fourth quarters of 2005 have had a substantial impact on the results of the Company for the year ended December 31, 2005. The Company has estimated losses incurred, net of reinsurance recoveries, of $1.27 billion, $357.9 million, $247.1 and $96.0 million related to Hurricane Katrina, Rita, Wilma, and the combined impact of the other catastrophes, respectively, based on preliminary reports and estimates to loss and damage.

     The 2004 Atlantic hurricane season resulted in four insured hurricane losses aggregating to what was at the time the largest seasonal loss in history and had a substantial impact on the results of the Company for that year. For the four hurricane losses, the Company incurred in 2004 net losses of $516.6 million, net of reinsurance recoverables.

17


Prior year net losses incurred

     The following tables present the development of the Company’s gross and net, losses and loss expense reserves for its general and financial operations. The tables also show the estimated reserves at the beginning of each fiscal year and the favorable or adverse development (prior year development) of those reserves during such fiscal year.

Gross   
   
   
 
(U.S. dollars in millions)   
2005 
2004 
2003 


          

          

Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves at the beginning of the year   
$
19,838   
$
16,763   
$
13,333 
Net adverse development of those reserves during the year   
371   
1,636   
1,871 






Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves re-estimated one year later   
$
20,209   
$
18,399   
$
15,204 






 
Net   
   
   
(U.S. dollars in millions)   
2005   
2004   
2003 






Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves at the beginning of the year   
$
12,875   
$
10,721   
$
8,313 
Net adverse development of those reserves during the year   
1,114   
268   
937 






Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves re-estimated one year later   
$
13,989   
$
10,989   
$
9,250 







     As different reinsurance programs cover different underwriting years, contracts and lines of business, net and gross loss experience do not develop proportionately. In particular, gross adverse development in 2004 related primarily to the acquired Winterthur International insurance operations (the “Winterthur Business”), which was reinsured through the post closing protection referred to below.

     The following table presents the net adverse (favorable) prior years loss development of the Company’s loss and loss expense reserves for its general and financial operations by each operating segment for each of the years indicated:

(U.S. dollars in millions)   
2005 
2004
2003
 


          

            

 
Insurance Segment   
$
1,020   
$
292    
$
153  
Reinsurance Segment   
94   
(24 )   
799  
Financial Products and Services Segment   
   
   
(15 ) 




 

 
   Total   
$
1,114   
$
268    
$
937  




 

 


     Prior years net adverse development in 2005 was impacted by the unfavorable conclusion of the independent actuarial process with Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company, as $834.2 million of reinsurance recoverables related to post closing protection on the acquired Winterthur Business were rendered uncollectible. In addition the Company incurred higher than expected development relating to U.S. casualty and professional reinsurance businesses of $267.0 million and excess professional liability insurance lines of business of $259.5 million. Partially offsetting this adverse development were releases of $211.6 million in reinsurance and insurance property lines of business globally and to a lesser degree casualty insurance business written on the Company’s European Global Risk platform.

     Prior years net adverse development in 2004, related primarily to increases in reported insurance case reserves for excess professional liability, excess casualty and specialty lines.

     See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8, Note 9 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information regarding the developments in prior year loss reserve estimates for each of the years indicated within each of the Company’s operating segments.

Net loss reserves acquired

There were no net loss reserves acquired in 2005 or 2004.

18


     Net loss reserves acquired in 2003 of $199.2 million included $85.2 million related to the Company’s Lloyd’s operation in connection with the closure of the Lloyd’s 2000 underwriting year where reserves and cash were transferred to the Company’s Lloyd’s Syndicates. The Company did not provide 100% of the Syndicate capacity for the 2000 underwriting year. In addition, $114.0 million related to the settlement of the purchase price in December 2003 for the acquisition of certain Winterthur International insurance operations. In connection with the settlement, the Company updated the fair value of the net assets acquired as of this date and reduced the estimated amount of unpaid losses recoverable from the Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company (“WSIC”) under the Sale and Purchase Agreement, as amended, between XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and WSIC. For further information see Item 8, Note 5(b) to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Exchange rate effects

     Exchange rate effects on net loss reserves in each of the three years ended December 31, 2005 related to the global operations of the Company where several operations have a functional currency that is not the U.S. dollar. The increase in the value of the U.S. dollar in 2005 and the reduction in the value of the U.S. dollar during the two preceding years mainly compared to the Swiss franc, U.K. sterling and the Euro has given rise to translation and revaluation exchange movements of $(375.7) million, $309.8 million and $394.1 million in 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively.

Net paid losses

     Total net paid losses were $2.6 billion in 2005 and $3.1 billion and $2.9 billion in 2004 and 2003, respectively. For 2005, the decrease in net paid losses over 2004 relates primarily to the recovery from Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company upon conclusion of the independent actuarial process, partially offset by payments for catastrophes in both 2004 and 2005. The increase in net paid losses in 2004 relates to both the increase in business over the last several years and the payments associated with the 2004 Atlantic hurricane losses. See further information under Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

Other loss related information

     The Company’s net incurred losses and loss expenses include actual and estimates of potential non-recoveries from reinsurers. As at December 31, 2005 and 2004, the reserve for potential non-recoveries from reinsurers was $234.3 million and $280.7 million, respectively.

     Except for certain workers’ compensation and long-term disability liabilities, the Company does not discount its unpaid losses and loss expenses. The Company utilizes tabular reserving for workers’ compensation and long-term disability unpaid losses that are considered fixed and determinable, and discounts such losses using an interest rate of 5% (2004: 5%). The Company decreased the interest rate in 2003 from 7% to 5%. The effect of the decrease in the interest rate resulted in an increase in loss reserves of approximately $35.0 million in 2003. The tabular reserving methodology results in applying uniform and consistent criteria for establishing expected future indemnity and medical payments (including an explicit factor for inflation) and the use of mortality tables to determine expected payment periods. Tabular unpaid losses and loss expenses, net of reinsurance, at December 31, 2005 and 2004 were $716.7 million and $578.6 million, respectively. The related discounted unpaid losses and loss expenses were $322.2 million and $290.0 million as of December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.

Investments

Investment structure and strategy

     The Company’s investment operations are managed centrally by the Company’s investment department, which also provides certain investment advice and support for the rest of the Company’s operations. The Finance Committee

19


of the Board of Directors approves the Company’s overall investment policy and guidelines and reviews the implementation of the investment strategy on a regular basis.

     The primary objectives of the investment strategy are to support the liabilities arising from the operations of the Company, generate stable investment income and build book value for the Company over the longer term. The strategy strives to maximize investment returns while taking into account market and credit risk. Market risk is due to interest rate variability and exposure to foreign denominated currencies, which the Company seeks to manage through asset/liability management, and due to the allocation to risk assets, including global equity securities, which the Company seeks to manage through diversification. Credit risk arises from investments in fixed income securities and is managed with aggregate and portfolio limits.

     The Company’s overall investment portfolio is structured to take into account a number of variables including local regulatory requirements, business needs, collateral management and risk tolerance. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, total investments, cash and cash equivalents and accrued investment income, less net payable for investments purchased, was $41.6 billion and $32.4 billion, respectively.

     Functionally, the Company’s investment portfolio is divided into four principal components. The largest component is the general account asset/liability portfolio supporting property and casualty and financial guaranty liabilities, which was approximately $23.7 billion and $18.4 billion at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The key focus for this component is asset and liability management and it is used to provide liquidity to settle claims arising from the Company’s general and financial operations. The asset/liability portfolio is made up entirely of investment grade fixed income securities.

     The second component of the investment portfolio is the structured and spread product portfolio, which was approximately $13.7 billion and $9.7 billion at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. This portfolio consists of highly structured actively managed investment portfolios that support specific insurance and reinsurance transactions, e.g., deposit liability and future policy benefit reserves. Many of these transactions have underlying liabilities that pay out over many years. As a result, asset and liability management is also a key focus for this portfolio.

     The third component of the investment portfolio is the risk asset portfolio, which was approximately $3.8 billion and $3.9 billion at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The Company utilizes a risk budgeting framework for the dynamic risk and asset allocation of the risk asset portfolio. The risk asset portfolio is that portion of the Company’s surplus that is invested in risk assets to generate growth in the Company’s book value over the longer term with the efficient utilization of risk. The fundamental premise of the risk budgeting methodology for the risk asset portfolio is to maximize expected returns for a given level of risk. The risk asset portfolio currently includes four core diversified total return strategy portfolios incorporating: (i) alternative investment strategies; (ii) high yield fixed income; (iii) public equities; and (iv) private investments, which include private equity and mezzanine funds and non-rated tranches of collateralized debt obligations.

     The Company sets specific constraints during the risk allocation process that reflect the Company’s overall tolerance for risk, including guidelines on the level of VaR of the risk asset portfolio, stress testing and a maximum drawdown level attributable to the alternative investment portfolio. These levels are approved by the Finance Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors annually. In addition, each of the core risk asset portfolios is subject to specific investment guidelines that are also approved by the Finance Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors. These guidelines address the investment parameters and risk associated with each portfolio. The Company monitors the total risk and return of the risk asset portfolio and the four strategy portfolios to ensure compliance with the risk target guidelines as approved.

     The alternative investment portfolio, part of the risk asset portfolio, is a highly diversified portfolio of investments in limited partnerships and similar investment vehicles, with each fund generally pursuing absolute return investment mandates. These are typically investing in one or more of the traditional asset classes including equities, fixed income, credit, currency and commodity markets, and similar investment vehicles. For the majority of the portfolio, the Company owns minority investment interests that are accounted for under the equity method and are

20


included in the Consolidated Balance Sheet under “Investments in affiliates.” The investment objective of the alternative investment portfolio is to attain a high risk-adjusted total return while maintaining a moderate to low level of sensitivity to the movements in traditional asset classes and realizing a low volatility. This portfolio was $1.7 billion and $1.7 billion at December 31, 2005 and 2004.

     The fourth component of the Company’s total investment portfolio, valued at $0.4 billion at December 31, 2005 and 2004, is related to insurance and financial affiliates and investments in investment management companies. At December 31, 2005, the Company owned minority stakes in eight independent investment management companies. These ownership stakes are part of the Company’s asset management strategy, pursuant to which the Company seeks to develop relationships with specialty investment management organizations, generally acquiring an equity interest in the business. In these investments, the Company seeks to achieve strong returns on capital while accessing the investment expertise of professionals to help manage portions of the Company’s investment assets. In addition, the Company is active in the relationships with these managers, seeking to benefit from the intellectual capital in ways that will enhance the Company’s overall financial performance and achieve broader strategic goals.

     Where the Company maintains significant influence over the decisions of the investment management organization, through board representation or through certain voting and/or consent rights, the Company’s proportionate share of the income or loss from these companies is reported as net income from operating affiliates. The Company’s existing managers manage or sponsor a broad range of investment products, providing institutional and high net worth investors access to a wide array of asset classes and investment strategies. It is a strategic objective of the Company to continue to expand the diversification of investment products offered by its affiliates by assisting existing affiliates in launching new products and new lines of business as well as by making additional ownership investments in other specialty asset managers. See Item 8, Note 6 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Implementation of investment strategy

     Although the Company’s investment department is responsible for implementation of the investment strategy, the day-to-day management of the investment portfolio is outsourced to investment management service providers. External investment managers are selected and monitored using a disciplined due diligence process. Each investment manager may manage one or more portfolios and is governed by a detailed set of investment guidelines, including overall objectives, risk parameters, and diversification requirements that fall within the overall guidelines discussed above. Compliance with investment guidelines is monitored on a regular basis by the investment department.

Investment performance

     See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” for discussion of the Company’s investment performance.

Credit ratings, duration and maturity profile

     It is the Company’s policy to operate the aggregate fixed income portfolio with a minimum weighted average credit rating of “Aa3/AA-.” The aggregate credit rating is determined based on the market value weighted average credit rating using a linear credit rating scale similar to that used by Moody’s. The highest credit rated fixed income securities are held within the asset/liability and structured product portfolios. Sub-investment grade (high yield) fixed income securities are held within the risk asset portfolio. The weighted average credit rating of the fixed income portfolio was “Aa2/AA” at December 31, 2005 and 2004.

     The Company did not have an aggregate investment in a single entity, other than the U.S. Government, in excess of 10% of shareholders’ equity at December 31, 2005 or 2004.

21


     The aggregate duration of the fixed income portfolio is managed relative to liabilities. Duration measures bond price volatility and is an indicator of the sensitivity of the price of a bond (or a portfolio of bonds) to changes in interest rates, assuming a parallel change in the yield curve reflecting the percentage change in price for a 100 basis point change in yield. Management believes that the duration of the fixed income portfolio is the best single measure of interest rate risk and the table below summarizes the weighted average duration in years of the main components of the fixed income portfolio at December 31, 2005 and 2004:

   
2005 
2004 

     

Asset/Liability portfolio:   
   General Account   
3.2 
3.3 
   Structured and Spread Products 
 
5.1 
6.5 
Total Fixed Income portfolio   
3.9 
4.4 

     The maturity profile of the fixed income portfolio is a function of the maturity profile of liabilities and, to a lesser extent, the maturity profile of common fixed income benchmarks. For further information on the maturity profile of the fixed income portfolio see Item 8, Note 6 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Ratings

     The Company’s ability to underwrite business is dependent upon the quality of its claims paying and financial strength ratings as evaluated by independent agencies.

     In March of 2006, Fitch upgraded the long-term debt ratings for XL Capital Ltd and XL Capital Finance (Europe) plc to “A” from “A-”. The outlooks remain stable.

     In the fourth quarter of 2005, Standard & Poor’s, lowered the Company’s core property and casualty operating companies’ financial strength ratings to “A+” from “AA-” and affirmed them with a stable outlook. During this period, Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. also lowered the insurance financial strength ratings of the Company’s leading insurance operating subsidiaries to “Aa3” from “Aa2” and confirmed the insurance financial strength ratings of its leading reinsurance operating subsidiaries at “Aa3”. In October 2005, Fitch Ratings Inc. lowered the insurance financial strength ratings of the Company’s lead insurance and reinsurance operating subsidiaries to “AA-” from “AA.” A.M. Best Company, Inc. affirmed the Company’s financial strength rating of “A+” and its operating subsidiaries’ issuer credit ratings of “aa-” in December 2005. The Company subsequently raised $3.2 billion through the issuance of ordinary shares and equity security units.

22


     The following are the financial strength and claims paying ratings from internationally recognized rating agencies in relation to the Company’s principal insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries and pools as at December 31, 2005:

Rating 
  Agency’s description       
Agency’s rating 
   
agency 
  of rating   
Rating 
 
definition 
  Ranking of Rating 

     
     
     
     
Standard & 
  “A current opinion of the    A+    “Strong”    The “A” grouping is the 
Poor’s 
  financial security characteristics    (Outlook    financial security    third highest out of nine main 
  of an insurance organization    Stable)    characteristics.    ratings. Main ratings from AA 
  with respect to its ability to pay            to CCC are subdivided into 
  under its insurance policies and            three subcategories: “+” 
  contracts in accordance with            indicating the high end of the 
  their terms.”            main rating; no modifier, 
              indicating the mid range of the 
              main rating; and “-” indicating 
              the lower end of the main rating. 
               
Fitch 
  “An assessment of the financial    AA-    “Very strong”    The “AA” rating is the second 
  strength of an insurance    (Outlook    capacity to meet    highest out of twelve ratings 
  organization, and its capacity to    Stable)    policyholder and    categories. AA insurers are 
  meet senior obligations to        contract    viewed as possessing very 
  policyholders and contract        obligations.    strong capacity to meet 
  holders on a timely basis.”            policyholder and contract 
              obligations. “+” or “-” may be 
              appended to a rating to indicate 
              the relative position of a credit 
              within the rating category. 
               
A.M. Best 
  “An opinion of an insurer’s    A+    “Superior” ability to    The “A+” grouping is the 
  financial strength and ability    (Outlook    meet its obligations    second highest ratings category 
  to meet ongoing obligations to    Stable)    to policyholders.    out of fifteen. It is assigned to 
  policyholders.”            companies that have, in A.M. 
              Best’s opinion, a superior ability 
              to meet their ongoing 
              obligations to policyholders. 
               
Moody’s 
  An opinion of “the ability of    Aa3    “Excellent”    The “Aa” grouping is the 
  insurance companies to repay    (Outlook    financial security.    second highest out of nine 
  punctually senior policyholder    Stable)        rating categories. Each rating 
  claims and obligations.”            category is subdivided into 
              three subcategories. Moody’s 
              appends numerical modifiers 1, 
              2, and 3 to each generic rating 
              classification from Aa through 
              Caa. Numeric modifiers are 
              used to refer to the ranking 
              within a group – with 1 being 
              the highest and 3 being the 
              lowest. 

23


     The following were the current financial strength and claims paying ratings from internationally recognized rating agencies in relation to the Company’s principal insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries and pools as at December 31, 2004:

Rating    Agency’s description       
Agency’s rating 
   
agency    of rating   
Rating 
  definition    Ranking of Rating 

     
     
     
     
Standard & 
  “A current opinion of the    AA-    “Very strong”    This is the second highest out of 
Poor’s 
  financial security characteristics    (Stable)    financial security    nine main ratings. Main ratings 
  of an insurance organization        characteristics.    from AA to CCC are subdivided 
  with respect to its ability to pay            into three subcategories: “+”, 
  under its insurance policies            indicating the high end of the 
  and contracts in accordance            main rating; no modifier, 
  with their terms.”            indicating the mid range of the 
              main rating; and “-”, indicating 
              the lower end of the main 
              rating. 
               
Fitch 
  “An assessment of the financial    AA    “Very strong”    The “AA” rating is the second 
  strength of an insurance    (Stable)    capacity to meet    highest of twelve ratings categories. 
  organization, and its capacity to        policyholder and    AA insurers are viewed as 
  meet senior obligations to        contract obligations.    possessing very strong capacity to 
  policyholders and contract            meet policyholder and contract 
  holders on a timely basis.”            obligations. “+” and “-” may be 
              appended to a rating to indicate 
              the relative positive of a credit 
              within the rating category. 
               
A.M. Best 
  “An opinion of an insurer’s    A+    “Superior”    This is the second highest out of 
  financial strength and ability to    (Outlook    ability to meet its    fifteen ratings. 
  meet ongoing obligations to    Negative)    obligations to     
  policyholders.”        policyholders     
               
Moody’s 
  An opinion of “the ability of    Aa2 (except    “Excellent”    The “Aa” grouping is the 
  insurance companies to repay    members of    financial security.    second highest out of nine 
    punctually senior policyholder    the XL        rating categories. Each rating 
    claims and obligations.”    America Pool,        category is subdivided into 
        XL Re Ltd, and        three subcategories. Moody’s 
        XL Life Insurance    appends numerical modifiers 1, 
        and Annuity        2, and 3 to each generic rating 
        Company, which        classification from Aa through 
        are rated Aa3)        Caa. Numeric modifiers are 
        (Outlook        used to refer to the ranking 
        Stable)        within a group – with 1 being 
                the highest and 3 being the 
                lowest. 

24


     The following are the financial strength ratings from internationally recognized rating agencies currently and as of December 31, 2004 and 2005 in relation to the Company’s principal financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries:

Rating    Agency’s description       
Agency’s rating 
   
agency    of rating   
Rating 
  definition    Ranking of Rating 

     
     
     
     
Standard & 
  “A current opinion of the    AAA    “Extremely strong”    This is the highest out of nine 
Poor’s 
  financial security characteristics        financial security    main ratings groupings. 
    of an insurance organization        characteristics.     
    with respect to its ability to pay             
    under its insurance policies and             
    contracts in accordance with             
    their terms.”             
                 
Moody’s 
  An opinion of “the ability of    Aaa    “Exceptional”    This is the highest out of nine 
    insurance companies to repay        financial security    main ratings categories. 
    punctually senior policyholder             
    claims and obligation.”             
                 
Fitch    “An assessment of the financial    AAA    “Exceptionally    This is the highest out of twelve 
    strength of an insurance        strong” capacity    main ratings categories. 
    organization, and its capacity to        to meet policyholder     
    meet senior obligations to        and contract     
    policyholders and contract        obligations.     
    holders on a timely basis.”             

     In addition, XL Capital Ltd currently has the following long term debt ratings: “a-” (stable) from A.M. Best, “A-” (stable) from Standard and Poor’s, “A3” (stable) from Moody’s and “A-” (stable) from Fitch.

     The Company believes that the primary users of ratings include commercial and investment banks, policyhold-ers, brokers, ceding companies and investors.

Tax Matters

     See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8, Note 23 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Regulation

     The Company’s operations are subject to regulation and supervision in each of the jurisdictions where they are domiciled and licensed to conduct business. Generally, regulatory authorities can have broad supervisory and administrative powers over such matters as licenses, fitness of management, standards of solvency, material transactions between affiliates, premium rates, policy forms, investments, security deposits, methods of accounting, form and content of financial statements, reserves for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, reinsurance, minimum capital and surplus requirements and/or risk based capital standards, dividends and other distributions to shareholders, periodic examinations and annual and other report filings. In general, such regulation is for the protection of policyholders rather than shareholders. The Company believes that it is in compliance with all applicable laws and regulations pertaining to its business that would have a material effect on its financial position in the event of non-compliance.

25


     Bermuda Operations

     The Insurance Act 1978 of Bermuda and related regulations, as amended (the “Act”), regulates the Company’s operating subsidiaries in Bermuda, and it provides that no person may carry on any insurance business in or from within Bermuda unless registered as an insurer by the Bermuda Monetary Authority (the “Authority”) under the Act. Insurance as well as reinsurance is regulated under the Act.

     The Act imposes on Bermuda insurance companies, solvency and liquidity standards, certain restrictions on the declaration and payment of dividends and distributions, certain restrictions on the reduction of statutory capital, auditing and reporting requirements, and grants the Authority powers to supervise, investigate and intervene in the affairs of insurance companies. Significant requirements include the appointment of an independent auditor, the appointment of a loss reserve specialist and the filing of the Annual Statutory Financial Return with the Authority. The Supervisor of Insurance is the chief administrative officer under the Act.

     Under the Bermuda Companies Act 1981, as amended, a Bermuda company may not declare or pay a dividend or make a distribution out of contributed surplus if there are reasonable grounds for believing that: (a) the company is, or would after the payment be, unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or (b) the realizable value of the company’s assets would thereby be less than the aggregate of its liabilities and its issued share capital and share premium accounts.

     United States

     Within the United States, the Company’s insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are subject to regulation and supervision by their respective states of incorporation and by other jurisdictions in which they do business. The methods of regulation vary, but in general have their source in statutes that delegate regulatory and supervisory powers to an insurance official. The regulation and supervision relate primarily to approval of policy forms and rates, the standards of solvency that must be met and maintained, including risk-based capital standards, material transactions between an insurer and its affiliates, the licensing of insurers, agents and brokers, restrictions on insurance policy terminations, the nature of and limitations on the amount of certain investments, limitations on the net amount of insurance of a single risk compared to the insurer’s surplus, deposits of securities for the benefit of poli-cyholders, methods of accounting, periodic examinations of the financial condition and market conduct of insurance companies, the form and content of reports of financial condition required to be filed, and reserves for unearned premiums, losses, expenses and other obligations. All transactions between or among the insurance and reinsurance company subsidiaries must be fair and equitable. In general, such regulation is for the protection of policyholders rather than shareholders.

     Regulations generally require insurance and reinsurance companies to furnish information to their domestic state insurance department concerning activities that may materially affect the operations, management or financial condition and solvency of the company. Regulations vary from state to state but generally require that each primary insurance company obtain a license from the department of insurance of a state to conduct business in that state. A reinsurance company is not generally required to have an insurance license to reinsure a U.S. ceding company from outside the U.S. However, for a U.S. ceding company to obtain financial statement credit for reinsurance ceded, the reinsurer must obtain an insurance license or accredited status from the cedent’s state of domicile or another U.S. state with equivalent insurance regulation or must post collateral to support the liabilities ceded. In addition, regulations for reinsurers vary somewhat from primary insurers in that the form and rate of reinsurance contracts and the market conduct of reinsurers are not subject to regulator approval.

     The Company’s U.S. insurance subsidiaries are required to file detailed annual and, in most states, quarterly reports with state insurance regulators in each of the states in which they are licensed. Such annual and quarterly reports are required to be prepared on a calendar year basis. In addition, the U.S. insurance subsidiaries’ operations and accounts are subject to financial condition and market conduct examination at regular intervals by state regulators. The respective reports filed in accordance with applicable insurance regulations with respect to the most recent periodic examinations of the U.S. insurance subsidiaries contained no material adverse findings.

26


     Statutory surplus is an important measure utilized by the regulators and rating agencies to assess the Company’s U.S. insurance subsidiaries’ ability to support business operations and provide dividend capacity. The Company’s U.S. insurance subsidiaries are subject to various state statutory and regulatory restrictions that limit the amount of dividends that may be paid from earned surplus without prior approval from regulatory authorities. These restrictions differ by state, but are generally based on a calculation of the lesser of 10% of statutory surplus or 100% of net investment income.

     Most states have implemented laws that establish standards for current, as well as continued, state licensing or accreditation. In addition, the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (the “NAIC”) promulgated and all states have adopted Risk-Based Capital (“RBC”) standards for property and casualty companies and life insurance companies as a means of monitoring certain aspects affecting the overall financial condition of insurance companies. RBC is designed to measure the adequacy of an insurer’s statutory surplus in relation to the risks inherent in its business. The NAIC’s RBC Model Law provides for four incremental levels of regulatory attention for insurers whose surplus is below the calculated RBC target. These levels of attention range in severity from requiring the insurer to submit a plan for corrective action to actually placing the insurer under regulatory control. The Company’s current RBC ratios for its U.S. subsidiaries are satisfactory and such ratios are not expected to result in any adverse regulatory action. The Company is not aware of any such actions relative to it.

     While the federal government does not directly regulate the insurance business (other than for flood, nuclear and reinsurance of losses from terrorism), federal legislation and administrative policies can affect the insurance industry. The federal government has also undertaken initiatives in several areas that may impact the insurance industry including tort reform, corporate governance and the taxation of insurance companies. In addition, legislation has been introduced from time to time in recent years that, if enacted, could result in the federal government assuming a more direct role in the regulation of the insurance industry, primarily as respects federal licensing in lieu of state licensing.

     European Union

     Financial services including insurance, reinsurance, securities and Lloyd’s in the United Kingdom are regulated by the Financial Services Authority (“FSA”). The FSA’s Handbook of Rules and Guidance (the “FSA Rules”) covers all aspects of regulation including capital adequacy, financial and non-financial reporting and certain activities of U.K.-regulated firms. The Company’s subsidiaries carrying out regulated activities in the U.K. comply with the FSA Rules. The Company’s Lloyd’s managing agency, its managed syndicates and its associated corporate capital vehicles are subject to additional requirements of the Council of Lloyd’s franchise.

     FSA regulations also impact the Company as “controller” (an FSA defined term) of its U.K.-regulated subsidiaries. Through the FSA’s Approved Persons regime, certain employees and Directors are subject to regulation by the FSA of their fitness and certain employees are individually registered at Lloyd’s.

     Subsidiaries in Ireland, Hungary and France are regulated in those jurisdictions. The Company’s network of offices in the European Union consists mainly of branches of U.K. and Irish companies that are principally regulated under European Directives from their home states, the U.K. and Ireland rather than by each individual jurisdiction.

     International Operations

     A substantial portion of the Company’s general insurance business and a majority of its life insurance business is carried on in foreign countries. The degree of regulation in foreign jurisdictions can vary. Generally, the Company’s subsidiaries must satisfy local regulatory requirements. Licenses issued by foreign authorities to subsidiaries of the Company are subject to modification or revocation for cause by such authorities. The Company’s subsidiaries could be prevented, for cause, from conducting business in certain of the jurisdictions where they currently operate. While each country imposes licensing, solvency, auditing and financial reporting requirements, the type and extent of the requirements differ substantially. Key areas where countries may differ include: (i) the type of financial reports to be

27


filed; (ii) a requirement to use local intermediaries; (iii) the amount of reinsurance permissible; (iv) the scope of any regulation of policy forms and rates; and (v) the type and frequency of regulatory examinations.

     In addition to these requirements, the Company’s foreign operations are also regulated in various jurisdictions with respect to currency, amount and type of security deposits, amount and type of reserves, amount and type of local investment and limitations on the share of profits to be returned to policyholders on participating policies. Certain countries have established reinsurance institutions, wholly or partially owned by the state, to which admitted insurers are obligated to cede a portion of their business on terms which do not always allow foreign insurers full compensation. For further information see Item 8, Note 24 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Employees

     At December 31, 2005, the Company employed approximately 3,600 employees. At that date, 385 of the Company’s employees were represented by workers’ councils and 423 of the Company’s employees were subject to collective bargaining agreements. The Company believes that it has a good relationship with its employees.

Available Information

     The public can read and copy any materials the Company files with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. The public can obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC maintains an Internet site that contains reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding issuers, including the Company, that file electronically with the SEC. The address of the SEC’s website is http://www.sec.gov.

     The Company’s Internet website address is http://www.xlcapital.com. The information contained on the Company’s website is not incorporated by reference into this annual report on Form 10-K or any other of the Company’s documents filed with or furnished to the SEC.

     The Company makes available free of charge, including through the Company’s Internet website, the Company’s annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, as soon as reasonably practicable after such material is electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC.

     The Company adopted Corporate Governance Guidelines, as well as written charters for each of the Audit Committee, the Compensation Committee, the Finance Committee, and the Nominating and Governance Committee of the Board of Directors, as well as a Code of Ethics for Senior Financial Officers, a Code of Business Conduct & Ethics for employees and a related Compliance Program. Each of these documents is posted on the Company’s web-site at http://www.xlcapital.com, and each is available in print to any shareholder who requests it by writing to us at Investor Relations Department, XL Capital Ltd, XL House, One Bermudiana Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda.

     The Company intends to post on its website at http://www.xlcapital.com any amendment to, or waiver from, a provision of its Code of Business Conduct & Ethics that applies to its Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Controller and that relates to any element of the code of ethics definition pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

28


ITEM 1A.      RISK FACTORS

     Any of the following risk factors could have a significant or material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and/or liquidity, in addition to the other information contained in this report. Additional risks not presently known to us or that we currently deem immaterial may also impair our business, financial condition and results of operations. In this Item 1A, “XL Capital”, “XL Group”, “we”, “our”, “ours” and “us” refer to XL Capital Ltd and its subsidiaries unless the context otherwise requires.

Risks Related to Our Company

A downgrade in our credit ratings by one or more rating agencies could materially and negatively impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and/or liquidity.

     In the fourth quarter of 2005, Standard & Poor’s, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. (“S&P”) lowered XL Capital’s core property and casualty operating companies’ financial strength ratings to “A+” from “AA-” and affirmed them with a stable outlook. During this period, Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”) also lowered the insurance financial strength ratings of XL Capital’s leading insurance operating subsidiaries to “Aa3” from “Aa2” and confirmed the insurance financial strength ratings of XL Capital’s leading reinsurance operating subsidiaries at “Aa3”. In October 2005, Fitch Ratings Inc. (“Fitch”) lowered the insurance financial strength ratings of XL Capital’s lead insurance and reinsurance operating subsidiaries to “AA-” from “AA.” A.M. Best Company, Inc. (“A.M. Best”) affirmed XL Capital’s financial strength rating of “A+” and XL Capital’s operating subsidiaries’ issuer credit ratings of “aa-” in December 2005. As our ability to underwrite business is dependent upon the quality of our claims paying and financial strength ratings as evaluated by these independent rating agencies, a further downgrade by any of these institutions could cause our competitive position in the insurance and reinsurance industry to suffer and make it more difficult for us to market our products. A downgrade could also result in a substantial loss of business for us as ceding companies and brokers that place such business may move to other insurers and reinsurers with higher ratings.

     A downgrade of the A.M. Best financial strength rating of XL Capital Ltd, XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd or XL Re Ltd below “A-”, which is two notches below our current A.M. Best rating of “A+”, would constitute an event of default under our letter of credit and revolving credit facilities. A similar downgrade by A.M. Best or S&P would trigger cancellation provisions in the majority of our assumed reinsurance contracts. See “—Risks Related to Our Company—A decline in our ratings may allow many of our clients to terminate their contracts with us,” below. Either of these events could reduce our financial flexibility and materially adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. For further discussion, see Part II, Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations”.

     S&P, Moody’s and Fitch have assessed “triple-A” (outlook stable) financial strength ratings to our financial guaranty companies, XL Capital Assurance Inc. (“XLCA”) and XL Financial Assurance Ltd. (“XLFA”). A downgrade, rating watch or outlook change of the financial strength ratings of XLCA or XLFA by one or more rating agencies would have an adverse effect on the competitive position of XLCA and XLFA and reduce their future business opportunities. Such a downgrade would reduce the value of the reinsurance offered by XLFA, as financial guaranty primary insurers usually must obtain triple-A-rated reinsurance to qualify for a 100% reinsurance credit on the rating agencies’ capital adequacy models. Also, certain of XLFA’s reinsurance agreements contain provisions that allow the ceding primary insurer to terminate the agreement in the event of a downgrade in XLFA’s credit ratings or other event that would result in the reinsurance credit provided by XLFA to the ceding primary insurer being diminished. To address rating agency requirements regarding the differential between the triple-A ratings of our financial guaranty companies and their affiliated companies in the XL Group, we are currently exploring a number of strategies that would provide greater independence and stability to XLCA’s and XLFA’s ratings. Examples of actions identified by the rating agencies are, among other things, the inclusion of additional independent directors to the boards of directors of our financial guaranty companies; adding some level of outside high-quality ownership with voting and/or veto rights; and securing a resolution from each of the boards of directors of our financial guaranty companies that clarifies

29


our expectations regarding cash payments from the financial guaranty companies. S&P has stated that one or more of these actions will need to be taken by mid-year 2006.

A decline in our ratings may allow many of our clients to terminate their contracts with us.

     The majority of our assumed reinsurance contracts contain provisions that would allow our clients to cancel the contract in the event of a downgrade in our ratings below specified levels by one or more rating agencies. Based on premium value, approximately 70% of our reinsurance contracts that incepted at January 1, 2005 contained provisions allowing clients additional rights upon a decline in our ratings.

     Typically, the cancellation provisions in our assumed reinsurance contracts would be triggered if S&P or A.M. Best were to downgrade our financial strength ratings below “A-”, which is equivalent to more than two levels below our current S&P rating of “A+” and more than two levels below our current A.M. Best rating of “A+”. Whether a client would exercise its cancellation rights after such a downgrade would likely depend, among other things, on the reasons for the downgrade, the extent of the downgrade, the prevailing market conditions, the degree of unexpired coverage, and the pricing and availability of replacement reinsurance coverage. In the event of such a downgrade, we cannot predict whether or how many of our clients would actually exercise such cancellation rights or the extent to which any such cancellations would have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or future prospects.

Losses related to Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma and other natural catastrophes have adversely affected our fiscal year 2005 results and uncertainty regarding estimated losses may further impact our financial condition, results of operations and/or liquidity.

     Based on current loss reports and estimates at December 31, 2005, we had pre-tax net losses arising from Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma and the combined impact of other previously announced natural catastrophes in 2005 of approximately $1.27 billion, $357.9 million, $247.1 million and $96.0 million, respectively. After taking into account net reinstatement premiums and tax effects, we had net losses due to these catastrophes of approximately $1.87 billion. However, calculating such estimates involves the exercise of considerable judgment and they are accordingly subject to revision. These losses have materially adversely affected our fiscal year 2005 results.

     Our loss estimates are based upon a review of contracts that we believe are exposed to these catastrophes, loss reports received from brokers and cedents, industry loss models and management’s best judgment, including as to the availability and collectibility of reinsurance. We expect that the loss adjustment processes for Hurricanes Katrina and Rita will be protracted due to the unprecedented complexity and scale of these events.

     Actual losses may vary materially from our estimates. Such variances may be caused by a number of factors, including receipt of additional information from insureds or brokers, the attribution of losses to coverages that had not previously been considered as exposed and inflation in repair costs due to additional demand for labor and materials. In addition, such loss estimates include a high level of uncertainty related to, among other things, complex coverage issues, claims data received to date and potential legal developments that may result in ultimate losses not being known for a considerable period of time as well as the availability and collectibility of reinsurance. Therefore, these losses may ultimately be materially greater than currently estimated. If our actual losses exceed our estimates, our financial condition and results of operations could be further materially adversely affected.

We have exhausted certain of our reinsurance and retrocessional coverage with respect to losses related to Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma leaving us exposed to further losses.

     Based on our current estimates of losses related to Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and, to a lesser degree, Wilma, we believe that we have exhausted portions of our reinsurance and retrocessional coverage with respect to such losses, meaning that, in certain cases, we will have no further reinsurance or retrocessional coverage available should our losses related to Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma prove to be greater than current estimates. If losses related to Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma prove to be greater than current estimates, to the extent that such adverse development affects lines of business with respect to which we have exhausted our reinsurance or retrocessional coverage, such adverse development could have a further material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of opera-

30


tions. We cannot assure you that reinsurance or retrocessional coverage with respect to the lines of business affected by the Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma will be available to us on acceptable terms, or at all, in the future. Elimination of all or portions of our reinsurance or retrocessional coverage could subject us to increased, and possibly material, exposure or could cause us to underwrite less business.

We may be unable to make full recovery of the reinsurance recoverables related to the Winterthur Business, either from third parties or from Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company (“WSIC”).

     Under the terms of the Sale and Purchase Agreement, as amended, between XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and WSIC (the “SPA”), WSIC provides us with protection with respect to third party reinsurance receivables and recoverables related to our acquisition of certain Winterthur International insurance operations (the “Winterthur Business”), which were approximately $1.6 billion, in the aggregate, as of December 31, 2005. There are two levels of protection from WSIC for these balances:

      1.      At the time of the Winterthur International acquisition, the Seller provided to the Company a liquidity facility. At the time of the payment of the net reserve seasoned amount on December 12, 2005, the Company exercised its right to repay up to the balances outstanding on this facility by assignment to WSIC of an equal amount of receivables relating to reinsurance recoverables selected by the Company. During December 2005, the Company assigned $265.4 million of receivables to WSIC under this arrangement, although WSIC has disputed the assignment of certain of these receivables
     
  2. Under two retrocession agreements the Company has reinsurance protection on the reinsurance recoverables with respect to the SNRA determined as of June 30, 2004 to the extent that the Company does not receive payment of such amounts from applicable reinsurers with one agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to June 30, 2001 and the other agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to December 31, 2000.

     Certain reinsurers responsible for some portions of the reinsurance of the Winterthur Business have raised issues as to whether amounts claimed are due and discussions are currently ongoing to achieve a resolution.

     We may record a loss in future periods if any or some of the following occur and any such loss could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations:

  • there is deterioration of the net reserves and premium balances relating to the Winterthur Business from what was reported in our Consolidated Financial Statements; and/or

  • we are unable to make full recovery of the reinsurance recoverables related to the Winterthur Business, either from third parties or from WSIC under the additional protections described above.

Our financial condition could be adversely affected by the occurrence of disasters.

     We have substantial exposure to losses resulting from natural and man-made disasters and other catastrophic events. Catastrophes can be caused by various events, including hurricanes, earthquakes, floods, hailstorms, explosions, severe winter weather, fires, war, acts of terrorism, political instability and other natural or man-made disasters. The incidence and severity of catastrophes are inherently unpredictable and our losses from catastrophes could be substantial.

     The occurrence of claims from catastrophic events is likely to result in substantial volatility in our financial condition and results of operations for the fiscal quarter or year in which a catastrophic event occurs, as well as subsequent fiscal periods, and could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations and our ability to write new business. This risk is exacerbated due to accounting principles and rules that do not permit reinsurers to reserve for such catastrophic events until they occur. We expect that increases in the values and concentrations of insured property will increase the severity of catastrophic events in the future. Although we attempt to manage our exposure to catastrophic events, a single catastrophic event could affect multiple geographic zones and lines of business and the frequency or severity of catastrophic events could exceed our estimates, in each case potentially

31


having a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. In addition, while we may, depending on market conditions, purchase catastrophe reinsurance and retrocessional protection, the occurrence of one or more major catastrophes in any given period could result in losses that exceed such reinsurance and retroces-sional protection and have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations and result in substantial liquidation of investments and outflows of cash as losses are paid.

The failure of any of the risk management strategies that we employ could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and/or liquidity.

     We seek to limit our loss exposure by, among other things, writing a number of our reinsurance contracts on an excess of loss basis, adhering to maximum limitations on reinsurance written in defined geographical zones, limiting program size for each client and prudently underwriting each program written. In addition, in the case of proportional treaties, we generally seek to use per occurrence limitations or loss ratio caps to limit the impact of losses from any one event. We cannot be sure that all of these loss limitation methods will have the precise risk management impact intended. For instance, although we also seek to limit our loss exposure by geographic diversification, geographic zone limitations involve significant underwriting judgments, including as to the determination of the area of the zones and the inclusion of a particular policy within a particular zone’s limits. Underwriting involves the exercise of considerable judgment and the making of important assumptions about matters that are inherently unpredictable and beyond our control, and for which historical experience and probability analysis may not provide sufficient guidance. The failure of any of the risk management strategies that we employ could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Also, we cannot assure you that various provisions of our policies, such as limitations or exclusions from coverage or choice of forum, will be enforceable in the manner that we intend and disputes relating to coverage and choice of legal forum may arise, which could materially adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.

The failure of our initiative to reduce our net catastrophe exposed risks could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and/or liquidity.

     Certain of our insurance accounts have the potential for significant volatility under worsening catastrophe event scenarios. In connection with our initiative to reduce our net catastrophe exposed risks, we intend to reduce exposure from such accounts, reduce catastrophe sublimits and eliminate insurance accounts that no longer meet our increased pricing needs. In addition, we plan to reduce our reinsurance catastrophe exposure within the property risk portfolio and restructure the way in which our marine excess of loss programs are written. If we are unable to carry out our initiative to reduce our net catastrophe exposed risks, or do so on a timely basis, we may not be able to meet rating agencies’ additional capital requirements and our financial condition and results of operations and/or liquidity could be materially adversely affected.

If actual claims exceed our loss reserves, our financial results could be adversely affected.

     Our results of operations and financial condition depend upon our ability to assess accurately the potential losses associated with the risks that we insure and reinsure. We establish reserves for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expense (“LAE”) liabilities, which are estimates of future payments of reported and unreported claims for losses and related expenses with respect to insured events that have occurred. The process of establishing reserves for property and casualty claims can be complex and is subject to considerable variability as it requires the use of informed estimates and judgments. Actuarial estimates of unpaid loss and LAE liabilities are subject to potential errors of estimation, which could be significant, due to the fact that the ultimate disposition of claims incurred prior to the date of such estimation, whether reported or not, is subject to the outcome of events that have not yet occurred. Examples of these events include the accuracy of the factual information on which the estimates were based, especially as this develops, jury decisions, court interpretations, legislative changes, changes in the medical condition of claimants, public attitudes, and economic conditions such as inflation. Any estimate of future costs is subject to the inherent limitation on the ability to predict the aggregate course of future events. It should therefore be expected that the actual emergence of loss and LAE liabilities will vary, perhaps materially, from any estimate. We have an actuarial staff in

32


each of our operating segments that regularly evaluates the levels of loss reserves, taking into consideration factors that may impact the ultimate losses incurred. Any such evaluation could result in future changes in estimates of losses or reinsurance recoverable and would be reflected in our results of operations in the period in which the estimates are changed. Losses and loss expenses, to the extent that they exceed the applicable reserves, are charged to income as incurred. The reserve for unpaid losses and loss expenses represents the estimated ultimate losses and loss expenses less paid losses and loss expenses, and comprises case reserves and incurred but not reported loss reserves (“IBNR”). During the loss settlement period, which can span many years in duration for casualty business, additional facts regarding individual claims and trends often will become known and case reserves may be adjusted by allocation from IBNR without any change in the overall reserve. In addition, application of statistical and actuarial methods may require the adjustment of the overall reserves upward or downward from time to time. Accordingly, the ultimate settlement of losses may be significantly greater than or less than reported loss and loss expense reserves.

Operational risks, including human or systems failures, are inherent in our business.

     Operational risk and losses can result from, among other things, fraud, errors, failure to document transactions properly or to obtain proper internal authorization, failure to comply with regulatory requirements, information technology failures, or external events.

     We believe that our modeling, underwriting and information technology and application systems are critical to our business. Moreover, our information technology and application systems have been an important part of our underwriting process and our ability to compete successfully. We have also licensed certain systems and data from third parties. We cannot be certain that we will have access to these, or comparable, service providers, or that our information technology or application systems will continue to operate as intended. A major defect or failure in our internal controls or information technology and application systems could result in management distraction, harm to our reputation or increased expense. We believe appropriate controls and mitigation procedures are in place to prevent significant risk of defect in our internal controls, information technology and application systems, but internal controls provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance as to the absence of errors or irregularities and any ineffectiveness of such controls and procedures could have a material adverse effect on our business.

The effects of emerging claim and coverage issues on our business are uncertain.

     As industry practices and legal, judicial, social and other environmental conditions change, unexpected issues related to claims and coverage may emerge. These issues may adversely affect our business by either extending coverage beyond our underwriting intent or by increasing the number or size of claims. In some instances, these changes may not become apparent until some time after we have issued the insurance or reinsurance contracts that are affected by the changes. For example, our actual losses in connection with the 2005 natural catastrophes may vary materially from our current estimate based on a number of factors, including receipt of additional information from insureds or brokers, the attribution of losses to coverages that had not previously been considered as exposed and inflation in repair costs due to additional demand for labor and materials. As a result, the full extent of liability under an insurance or reinsurance contract may not be known for many years after such contract is issued.

We may require additional capital in the future, which may not be available to us on satisfactory terms, or at all.

     Our future capital requirements depend on many factors, including our ability to write new business successfully and to establish premium rates and reserves at levels sufficient to cover our losses. To the extent that the funds generated by our ongoing operations are insufficient to fund future operating requirements and cover claim payments, we may need to raise additional funds through financings or curtail our growth and reduce our assets. Any future equity or debt financing may not be available on terms that are favorable to us, if at all. Any future equity financings could be dilutive to our existing shareholders or could result in the issuance of securities that have rights, preferences and privileges that are senior to those of our other securities. Our inability to obtain adequate capital could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

33


We may be unable to purchase reinsurance and, even if we are able to successfully purchase reinsurance, we are subject to the possibility of uncollectability.

     We purchase reinsurance for our own account in order to mitigate the volatility that losses impose on our financial condition. Our clients purchase reinsurance from us to cover part of the risk originally written by them. Retrocessional reinsurance involves a reinsurer ceding to another reinsurer, the retrocessionaire, all or part of the reinsurance that the first reinsurer has assumed. Reinsurance, including retrocessional reinsurance, does not legally discharge the ceding company from its liability with respect to its obligations to its insureds or reinsureds. A reinsurer’s or retrocessionaire’s insolvency, inability or refusal to make timely payments under the terms of its agreements with us, therefore, could have a material adverse effect on us because we remain liable to our insureds and reinsureds. At December 31, 2005, we had approximately $7.5 billion of reinsurance recoverables, net of reserves for uncollectible recoverables. For further information regarding our reinsurance exposure, see Part II, Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations”.

     From time to time, market conditions may limit or prevent us from obtaining the types and amounts of reinsurance that we consider adequate for our business needs such that we may not be able to obtain reinsurance or retroces-sional reinsurance from entities with satisfactory creditworthiness in amounts that we deem desirable or on terms that we deem appropriate or acceptable.

Since we depend on a few brokers for a large portion of our revenues, loss of business provided by any one of them could adversely affect us.

     We market our insurance and reinsurance products worldwide primarily through insurance and reinsurance brokers. Marsh & McLennan Companies and AON Corporation and their respective subsidiaries provided approximately 21% and 17%, respectively, of our gross written premiums from general operations for the year ended December 31, 2005. Loss of all or a substantial portion of the business provided by one or more of these brokers could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Our reliance on brokers subjects us to credit risk.

     In certain jurisdictions, when an insured or ceding insurer pays premiums for policies of insurance or contracts of reinsurance to brokers for further payment to us, such premiums might be considered to have been paid and the insured or ceding insurer will no longer be liable to us for such amounts, whether or not we have actually received the premiums from the broker. In addition, in accordance with industry practice, we generally pay amounts owed on claims under our reinsurance contracts to brokers, and these brokers, in turn, pay these amounts over to the clients that have purchased reinsurance from us. Although the law is unsettled and depends upon the facts and circumstances of the particular case, in some jurisdictions, if a broker fails to make such a claims payment to the insured or ceding insurer, we might remain liable to the insured or ceding insurer for that non-payment. Consequently, we assume a degree of credit risk associated with the brokers with whom we transact business. Due to the unsettled and fact-specific nature of the law governing these types of scenarios, we are unable to quantify our exposure to this risk. To date, we have not experienced any material losses related to such credit risks.

Our investment performance may adversely affect our financial results and ability to conduct business.

     Our funds are invested by a number of professional investment advisory management firms under the direction of our management team in accordance with detailed investment guidelines set by us. Although our investment policies stress diversification of risks, conservation of principal and liquidity, our investments are subject to market-wide risks and fluctuations, as well as to risks inherent in particular securities. Investment losses could significantly decrease our asset base, thereby adversely affecting our ability to conduct business and pay claims.

We may be adversely affected by interest rate changes.

     Our operating results are affected, in part, by the performance of our investment portfolio. Our investment portfolio contains interest rate sensitive instruments, such as fixed income securities, which may be adversely affected by

34


changes in interest rates. Changes in interest rates could also have an adverse effect on our investment income and results of operations. For example, if interest rates decline, funds reinvested will earn less than expected.

     Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors, including governmental monetary policies, domestic and international economic and political conditions and other factors beyond our control. Although we take measures to manage the economic risks of investing in a changing interest rate environment, we may not be able to mitigate the interest rate risk of our assets relative to our liabilities. Our mitigation efforts with respect to interest rate risk are primarily focused towards maintaining an investment portfolio with diversified maturities that has a weighted average duration that is approximately equal to the duration of estimated future paid liabilities. However, our estimate of future paid liabilities may be inaccurate and we may be forced to liquidate investments prior to maturity at a loss in order to cover liabilities. In addition, even if the duration of our fixed income portfolio perfectly matched future paid liabilities, a sharp rise in interest rates would cause the market value of our fixed income portfolio to decline and could have a material adverse effect on our book value.

     For further information regarding our exposure to interest rate risk and other investment portfolio risks, see Part II, Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk”.

Our operating results may be adversely affected by currency fluctuations.

     Our functional currency is the U.S. dollar and exchange rate fluctuations relative to the U.S. dollar may materially impact our financial position and results of operations. Many of our non-U.S. subsidiaries maintain both assets and liabilities in local currencies, which exposes us to changes in currency exchange rates to the extent that we need to convert U.S. dollars into such local currencies or vice versa. In addition, locally-required capital levels are invested in home currencies in order to satisfy regulatory requirements and to support local insurance operations regardless of currency fluctuations. Foreign exchange rate risk is reviewed as part of our risk management process. The principal currencies creating foreign exchange risk for us are the British pound sterling, the euro and the Swiss franc.

     While we utilize derivative instruments such as futures, options and foreign currency forward contracts to, among other things, manage our foreign currency exposure, it is possible that these instruments will not effectively mitigate all or a substantial portion of our foreign exchange rate risk.

Current legal and regulatory activities relating to insurance brokers and agents, contingent commissions and certain finite-risk insurance products could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

     Contingent commission arrangements and finite-risk reinsurance have become the focus of investigations by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) and U.S. Attorney’s Offices and state Attorneys General. Finite-risk reinsurance has been defined as a form of reinsurance in which, among other things, the time value of money is considered in the product’s design and pricing, and there is less risk transfer to the insurer or reinsurer in return for less premium being paid.

     In May and June of 2005, we received a subpoena from the SEC and a grand jury subpoena from the U.S. Attorney’s Office for the Southern District of New York, respectively, in each case for documents and information relating to certain finite risk and loss mitigation insurance products. We are fully cooperating with, and responding to, these requests.

     On August 1, 2005, plaintiffs in a proposed class action multi-district lawsuit (the “MDL”) filed a consolidated amended complaint, which named as new defendants in the pending action approximately 30 entities, including XL Capital Ltd and its subsidiaries XL Insurance America, Inc., Greenwich Insurance Company and Indian Harbor Insurance Company. In the MDL, named plaintiffs have asserted various claims, purportedly on behalf of a class of commercial insureds, against approximately 113 insurance companies and insurance brokers through which the named plaintiffs allegedly purchased insurance. The amended complaint alleges that the defendant insurance companies and insurance brokers conspired to manipulate bidding practices for insurance policies in certain insurance lines and failed to disclose certain commission arrangements. The named plaintiffs have asserted statutory claims under the

35


Sherman Act, various state antitrust laws and the Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations Act, as well as common law claims alleging breach of fiduciary duty, aiding and abetting a breach of fiduciary duty and unjust enrichment.

     From time to time, we have also received and responded to additional requests from state Attorneys General and insurance regulators for information relating to our contingent commission arrangements with brokers and agents, and our insurance and reinsurance practices in connection with certain finite-risk and loss mitigation insurance products. Similarly, our affiliates outside the United States have, from time to time, received and responded to requests from regulators relating to our insurance and reinsurance practices. We are fully cooperating with these requests.

     At this time, we are unable to predict the potential effects, if any, that these investigations may have upon us, the insurance and reinsurance markets in general or industry and reinsurance business practices or what, if any, changes may be made to laws and regulations regarding the industry and financial reporting. Any of the foregoing could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The loss of one or more key executives or the inability to attract and retain qualified personnel could adversely affect our ability to conduct business.

     Our success depends on our ability to retain the services of our existing key executives and to attract and retain additional qualified personnel in the future. The loss of the services of any of our key executives or the inability to hire and retain other highly qualified personnel in the future could adversely affect our ability to conduct our business. In addition, we do not maintain key man life insurance policies with respect to our employees.

     Many of our senior executives working in Bermuda are not Bermudian and our success may depend in part on the continued services of key employees in Bermuda. Under Bermuda law, non-Bermudians (other than spouses of Bermudians and holders of permanent resident certificates) may not engage in any gainful occupation in Bermuda without an appropriate governmental work permit. A work permit may be granted or renewed by the Bermuda government for a specific period of time, upon showing that, after proper public advertisement, no Bermudian (or spouse of a Bermudian or holder of a permanent resident certificate) is available who meets the minimum standards reasonably required by an employer with respect to a certain position. The government of Bermuda places a six-year term limit on individuals with work permits, subject to certain exemptions for key employees. No assurances can be given that any work permit will be issued or, if issued, renewed upon the expiration of the relevant term.

Because we are a holding company, if our subsidiaries do not make dividend and other payments to us, we may not be able to pay dividends or make payments on our debt securities and other obligations.

     As a holding company with no direct operations or significant assets other than the capital stock of our subsidiaries, we rely on investment income, cash dividends and other permitted payments from our subsidiaries to make principal and interest payments on our debt, to pay operating expenses and common and preferred shareholder dividends and to pay other obligations of ours that may arise from time to time. We expect future investment income, dividends and other permitted payments from these subsidiaries to be our principal source of funds to pay such expenses, preferred and common stock dividends and obligations. The payment of dividends to us by our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries is limited under Bermuda laws and certain insurance statutes of various states in the United States in which our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are licensed to transact business.

     Our U.S. insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are subject to state regulatory restrictions that generally require cash dividend to be paid only out of earned statutory surplus. Further, the amount payable without the prior approval of the applicable state insurance department is generally limited to the greater of 10% of policyholders’ surplus or statutory capital, or 100% of the subsidiary’s prior year statutory net income. In addition, Bermuda insurance laws and regulations (i) require our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries to maintain certain minimum solvency margins and minimum liquidity ratios, (ii) prohibit dividends that would result in a breach of these requirements, and (iii) limit the amount by which we can reduce surplus without prior approval from the Bermuda Monetary Authority.

36


     In addition, the ability of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries to pay dividends could be constrained by our dependence on financial strength ratings from independent rating agencies. Our ratings from these agencies depend to a large extent on the capitalization levels of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries. Any such restriction on our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries’ ability to pay dividends to us could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries may not always be able to, or may not, pay preferred and common stock dividends to us sufficient to make our debt payments and pay our operating expenses, shareholder dividends or other obligations.

Risks Related to Our Industry

The insurance and reinsurance industries are historically cyclical and we may experience periods with excess underwriting capacity and unfavorable premium rates.

     The insurance and reinsurance industries have historically been cyclical, characterized by periods of intense price competition due to excess underwriting capacity as well as periods when shortages of capacity permitted favorable premium levels. An increase in premium levels is often offset by an increasing supply of insurance and reinsurance capacity, either by capital provided by new entrants or by the commitment of additional capital by existing insurers or reinsurers, which may cause prices to decrease. Either of these factors could lead to a significant reduction in premium rates, less favorable policy terms and conditions and fewer submissions for our underwriting services. In addition to these considerations, changes in the frequency and severity of losses suffered by insureds and insurers may affect the cycles of the insurance and reinsurance industries significantly.

Competition in the insurance and reinsurance industries could reduce our operating margins.

     The insurance and reinsurance industries are highly competitive. We compete on an international and regional basis with major U.S., Bermudian, European and other international insurers and reinsurers and with underwriting syndicates, some of which have greater financial and management resources than we do. We also compete with new companies that continue to be formed to enter the insurance and reinsurance markets. In addition, capital market participants have recently created alternative products that are intended to compete with reinsurance products. Increased competition could result in fewer submissions, lower premium rates and less favorable policy terms and conditions, which could reduce our margins.

Unanticipated losses from terrorism and uncertainty surrounding the future of the Terrorism Risk Insurance Act of 2002 could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

     Following the September 11th terrorist attacks, the Terrorism Risk Insurance Act of 2002, as amended by the Terrorism Risk Insurance Extension Act of 2005, (“TRIA”) was enacted to ensure the availability of insurance coverage for “certified” acts of terrorism in the U.S and is scheduled to expire on December 31, 2007. Pursuant to TRIA, in the event of a “certified” act of terrorism, the U.S. Government may become liable to pay, above a specified deductible, a portion of up to 90% of our U.S. insurance operations’ losses in fiscal years 2005 and 2006 and 85% of such losses in fiscal year 2007. This deductible is based on prior year gross written premiums for certain commercial lines multiplied by a specified percentage, which is 15%, 17.5% and 20% for fiscal years 2005, 2006 and 2007, respectively. Given the incremental increase in the deductible percentage, the amount of our deductible for 2007 could increase substantially, depending upon the amount of certain direct commercial earned premiums written in 2006. Insurance companies are allowed to purchase commercial reinsurance for their deductible amounts and quota share exposure, however to date there has not been a viable market for such reinsurance coverage in terms of capacity, price or coverage terms. Currently, there is uncertainty as to what effect the changes to TRIA will have on the insurance industry.

     Our Lloyds & U.S.-based property and casualty insurers are subject to TRIA. Accordingly, TRIA does not apply to our non-U.S. and non-Lloyds insurance business, or our reinsurance operations.

37


     While we believe our risk management programs, together with the coverage provided under the TRIA are sufficient to reasonably limit our net losses relating to potential future terrorist attacks, we can offer no assurance in that regard. It is not possible to eliminate completely our exposure to unforecasted or unpredictable events, and to the extent that losses from such risks occur, our financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected. In addition, despite the implementation and extension of the TRIA there remains an uncertainty regarding the future of terrorism coverage should the U.S. government not further extend the TRIA after its expiration on December 31, 2007, or pass subsequent terrorism legislation.

     Potential government intervention in our industry as a result of recent events and instability in the marketplace for insurance products could hinder our flexibility and negatively affect the business opportunities that may be available to us in the market.

     Government intervention and the possibility of future government intervention have created uncertainty in the insurance and reinsurance markets. Government regulators are generally concerned with the protection of policyhold-ers to the exclusion of other constituencies, including shareholders of insurers and reinsurers. While we cannot predict the exact nature, timing or scope of possible governmental initiatives, such proposals could adversely affect our business by, among other things:

  • Providing insurance and reinsurance capacity in markets and to consumers that we target;
  • Requiring our participation in industry pools and guaranty associations;
  • Expanding the scope of coverage under existing policies, e.g., following large disasters such as Hurricanes Katrina and Rita;
  • Regulating the terms of insurance and reinsurance policies; or
  • Disproportionately benefiting the companies of one country over those of another.

     The insurance industry is also affected by political, judicial and legal developments that may create new and expanded theories of liability, which may result in unexpected claims frequency & severity and delays or cancellations of products and services by insureds, insurers and reinsurers which could adversely affect our business.

Risks Related to Regulation

The regulatory regimes under which we operate, and potential changes thereto, could have a material adverse effect on our business.

     Our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries operate in 29 countries around the world as well as in all 50 U.S. states. Our operations in each of these jurisdictions are subject to varying degrees of regulation and supervision. The laws and regulations of the jurisdictions in which our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are domiciled require, among other things, that these subsidiaries maintain minimum levels of statutory capital, surplus and liquidity, meet solvency standards, submit to periodic examinations of their financial condition and restrict payments of dividends and reductions of capital. Statutes, regulations and policies that our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are subject to may also restrict the ability of these subsidiaries to write insurance and reinsurance policies, make certain investments and distribute funds.

     In recent years, the U.S. insurance regulatory framework has come under increased federal scrutiny. In addition, some state legislatures have considered or enacted laws that may alter or increase state regulation of insurance and reinsurance companies and holding companies. Moreover, the National Association of Insurance Commissioners, which is the organization of insurance regulators from the 50 U.S. states, the District of Columbia and the four U.S. territories, as well as state insurance regulators regularly reexamine existing laws and regulations.

     We may not be able to comply fully with, or obtain desired exemptions from, revised statutes, regulations and policies that govern the conduct of our business. Failure to comply with, or to obtain desired authorizations and/or exemptions under, any applicable laws could result in restrictions on our ability to do business or undertake activities that are regulated in one or more of the jurisdictions in which we operate and could subject us to fines and other sanc-

38


tions. In addition, changes in the laws or regulations to which our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are subject, or in the interpretations thereof by enforcement or regulatory agencies, could have a material adverse effect on our business.

If our Bermuda operating subsidiaries become subject to insurance statutes and regulations in jurisdictions other than Bermuda or if there is a change in Bermuda law or regulations or the application of Bermuda law or regulations, there could be a significant and negative impact on our business.

     XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, two of our wholly-owned operating subsidiaries, are registered Bermuda Class 4 insurers. As such, they are subject to regulation and supervision in Bermuda. Bermuda insurance statutes and the regulations and policies of the Bermuda Monetary Authority require XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd to, among other things:

  • maintain a minimum level of capital and surplus;
  • maintain solvency margins and liquidity ratios;
  • restrict dividends and distributions;
  • obtain prior approval regarding the ownership and transfer of shares;
  • maintain a principal office and appoint and maintain a principal representative in Bermuda;
  • file an annual statutory financial return; and
  • allow for the performance of certain periodic examinations of XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd and their respective financial conditions.

     These statutes and regulations may restrict our ability to write insurance and reinsurance policies, distribute funds and pursue our investment strategy.

     We do not presently intend for XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd to be admitted to do business in the United States, the United Kingdom or any jurisdiction other than Bermuda. However, we cannot assure you that insurance regulators in the United States, the United Kingdom or elsewhere will not review the activities of XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd or XL Re Ltd, their respective subsidiaries or their agents and claim that XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd or XL Re Ltd is subject to such jurisdiction’s licensing requirements. If any such claim is successful and XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd or XL Re Ltd must obtain licenses in a jurisdiction other than Bermuda, we may be subject to taxation in such jurisdiction.

     In addition, XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd are subject to indirect regulatory requirements imposed by jurisdictions that may limit their ability to provide insurance or reinsurance to that jurisdiction’s domestic insurers or reinsurers. For example, the ability of XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd to write insurance or reinsurance may be subject, in certain cases, to a country’s limits on how much reinsurance can be purchased from non-domestic reinsurers or requirements that such non-domestic reinsurers collateralize their payment obligations to domestic ceding companies. If we are unable to collateralize or provide other credit support for these reinsurance clients on commercially reasonable terms, we could be limited in our ability to write business for some of our clients. Proposed legislation and regulations may have the effect of imposing additional requirements upon, or restricting the market for, non-domestic insurers or reinsurers with whom domestic companies place business.

     Generally, Bermuda insurance statutes and regulations applicable to XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd are less restrictive than those that would be applicable if they were governed by the laws of any state in the United States. If in the future we become subject to any insurance laws of the United States or any state thereof or of any other jurisdiction, we cannot assure you that we would be in compliance with such laws or that complying with such laws would not have a significant and negative effect on our business.

     The process of obtaining licenses is very time consuming and costly and XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd may not be able to become licensed in jurisdictions other than Bermuda should we choose to do so. The modification of the conduct of our business that would result if we were required or chose to become licensed in certain jurisdictions could significantly and negatively affect our financial condition and results of operations. In addi-

39


tion, our inability to comply with insurance statutes and regulations could significantly and adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations by limiting our ability to conduct business as well as subjecting us to penalties and fines.

     Because XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd are Bermuda companies, they are subject to changes in Bermuda law and regulation that may have an adverse impact on our operations, including through the imposition of tax liability or increased regulatory supervision. In addition, XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd will be exposed to any changes in the political environment in Bermuda, including, without limitation, changes as a result of the independence issues currently being discussed in Bermuda. The Bermuda insurance and reinsurance regulatory framework recently has become subject to increased scrutiny in many jurisdictions, including the United Kingdom. While we cannot predict the future impact on our operations of changes in the laws and regulation to which we are or may become subject, any such changes could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Risks Related to Taxation

We and our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries may become subject to taxes in Bermuda after March 28, 2016, which may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

     We and our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries have received from the Ministry of Finance in Bermuda exemptions from any Bermuda taxes that might be imposed on profits, income or any capital asset, gain or appreciation until March 28, 2016. The exemptions are subject to the proviso that they are not construed so as to prevent the application of any tax or duty to such persons as are ordinarily resident in Bermuda (we and our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries are not so currently designated) and to prevent the application of any tax payable in accordance with the provisions of The Land Tax Act 1967 or otherwise payable in relation to the land leased to us and our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries. We, as a permit company under The Companies Act 1981 of Bermuda, have received similar exemptions, which are effective until March 28, 2016. We and our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries are required to pay certain annual Bermuda government fees and certain business fees as an insurer under The Insurance Act 1978 of Bermuda. Currently there is no Bermuda withholding tax on dividends paid by our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries to us. Given the limited duration of the Ministry of Finance’s assurance, we cannot be certain that we or our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries will not be subject to any Bermuda tax after March 28, 2016. Such taxation could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

We may become subject to taxes in the Cayman Islands after June 2, 2018, which may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

     Under current Cayman Islands law, we are not obligated to pay any taxes in the Cayman Islands on our income or gains. We have received an undertaking from the Governor-in-Council of the Cayman Islands pursuant to the provisions of the Tax Concessions Law, as amended, that until June 2, 2018, (i) no subsequently enacted law imposing any tax on profits, income, gains or appreciation shall apply to us and (ii) no such tax and no tax in the nature of an estate duty or an inheritance tax shall be payable on any of our ordinary shares, debentures or other obligations. Under current law, no tax will be payable on the transfer or other disposition of our ordinary shares. The Cayman Islands currently impose stamp duties on certain categories of documents; however, our current operations do not involve the payment of stamp duties in any material amount. The Cayman Islands also currently impose an annual corporate fee upon all exempted companies incorporated in the Cayman Islands. Given the limited duration of the undertaking from the Governor-in-Council of the Cayman Islands, we cannot be certain that we will not be subject to any Cayman Islands tax after June 2, 2018. Such taxation could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

40


We and our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries may become subject to U.S. tax, which may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

     We take the position that neither we nor any of our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries are engaged in a U.S. trade or business through a U.S. permanent establishment. Accordingly, we take the position that none of our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries should be subject to U.S. tax (other than U.S. excise tax on insurance and reinsurance premium income attributable to insuring or reinsuring U.S. risks and U.S. withholding tax on some types of U.S. source investment income). However, because there is considerable uncertainty as to the activities that constitute being engaged in a trade or business within the United States, we cannot be certain that the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) will not contend successfully that we or any of our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries are engaged in a trade or business in the United States. If we or any of our Bermuda insurance subsidiaries were considered to be engaged in a trade or business in the United States, any such entity could be subject to U.S. corporate income and additional branch profits taxes on the portion of its earnings effectively connected to such U.S. business, in which case our financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

The Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development is considering measures that might change the manner in which we are taxed.

     On June 27, 2005 the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (“OECD”) issued a discussion draft, “Attribution of Profits to a Permanent Establishment—Release of Discussion Draft of Part IV (Insurance)” (the “Draft”), which constitutes the fourth and final part of the report on OECD’s project to establish a broad consensus regarding the interpretation and practical application of Article 7 (“Article 7”) of the OECD Model Tax Convention on Income and on Capital. Article 7 sets forth international tax principles for attributing profits to a permanent establishment and forms the basis of an extensive network of bilateral income tax treaties between OECD member countries and between many OECD member and non-member countries. Once finalized, the conclusions of Parts I-IV of the report will be implemented through revision of the Commentary on Article 7 and/or Article 7 itself. Section C of the Draft discusses the application of the 1995 OECD Transfer Pricing Guidelines to insurance business conducted between associated enterprises and, if adopted in its current form, might change the manner in which we are taxed and could therefore impact our future after-tax profitability. We cannot predict the effect of any such changes.

ITEM 1B.      UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

     None.

41


ITEM 2.      PROPERTIES

     The Company operates in the United States, Bermuda, Europe and various other locations around the world. In 1997, the Company acquired commercial real estate in Hamilton, Bermuda for the purpose of securing long-term office space for its worldwide headquarters. The development was completed in April 2001. The total cost of this development, including land, was approximately $126.6 million.

     In July 2003, the Company acquired new offices at 70 Gracechurch Street, London, which have become the Company’s new London headquarters. The acquisition was made through a purchase, sale and leaseback transaction. The move to the new offices was completed in 2004 and consolidated the Company’s London businesses in one location. The Company has recorded a capital lease asset and liability of approximately $150.0 million related to this transaction.

     The majority of all other office facilities throughout the world that are occupied by the Company and its subsidiaries are leased.

     Total rent expense for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003 was approximately $34.9 million, $31.2 million and $42.3 million, respectively. See Item 8, Note 18(d) to the Consolidated Financial Statements for discussion of the Company’s lease commitments for real property.

ITEM 3.      LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     On June 21, 2004, a consolidated and amended class action complaint (the “Amended Complaint”) was served on the Company and certain of its present and former directors and officers as defendants in a putative class action (Malin et al. v. XL Capital Ltd et al.) filed in United States District Court, District of Connecticut (the “Malin Action”). The Malin Action purports to be on behalf of purchasers of the Company’s common stock between November 1, 2001 and October 16, 2003, and alleges claims under Sections 10(b) and 20(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and Rule 10b-5 promulgated thereunder (the “Securities Laws”). The Amended Complaint alleged that the defendants violated the Securities Laws by, among other things, failing to disclose in various public and shareholder and investor reports and other communications the alleged inadequacy of the Company’s loss reserves for its NAC Re subsidiary (now known as XL Reinsurance America, Inc.) and that, as a consequence, the Company’s earnings and assets were materially overstated. On August 26, 2005, the Court dismissed the Amended Complaint owing to its failure adequately to allege “loss causation,” but provided leave for the plaintiffs to file a further amended complaint. The plaintiffs thereafter filed a second amended complaint (the “Second Amended Complaint”), which is similar to the Amended Complaint in its substantive allegations. On December 31, 2005, the defendants filed a motion to dismiss the Second Amended Complaint. The plaintiffs have opposed the motion. The Company and the defendant present and former officers and directors intend to vigorously defend the claims asserted against them.

     On June 17, 2004, William Kronenberg, III, Frank A. Piliero and David M. Rosenberg (together, the “Claimants”) commenced an arbitration against the Company before the American Arbitration Association (“AAA”) in New York, New York. The Claimants and the Company were parties to a stock purchase agreement dated June 1, 1999, pursuant to which the Company acquired the outstanding capital stock of ECS, Inc. (the “Stock Purchase Agreement”). In their AAA arbitration demand, the Claimants asserted claims of fraud and deceitful conduct, negligent misrepresentation, and breach of contract and a covenant of good faith and fair dealing, all relating to the allegation that the Company failed to make certain contingent payments allegedly due to the Claimants under the Stock Purchase Agreement. Claimants sought $85 million (the maximum amount payable under the contingent payment provision at issue), plus punitive damages, interest, costs and attorneys’ fees. On February 21, 2006, the AAA panel issued a final award in favor of the Company with respect to the major disputes at issue. The AAA panel referred certain remaining accounting issues to additional arbitration proceedings before an independent accounting firm pursuant to rulings of the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York and the United States Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit concerning the scope of the AAA arbitration. The Claimants have not yet taken a position as to the extent of any damages they may still claim in such arbitration in light of the AAA panel’s award. If the

42


Claimants proceed to arbitration before the accounting firm, the Company will continue to vigorously defend the Claimants’ claims.

     The Company is also subject to litigation and arbitration in the normal course of its business. These lawsuits and arbitrations principally involve claims on policies of insurance and contracts of reinsurance and are typical for the Company and for the property and casualty insurance and reinsurance industry in general. Such legal proceedings are considered in connection with the Company’s loss and loss expense reserves. Reserves in varying amounts may or may not be established in respect of particular claims proceedings based on many factors, including the legal merits thereof. In addition to claims litigation, the Company and its subsidiaries are subject to lawsuits in the normal course of business that do not arise from or directly relate to claims on policies of insurance or contracts of reinsurance.

     As previously disclosed, in May and June of 2005, the Company received a subpoena from the SEC and a grand jury subpoena from the U.S. Attorney’s Office for the Southern District of New York, respectively, in each case for documents and information relating to certain finite-risk and loss mitigation insurance products. The Company is fully cooperating and responding to these requests.

     From time to time, the Company has also received and responded to additional requests from Attorneys General and state insurance regulators for information relating to the Company’s contingent commission arrangements with brokers and agents and the Company’s insurance and reinsurance practices in connection with certain finite-risk and loss mitigation products. Similarly, the Company’s affiliates outside the United States have, from time to time, received and responded to requests from regulators relating to the Company’s insurance and reinsurance practices regarding contingent commissions or finite-risk and loss mitigation products. The Company is fully cooperating with these regulators in these matters.

     On August 1, 2005, plaintiffs in a proposed class action multi-district lawsuit, captioned In re Insurance Brokerage Antitrust Litigation, MDL No. 1663, Civil Action No. 04-5184 (FSH) (the “MDL”), filed a consolidated amended complaint (the “Amended Complaint”), which named as new defendants in the pending action approximately 30 entities, including Greenwich Insurance Company, Indian Harbor Insurance Company and XL Capital Ltd. In the MDL, named plaintiffs have asserted various claims, purportedly on behalf of a class of commercial insureds, against approximately 113 insurance companies and insurance brokers through which the named plaintiffs allegedly purchased insurance. The Amended Complaint alleges that the defendant insurance companies and insurance brokers conspired to manipulate bidding practices for insurance policies in certain insurance lines and failed to disclose certain commission arrangements. The named plaintiffs have asserted statutory claims under the Sherman Act, various state antitrust laws and the Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations Act, as well as common law claims alleging breach of fiduciary duty, aiding and abetting a breach of fiduciary duty and unjust enrichment. Discovery in the MDL continues. Defendants filed motions to dismiss the Amended Complaint in late November 2005. On February 1, 2006, plaintiffs filed a motion seeking leave to further amend their Amended Complaint to, among other things, add additional defendants, including X.L. America, Inc. and XL Insurance America, Inc. That motion was denied without prejudice. On or about February 13, 2006, plaintiffs filed a motion seeking class certification.

     The Company believes that the ultimate outcome of all outstanding litigation and arbitration will not have a material adverse effect on its consolidated financial condition, future operating results and/or liquidity, although an adverse resolution of a number of these items could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations in a particular fiscal quarter or year.

43


ITEM 4.      SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS

     No matters were submitted to a vote of ordinary shareholders during the fourth quarter of the fiscal year covered by this report.

Executive Officers of the Company

     The table below sets forth the names, ages and titles of the persons who were the executive officers of the Company for the year ended December 31, 2005:

Name   
Age 
                                                               Position 


          
Brian M. O’Hara   
57 
  President, Chief Executive Officer and Director 
         
Fiona E. Luck   
48 
  Executive Vice President, Global Head of Corporate Services and Assistant 
   
  Secretary 
         
Jerry M. de St. Paer   
64 
  Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and Assistant 
   
  Secretary 
         
Charles F. Barr   
56 
  Executive Vice President and General Counsel 
         
Christopher V. Greetham   
61 
  Executive Vice President and Chief Investment Officer 
         
Clive R. Tobin   
56 
  Executive Vice President of the Company and Chief Executive of Insurance 
   
  Operations 
         
Henry C.V. Keeling   
50 
  Executive Vice President of the Company and Chief Executive of 
   
  Reinsurance Operations and Global Head of Business Services 
         
Paul S. Giordano   
43 
  Executive Vice President of the Company and Chief Executive of Financial 
   
 
Products and Services Operations
         
Anthony E. Beale   
63 
  Senior Vice President, Head of Global Human Resources 

     Brian M. O’Hara has been President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company since 1994 and a Director of the Company since 1986, having previously served as Vice Chairman of the Company from 1987. He is Chairman of XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and was Chief Executive Officer of XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd until 1998, having previously served as Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer from 1994, President and Chief Executive Officer from 1992 and as President and Chief Operating Officer from 1986.

     Fiona E. Luck has been Executive Vice President and Global Head of Corporate Services since November 2004 and Assistant Secretary since January 2002. From 1999 to 2004, Ms. Luck was Executive Vice President of Group Operations of the Company. Ms. Luck was previously employed at ACE Bermuda as Executive Vice President from 1998, and Senior Vice President from 1997. From 1992 to 1997, Ms. Luck was the Managing Director of the Marsh & McLennan Global Broking office in Bermuda.

     Jerry M. de St. Paer has been Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of the Company since February 2001. Mr. de St. Paer was appointed Treasurer and Assistant Secretary of the Company in January 2002. Mr. de St. Paer was previously Managing Director of Hudson International Advisors in New York. Prior to forming Hudson International in 1998, he served as Managing Director, Insurance at J.P. Morgan & Company, Inc. Mr. de St. Paer was previously employed at The Equitable (now AXA Financial Advisors), from 1986 until 1997, serving most recently as Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of The Equitable and as Executive Vice President of Strategic Studies and Development of the AXA Group.

     Charles F. Barr has been Executive Vice President and General Counsel of the Company since November 2004, having previously served as General Counsel of X.L. America, Inc. from 2002. Before joining the Company, Mr. Barr was General Counsel of Benfield Blanch from 2000 to 2002. Mr. Barr was previously Senior Vice President,

44


Secretary and General Counsel of General Re Corporation from 1994 to 2000 and Assistant General Counsel from 1989 to 1994. Prior to that he was Senior Vice President and General Counsel of General Accident Insurance Company of America from 1987 to 1989.

     Christopher V. Greetham has been Executive Vice President of the Company since December 1998 and has served as Chief Investment Officer of the Company since 1996. Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Greetham served as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of OIL Insurance Ltd from 1982 to 1996 and as Vice President of Bankers Trust Company from 1975 to 1982.

     Clive R. Tobin has been Executive Vice President and Chief Executive of Insurance Operations since April 2004. Mr. Tobin was President and Chief Executive of XL Winterthur International from February 2002, having previously served as Deputy Chief Executive and Chief Underwriting Officer of XL Winterthur International following the Company’s acquisition of the risk management business from Credit Suisse in 2001, and President and Chief Executive of XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd since July 1999. From 1995 to 1999, Mr. Tobin held a variety of senior management positions at XL. Prior to joining XL in 1995, Mr. Tobin served as President of Rockefeller Insurance Company and Acadia Risk Management Services, Inc., in New York. From 1979 to 1986, Mr. Tobin served as Vice President of Risk Management Services for Marsh & McLennan, Inc.

     Henry C.V. Keeling was Executive Vice President of the Company (“EVP”) and Chief Executive of Reinsurance Operations from July 2000 until November 2004 when he was appointed EVP, Chief Executive of Reinsurance Operations and Global Head of Business Services, and January 2006 when he became EVP, Chief Global Head of Business Services and Chief Executive, Reinsurance Life Operations. Mr. Keeling was Chief Executive Officer of XL Re Ltd since August 1998. Mr. Keeling was President and Chief Operating and Underwriting Officer of Mid Ocean Re (now known as XL Re Ltd) from 1992 to 1998. He previously served as a director of Taylor Clayton (Underwriting Agencies) Ltd and deputy underwriter for Syndicate 51 at Lloyd’s from 1984 through 1992.

     Paul S. Giordano has been Executive Vice President and Chief Executive of Financial Products and Services since November 2004. Mr. Giordano served as General Counsel of the Company from January 1997 to November 2004. Mr. Giordano was associated with Cleary, Gottlieb, Steen & Hamilton and Clifford Chance in New York and London prior to joining the Company.

     Anthony E. Beale has been Senor Vice President, Head of Global Human Resources since he joined the Company in September 2000. Mr Beale was Managing Director at Santander Investment Securities from 1997 to 1999. Mr. Beale previously served as Managing Director of J.P. Morgan until 1997.

45


PART II

ITEM 5.     MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

     The Company’s Class A ordinary shares, $0.01 par value, are listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “XL”.

     The following table sets forth the high, low and closing sales prices per share of the Company’s Class A ordinary shares per fiscal quarter, as reported on the New York Stock Exchange Composite Tape.

  High    Low   
Close 

          
          
2005:
           
     1st Quarter
  $79.80     $70.89    
$72.37   
     2nd Quarter
  76.05    67.40   
74.42 
     3rd Quarter
  74.99    64.95   
68.03 
     4th Quarter
  74.44    60.03   
67.38 
             
2004:
         
     1st Quarter
  $81.54      $72.44     
$76.04   
     2nd Quarter
  79.55    73.92   
75.46 
     3rd Quarter
  75.99    68.87   
73.99 
     4th Quarter
  79.56    67.62   
77.65 

     Each Class A ordinary share has one vote, except if, and so long as, the Controlled Shares (defined below) of any person constitute ten percent (10%) or more of the issued Class A ordinary shares, the voting rights with respect to the Controlled Shares owned by such person are limited, in the aggregate, to a voting power of approximately 10%, pursuant to a formula specified in the Articles of Association. “Controlled Shares” includes, among other things, all Class A ordinary shares which such person is deemed to beneficially own directly, indirectly or constructively (within the meaning of Section 13(d)(3) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 or Section 958 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended).

     The number of record holders of Class A ordinary shares as of December 31, 2005 was 932. This figure does not represent the actual number of beneficial owners of the Company’s Class A ordinary shares because such shares are frequently held in “street name” by securities dealers and others for the benefit of individual owners who may vote the shares.

     In 2005, four quarterly dividends were paid at $0.50 per share to all ordinary shareholders of record as of March 10, June 9, September 8 and December 8. In 2004, four regular quarterly dividends were paid at $0.49 per share to all ordinary shareholders of record as of March 8, June 7, September 6 and December 6.

     Management has recommended that the Board of Directors reduce the future quarterly dividend payable on the Company’s Class A ordinary shares to $0.38 per share.

     On January 27, 2006, the Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend of $0.38 per share payable on March 31, 2006 to shareholders of record on March 15, 2006.

     The declaration and payment of future dividends by the Company will be at the discretion of the Board of Directors and will depend upon many factors, including the Company’s earnings, financial condition, business needs, capital and surplus requirements of the Company’s operating subsidiaries and regulatory and contractual restrictions.

     As a holding company, the Company’s principal source of income is dividends or other statutorily permissible payments from its subsidiaries. The ability to pay such dividends is limited by the applicable laws and regulations of

46


the various countries that the Company operates in, including Bermuda, the United States and the U.K., and those of the Society of Lloyd’s, and certain contractual provisions. See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8, Note 24 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion.

     Rights to purchase Class A ordinary shares (“Rights”) were distributed as a dividend at the rate of one Right for each Class A ordinary share held of record as of the close of business on October 31, 1998. Each Right entitles holders of Class A ordinary shares to buy one ordinary share at an exercise price of $350. The Rights would be exercisable, and would detach from the Class A ordinary shares, only if a person or group were to acquire 20% or more of the Company’s outstanding Class A ordinary shares, or were to announce a tender or exchange offer that, if consummated, would result in a person or group beneficially owning 20% or more of Class A ordinary shares. Upon a person or group without prior approval of the Board acquiring 20% or more of Class A ordinary shares, each Right would entitle the holder (other than such an acquiring person or group) to purchase Class A ordinary shares (or, in certain circumstances, Class A ordinary shares of the acquiring person) with a value of twice the Rights exercise price upon payment of the Rights exercise price. The Company will be entitled to redeem the Rights at $0.01 per Right at any time until the close of business on the tenth day after the Rights become exercisable. The Rights will expire at the close of business on September 30, 2008, and do not initially have a fair value. The Company has initially reserved 119,073,878 Class A ordinary shares being authorized and unissued for issue upon exercise of Rights.

     Information concerning securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans appears in Part III, Item 12, “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters.”

     Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliate Purchases

     The following table provides information about purchases by the Company during the quarter ended December 31, 2005 of equity securities that are registered by the Company pursuant to Section 12 of the Exchange Act:

            Total Number    Approximate Dollar
            Of Shares    Value of Shares
            Purchases as    that May Yet Be
            Part of    Purchased Under
    Total Number    Average Price    Publicly    the Plans
    of Shares    Paid    Announced Plans    or Programs
Period    Purchased (1)    per share (2)    or Programs   
(3)





October      7,486    73.88   
  $135.4 million
November        997    68.09   
  $135.4 million
December      1,837    66.31   
  $135.4 million



Total    10,320    71.97   
  $135.4 million


 


(1)      All of the shares included in each period were purchased in connection with the vesting of restricted shares granted under the Company’s restricted stock plan. All of these purchases were made in connection with satisfying tax withholding obligations of those employees. These shares were not purchased as part of the Company’s publicly announced share repurchase program.
(2) The price paid per share is the closing price of the shares on the vesting date.
(3) On January 9, 2000, the Board of Directors previously authorized a $500.0 million share repurchase program. The Company did not repurchase any equity securities under the program during the year ended December 31, 2005. As of December 31, 2005 the Company could repurchase up to approximately $135.4 million of the Company’s equity securities under the Company’s share repurchase program.
 

47


ITEM 6.      SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

     The selected consolidated financial data below is based upon the Company’s fiscal year end of December 31. The selected consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements and the Notes thereto presented under Item 8.

       
2005(1)
 
2004(1)
 
2003(1)
2002(1)
2001
 


       

       
       
       
 
       
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts and ratios) 
 
Income Statement Data:       
   
   
   
   
 
   Net premiums earned – general operations       
$
6,873,638    
$
6,987,940    
$
6,089,578    
$
4,889,867      
$
2,706,541  
   Net premiums earned – financial operations       
254,136    
228,898    
195,344    
162,357    
73,386  
   Net premiums earned – life and annuity operations       
2,237,721    
1,365,176    
708,994    
990,736    
695,595  
   Net investment income       
1,475,039    
1,035,012    
815,487    
758,358    
624,914  
   Net realized gains (losses) on investments       
241,882    
246,547    
120,195    
(214,160 )   
(93,237 ) 
   Net realized and unrealized       
   
   
   
   
 
       gains (losses) on derivative instruments 
     
28,858    
73,493    
6,073    
(41,546 )   
13,041  
   Net income from investment affiliates (2)(7)       
154,844    
124,008    
119,200    
54,143    
80,580  
   Fee income and other       
19,297    
35,317    
41,744    
54,963    
18,247  
   Net losses and loss expenses incurred –       
   
   
   
   
 
       general operations       
7,358,929    
4,796,855    
4,595,992
   
3,358,955     2,885,339  
   Net losses and loss expenses incurred –       
   
   
   
   
 
       financial operations       
106,072    
114,633    
100,435    
69,477    
33,559  
   Claims and policy benefits – life operations       
2,479,364    
1,480,535    
791,454    
1,031,704    
698,675  
   Acquisition costs, operating expenses       
   
   
   
   
 
       and foreign exchange gains and losses       
2,188,357    
2,277,321    
1,926,393    
1,549,440      
1,073,903  
   Interest expense       
403,849    
292,234    
233,929    
190,442    
125,298  
   Amortization of intangible assets       
10,752    
15,827    
4,637    
6,187    
58,569  
   (Loss) income before minority interests,       
   
   
   
   
 
       net income from operating affiliates       
   
   
   
   
 
       and income tax expense       
(1,261,908 )   
1,118,986    
443,775    
448,513    
(756,276 ) 
   Preference share dividends       
40,322    
40,321    
40,321    
9,620    
 
   Net (Loss) income available to ordinary shareholders    .   
$
(1,292,298 )   
$
1,126,292    
$
371,658    
$
395,951    
$
(576,135
) 
 
Per Share Data:       
   
   
   
   
 
   Net (loss) income per ordinary share – basic (3)       
$
(9.14 )   
$
8.17    
$
2.71    
$
2.92    
$
(4.55 ) 
   Net (loss) income per ordinary share – diluted (3)       
$
(9.14 )   
$
8.13    
$
2.69    
$
2.88    
$
(4.55 ) 
   Weighted average ordinary shares       
   
   
   
   
 
   Outstanding – diluted (3)       
141,406    
138,582    
138,187    
137,388    
126,676  
   Cash dividends per ordinary share       
$
2.00    
$
1.96    
$
1.92    
$
1.88     $
1.84  

48


   
2005(1)
 
2004(1)
2003(1)
2002(1)
2001
 


       

       

       

       

 
   
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts and ratios)
 
Balance Sheet Data:   
   
   
   
   
 
   Total investments available for sale   
$
35,724,439    
$
27,823,828    
$
20,775,256    
$
16,059,733    
$
12,429,845  
   Cash and cash equivalents   
3,693,475    
2,203,726    
2,722,405    
3,595,782    
2,201,723  
   Investments in affiliates   
2,046,721    
1,936,852    
1,903,341    
1,750,005    
1,113,344  
   Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable   
6,441,522    
6,971,356    
6,045,025    
5,223,966    
4,803,248  
   Premiums receivable   
3,799,041    
3,838,228    
3,487,322    
3,592,713    
2,182,348  
   Total assets   
58,454,901    
49,245,469    
41,455,745    
35,971,325    
28,508,129  
   Unpaid losses and loss expenses   
23,767,672    
19,837,669    
16,763,124    
13,332,502    
11,806,745  
   Unearned premiums   
5,388,996    
5,191,368    
4,729,989    
4,028,299    
2,636,428  
   Notes payable and debt   
3,412,698    
2,721,431    
1,905,483    
1,877,957    
1,604,877  
   Shareholders’ equity   
8,471,811    
7,738,695    
6,936,915    
6,569,589    
5,437,184  
   Book value per ordinary share   
$
44.31    
$
51.98    
$
46.74    
$
44.48    
$
40.35  
 
Operating Ratios:   
   
   
   
   
 
   Loss and loss expense ratio (4)   
107.1 %   
68.6 %   
75.5 %   
68.6 %   
106.6 % 
   Underwriting expense ratio (5)   
25.8 %   
27.3 %   
27.3 %   
28.9 %   
33.8 % 
   Combined ratio (6)   
132.9 %   
95.9 %   
102.8 %   
97.5 %   
140.4 % 

(1)      Results for all periods subsequent to July 1, 2001 include the results of Winterthur International, which was acquired with effect from this date. The results also include the consolidation of XL Re Europe, which has been accounted for as a subsidiary with effect from January 1, 2002. In the year ended December 31, 2001 the Company’s share of net income of Le Mans Ré (now known as XL Re Europe) was included in equity in net income of operating affiliates. The Company’s net income for the years ended December 31, 2001 and after was impacted by the September 11 event. The effect of all of these items should be considered when making period to period comparisons of the Company’s results of operations and financial condition and liquidity. See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” for further discussion and analysis.
(2) Net income from investment affiliates in 2003 includes income on the alternative investment portfolio for eleven months ended November 30, 2003 as compared to the twelve months ended December 31 in prior years and the twelve months ended November 30 in subsequent years. The fair market values of certain of these alternative investments often take longer to obtain as compared to the other of our investments and we record the investment affiliates on a one month lag in order for us to meet the accelerated filing deadlines as specified by the SEC.
(3) Net income per ordinary share is based on the basic and diluted weighted average number of Class A ordinary shares and share equivalents outstanding for each period. Net loss per ordinary share is based on the basic weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding.
(4) The loss and loss expense ratio is calculated by dividing the losses and loss expenses incurred by the net premiums earned for general insurance and reinsurance operations.
(5) The underwriting expense ratio is the sum of acquisition expenses and operating expenses for general insurance and reinsurance operations divided by net premiums earned for general insurance and reinsurance operations. See Item 8, Note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.
(6) The combined ratio is the sum of the loss and loss expense ratio and the underwriting expense ratio. A combined ratio under 100% represents an underwriting profit and over 100% represents an underwriting loss.
(7) Certain reclassifications to prior period information have been made to conform to current year presentation.
 

49


ITEM 7.     MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     This “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” contains forward-looking statements which involve inherent risks and uncertainties. Statements that are not historical facts, including statements about the Company’s beliefs and expectations, are forward-looking statements. These statements are based upon current plans, estimates and expectations. Actual results may differ materially from those projected in such forward-looking statements, and therefore undue reliance should not be placed on them. See “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements” for a list of additional factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statement.

     This discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with the audited Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes thereto presented under Item 8.

     Certain aspects of the Company’s business have loss experience characterized as low frequency and high severity. This may result in volatility in both the Company’s results of operations and financial condition.

Executive Overview

     The Company operates on a global basis primarily in the property and casualty industry and, to a lesser extent, the financial services industry. The Company serves the insurance, reinsurance and financial services needs of institutional and corporate clients, typically the global equivalent of the Fortune 2000. The Company operates in markets where the Company believes its underwriting expertise and financial strength represent a relative advantage. The Company does not operate in any retail markets.

     The property and casualty insurance and reinsurance markets have historically been cyclical, meaning that based on market conditions, there have been periods where premium rates are high and policy terms and conditions are more favorable (a “hard market”) to the Company and there have been periods where premium rates decline and policy terms and conditions are less favorable (a “soft market”) to the Company. This has been driven primarily by competition in the marketplace, the supply of capital in the industry, investment yields and the frequency and severity of loss events. Management’s goal is to build long-term shareholder value by capitalizing on current opportunities and managing through any potential downward cycles by reducing its property and casualty book of business and exposures if and when rates deteriorate to unprofitable levels for the Company. As part of its long-term strategy, the Company also looks to its financial products and services segment to provide a diversified stream of earnings that are not directly tied to the property and casualty cycle. In this regard, the Company’s financial guaranty operations have substantially achieved relative trading parity with its peers.

     The Company has grown through acquisition activity and development of new business opportunities. Acquisitions included Global Capital Underwriting Ltd in 1996, Mid Ocean Limited in 1998, ECS, Inc. and NAC Re Corp. in 1999, Winterthur International in 2001 and Le Mans Ré in 2002. All acquisitions have supported the Company’s strategic plan to develop a global platform in insurance and reinsurance. Recent business developments include XL Capital Assurance Inc. and XL Financial Assurance Ltd., the Company’s financial guaranty primary and reinsurance guarantors, XL Weather & Energy Inc. and XL Life Insurance & Annuity Company. As a result of these combined developments, the Company now competes as an integrated global business with more than 3,500 employees in 29 countries.

     The Company earns its revenue primarily from net premiums written and earned. Premium rates in the property and casualty industry began to increase in 2001 following five years of poor underwriting performance in the industry. These price increases were further compounded by the September 11 event. In the three years ended December 31, 2003, the Company experienced pricing increases and improved terms and conditions across most of the lines of business it writes. These generally across-the-board price increases were unprecedented, meaning that, in the past, pricing increases and more favorable terms and conditions were not experienced across all of the Company’s product lines at one point in any one cycle.

50


     During 2004, property and casualty market conditions overall remained attractive although price competition increased throughout the year, most notably in regards to property and professional lines. Accordingly, the Company continued to focus on disciplined risk selection. In relation to insurance and reinsurance, downward pressure on rates across most non-catastrophe exposed lines continued throughout 2005 although the impact of the 2004 storm season, the backdrop of continued emergence of adverse development related to the market of the late 1990s and concerns about reinsurer financial strength, all served to reinforce a sense of discipline in the market.

     Subsequent to the unprecedented catastrophic losses in 2005 and into the 2006 first quarter renewals, the market in general has seen an improvement in terms and conditions as well as pricing, in particular in geographic territories and classes impacted by the catastrophe losses. Casualty and professional lines, which have seen significant price reductions in 2004 and 2005, have begun to stabilize. In the Reinsurance segment, however, these improvements have been offset somewhat by increased ceding company retentions which is common in a hardening market. While the Company is not focused on top line premium growth unless it is profitable and meets demanding standards and internal hurdle rates, the Company’s expectation is for flat earned premium growth for the full year of 2006, with insurance contributing flat to low single digit growth and reinsurance contributing flat to mid-single digit declines.

     The Company also generates revenue from investment activities through returns on its investment portfolio. The Company’s current investment strategy seeks to support the liabilities arising from the operations of the Company, generate investment income and build book value over the longer term. During both 2005 and 2004, interest rates in the U.S. increased. During 2005, the U.S. yield curve flattened significantly, as short to medium term rates increased significantly while long-term rates showed a small decline. The benchmark 90-day treasury rose from 2.22% to 4.08% and the 5-year treasury rose from 3.61% to 4.35%, while the 30-year treasury fell from 4.83% to 4.54% . Interest rates declined in the U.K., where the yield on the benchmark 5-year Gilt fell from 4.49% to 4.17%, however, in the Euro-zone, the yield on the benchmark 5-year German Bund rose slightly from 3.03% to 3.07% .

     The Company expects net investment income to rise in 2006 supported by positive cash flow from operating activities and anticipated moderate increases in market interest rates.

     In 2005, the Company generated net realized gains from both its equity and fixed income portfolios, reflecting the current and accumulated performance of the capital markets. In 2004, the Company generated net realized gains from both its equity and fixed income portfolios reflecting the overall performance of capital markets and the deterioration of the U.S. dollar relative to foreign currencies. In 2003, the Company generated net realized gains from both its equity and fixed income portfolios reflecting the overall improvement in capital markets and narrowing of credit spreads.

     The Company’s profitability in any given period is based upon its premium and investment revenues as noted above, less net losses incurred and expenses. Net losses incurred are based upon claims paid and changes to unpaid loss reserves. Unpaid loss reserves are estimated by the Company and include both reported loss reserves and reserves for losses incurred but not reported. The Company’s results for 2005 were significantly impacted by the unprecedented insured hurricane losses during the 2005 Atlantic hurricane season, the charge related to the conclusion of the independent actuarial process with Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company and adverse development of prior year loss reserves in both insurance professional lines and reinsurance casualty lines. The Company’s results for 2004 were also significantly impacted by the catastrophe activity in the year, which resulted in $591.2 million in estimated net loss and loss expenses, combined with adverse prior year development in certain lines of the Company’s insurance segment. For a further discussion of these events see “Results of Operations” below.

51


     Financial measures

     The following are some of the financial measures management considers important in evaluating the Company’s operating performance in the Company’s general operations:

(U.S. dollars in thousands, except ratios and per share amounts)     
2005
2004
2003
 


 

 

 
Underwriting (loss) profit – general operations      $  (2,268,164 )    $ 343,990     $ (112,594 ) 
Combined ratio – general operations        132.9 %    95.9 %    102.8 % 
Investment income – general operations      $  798,805     $ 614,128     $ 542,074  
Book value per ordinary share      $  44.31     $ 51.98     $ 46.74  
Return on average ordinary shareholders’ equity        NA     16.5 %    6.0 % 

     Underwriting profit (loss) – general operations

     One way that the Company evaluates the performance of its insurance and reinsurance general operations is the underwriting profit or loss. The Company does not measure performance based on the amount of gross premiums written. Underwriting profit or loss is calculated from premiums earned and fee income, less net losses incurred and expenses related to the underwriting activities. As noted above, the Company’s underwriting profit and loss for the last three years have been negatively impacted by net losses incurred from catastrophic losses, the results of the independent actuarial process with Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company and adverse development of prior year loss reserves. Partially offsetting this has been the addition of certain new business lines, the increase in premium rates in 2003 and favorable underwriting terms and conditions. Any changes to loss reserves affect the calculation of underwriting profit or loss but most often do not directly affect the Company’s cash flow in the same period. See further discussion below. Barring any unusual catastrophic loss events, the Company expects to produce an underwriting profit in 2006.

     Combined ratio – general operations

     The combined ratio for general operations is used by the Company and many other insurance and reinsurance companies as another measure of underwriting profitability. The combined ratio is calculated from the net losses incurred and underwriting expenses as a ratio of the net premiums earned for the Company’s general insurance and reinsurance operations. A combined ratio of less than 100% indicates an underwriting profit and over 100% indicates an underwriting loss. The Company’s combined ratio for the last three years have been negatively impacted by the factors affecting the underwriting profit (loss), noted above.

     Net investment income – general operations

     Net investment income from its general operations is an important measure that affects the Company’s overall profitability. The largest liability of the Company relates to its unpaid loss reserves and the Company’s investment portfolio provides liquidity for claims settlements of these reserves as they become due, and thus a significant part of the portfolio is in fixed income securities. Net investment income is primarily affected both by the size of the portfolio and the level of market interest rates. In 2005, the U.S. yield curve flattened significantly with U.S. short to medium term interest rates increasing markedly while long term rates showed a small decline. U.K. rates declined, while in the Euro-zone short term rates rose while medium to long term rates declined. In 2004, U.S. interest rates increased moderately while interest rates in the U.K. and Euro-zone declined. The size of the portfolio is also impacted by cash flow generated from operations and financing, which has been positive during the last three years and which the Company currently expects to be positive in 2006.

     Book value per ordinary share

     Management also views the change in the Company’s book value per ordinary share as an additional measure of the Company’s performance. Book value per share is calculated by dividing ordinary shareholders’ equity by the number of outstanding ordinary shares at any period end. Book value per ordinary share is affected primarily by

52


the Company’s net income and also by any changes in the net unrealized gains and losses on its investment portfolio. The Company’s book value per ordinary share decreased in 2005 as a result of the underwriting losses incurred, partially offset by the significant capital-raising during December 2005, where ordinary shares were issued at a premium to the book value at that time. During 2005, book value per share also decreased as a result of a decrease in the unrealized gains on the Company’s investment portfolio. The decrease was primarily as a result of increasing short to medium term U.S. interest rates, partially offset by declining longer term U.K. interest rates. The Company’s book value per ordinary share increased in 2004, primarily as a result of an increase in net income combined with an increase in the net unrealized gains on the investment portfolio. The increase in unrealized gains on the Company’s fixed income portfolio was primarily a result of the foreign exchange benefits for non-U.S. dollar investments partially offset by a moderate increase in interest rates in the U.S.

     Return on average ordinary shareholders’ equity

     Return on average ordinary shareholder’s equity (“ROE”) is a widely used measure of any company’s profitability. It is calculated by dividing the net income for any period by the average of the opening and closing ordinary shareholders’ equity. The Company establishes minimum target ROEs for its total operations, segments and lines of business. If the Company’s minimum ROE targets over the longer term are not met with respect to any line of business, the Company seeks to modify and/or exit these lines. In addition, the Company’s compensation of its senior officers is significantly dependent on the achievement of the Company’s performance goals to enhance shareholder value as measured by ROE. The Company reported a loss in 2005 and ROEs for the prior two years have been negatively affected mainly by its general operations’ underwriting results and investment income.

Other Key Focuses of Management

     Ratings and Capital Management

     The Company’s ability to underwrite business is largely dependent upon the quality of its claims paying and financial strength ratings as evaluated by independent rating agencies. As a result, in the event that the Company’s financial strength rating is downgraded, its ability to write business will be adversely affected. Such a downgrade would also adversely affect the Company’s financial guaranty lines of business. During the third and fourth quarters of 2005 a number of ratings actions were taken by independent rating agencies including some downgrades of the Company’s principal insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries. The Company subsequently raised $3.2 billion through an issuance of a combination of ordinary shares and equity security units. The financial strength ratings of the Company’s financial guaranty companies remain “triple A” with a stable outlook (by Standard & Poor’s, Moody’s and Fitch Ratings). For a further discussion see “Ratings” above.

     To address rating agency requirements regarding the differential between the triple-A ratings of the Company’s financial guaranty companies and their affiliated companies, management is currently exploring a number of strategies that would provide greater independence and stability to XLCA’s and XLFA’s ratings. Examples of actions identified by the rating agencies are, among other things, the inclusion of additional independent directors to the boards of directors of the Company’s financial guaranty companies; adding some level of outside high-quality ownership with voting and/or veto rights; and securing a resolution from each of the boards of directors of the Company’s financial guaranty companies that clarifies our expectations regarding cash payments from the financial guaranty companies. S&P has stated that one or more of these actions will need to be taken by mid-year 2006.

     In the normal course of business, the Company evaluates its capital needs to support the volume of business written in order to maintain its claims paying and financial strength ratings. In response to the unprecedented insured hurricane losses during the 2005 Atlantic hurricane season, the loss related to the conclusion of the independent actuarial process with WSIC, rising capital requirements for the property catastrophe business from rating agencies and the currently anticipated growth in business to be written in 2006, the Company raised $3.2 billion in capital through the issuance of a combination of ordinary shares and equity security units. In addition, the Company has implemented several key business initiatives with ratings and capital management implications.

      1.      Management has entered into a strategic initiative intended to augment the Company’s overall underwriting capacity to take advantage of opportunities in certain catastrophe-exposed lines of business. Management has entered into a collateralized quota share reinsurance treaty with Cyrus Reinsurance Limited. Under this agreement, as of January 1, 2006, the Company cedes specified portions of the Company’s property catastrophe reinsurance and retrocession lines of business.
 
  2. Management continues to reduce the Company’s net catastrophe exposed risks. In the Insurance segment, management continues to reduce exposure to accounts that have the potential for significant volatility under wors-
 

53


             ening catastrophe event scenarios, reduce catastrophe sublimits and eliminate accounts that no longer meet the Company’s increased pricing needs. In addition to the strategic initiative noted above, the Reinsurance segment’s management intends to reduce catastrophe exposure within the property risk portfolio and restructure the way in which marine excess of loss programs are written.

     Operational Efficiency and Effectiveness

     The Company’s ability to compete is influenced by its operational efficiency and effectiveness, including the development and retention of its people. In recognition of this, the Company has in place and continues to develop, programs and initiatives aimed at enhancing its position in these areas. For example, the Company continues to make significant investments in information technology in both the Insurance and Reinsurance segments, develop and implement a new framework for Financial Reporting and Controls, and establish an operations center, based in, India. Each of these projects requires considerable investment and commitment of the Company’s resources in an effort to achieve the ultimate goals of increased operational efficiency and effectiveness.

     Collateral Management

     Another important matter on which management is focused (and which also affects the Company’s ability to underwrite business) is the availability of collateral. Collateral includes letters of credit, insurance trusts and other credit facilities required to provide security to cedants (which are companies who reinsure their liabilities to the Company), particularly as required by state insurance regulation in the U.S. and at Lloyd’s, and also to provide the Company with liquidity as required. These facilities are provided to the Company from commercial banks. Our principal credit facilities have tenors of two, three, and five years. The Company has also utilized “off balance sheet” transactions in order to obtain more collateral capacity (these transactions are described below under “Variable Interest Entities and Other Off Balance Sheet Arrangements”). As the Company writes more business, its collateral requirements will increase. A key challenge for management is to ensure that sufficient collateral capacity is available as to not hinder future writing of business.

     Liquidity and cash flow

     As a property and casualty insurer, the Company must ensure that it has sufficient funds to settle claims promptly, especially upon the occurrence of a major catastrophic event. Management is focused on making sure that liquidity requirements are supported by having lines of credit facilities available to the Company as well as by the Company’s general investment portfolio of which the majority is in high grade fixed income securities. The Company has had significant positive cash flow from operations in the three years ended December 31, 2005 generated from its underwriting activities (premiums less claim and expense settlements) as well as the receipt of investment income on its portfolio. In addition during 2005, capital raising activity provided significant cash flows from financing activities. The Company expects cash flow from operations to be positive in 2006.

54


Results of Operations

     The following table presents an analysis of the Company’s net income available to ordinary shareholders and other financial measures (described below) for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003:

(U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts)   
2005
2004 
2003 


            

          

Net (loss) income available to ordinary shareholders   
$
(1,292,298 )   
$
1,126,292   
$
371,658 


 



(Loss) earnings per ordinary share – basic   
$
(9.14 )   
$
8.17   
$
2.71 
(Loss) earnings per ordinary share – diluted   
$
(9.14 )   
$
8.13   
$
2.69 
Weighted average number of ordinary shares and ordinary   
   
   
 
   share equivalents – basic   
141,406    
137,903   
136,906 
Weighted average number of ordinary shares and ordinary   
   
   
 
   share equivalents – diluted   
141,406    
138,582   
138,187 

     The Company’s net (loss) income and other financial measures as shown above for the three years ended December 31 have been affected, among other things, by the following significant items:

      1)      Significant large catastrophe activity;
 
  2) The impact of the unvaforable result of the independent actuarial process with Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company;
 
  3) Net adverse prior year loss development in general insurance and reinsurance operations;
 
  4) Growing asset base and positive performance from investments in affiliates.

     1. Significant large catastrophe activity (Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and other natural catastrophes)

     During the third and fourth quarters of 2005, there was an unprecedented number of natural catastrophes. In August 2005, Hurricane Katrina, a Category 4 storm, hit the Gulf Coast of the United States and is estimated to have caused the largest ever insured loss from a natural disaster in the property and casualty insurance industry. In September 2005, Hurricane Rita, a Category 3 storm, hit the Gulf Coast on the United States and caused considerable damage, although Rita was less severe than Katrina. In October 2005, Hurricane Wilma hit South Florida after causing significant damage in Mexico and Cuba. In addition, there were several other natural loss events in the third and fourth quarter 2005, including hurricanes Dennis, Emily and Ophelia, the European and Mumbai Floods and Typhoon Mawar (collectively, the “Other Cats”). Collectively, Hurricanes Katrina, Rita, Wilma, and these Other Cats have had a substantial impact on the Company’s results of operations and financial condition.

     As a result of the substantial impact the Hurricanes Katrina, Rita, Wilma and the Other Cats have had on the results of the Company for the year ended December 31, 2005, the Company has estimated losses incurred, net of reinsurance recoveries, of $1.27 billion, $357.9 million and $247.1 million and $96.0 million, respectively, based on preliminary reports and estimates of such loss and damage. The Company has performed an analysis of contracts it believes are exposed to these catastrophes and, together with other preliminary information received from insureds and cedents and industry models, has determined its best estimates at this time for the expected ultimate loss. Actual losses may vary materially from this estimate based on a number of factors, including receipt of additional information from insureds or brokers, the attribution of losses to coverages and/or layers that had not previously been considered as exposed and inflation in repair costs due to additional demand for labor and materials. In addition, the loss estimate includes a high level of uncertainty related to, among other things, complex coverage issues associated with Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma and potential legal developments that may result in ultimate losses not being known for a considerable period of time. Therefore, losses may ultimately be materially greater or lesser than the current estimate and accordingly impact future financial results. Losses in connection with these events were incurred almost equally from the Company’s Insurance and Reinsurance segments.

55


     The year ended December 31, 2004 was negatively impacted by four hurricanes, Frances, Charley, Ivan and Jeanne, for a total net loss of $516.6 million, net of reinsurance recoveries. In addition, the Company incurred net losses and loss expenses of $74.6 million in 2004 as a result of the earthquake and the subsequent tsunami that struck South Asia on December 26, 2004.

     The following are analyses of the financial impact on the Company’s results of operations for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 from natural catastrophes:

   
Year ended
 
   
December 31, 2005
 
   
(U.S. dollars in millions, except ratios)
 










 
   
Financial
 
   
Products and
 
   
Insurance
Reinsurance
Services
Total
 


       

       

       

 
Operating Data:               
       
Net premiums earned               
       
   Katrina    $  (74.6 )    $  16.3    
$
23.6     $  (34.7 ) 
   Rita      (13.3 )      8.8    
      (4.5 ) 
   Wilma      (1.2 )      6.2    
      5.0  
   Other natural catastrophes*            3.4    
      3.4  


 

 

 

 
   Total net premiums earned    $  (89.1 )    $  34.7    
$
23.6     $  (30.8 ) 


 

 

 

 
 
Gross losses and loss expenses:               
       
   Katrina      1,339.7       1,128.0    
45.0       2,512.7  
   Rita      521.9       232.4    
      754.3  
   Wilma      172.7       214.4    
      387.1  
   Other natural catastrophes*      40.2       57.5    
      97.7  


 

 

 

 
   Total gross losses and loss expenses    $  2,074.5     $  1,632.3    
$
45.0     $  3,751.8  


 

 

 

 
 
Losses and loss expenses recoverable:               
       
   Katrina      748.6       495.3    
      1,243.9  
   Rita      312.9       83.5    
      396.4  
   Wilma      64.3       75.7    
      140.0  
   Other natural catastrophes*      1.7          
      1.7  


 

 

 

 
   Total losses and loss expenses recoverable    $  1,127.5     $  654.5    
$
    $  1,782.0  


 

 

 

 
Underwriting loss    $  (1,036.1 )    $  (943.1 )   
$
(21.4 )    $  (2,000.6 ) 


 

 

 

 
Income tax benefit               
    $  135.5  


 
Net loss               
    $  (1,865.1 ) 


 
Loss ratio impact for the year ended December 31, 2005 
      28.7 % 


*      Other natural Catastrophes include European and Mumbai floods, Hurricanes Dennis, Emily and Ophelia and Typhoon Mawar.

56


   
Year ended
 
   
December 31, 2004
 
   
(U.S. dollars in millions, except ratios)
 


 
   
Insurance
Reinsurance
Total
 


       

       

 
Operating Data:   
   
     
Net premiums earned:   
   
     
     Charley   
$
   
$
7.7     $ 7.7  
     Frances   
   
3.5     3.5  
     Ivan   
(12.2 )   
(6.5 )    (18.7 ) 
     Jeanne   
   
2.7     2.7  
     South Asia Tsunami   
   
     


 

 

 
     Total net premiums earned   
$
(12.2 )   
$
7.4     (4.8 ) 


 

 

 
 
Gross losses and loss expenses:   
   
     
     Charley   
$
72.8    
$
85.5     $ 158.3  
     Frances   
93.4    
83.2     176.6  
     Ivan   
168.4    
186.5     354.9  
     Jeanne   
37.6    
49.5     87.1  
     South Asia Tsunami   
50.0    
24.6     74.6  


 

 

 
     Total gross losses and loss expenses   
$
422.2    
$
429.3     $ 851.5  


 

 

 
 
Losses and loss expenses recoverable:   
   
     
     Charley   
$
16.9    
$
10.8     $ 27.7  
     Frances   
21.9    
10.2     32.1  
     Ivan   
77.7    
111.5     189.2  
     Jeanne   
7.4    
3.9     11.3  
     South Asia Tsunami   
   
     


 

 

 
     Total losses and loss expenses recoverable   
$
123.9    
$
136.4     $ 260.3  


 

 

 
Underwriting loss   
$
310.5    
$
285.5     $ 596.0  


 

 

 
Income tax benefit   
   
    $ 37.7  


 
Net loss   
   
    $ 558.3  


 
Loss ratio impact for the year ended December 31, 2004 
   
    8.5 % 

     2. Losses related to the result of the independent actuarial process with Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company

     On December 6, 2005, the Company received the report from the Independent Actuary in connection with the Company’s post-closing protection for adverse development of net loss and unearned premium relating to the acquisition of certain Winterthur International insurance operations from Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company (“WSIC”) in 2001.

     The Independent Actuary’s report concluded that WSIC’s submitted Seasoned Net Reserve Amount (“SNRA”) and Net Premium Receivable Amount (“NPRA”) were closest to the Independent Actuary’s determinations of SNRA and NPRA. These determinations resulted in the Company receiving a net lump sum payment in the amount of approximately $575.0 million (including interest receivable) from WSIC. As the Company had recorded $1.4 billion in unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable related to this protection, a loss of approximately $808.9 million, net of interest, was recorded in the fourth quarter of 2005.

57


     3. Net adverse prior year loss development

     Net adverse prior year loss development occurs when there is an increase to loss reserves recorded at the beginning of the year, resulting from actual or reported loss development for prior years exceeding expected loss development. The net adverse prior year loss development in 2005 related to the Company’s general insurance operations most notably in the casualty and professional lines of business.

     The results for the year ended December 31, 2005 have been negatively impacted by adverse development in both the Insurance and Reinsurance segments. The following table presents the net adverse (favorable) prior year loss development of the Company’s loss and loss expense reserves for its general and financial operations by each operating segment for each of the years indicated:

(U.S. dollars in millions)   
2005 
2004
2003
 


          

            

 
Insurance segment   
$
1,020   
$
292    
$
153  
Reinsurance segment   
94   
(24 )   
799  
Financial Products and Services segment   
   
   
(15 ) 




 

 
Total   
$
1,114   
$
268    
$
937  




 

 

     During 2005, the Insurance segment’s net adverse prior year development of $1.02 billion includes the results of the independent actuarial process noted above. Excluding this development the remaining $185.8 million was driven primarily by increases in reported case reserves for excess professional liability. Strengthening of $259.5 million in professional lines was caused primarily by the establishment of case reserves on both directors’ and officers’ claims in pre-2002 business, and errors and omissions claims. Strengthening of $34.7 million within other specialty lines was caused primarily by increases in reported losses for specialty lines of business currently in run-off including certain Lloyd’s business, discontinued programs business, and surety. A net release of $108.4 million for global risks lines of business was driven by the reduction in case reserves for pre-2002 claims primarily relating to casualty business written out of Europe.

     During 2005, net prior year reserves across the Reinsurance segment developed adversely by $93.5 million. Reserve strengthening of $266.9 million in casualty and professional lines was partially offset by releases in other lines of business of $173.4 million. The casualty strengthening is primarily attributable to workers’ compensation, umbrella liability and certain professional lines of business written in the Company’s North American operations. The reserve releases relate primarily to the property line where releases of $135.6 million occurred across all business units globally in the 2002 to 2004 underwriting years. Releases also occurred in the marine and aviation classes of business across the reinsurance segment.

     The majority of the workers’ compensation reserve increase during 2005 was related to an XL Reinsurance America Inc. (“XLRA”) working layer program written across multiple underwriting years with a single cedent. This program was not renewed at the end of 2001. Other than this program, XLRA has not written significant working layer workers’ compensation business. The remaining source of the workers’ compensation reserve strengthening relates to an update of the mortality tables used in our tabular reserving methodology.

     The remainder of the strengthening in the casualty and professional lines reserves was driven by a small number of increases in reported claims in the other liability and errors and omissions lines of business in the pre-1997 underwriting years as well as recently reported claims in umbrella liability, errors and omissions and directors’ and officers’ lines of business in the 1997-2001 underwriting years. The professional lines claims activity arose largely from a limited number of cedents. This reserve increase was partially offset by favorable development in the 1997- 2001 underwriting years in the medical malpractice business line. Activity in the post-2001 underwriting years relates primarily to certain large individual claims affecting a number of lines, including surety, umbrella liability and errors and omissions.

     During 2004, the Company’s net adverse prior year development of $268.0 million was a result of increases in reported insurance case reserves for excess professional liability, excess casualty liability and specialty lines within the Insurance segment offset by net prior year releases in the Reinsurance segment. These increases in reported insurance case reserves exceeded the Company’s expected losses based on historical patterns of loss development.

58


Strengthening of $144.0 million in professional lines was caused by a few large directors’ and officers’ claims in pre-2002 business, and increases in errors and omissions reserves were caused by claims related to large accounting firms and to insurance/reinsurance brokers. For specialty lines, strengthening of $135.0 million was caused by reported loss increases in discontinued programs business with workers’ compensation exposure, environmental related coverages, and Lloyd’s as well as high severity claims on the surety book.

     During 2003, the net adverse prior period loss development related primarily to the Company’s general reinsurance operations and principally to losses on business written in the 1997 through 2001 underwriting years in the Company’s U.S. casualty reinsurance business. In the third quarter of 2003, the Company experienced a significant increase in claims reported that was in excess of the Company’s expected loss development based on historical reporting patterns and recorded an increase to reserves of $184.0 million related to this book of business. As a result of this increase, the Company began a detailed claims audit review of the cedents contributing to this increase and the lines of business affected were primarily directors’ and officers’, errors and omissions, medical malpractice, commercial umbrella and general liability. Upon completion of this claims audit review, the Company increased case and IBNR reserves relating to this book of business a total of $663.0 million in the fourth quarter of 2003. The Company monitors actual against expected reported claims on an ongoing basis. To the extent that actual experience on loss reserves differs significantly for this, or any other line of business, the Company would again expand its normal and ongoing cedent review program accordingly.

     See Item 8, Note 9 to the Consolidated Financial Statements and see further discussion under “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” and under “—Segments—Reinsurance” below.

     4. Growing asset base and positive performance from investments in affiliates.

     Net investment income was $1.5 billion in 2005 as compared to $1.0 billion in 2004 due primarily to a larger investment base combined with higher investment yields, as well as receipt of a distribution associated with the unwinding of a collateralized debt obligation which resulted in a one time benefit to investment income, and the accrued interest on the proceeds from the conclusion of the independent actuarial process with WSIC. The investment portfolio increased due to growth in structured and spread balances and positive operating cash flows combined with capital raising activities late in the fourth quarter. Higher investment yields were driven primarily by the impact of increasing U.S. interest rates on cash flow and reinvested assets. In addition, net realized gains produced by the investment portfolio and the equity earnings from the Company’s affiliates also contributed positively to the year. Net realized gains on investments were $241.9 million in 2005 compared to $246.5 million in 2004. Net income from investment affiliates was $154.8 million in 2005 compared to $124.0 million in 2004. This increase was attributable to good underlying alternative fund returns combined with strong results from certain private equity affiliates that benefited from a series of successful liquidation events. Net income from operating affiliates (including insurance, financial and investment manager affiliates) was $67.4 million in 2005 compared to $147.4 million in 2004. Earnings from investment manager affiliates were strong during 2005. Earnings from operating affiliates during 2004 included $102.1 million of income in connection with the sales of Admiral Group Ltd and Pareto Partners L.P. and its affiliated companies. See Item 8, Note 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

     The following are considered to be the Company’s critical accounting policies and estimates due to the judgments and uncertainties affecting the application of these policies and/or the likelihood that materially different amounts would be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions. If actual events differ significantly from the underlying assumptions or estimates applied for any or all of the accounting policies (either individually or in the aggregate), there could be a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. These critical accounting policies have been discussed by management with the Audit Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors.

     Other significant accounting policies are nevertheless important to an understanding of the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements. Policies such as those related to revenue recognition, financial instruments and

59


consolidation require difficult judgments on complex matters that are often subject to multiple sources of authoritative guidance. See Item 8, Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     1) Unpaid Losses and Loss Expenses and Unpaid Loss and Loss Expenses Recoverable

     As the Company earns premiums for the underwriting risks it assumes, it also establishes an estimate of the expected ultimate losses related to the premium. Loss reserves or unpaid losses and loss expenses are established due to the significant periods of time that may lapse between the occurrence, reporting and settlement of a loss. The process of establishing reserves for unpaid property and casualty claims can be complex and is subject to considerable variability as it requires the use of informed estimates and judgments. These estimates and judgments are based on numerous factors, and may be revised as additional experience and other data become available and are reviewed, as new or improved methodologies are developed or as current laws change. Loss reserves include:

      a)      Case reserves – reserves for reported losses and loss expenses that have not yet been settled and,
 
  b) Losses incurred but not reported (“IBNR”).

     At December 31, 2005 and 2004, the Company’s total gross reserves for unpaid losses and loss expenses were $23.8 billion and $19.8 billion, respectively, of which $10.6 billion and $9.8 billion related to case reserves for reported claims and $13.2 billion and $10.0 billion for IBNR reserves, respectively.

     Case reserves for the Company’s general operations are established by management based on amounts reported from insureds or ceding companies and consultation with legal counsel, and represent the estimated ultimate cost of events or conditions that have been reported to or specifically identified by the Company. The method of establishing case reserves for reported claims differs among the Company’s operations.

     With respect to the Company’s insurance operations, the Company is notified of insured losses and records a case reserve for the estimated amount of the settlement, if any. The estimate reflects the judgment of claims personnel based on general reserving practices, the experience and knowledge of such personnel regarding the nature of the specific claim and, where appropriate, advice of legal counsel. Reserves are also established to provide for the estimated expense of settling claims, including legal and other fees and the general expenses of administering the claims adjustment process. With respect to the Company’s reinsurance general operations, case reserves for reported claims are generally established based on reports received from ceding companies. Additional case reserves may be established by the Company to reflect the estimated ultimate cost of a loss. With respect to the Company’s financial products and services operations, financial guaranty claims incurred on policies written on an insurance basis are established consistent with the Company’s insurance operations and financial guaranty claims incurred on policies written on a reinsurance basis are established consistent with the Company’s reinsurance operations.

     IBNR reserves relate mainly to the Company’s insurance and reinsurance casualty business. IBNR reserves are calculated by the Company’s actuaries using several standard actuarial methodologies including paid and incurred loss development, the Bornhuetter-Ferguson incurred loss method and frequency and severity approaches.

     IBNR reserves are calculated by the Company’s actuaries using standard actuarial methodologies as discussed above. Prior to the year ended December 31, 2003, the outcomes of the Company’s actuarial reviews, consistent with historical practice, provided either (i) a single point reserve estimate or (ii) a range of reserve estimates from which the Company selected a best estimate. Since the year ended December 31, 2003, the Company adopted a methodology that provided a single point reserve estimate separately for each line of business and also a range of possible outcomes across each single point reserve estimate. This is discussed further below. As a result, reserve ranges disclosed previously are not comparable to the reserve ranges disclosed herein.

     While the proportion of unpaid loss and loss expenses represented by IBNR is sensitive to a number of factors, the most significant ones have historically been accelerating business growth and changes in business mix. Other factors that have affected the ratio in the past include; additions to prior period reserves, catastrophic occurrences, settlement of large claims and changes in claims settlement patterns.

60


     The ratio of IBNR to total reserves has increased in recent years due to the growth of casualty business written over that period. The ratio of IBNR to total reserves is higher for more recent years’ business because these immature years have relatively fewer claims reported and, as a result, a higher proportion of claims reserves are based on experience in respect of incurred but not reported losses. As each prior year of business matures and claims become known, the ratio of IBNR to total reserves will typically decline, all other factors remaining constant. Since the Company has experienced rapid premium volume growth in recent years, the ratio of IBNR to total reserves has increased because the Company’s aggregate exposure has become relatively less mature. Conversely, in a situation of declining premium volume, this ratio will typically decline, all other factors remaining constant. The Company writes insurance and reinsurance business in many different lines. Typically, the ratio of IBNR to total reserves is greater for casualty lines (which are longer-tail in nature) than for property lines due to the policy forms utilized and timing of loss reporting. In recent years, casualty lines have increased as a proportion of the Company’s business when compared to property lines (which are shorter-tail in nature).

     The single point reserve estimate is generally management’s best estimate, which the Company considers to be one that has an equal likelihood of developing a redundancy or deficiency as the loss experience matures, and this amount is recorded. The Company’s actuaries utilize one set of assumptions in determining its single point estimate, which includes loss development factors, loss ratios, reported claim frequency and severity. These reviews and documentation are completed in accordance with professional actuarial standards appropriate to the jurisdictions where the business is written. The selected assumptions reflect the actuary’s judgment based on historical data and experience combined with information concerning current underwriting, economic, judicial, regulatory and other influences on ultimate claim settlements.

     Loss and loss expenses are charged to income as they are incurred. These charges include loss and loss expense payments and any changes in case and IBNR reserves. During the loss settlement period, additional facts regarding claims are reported. As these additional facts are reported, it may be necessary to increase or decrease the unpaid losses and loss expense reserves. The actual final liability may be significantly different than prior estimates.

     The Company’s net unpaid loss and loss expense general and financial reserves broken down by operating segment at December 31, 2005 and 2004 were as follows:

(U.S. dollars in millions)   
2005 
2004 


     

Insurance   
$
9,860   
$
6,975 
Reinsurance   
7,212   
5,695 
Financial products and services   
283   
205 




Net unpaid loss and loss expense reserves   
$
17,355   
$
12,875 





     The following table shows the recorded estimate and the high and low ends of the range of reserves for each of the lines of business noted above at December 31, 2005:

(U.S. dollars in millions)   
Recorded 
High 
Low 


          

          

Casualty insurance   
$
7,388   
$
8,059 
 
$
6,739 
Casualty reinsurance   
4,141   
4,705 
  3,606 
Property catastrophe   
914   
1,080 
  758 
Other property   
1,724   
1,947 
  1,513 
Marine and aviation reinsurance and insurance   
1,628   
1,852 
  1,416 
Other (1)   
1,043   
1,141 
  950 


Total   
16,838         
Financial Operations   
283         
Provision for potential non recoveries   
234         


Total   
$
17,355         




(1)      Other consists of several products, including accident and health, political risk, surety and bonding.

61


     With the exception of the adverse development associated with the unfavorable conclusion of the independent actuarial process, actual development of recorded reserves as of December 31, 2004 during 2005 was within the estimated reserve range.

     As shown in the table above and as previously noted, the Company developed a methodology for calculating reserve ranges around its single point reserve estimates for all its lines of business. Similar to VAR (Value At Risk) models commonly used to evaluate risk, the Company modeled a statistical distribution of potential reserve outcomes over a one year run-off period. The Company used the modeled statistical distribution to calculate an 80% confidence interval for the potential reserve outcomes over this one year run-off period. The high and low end points of the ranges set forth in the above table are such that there is a 10% modeled probability that the reserve will develop higher than the high point and a 10% modeled probability that the reserve will develop lower than the low point.

     The development of a reserve range models the uncertainty of the claim environment as well as the limited predictive power of past loss data. These uncertainties and limitations are not specific to the Company. The ranges represent an estimate of the range of possible outcomes over a one year development period. A range of possible outcomes should not be confused with a range of best estimates. The range of best estimates will generally be much narrower than the range of possible outcomes as it will reflect reasonable actuarial and management best estimates of the expected reserve.

     Reserve volatility was analyzed for each line of business within each of the Reinsurance and Insurance segments’ general operations using the Company’s historical data supplemented by industry data. These ranges were then aggregated to the lines of business shown above taking into account correlation between lines of business based on a study of the Company’s historical data supplemented by industry data. The practical result of the correlation approach to aggregation is that the ranges by line of business disclosed above, are narrower than the sum of the ranges of the individual lines of business. Similarly, the range for the Company’s total reserves in the aggregate, is narrower than the sum of the ranges for the lines of business disclosed above.

     The Company is not aware of any generally accepted model to perform the reserve range analysis described above and other models may also be employed to develop ranges.

     The Company does not calculate a range for its total net unpaid loss and loss expense reserves as it would not be appropriate to add the ranges for each line of business to obtain a range around the Company’s total reserves, because this would not reflect the diversification effects across the Company’s various lines of business. The diversification effects result from the fact that losses across the Company’s different lines of business are not completely correlated.

     The Company writes both “short-tail” and “long-tail” lines of business. “Short-tail” and “long-tail” describe the time between the receipt of the premium from a policy and the final settlement of any loss incurred under such policy. Short-tail lines include property catastrophe, other property and certain marine and aviation lines where, on average, the settlement period may be up to 24 months. Long-tail lines, on the other hand, include the Company’s casualty business in which claims may take up to 30 years to be reported and settled. The increase in the time associated with ultimate settlement of a claim is directly related to an increase in the amount of judgment required to establish loss reserves, especially IBNR reserves.

     See further discussion under “– Segments” below for prior year development of loss reserves.

     The Company’s three types of reserve exposure with the longest tails are:

      (1)      high layer excess casualty insurance;
 
  (2) casualty reinsurance; and
 
  (3) discontinued asbestos and long-tail environmental business.

     Certain aspects of the Company’s casualty operations complicate the actuarial process for establishing reserves. Certain casualty business written by the Company’s insurance operations is high layer excess casualty business,

62


meaning that the Company’s liability attaches after large deductibles including self insurance or insurance from sources other than the Company. The Company commenced writing this type of business in 1986 and issued policies in forms that were different from traditional policies used by the industry at that time. Initially, there was a lack of industry data available for this type of business. Consequently, the basis for establishing loss reserves by the Company for this type of business was largely judgmental and based upon the Company’s own reported loss experience which was used as basis for determining ultimate losses, and therefore IBNR reserves. Over time, the amount of available historical loss experience data has increased. As a result, the Company has obtained a larger statistical base to assist in establishing reserves for these excess casualty insurance claims.

     High layer excess casualty insurance claims typically involve claims relating to (i) a “shock loss” such as an explosion or transportation accident causing severe damage to persons and/or property over a short period of time, (ii) a “non-shock” loss where a large number of claimants are exposed to injurious conditions over a longer period of time, such as exposure to chemicals or pharmaceuticals or (iii) a professional liability loss such as a medical malpractice claim. In each case, these claims are ultimately settled following extensive negotiations and legal proceedings. This process can typically take 5 to 15 years following the date of loss.

     Reinsurance operations by their nature add further complications to the reserving process, particularly for casualty business written, in that there is an inherent lag in the timing and reporting of a loss event from an insured or ceding company to the reinsurer. This reporting lag creates an even longer period of time between the policy inception and when a claim is finally settled. As a result, more judgment is required to establish reserves for ultimate claims in the Company’s reinsurance operations.

     In the Company’s reinsurance general operations, case reserves for reported claims are generally established based on reports received from ceding companies. Additional case reserves may be established by the Company to reflect the Company’s estimated ultimate cost of a loss.

     Casualty reinsurance business involves reserving methods that generally include historical aggregated claim information as reported by ceding companies, combined with the results of claims and underwriting reviews of a sample of the ceding company’s claims and underwriting files. Therefore, the Company does not always receive detailed claim information for this line of business.

     Discontinued asbestos and long-tail environment business had been previously written by NAC Re Corp. (now known as XL Reinsurance America Inc.), prior to its acquisition by the Company.

     Except for certain workers’ compensation and long-term disability liabilities, the Company does not discount its unpaid losses and loss expenses. The Company utilizes tabular reserving for workers’ compensation and long-term disability unpaid losses that are considered fixed and determinable, and discounts such losses using an interest rate of 5% at December 31, 2005 and 2004. For further discussion see the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     Financial Guaranty Loss Reserving

     The Company is aware of the SEC’s recent review of the loss reserving practices in the financial guaranty industry. The Company recognizes that there is diversity in practice among financial guaranty insurers and reinsurers with respect to their accounting policies. Current accounting literature, specifically FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 60 “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises” (“FAS 60”) and FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 97 “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises for Certain Long-Duration Contracts and for Realized Gains and Losses from the Sale of Investments” (“FAS 97”), does not specifically address the unique characteristics of financial guaranty insurance contracts. Consequently, the accounting principles applied by the industry have evolved over time and incorporate the concepts of both short-duration and long-duration contracts accounting under the provisions of FAS 60 and FAS 97. It is the Company’s understanding that the SEC has requested that the FASB review this matter and provide guidance for the accounting of financial guaranty insurance contracts. The Company will continue its loss reserving methodology as noted in Note 2 (k) to the Consolidated Financial

63


Statements until further guidance is provided by the SEC or the FASB. The Company had net reserves for financial guaranty insurance contracts of $173.7 million and $146.3 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.

     Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable

     The recognition of unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable requires two key judgments. The first judgment involves the Company’s estimation of the amount of gross IBNR to be ceded to reinsurers. Ceded IBNR is generally developed as part of the Company’s loss reserving process and consequently, its estimation is subject to similar risks and uncertainties as the estimation of gross IBNR (see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Unpaid losses and loss expenses and unpaid loss and loss expense recoverable”). The second judgment involves the Company’s estimate of the amount of the reinsurance recoverable balance that the Company will ultimately be unable to recover from related reinsurers due to insolvency, contractual dispute, or for other reasons. Amounts estimated to be uncollectible are reflected in a bad debt provision that reduces the reinsurance recoverable balance and shareholders’ equity. Changes in the bad debt provision are reflected in net income. See “Financial Condition and Liquidity” and Item 8, Note 10 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.

     As a result of the Company’s acquisition of Winterthur International in July 2001, WSIC provides protection to the Company with respect to third party reinsurance receivables and recoverables related to the Winterthur International acquisition, which are $1.6 billion in the aggregate, as of December 31, 2005. The Company has reinsurance protection under two retrocession agreements on the remaining portion of reinsurance recoverables with respect to incurred losses seasoned as of June 30, 2004 to the extent that the Company does not receive payment of such amounts from applicable reinsurers, with one agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to June 30, 2001, and the other agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to December 31, 2000.

     2) Future Policy Benefit Reserves

     Future policy benefit reserves relate to the Company’s life operations and are estimated using assumptions for investment yields, mortality, expenses and provisions for adverse loss deviation. Uncertainties related to interest rate volatility and mortality experience make it difficult to project and value the ultimate benefit payments.

     Most of the Company’s future policy benefit reserves relate to annuity portfolio reinsurance contracts under which the Company makes annuity payments throughout the term of the contract for a specified portfolio of policies.

     For certain of these contracts, a single premium is paid at inception of the contract by way of a transfer of cash and investments to the Company.

     The reserving methodology for these annuity portfolio reinsurance contracts is described in FAS 60 as amended by FAS 97. These contracts subject the Company to risks arising from policyholder mortality over a period that extends beyond the periods in which premiums are collected. Liabilities for future policy benefit reserves are established in accordance with the provisions of FAS 60.

     Claims and expenses for individual policies within these annuity reinsurance contracts are projected over the lifetime of the contract to calculate a net present value of future cash flows. Assumptions for each element of the basis (mortality, expenses and interest) are determined at the issue of the contract and these assumptions are locked-in throughout the term of the contract unless a premium deficiency exists. The assumptions are best estimate assumptions plus provisions for adverse deviations on the key risk elements (i.e., mortality and interest). Provisions for adverse deviation are designed to cover reasonable deviations from the best estimate outcome of the contract. As the experience on the contracts emerges, the assumptions are reviewed. This occurs at least annually and includes both an analysis of experience and review of likely future experience. If such review would produce reserves in excess of those currently held then lock-in assumptions will be revised and a loss recognized. During the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003, there were no adjustments to the locked-in assumptions for any of these contracts.

64


     The future policy benefit reserves for these annuity portfolio reinsurance contracts amounted to $5.2 billion and $3.9 billion at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The Company holds the investment assets backing these liabilities. These investments are primarily fixed income securities with maturities that closely match the expected claims settlement profile. A 0.1% decrease in the investment yield assumption would result in a $49 million increase in the value of future claims related to annuity portfolio reinsurance.

     As stated above, the future policy benefit reserves include provisions for adverse deviation in excess of best estimate assumptions that amounted to approximately $310 million and $145 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The future policy benefit reserves would only be increased if these provisions for adverse deviation became insufficient in the light of emerging claims experience. The present value of future claims would increase by approximately $18 million if mortality rates were to decrease by 1% in all future years, relative to the reserving assumptions.

     The Company also provides reinsurance of disability income protection. The future policy benefit reserves for these contracts amounted to $85 million and $86 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Future policy benefit reserves are established in accordance with the provisions of FAS 60, including the lock-in of assumptions at inception with periodic review against experience. The liabilities relate to in-force blocks of business, comprising underlying insurance policies that provide an income if the policyholder becomes sick or disabled. The liabilities are therefore driven mainly by the rates at which policyholders become sick (where sickness is defined by the policy conditions) and by the rates at which these policyholders recover or die. A 1% increase in the incidence rate would increase the value of future claims by approximately $0.1 million, while a 1% decrease in the termination rate would increase the value of future claims by approximately $0.4 million.

     Following a review of morbidity experience, the locked-in assumptions were revised during the year ended December 31, 2005. The overall effect of using the revised assumptions was a reduction in income of $0.4 million.

     The Company also provides reinsurance of term assurance and critical illness policies written in the U.K. and Ireland. The future policy benefit reserves for these contracts amounted to $62 million and $41 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Future policy benefit reserves are established in accordance with the provisions of FAS 60, including the lock-in of assumptions at inception with periodic review against experience.

     The liabilities relate to in-force blocks of business, comprising underlying insurance policies that provide mainly lump sum benefits if the policyholder dies or becomes sick. For term assurance, the liabilities are therefore driven by the rates of mortality and for critical illness cover, the liabilities are driven predominantly by the rates at which policyholders become sick (where sickness is defined by the treaty conditions), i.e., the morbidity rates. A 1% increase in the mortality rate relative to the reserving assumption would increase the value of future claims by approximately $0.6 million, and a 1% increase in the morbidity rate would increase the value of future claims by approximately $0.6 million.

     The term assurance and critical illness treaties have been written using a variety of structures, some of which incur acquisition costs during an initial period. For such treaties, a deferred acquisition cost (“DAC”) asset has been established and an increase in future lapse rates could impact the recoverability of such costs from future premiums. The recoverability will also be influenced by the impact of lapses on future claims. An increase in the annual lapse rates by 1% could lead to a 5%-10% reduction in future margins available for amortizing the DAC asset.

     The Company also provided reinsurance of U.S. based term assurance, which was novated to the Company from an insurance affiliate in December 2002. The future policy benefit reserves for these contracts amounted to $184 million and $123 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Future policy benefit reserves are established in accordance with the provisions of FAS 60, including the lock-in of assumptions at inception with periodic review against experience.

     The liabilities relate to in-force blocks of business, which are comprised of underlying insurance policies that provide mainly lump sum benefits if the policyholder dies. The liabilities are therefore driven by the rates of mortality,

65


and a 1% increase in the mortality rate relative to the reserving assumption would increase the value of future claims by approximately $8 million. Following a review of mortality experience, the locked-in assumptions were revised during the year ended December 31, 2005. The overall affect of using the revised assumptions was a reduction in income of $63 million. See Item 8, Note 12 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     3) Deposit Liabilities

     The Company’s deposit liabilities at December 31, 2005 reflect obligations assumed under funding agreements, municipal guaranteed reinvestment contracts, payment undertaking agreements and certain structured insurance and reinsurance agreements. For each of these contracts, the Company establishes a deposit liability equal to the net cash received at inception. Each deposit liability accrues at a rate equal to the internal rate of return of the payment receipts and obligations due during the life of the agreement. Where the timing and/or amount of future payments are uncertain, cash flows reflecting the Company’s actuarially determined best estimates are utilized. The ultimate size of underlying losses, the impact of the contractual limits upon settlement of such losses, and the impact of the underlying loss settlement process on the timing of payments are considered as appropriate. Where uncertainty is present, an increase in the ultimate claims cost or accelerated claims settlement would potentially lead to an increase in the deposit liability accretion rate or lead to incurred losses if significant. The interest expense reported due to the accretion of deposit liabilities associated with structured insurance and reinsurance contracts was $49.8 million, $59.4 million and $92.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively. For some of the Company’s deposit liabilities, the accretion rate is recorded at its contractual maximum level. For all other contracts, a 1% increase in the average accretion rate would result in an increase in deposit liabilities and interest expense by $16.3 million on an annualized basis. See Item 8, Note 11 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     4) Derivative Instruments

     The Company conducts activities in three main types of derivative instruments: credit derivatives, weather and energy derivatives and investment-related derivative instruments. The estimate of fair value for credit derivatives and weather and energy derivatives requires management’s judgment. These two activities are discussed below:

     a) Credit Derivatives

     The Company enters into credit derivatives in connection with its financial guaranty business and the Company intends to hold these contracts to maturity. In determining fair value, management differentiates between investment and non-investment grade exposures and models them separately. Management estimates fair value for investment grade exposures by monitoring changes in credit quality and selecting appropriate market indices to determine credit spread movements over the life of the contracts. The determination of the credit spread movements is the basis for calculating the fair value. For credit derivatives that are non-investment grade and therefore do not have a readily determinable market value, the Company uses an alternative fair value methodology. The fair value is determined using a cash flow model developed by the Company and is dependent upon a number of factors, including changes in interest rates, future default rates, credit spreads, changes in credit quality, future expected recovery rates and other market factors. Installment premiums are also considered in the determination of discounted net cash flows. Other elements of the change in fair value are based upon pricing established at the inception of the contract. Changes in fair value are unrealized as the credit derivatives are not traded to realize this value. See Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk” for sensitivity analysis and Item 8, Note 14 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     b) Weather and Energy Derivatives

     The fair value of weather and energy derivatives is determined through the use of quoted market prices where available. Where quoted market prices are unavailable, the fair value is estimated using available market data and internal pricing models using consistent statistical methodologies. Estimating fair value of instruments that do not

66


have quoted market prices requires management’s judgment in determining amounts that could reasonably be expected to be received from, or paid to, a third party in settlement of the contracts. The amounts could be materially different from the amounts that might be realized in an actual sale transaction. Fair values are subject to change in the near-term and reflect management’s best estimate based on various factors including, but not limited to, actual and forecasted weather conditions, changes in commodity prices, changes in interest rates and other market factors. See Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk” for sensitivity analysis and Item 8, Note 14 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     5) Other Than Temporary Declines in Investments

     The Company’s process for identifying declines in the fair value of investments that are other than temporary involves consideration of several factors. These factors include (i) the time period during which there has been a significant decline in value, (ii) an analysis of the liquidity, business prospects and financial condition of the issuer, (iii) the significance of the decline, (iv) an analysis of the collateral structure and other credit support, as applicable, of the securities in question and (v) the Company’s intent and ability to hold the investment for a sufficient period of time for the value to recover. Where the Company’s analysis of the above factors results in the Company’s conclusion that declines in fair values are other than temporary, the cost of the security is written down to fair value and the previously unrealized loss is therefore realized in the period such determination is made.

     With respect to securities where the decline in value is determined to be temporary and the security’s value is not written down, a subsequent decision may be made to sell that security and realize a loss. Subsequent decisions on security sales are made within the context of overall risk monitoring, changing information, market conditions generally and assessing value relative to other comparable securities. Day-to-day management of the Company’s investment portfolio is outsourced to third party investment managers. While these investment managers may, at a given point in time, believe that the preferred course of action is to hold securities with unrealized losses that are considered temporary until such losses are recovered, the dynamic nature of the portfolio management may result in a subsequent decision to sell the security and realize the loss, based upon a change in market and other factors described above. The Company believes that subsequent decisions to sell such securities are consistent with the classification of the Company’s portfolio as available for sale.

     As mentioned above, the Company considers its intent and ability to hold a security until the value recovers as part of the process of evaluating whether a security’s unrealized loss represents an other than temporary decline. However, this factor on its own does not dictate whether or not the Company recognizes an impairment charge. The Company believes its ability to hold such securities is supported by positive and sufficient cash flow from its operations and from maturities within its investment portfolio in order to meet its claims payment obligations arising from its underwriting operations without selling such investments. In this regard, cash flow from operating activities was $4.2 billion and $4.4 billion in 2005 and 2004, respectively.

     There are risks and uncertainties associated with determining whether declines in the fair value of investments are other than temporary. These include subsequent significant changes in general economic conditions as well as specific business conditions affecting particular issuers, subjective assessment of issue-specific factors (seniority of claims, collateral value, etc.), future financial market effects, stability of foreign governments and economies, future rating agency actions and significant disclosure of accounting, fraud or corporate governance issues that may adversely affect certain investments. In addition, significant assumptions and management judgment are involved in determining if the decline is other than temporary. If management determines that a decline in fair value is temporary, then a security’s value is not written down at that time. However, there are potential effects upon the Company’s future earnings and financial position should management later conclude that some of the current declines in the fair value of the investments are other than temporary declines. See “– Investment Activities – Unrealized losses on investments” for further information.

67


     6) Income Taxes

     The Company utilizes the asset and liability method of accounting for income taxes. Under this method, deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effect of temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes. The Company has capitalized net operating tax losses of $238.1 million and $230.6 million against which a valuation allowance of $154.5 million and $68.6 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively, has been established. The Company has capitalized realized and unrealized capital losses of $19.7 million and $7.7 million, respectively, against which a valuation allowance of $23.7 million at December 31, 2005 has been established. The deferral of benefits from tax losses is evaluated based upon management’s estimates of the future profitability of the Company’s taxable entities based on current forecasts, the character of income and the period for which losses may be carried forward. A valuation allowance may have to be established for any portion of a deferred tax asset that management believes will not be realized. Should the future income of these entities fall below expectations, a further valuation allowance would have to be established, which could be significant. In addition, if any further losses are generated by these entities, these losses may not be tax affected.

     Effective as of January 1, 2004, XL Re America Inc (“XLRA”), a subsidiary of the Company, entered into an adverse development reinsurance treaty with another reinsurance subsidiary of the Company. The treaty related to the 1985 through (and including) 2000 underwriting years covering any adverse development on reserves calculated as of December 31, 2003 between January 1, 2004 and December 31, 2005. The treaty has a limit of $500 million and limited loss development at XLRA relating to these underwriting years through December 31, 2005. Any commutation of this treaty requires the prior approval of the New York Department of Insurance. There is no impact of this treaty on the consolidated financial statements of the Company; however, as part of management’s continuing evaluation of its deferred tax asset, the treaty is critical in evaluating the future income position of the U.S. group of companies. Management believes that the treaty will protect the U.S. group from unexpected prior loss development. Absent unexpected loss development from the 2000 and prior underwriting years, management has concluded that there is sufficient positive evidence of future profitability in the U.S. and that a valuation allowance as a charge against the deferred tax asset is not required at this time.

     For further information see “– Other Revenues and Expenses” and Item 8, Note 23 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     7) Intangible Assets

     Intangible assets are carried at or below estimated fair value. There are many assumptions and estimates underlying the fair value calculation. Principally, the Company identifies the business entity that the intangible asset is attributed to, and reviews historical and forecasted performance and other underlying factors affecting such analysis, including market conditions, premium rates and loss trends. Other assumptions used could produce a significantly different result which may result in a change in the value of the intangible asset and related amortization charge in the Consolidated Statement of Income. Based on the current expectations of profitability, an impairment charge would only be recognized in the event of a significant decline in the expected profitability of those operations where such intangible assets are applicable. At December 31, 2005, intangible assets were $1.8 billion of which approximately $1.4 billion and $0.4 billion related to the Company’s reinsurance and insurance segments, respectively. See “ Other Revenue and Expenses” for further information.

     8) Variable Interest Entities

     The Company utilizes variable interest entities both directly and indirectly in the ordinary course of business. The Company must assess consolidation of variable interest entities based on whether the Company is the primary beneficiary of the entity. The company that absorbs a majority of the expected losses or residual rewards of the entity is deemed to be the primary beneficiary and is therefore required to consolidate the entity. The determination of expected losses and expected residual returns requires the Company to estimate the expected cash flows of the entities

68


and measure the expected variability of these cash flows. The use of different assumptions to determine the expected cash flows and variability could affect the Company’s determination of the primary beneficiary. The assumptions used to determine the expected cash flows depend on the type of structure and the nature of the Company’s variable interest. The Company has made assumptions primarily regarding default rates, the timing of defaults and recovery rates to estimate these expected cash flows of the variable interest entities that it utilizes.

     9) Reinsurance Premium Estimates

     The Company writes business on both an excess of loss and proportional basis. In the case of excess of loss contracts, the subject written premium is generally outlined within the treaty and the Company receives a minimum and/or deposit premium on a quarterly basis which is normally followed by an adjustment premium based on the ultimate subject premium for the contract. The Company estimates the premium written on the basis of the expected subject premium and regularly reviews this against actual quarterly statements to revise the estimate based on the information provided by the cedent.

     On proportional contracts, written premiums are estimated to expected ultimate premiums based on information provided by the ceding companies. An estimate of premium is recorded at the inception of the contract. When the actual premium is reported by the ceding company, normally on a quarterly basis, it may be materially higher or lower than the estimate. Adjustments arising from the reporting of actual premium by the ceding companies are recorded in the period in which they are determined.

     Written premiums on excess of loss contracts are earned in accordance with the loss occurring period defined within the treaty, normally 12 months following inception of the contract. Written premiums on proportional contracts are earned over the risk periods of the underlying policies issued and renewed, normally 24 months. For both excess of loss and proportional contracts, the earned premium is recognized ratably over the earning period, namely 12 – 24 months. The portion of the premium related to the unexpired portion of the policy at the end of any reporting period is reflected in unearned premiums.

     Reinsurance operations by their nature add further complications in that generally the ultimate premium due under a specific contract will not be known at the time the contract is entered into. As a result, more judgment and ongoing monitoring is required to establish premiums written and earned in the Company’s reinsurance operations.

     Reinstatement premiums are recognized at the time a loss event occurs where coverage limits for the remaining life of the contract are reinstated under pre-defined contract terms and are fully earned when recognized. Accrual of reinstatement premiums is based on the Company’s estimate of loss and loss adjustment expense reserves, which involves management judgment as described below.

Segments

     The Company operates through three business segments: Insurance, Reinsurance and Financial Products and Services. These business segments were determined in accordance with FAS No. 131, “Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information”.

     The Company’s segment results have been significantly impacted by the catastrophe loss events of 2005 and 2004, as noted above. These should be considered when making period to period comparisons of segment results.

     Following changes in certain executive management responsibilities in January 2005, the Company changed the reporting segments under which certain business units are reported in order to reflect these changes in responsibilities.

     The following areas have been changed for all periods presented:

  • Results of business structured by XL Financial Solutions Ltd (“XLFS”) are now included entirely within the Financial Products and Services segment whereas previously this unit was reported in all three segments, depending on the nature of individual contracts.

69


  • Certain blocks of U.S.-based term life mortality reinsurance business previously included in the Financial Products and Services segment are now included in the Reinsurance segment as management of these contracts was transferred to the life reinsurance business units in order to centralize the Company’s management of traditional mortality-based reinsurance business.

  • Political risk insurance business units now report to executive management of the Financial Products and Services segment and, as such, future earnings from this business will no longer be reported in the Insurance segment but included with financial operations.

  • All operations of business units within the Financial Products and Services segment, including guaranteed investment contracts and funding agreements, are now reported under financial operations in order to consolidate businesses with similar operating characteristics and risks.

  • All net investment income and net income from affiliates generated by assets and interest expense incurred on liabilities of the business units within the Financial Products and Services segment is reported under financial operations. This income and expense is included in financial operations as it relates to interest on portfolios of separately identified and managed assets and deposit liabilities. Management believes this change will better reflect the nature of spread focused business.

     In addition, the Company has changed its presentation of certain credit derivatives and now records premiums received from sales of these derivatives in gross written premiums and establishes unearned premium reserves and loss reserves for its investment grade credit derivative business. Previously, all components of the Company’s consolidated statements of income impact related to credit default swaps had been reported on one line, “Net Realized and Unrealized Gains (Losses) on Derivative Instruments.” Prior periods have been re-presented for consistency in presentation.

     The Company’s business is conducted on a global basis where several of its subsidiaries operate in foreign currencies which are the base currency of that entity. Under U.S. GAAP, revenues and expenses of those operations are translated into the U.S. dollar at average exchange rates during the year and assets and liabilities at exchange rates at the end of the year.

Insurance

The following table summarizes the underwriting profit for this segment:

   
% Change
% Change
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
05 vs 04
2004
04 vs 03
2003
 


       

     

       

     

 
General:                     
Gross premiums written   
$
5,785,750     (2.3 )%   
$
5,924,951     14.1 %   
$
5,193,287  
Net premiums written   
4,248,105     (3.4 )%   
$
4,395,619     18.9 %   
3,698,163  
   
           
           
   
Net premiums earned   
$
4,102,697     1.2 %   
$
4,054,795     12.3 %   
$
3,611,444  
Fee income and other   
4,223     (82.0 )%   
23,461     79.1 %   
13,103  
Net losses and loss expenses   
4,595,551     60.7 %   
2,859,854     20.6 %   
2,371,195  
Acquisition costs   
505,636     (5.9 )%   
537,106     0.2 %   
536,293  
Operating expenses   
517,800     (2.6 )%   
531,502     29.8 %   
409,406  
Foreign exchange (gains)   
(25,472 )    157.1 %   
(9,907 )    23.2 %   
(8,042 ) 


 

 

 
Underwriting (loss) profit   
$
(1,486,595 )    NM    
$
159,701     49.4 %   
$
315,695  


 

 

 


*NM — Not meaningful

     Gross and net premiums written decreased by 2.3% and 3.4%, respectively, in the year ended December 31, 2005 compared with the year ended December 31, 2004. These decreases were primarily due to continued competitive pricing across most lines, most notably property. Decreases were partially offset by continued growth in the

70


newer select and design professional and U.S. primary casualty units, and the impact of foreign exchange movements on premiums. Net premiums written declined in line with gross premiums written combined with increased ceded reinstatement premiums payable as a result of the catastrophe activity in the year.

     Increases in gross and net premiums written in 2004 as compared to 2003 were primarily due to new business in the casualty and professional lines, multi-year contracts written in the year and favorable foreign exchange movements. The most significant growth was due to new business product offerings in the areas of primary casualty, specialty professional and property catastrophe risks. Partially offsetting the growth in gross and net premiums written in 2004 were rate reductions in most property and professional lines as well as growing rate pressures on most casualty lines during 2004.

     Net premiums earned increased by 1.2% in 2005 compared with 2004. Growth in net premiums earned is primarily as a result of the earn-out of net premiums written in 2004, including the newer business initiatives mentioned above and increased net retentions. This growth was partially offset by the decreased volume in 2005, noted above, and net $89.1 million ceded reinstatement premiums as a result of the natural catastrophes in 2005.

     Net premiums earned increased in each of the two years ended December 31, 2004 and 2003 due to the increases in net premiums written in each year, as noted above. Growth in net premiums earned in 2004 and 2003 were partially offset by several non-renewed portfolios as the earned premium impact of the non-renewed business lags behind the written premium impact.

     Fee income and other decreased in 2005 compared to 2004 and increased in 2004 as compared to 2003 primarily due to the income recorded on the sale of property in London in 2004, combined with fees generated by the Company’s professional lines start up businesses for administration of third party portfolios.

     Exchange gains are primarily generated by movement in foreign exchange rates applied to loss reserves held in currencies other than the functional currency of the reporting subsidiary. The gain in 2003 was partially reduced by a hedge put in place by the Company in February 2003 to cover part of its exposure to a U.K. sterling reinsurance recoverable balance.

     The decreases in the underwriting profit in 2005 as compared with 2004 and the decreases in 2004 as compared with 2003 were also reflective of the combined ratios, as shown below. The following table presents the ratios for the Insurance segment for each of the last three years ended December 31:

         
2005
2004
2003


          

          

  Loss and loss expense ratio    112.0 %    70.5 %    65.7 % 
  Underwriting expense ratio    25.0 %    26.4 %    26.2 % 






  Combined ratio    137.0 %    96.9 %    91.9 % 







     The loss and loss expense ratio includes net losses incurred for both the current year and any adverse or favorable prior year development of loss and loss reserves held at the beginning of the year.

     The loss and loss expense ratio for the Insurance segment for the year ended December 31, 2005 increased compared with the year ended December 31, 2004, primarily reflecting the net losses of $947.0 million incurred in the property catastrophe and property lines of business as a result of Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma and the Other Cats combined with the impact of overall continued softening market conditions in 2005, losses of $834.2 million representing the unfavorable outcome of the independent actuarial process with WSIC and $185.8 million in net adverse prior year development.

     The loss and loss expense ratio for the Insurance segment for the year ended December 31, 2004 increased compared with the year ended December 31, 2003 primarily due to net hurricane losses of $298.3 million in the property and marine lines, combined with prior year reserve strengthening as discussed below, and losses and loss

71


expenses related to the South Asia Tsunami. Losses due to Hurricanes Charley, Frances, Ivan and Jeanne combined with the South Asia Tsunami increased the loss ratio for the year by 7.5% .

     The following tables present the prior year adverse or favorable development of the Company’s gross and net loss and loss expense reserves for its insurance operations:

      Gross               
  (U.S. dollars in millions)   
2005 
2004 
2003 


          

          

  Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves at the               
     beginning of the year    $  12,396    $  10,225   
$
8,141 
  Net adverse development of those reserves during the year      286      1,674   
1,017 






  Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves re-estimated               
     one year later    $  12,682    $  11,899   
$
9,158 






 
  Net               
  (U.S. dollars in millions)      2005      2004   
2003 





  Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves at the               
     beginning of the year    $  6,975    $  5,846   
$
4,804 
  Net adverse development of those reserves               
     during the year      1,020      292   
153 






  Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves re-estimated               
     one year later    $  7,995    $  6,138   
$
4,957 







     The Company did not change its methodology or key assumptions used in 2005, 2004 or 2003 to determine ultimate loss reserves for any line of insurance business written.

     Included in net adverse prior year development is the loss associated with the independent actuarial process with WSIC. The Independent Actuary’s report concluded that WSIC’s submitted SNRA and NPRA were closest to the Independent Actuary’s determinations of SNRA and NPRA. These determinations resulted in the Company receiving a net lump sum payment in the amount of approximately $575.0 million (including interest receivable) from WSIC. As the Company had recorded $1.4 billion in unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable related to this protection, incurred losses of approximately $834.2 million were recorded in the fourth quarter of 2005.

     During 2005, the Insurance segment’s net adverse prior year development, excluding the impact of the result of the independent actuarial process, of $185.8 million was driven primarily by increases in reported case reserves for excess professional liability. Strengthening of $259.5 million in professional lines was caused primarily by the establishment of case reserves on both directors’ and officers’ claims in pre-2002 business, and errors and omissions claims. Strengthening of $34.7 million within other specialty lines was caused primarily by increases in reported losses for specialty lines of business currently in run-off including certain Lloyd’s business, discontinued programs business, and surety. A net release of $112.5 million for global risk lines of business was driven by the reduction in case reserves for pre-2002 claims primarily relating to casualty business written out of Europe.

     During 2004, the segment’s net adverse development of $292.0 million was driven primarily by increases in reported case reserves for excess professional liability, excess casualty liability and specialty lines. These increases in reported case reserves exceeded the Company’s expected losses based on historical patterns of loss development. Strengthening of $144.0 million in professional lines was caused by a few large directors’ and officers’ claims in pre-2002 business, while increases in errors and omissions reserves were caused by loss related to large accounting firms and insurance and reinsurance brokers. For specialty lines, strengthening of $135.0 million was caused by reported loss increases in discontinued programs business with workers’ compensation exposure, environmental related coverages, certain Lloyd’s business and high severity claims on the surety book.

72


     During 2004 and 2003, the Company’s net adverse development of its gross reserves greatly exceeded its net reserve adverse development due principally to an increase in prior year reserves related to Winterthur International. The Company had protection with respect to any adverse loss or premium development related to the acquired Winterthur International insurance operations with effect from July 1, 2001, under the SPA with WSIC, and recorded a recoverable of the same amount.

     There is no assurance that conditions and trends that have affected the development of liabilities in the past will continue. Accordingly, it is not appropriate to extrapolate future redundancies or deficiencies based on the Company’s historical results.

     The underwriting expense ratio for the year ended December 31, 2005 decreased compared with the same period in 2004 as a result of a decrease in the operating expense ratio of 0.5 points (12.6% as compared to 13.1%) combined with a decrease in the acquisition expense ratio of 0.8 points (12.4% as compared to 13.2%) . The reduction in the operating expense ratio was due to productivity expense management initiatives and certain compensation cost adjustments. The reduction in the acquisition expense ratio was due primarily to a change in the commission structure with certain brokers, partially offset by the impact of ceded reinstatement premiums.

     The underwriting expense ratio for the year ended December 31, 2004 compared to the same period in 2003 increased slightly. The decrease in the acquisition expense ratio of 1.6 points (13.3% as compared to 14.9%) was offset by an increase in the operating expense ratio of 1.8 points (13.1% as compared to 11.3%) . The reduction in the acquisition expense ratio was due primarily to a change in the mix of business earned compared to the same period in the prior year and changes in the commission structure with certain brokers. The increase in the operating expense ratio was due primarily to the increased costs associated with supporting new business growth in the segment operations globally, including start up operations, an allocation of certain corporate expenses to the Insurance segment and the impact of foreign exchange movements.

Reinsurance

Reinsurance – General Operations

     The following table summarizes the underwriting results for the general operations of the Reinsurance segment:

   
% Change
% Change
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
05 vs 04
2004
04 vs 03
2003
 


       

     

       

     

 
Gross premiums written   
$
3,411,087     (1.3 )%   
$
3,456,511     0.4 %   
$
3,443,405  
Net premiums written   
$
2,776,006     (3.4 )%   
$
2,874,115     0.3 %   
$
2,865,040  
Net premiums earned   
$
2,770,941     (5.5 )%   
$
2,933,145     18.4 %   
$
2,478,134  
Fee income and other   
(278 )    NM    
223     (89.5 )%   
2,121  
Net losses and loss expenses   
2,763,378     42.7 %   
1,937,001     (12.9 )%   
2,224,797  
Acquisition costs   
600,615     (7.4 )%   
648,430     14.4 %   
566,873  
Operating expenses   
155,095     (18.7 )%   
190,750     29.2 %   
147,667  
Foreign exchange losses (gains)   
33,144     NM    
(27,102 )    (12.0 )%   
(30,793 ) 


 

 

 
Underwriting (loss) profit   
$
(781,569 )    NM    
$
184,289     NM    
$
(428,289 ) 


 

 

 


*NM – Not meaningful

     Gross and net premiums written decreased by 1.3% and 3.4%, respectively, in the year ended December 31, 2005 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2004. Selective underwriting, rate reductions across most lines, and increased retentions by ceding companies, were partially offset by new proportional Lloyd’s treaties as well as significant written and ceded reinstatement premiums related to the 2005 catastrophes. Price reductions were most notable in casualty and professional lines. The rate improvements noted in late 2004 increased further subsequent to the 2005 Hurricane season in catastrophe exposed lines. Favorable foreign exchange movements also partially offset the decrease in gross premiums written. Net premiums written reflect the above gross changes.

73


     Gross premiums written increased slightly for the year ended December 31, 2004 as compared to 2003. Most lines of business remained relatively flat as a result of rate decreases being offset by selective new premium volume growth. Casualty rates have remained stronger than the shorter tail lines of business. The high frequency of catastrophic events prompted some stabilization of rates in the property catastrophe business most impacted by the losses, namely in Florida, in the latter half of the year. In addition, the increasingly competitive market has resulted in the non-renewal of certain Latin American property programs. Favorable foreign exchange movements also contributed $107.3 million to the growth in gross premiums written. Net premiums written reflect the above gross changes, together with higher retentions, offset by the effects of retrocessional reinstatement premiums and growth in certain large proportional programs that are largely retroceded.

     Net premiums earned in the year ended December 31, 2005 decreased 5.5% compared to the year ended December 31, 2004, due primarily to the earn-out of the impact of rate pressures seen in gross premiums.

     Net premiums earned in 2004 increased 18.4% as compared to 2003 due primarily to the earning of net written premium growth over the last several years, most notably in casualty and professional lines of business. Net premiums earned for casualty and professional reinsurance lines combined were $1.2 billion in 2004 as compared to $971.2 million in 2003.

     The following table presents the underwriting ratios for this segment:

         
2005
 
2004
 
2003






  Loss and loss expense ratio    99.7 %    66.0 %    89.8 % 
  Underwriting expense ratio    27.3 %    28.6 %    28.8 % 






  Combined ratio    127.0 %    94.6 %    118.6 % 







     The loss and loss expense ratio includes net losses incurred for both the current year and any adverse or favorable prior year development of loss reserves held at the beginning of the year.

     The increase in the loss and loss expense ratio in the year ended December 31, 2005, compared to the same period in 2004, primarily reflected the effects of Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma combined with the Other Cats from which the Reinsurance segment incurred a combined $977.9 million of net losses. These natural catastrophes added 34.4% to the segment loss ratio for the year ended December 31, 2005. In addition, there was higher than expected adverse prior year development of $93.5 million relating to primarily U.S. casualty business partially offset by reserve releases in short tail lines, as discussed further below.

     The decrease in the loss and loss expense ratio for the year ended December 31, 2004 compared to the same period in 2003 was primarily due to the fact that 2003 included significant adverse prior period development related to the Company’s North American casualty business. See further discussion below. The Reinsurance segment experienced losses in 2004 resulting from Hurricanes Charley, Frances, Ivan and Jeanne, from which the segment incurred a combined $268.3 million of net losses and loss expenses. In addition, the segment incurred net losses and loss expenses of $24.6 million as a result of the earthquake and tsunami in South Asia. These large catastrophe losses contributed 10.0% to the segment loss ratio for the year ended December 31, 2004. Catastrophe losses were partially offset by lower than expected incurred loss development in the year relating to shorter tail lines prior underwriting years and price improvements on earned premiums from prior periods.

74


     The following tables present the adverse prior year development of the Company’s gross and net loss and loss expense reserves for its reinsurance general operations:

      Gross   
   
   
 
  (U.S. dollars in millions)   
2005 
 
2004
   
2003 


          

            

  Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves at the   
   
   
 
     beginning of the year   
$
7,226   
$
6,454    
$
5,179 
  Net (favorable) adverse development of those reserves   
   
   
 
     during the year   
85   
(38 )   
854 




 

  Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves re-estimated   
   
   
 
     one year later   
$
7,311   
$
6,416    
$
6,033 




 

 
  Net   
   
   
 
  (U.S. dollars in millions)   
2005   
2004    
2003 




 

  Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves at the   
   
   
 
     beginning of the year   
$
5,695   
$
4,813    
$
3,473 
  Net (favorable) adverse development of those reserves   
   
   
 
     during the year   
94   
(24 )   
799 




 

  Unpaid losses and loss expense reserves re-estimated   
   
   
 
     one year later   
$
5,789   
$
4,789    
$
4,272 




 


     During 2005, the Insurance segment’s net adverse prior year development of $1.02 billion includes the results of the independent actuarial process noted above. Excluding this development the remaining $185.8 million was driven primarily by increases in reported case reserves for excess professional liability. Strengthening of $259.5 million in professional lines was caused primarily by the establishment of case reserves on both directors’ and officers’ claims in pre-2002 business, and errors and omissions claims. Strengthening of $34.7 million within other specialty lines was caused primarily by increases in reported losses for specialty lines of business currently in run-off including certain Lloyd’s business, discontinued programs business, and surety. A net release of $108.4 million for global risks lines of business was driven by the reduction in case reserves for pre-2002 claims primarily relating to casualty business written out of Europe.

     During 2005, net prior year reserves across the Reinsurance segment developed adversely by $93.5 million. Reserve strengthening of $266.9 million in casualty and professional lines was partially offset by releases in other lines of business of $173.4 million. The casualty strengthening is primarily attributable to workers’ compensation, umbrella liability and certain professional lines of business written in the Company’s North American operations. The reserve releases relate primarily to the property line where releases of $135.6 million occurred across all business units globally in the 2002 to 2004 underwriting years. Releases also occurred in the marine and aviation classes of business across the reinsurance segment.

     The remainder of the strengthening in the casualty and professional lines reserves was driven by a small number of increases in reported claims in the other liability and errors and omissions lines of business in the pre-1997 underwriting years as well as recently reported claims in umbrella liability, errors and omissions and directors’ and officers’ lines of business in the 1997-2001 underwriting years. The professional lines claims activity arises largely from a limited number of cedents. This reserve increase was partially offset by favorable development in the 1997- 2001 underwriting years in the medical malpractice business line. Activity in the post-2001 underwriting years relates primarily to certain large individual claims affecting a number of lines, including surety, umbrella liability and errors and omissions.

     During 2004, net prior year reserves across the Reinsurance segment developed favorably by $24 million. Releases of $144 million in the property, aviation, marine and other lines of business were partially offset by strengthening of casualty and accident and health reserves amounting to approximately $122 million. Property catastrophe and property other reserve releases totaled approximately $95 million net related primarily to the 2002 and 2003 underwriting years where loss experience has been exceptionally good for the property line. The strengthening of casualty reserves totaled $77 million and related most significantly to professional liability reserves which were strengthened by $32 million for Enron and Worldcom claims. The accident & health reserve strengthening of $45 million relates to a portfolio of business underwritten by certain of the Company’s Lloyd’s syndicates.

75


     During 2003, the Company increased its estimated reserves related to its reinsurance segment (excluding the September 11 event) by $996 million, of which approximately $877 million related primarily to the Company’s North American reinsurance operations for casualty business underwritten during the 1997 through 2001 underwriting years. The main lines of business affected by this adverse development included general liability, medical malpractice, professional and surety lines. This adverse development was due to competitive market pressures on pricing during these underwriting years combined with an increase in the number and size of claims reported in recent years as a result of increases in court filings, corporate scandals, rising tort costs and settlement awards. Prior year reserves also developed adversely on certain other casualty business written in the 1998 through 2001 underwriting years outside of North America. These exposures were affected by trends similar to those as described above for the North American casualty reinsurance operations. The casualty exposures underwritten in these entities were much less than those of the North American operations, so the impact on the prior year reserves was relatively smaller.

     In the fourth quarter of 2003, the Company reduced aviation loss reserves related to the September 11 event by $197 million. This reduction in reserves was due to higher than expected levels of participation (97%) in the September 11 Victim Compensation Fund, a no-fault compensation scheme funded by the U.S. Government, which closed on December 22, 2003. This resulted in a reduction of the estimated ultimate losses by the Company for this event.

     The segment’s reserving process includes a continuing evaluation of the potential impact on unpaid liabilities from exposure to asbestos and environmental claims, including related loss adjustment expenses. Liabilities are established to cover both known and incurred but not reported claims.

     A reconciliation of the opening and closing unpaid losses and loss expenses related to asbestos and environmental exposure claims related to business written prior to 1986 for the years indicated is as follows:

Year Ended December 31   
   
   
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


            

            

 
Net unpaid losses and loss expenses at beginning of year   
$
57,400    
$
60,525    
$
66,130  
Net incurred losses and loss expenses   
   
   
(1,000 ) 
Less net paid losses and loss expenses   
6,140    
3,125    
4,605  


 

 

 
Net decrease in unpaid losses and loss expenses   
(6,140 )   
(3,125 )   
(5,605 ) 
Net unpaid losses and loss expenses at end of year   
51,260    
57,400    
60,525  
Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable at end of year   
72,741    
82,922    
86,576  


 

 

 
Gross unpaid losses and loss expenses at end of year   
$
124,001    
$
140,322    
$
147,101  


 

 

 

     Incurred but not reported losses, net of reinsurance, included in the above table was $16.7 million at December 31, 2005, $22.5 million at December 31, 2004 and $27.0 million at December 31, 2003. Unpaid losses recoverable are net of potential uncollectible amounts.

     The Company utilizes industry standard asbestos and environmental claims models to estimate its ultimate liability for these exposures.

     The Company reviews its actual reported loss experience for asbestos and environmental claims for its 1985 and prior exposures annually. The actual loss experience was consistent with assumptions established and, therefore, there was no adverse prior year development of the Company’s asbestos and environmental reserves in 2004 or 2005. The reserves for these exposures represented less than 1% of the Company’s total unpaid loss and loss expense reserves at December 31, 2005.

     The Company believes it has made reasonable provision for its asbestos and environmental exposures and is unaware of any specific issues that would significantly affect its estimate for loss and loss expenses. For further information see Item 8, Note 9 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     The decrease in the underwriting expense ratio in the year ended December 31, 2005, as compared with the year ended December 31, 2004, was due to a decrease in both the acquisition expense ratio and operating expense

76


ratio to 21.7% and 5.6%, respectively, as compared to 22.1% and 6.5%, respectively, for the year ended 2004. The decrease in the acquisition expense ratio was mainly due to decreased profit commissions, which resulted from the 2005 hurricane activity. The operating expense ratio decrease primarily reflects severance costs incurred during 2004 for reduction of staff as well as productivity expense management initiatives in 2005 and adjustments to certain 2005 compensation costs.

     The decrease in the underwriting expense ratio for the year ended December 31, 2004 as compared with 2003 was primarily due to a decrease in acquisition cost ratio driven by reduced profit commissions as a result of the year’s catastrophic losses. This decrease was partially offset by an increase in the operating expense ratio resulting from additional allocations of corporate expenses as well as the adverse impact of foreign exchange.

     Exchange losses in the year ended December 31, 2005 were mainly attributable to an overall strengthening in the value of the U.S. dollar against U.K. Sterling and the Euro in those operations’ unpaid losses in non-U.S. dollar currencies. Exchange gains in 2004 and 2003 were mainly attributable to a decline in the value of the U.S. dollar against U.K. sterling and the Euro in Bermuda-based operations that write business globally.

Reinsurance – Life and Annuity Operations

     The following table summarizes the net income from life and annuity operations of this segment:

   
% Change
% Change
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
05 vs 04
2004
04 vs 03
2003
 


       

     

       

     

 
Gross premiums written   
$
2,274,520     62.8 %   
$
1,397,516     90.5 %   
$
733,649  
Net premiums written   
2,236,903     64.1 %   
1,363,131     94.1 %   
702,107  
Net premiums earned   
2,237,721     63.9 %   
$
1,365,176     92.6 %   
$
708,994  
Fee income and other   
320     NM    
293     NM    
1,368  
Claims and policy benefits   
2,479,364     67.5 %   
1,480,535     87.1 %   
791,454  
Acquisition costs   
59,018     20.9 %   
48,830     33.3 %   
36,636  
Operating expenses   
18,664     32.6 %   
14,071     83.4 %   
7,674  
Net investment income   
290,517     41.1 %   
205,863     48.9 %   
138,267  
Foreign exchange losses (gains)   
1,421     NM    
(499 )    28.9 %   
(387 ) 
Interest (income) expense   
    NM    
(6 )    NM    
 


 

 

 
Net (loss) income   
$
(29,909 )    NM    
$
28,401     114.3 %   
$
13,252  


 

 

 


*NM – Not meaningful

     Life and annuity gross and net premiums written, net premiums earned and claims and policy benefits in each of the three years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003 included the assumption of the following long duration annuity portfolios:

     1. Second and fourth quarters of 2005 – A large U.K. immediate annuity portfolio contract bound representing $1.8 billion in net premiums earned and two smaller Irish immediate annuity portfolios amounted to $96.2 million.

     2. Second and fourth quarters of 2004 – Two large U.K. portfolio contracts, representing $995 million in net premiums earned and related claims and policy benefits.

     3. Fourth quarter of 2003 – two portfolios, one U.K. and one Irish, for a total of approximately $395.5 million in net premiums earned and related claims and policy benefits.

     The Company acquired cash and investment assets related to the future policy benefit reserves assumed at inception of these large contracts. While the Company expects to write more of these contracts, the frequency of these transactions will likely continue to be irregular.

77


     Excluding these large contracts, net premiums earned in life and annuity reinsurance increased in 2005 compared with 2004 and 2004 compared with 2003, as the Company expanded its life and annuity reinsurance operations in Europe, and continues to bind additional regular premium term assurance contracts which generate ongoing premiums.

     Claims and policy benefits also increased significantly in 2005 as compared to 2004, as a result of the annuity payout liabilities accepted under the contracts noted above where investment assets were acquired with the assumption of the policy benefit reserves at the inception of the contract. In addition, $37.4 million in losses were recorded during the second quarter of 2005 related to certain novated blocks of U.S.-based term life mortality reinsurance business as a result of the actuarially modeled impact of actual paid losses being greater than expected. In accordance with U.S. GAAP treatment for life business, a loss recognition test process was carried out to determine if expected future premiums would be sufficient to pay for expected future losses. This process led to management’s decision to unlock the current policy benefit reserve ratio and record a loss.

     Acquisition costs increased in the year ended December 31, 2005 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2004 reflecting the write-off of certain deferred costs of $25.9 million, including value of business assumed related to the U.S. mortality business noted above, as current profit projections did not support the recovery of the deferred costs booked in the prior year. Operating expenses increased in 2005 compared to 2004 due to build-out of existing operations and start-up costs of new life operations in the U.S.

     Net investment income has increased reflecting the increase in life business invested assets primarily arising from new large annuity contracts written since 2004. Net investment income is included in the calculation of net income from life and annuity operations as it relates to income earned on portfolios of separately identified and managed life investment assets and other allocated assets. The accretion of the related future policy benefit reserves is included in claims and policy benefits.

Financial Products and Services

Financial Products and Services – Financial Operations

     The following table summarizes the underwriting results for this segment:

   
% Change
% Change
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005 
05 vs 04
2004
04 vs 03
2003 


     

     

       

     

Gross premiums written   
$
378,140    9.5 %   
$
345,235     (4.2 )%   
$ 
360,509 
Net premiums written   
356,445    9.5 %   
325,662     (7.2 )%   
350,845 
Net premiums earned   
254,136    11.0 %   
228,898     17.2 %   
195,344 
Fee income and other   
15,032    32.6 %   
11,340     (54.9 )%   
25,153 
Net losses and loss expenses   
106,072    (7.5 )%   
114,633     14.1 %   
100,435 
Acquisition costs   
30,075    (1.4 )%   
30,498     11.4 %   
27,384 
Operating expenses   
70,912    1.4 %   
69,934     48.1 %   
47,209 
Foreign exchange (gains) losses   
1,861    NM    
(3,170 )    NM    
603 




 

Underwriting profit (loss)   
$
60,248    112.6 %   
$
28,343     (36.8 )%   
$ 
44,866 
Net investment income – financial guarantee   
71,781    76.0 %   
40,780     75.2 %   
23,273 
Net investment income – structured products   
313,936    80.2 %   
174,241     55.7 %   
111,873 
Interest expense – structured products   
216,392    90.6 %   
113,523     15.8 %   
98,022 
Operating expenses – structured products   
42,679    (15.0 )%   
50,230     23.2 %   
40,785 
Net income from financial affiliates   
10,866    (47.4 )%   
20,668     (56.5 )%   
47,478 
Minority interest   
8,431    (3.2 )%   
8,708     (23.8 )%   
11,424 
Net results from derivatives   
45,433    (8.2 )%   
49,481     NM    
7,983 




 

Net contribution from financial operations   
$
234,762    66.4 %   
$
141,052     65.5 %   
$ 
85,242 




 



*NM – Not meaningful

78


     Increases in gross and net premiums written of 9.5% in 2005, as compared to 2004, were primarily due to additional premiums due in 2005 on a structured property and casualty policy, which incurred a loss related to Hurricane Katrina, as well as premiums from several new structured property and casualty policies written during the year. Financial guaranty premiums remained relatively flat in 2005, as compared to 2004.

     Decreases in gross and net premiums written of 4.2% and 7.2%, respectively, in 2004, as compared to 2003, were primarily due to lower financial guaranty premiums written, resulting from management’s underwriting and pricing discipline during generally weaker market conditions in 2004. In addition, during 2004 there were fewer large up-front premium contracts written, as compared with the prior year. Financial guaranty market conditions in 2004, as compared to 2003 were characterized by tighter credit spread compression, higher interest rates, increased competition and reduced public financing volume.

     Financial guaranty up-front premiums are earned over the life of the insured debt obligations based on par amount of risk outstanding. Financial guaranty installment premiums are earned over the installment period. Premiums from structured property and casualty and political risk business are generally earned over the period of coverage.

     The following table provides a line of business breakdown of the Financial Products and Services segment’s net premiums earned:

Year Ended December 31   
   
   
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005 
2004 
2003 


          

          

Financial Guaranty   
$
173,133   
$
183,422   
$
154,133 
Political Risk   
25,906   
27,938   
28,886 
Other (1)   
55,097   
17,538   
12,325 






   
$
254,136   
$
228,898   
$
195,344 
 







(1)      Includes structured property and casualty and alternative risk transfer products and weather and energy risk management products.

     The increase in net premiums earned of 11.0% during 2005, as compared to 2004, primarily resulted from additional premiums due in 2005 on a structured property and casualty policy which incurred a loss related to Hurricane Katrina, as well as new structured property and casualty business production in 2005, offset in part by lower earned premium in our financial guaranty line of business in 2005, as compared to 2004. The year over year decrease in earnings in our financial guaranty line of business was primarily attributable to $23.3 million of premium earnings recorded in 2004 relating to an insured project financing on which a full-limit loss was recognized during the year (for further discussion see “Net losses and loss expenses” below).

     The increase in net premiums earned in 2004, as compared to the prior year, was primarily due to growth in the financial guaranty in force book of business, in conjunction with the acceleration of $23.3 million in premium earnings on the insured project financing discussed above (for further discussion see “Net losses and loss expenses” below). This increase was partially offset by the impact on earned premiums in 2003 related to the refunding of certain insured financings and certain short term contract enhancements.

     Net losses and loss expenses include current year net losses incurred and adverse or favorable development of prior year reserves for net losses and loss expenses. Net losses and loss expenses during 2005 decreased by 7.5%, as compared to 2004. This decrease primarily resulted from lower incurred losses in the Company’s financial guaranty business of approximately $65.8 million due primarily to the absence of significant individual losses as compared to the prior year, as well as favorable development associated with the Company’s unallocated loss reserves, partially offset by an increase in loss reserves in our structured property and casualty business of approximately $50.4 million that primarily resulted from a limit loss incurred under a contract related to Hurricane Katrina.

     Net losses and loss expenses in 2004 increased by 14.1% compared to 2003. The increase was primarily the result of a provision for losses in 2004 of approximately $41.7 million relating to the subordinate layer of an insured

79


project financing structure, as well as a net increase in unallocated reserves resulting from the growth in financial guaranty in force business, offset by a decrease in reserves in 2004, as compared to 2003, relating to non-investment grade credit default swaps of approximately $37.4 million.

     For 2005, acquisition costs decreased by approximately $0.4 million. This decrease consisted of higher acquisition expenses in our guaranteed investment contract and funding agreement businesses, offset by lower acquisition expenses in our financial guaranty business. Lower acquisition expenses in our financial guaranty business were primarily the result of ceding proportionally more installment business relative to upfront business in 2005, as compared to 2004. Risk on installment business generally expires faster than that on upfront business, which resulted in a higher year over year amortization of deferred commissions. For 2004 acquisition costs decreased compared with 2003 reflecting a change in the average life of the financial guaranty in force book of business over which such costs are expensed.

     For 2005, net operating expenses, including non-structured and structured products, were $113.6 million, a decrease of $6.6 million from $120.2 million in 2004. The favorable movement was mostly attributable to a reduction in compensation expense and professional fees. For 2004, net operating expenses, including non-structured and structured products, increased by $32.2 million to $120.2 million from $88.0 million for 2003 due primarily to the investment in segment infrastructure and continued build-out of the financial products platform as well as an increase in the allocation of certain corporate expenses.

     Net investment income related to the financial guaranty business increased by 76.0% in 2005, as compared to 2004, due primarily to higher average invested assets resulting from net cash inflows from operations and a $125.0 million capital infusion during the fourth quarter of 2004. In addition, $16.3 million in investment income (including a special one-time dividend paid in 2005 of $9.9 million) relates to the Company’s investment in Financial Security Assurance International Ltd. (“FSAI”). The special dividend was paid in connection with the redemption of the Company’s investment in FSAI during December of 2005. Prior to October 1, 2004, this investment in FSAI was accounted for under the equity method and reported the associated results thereof in “Net income from financial and investment affiliates”. Effective October 1, 2004, the Company changed the accounting for its investment in FSAI from the equity method to FSAB 115, Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities to conform to the requirements of EITF 02-14 Whether an Investor Should Apply the Equity Method of Accounting to Investments Other Than Common Stock (“EITF 02-14”). Accordingly, beginning October 1, 2004 the only earnings recognized by the Company on its investment in FSAI were dividends that were reported in investment income.

     Net investment income related to the financial guaranty business increased by 75.2% in 2004, as compared to 2003, due primarily to higher average invested assets resulting from net cash inflows from operations and a $100.0 million capital infusion to this business in the fourth quarter of 2003.

     Net investment income related to structured products increased by 80.2% in 2005, as compared to 2004, primarily as a result of a significant increase in average funding agreement and guaranteed investment contract deposits from $2.8 billion in 2004 to $4.9 billion in 2005. Similarly, net investment income related to structured products increased 55.7% in 2004, as compared to 2003, due to an increase in average funding agreement and guaranteed investment contract deposits from $1.1 billion in 2003 to $2.8 billion in 2004.

     Interest expense on structured products relates to deposit liabilities associated with funding agreements, guaranteed investment contracts and certain structured property and casualty contracts. The increase in interest expense during 2005, as compared to 2004, related primarily to the increase in the average funding agreement and guaranteed investment contract deposits in 2005 discussed above, partially offset by reduced interest expense on certain structured property and casualty contracts resulting from a change in the timing of estimated future cash outflows from such contracts during 2005.

     Net income from financial affiliates includes earnings on the Company’s investment in Primus Guaranty, Ltd (“Primus”) and certain of the Company’s investment affiliates, which are accounted for under the equity method. The decrease in such earnings in 2005, as compared to 2004, was due primarily to a decrease in earnings from Primus, as

80


well as the change in accounting related to the Company’s investment in FSAI to conform with the requirements of EITF 02-14 as discussed above. Primus specializes in providing credit risk protection through credit derivatives. Net income from financial affiliates also decreased in 2004, as compared to 2003, due primarily to the Company’s investment in Primus. Primus had a mark-to-market adjustment in 2004, which was less favorable than that recorded in 2003. This decrease was partially offset by income from the sale of a portion of the Company’s investment in Primus, in connection with the initial public offering of Primus in the fourth quarter of 2004.

     Minority interest in 2005 is consistent with 2004. The decrease in minority interest in 2004, as compared to 2003, reflects the fact that the minority interest holder’s return on investment is contractually capped. The minority interest relates to an equity position in XL Financial Assurance Ltd., which is held by a third party.

     Net results from structured derivatives represent changes in the market value of the segment’s insured credit derivative portfolio, as well as results from its weather and energy derivative business and certain structured financial risk management products. Net results from structured derivatives decreased 8.2% in 2005, as compared to 2004. Results in 2005 primarily consist of (i) $8.2 million of unrealized gains resulting from the reclassification to “net losses and loss expenses” of an incurred loss on a credit default swap, (ii) an $18.6 million gain on the settlement of a structured market risk management derivative product tied to a housing price index, and (iii) $17.8 million net realized and unrealized gains in the weather and energy business. Results in 2004 primarily consist of (i) net unrealized gains on the credit derivative portfolio of $44.2 million resulting primarily from tightening credit spreads during the year, (ii) $3.3 million of net realized and unrealized gains on the structured financial derivative business, and (iii) $2.0 million of net realized and unrealized gains in the weather and energy business.

     Investment Activities

     The following table illustrates the change in net investment income from general operations, net income from investment affiliates, net realized gains and losses on investments and net realized and unrealized gains and losses on investment derivatives for each of the three years ended December 31:

   
% Change
% Change
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
05 vs 04
2004 
04 vs 03
2003
 


      

     

     

     

 
Net investment income – general operations   
$
798,805   30.1 %   
$
614,128    13.3 %   
$
542,074  
Net income from investment affiliates (1)    149,032   28.3 %    116,161    7.1 %    108,476  
Net realized gains (losses) on investments    241,882   (1.9 )%    246,547    105.1 %    120,195  
Net realized and unrealized gains (losses) on                   
     investment derivative instruments (2) 
  (16,575 )  NM     24,012    NM     (1,910 ) 

*NM – Not meaningful
   
(1)      Net income from investment affiliates in 2004 and 2005 reflect the twelve months to November 30, 2004 and 2005, as compared to the eleven months ended November 30, 2003. The Company records the investment affiliates on a one month lag in order for the Company to meet the accelerated filing deadlines as specified by the SEC.
(2) For a summary of realized and unrealized gains and losses on all derivative instruments, see Item 8, Note 14 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     Net investment income related to general operations increased in 2005 as compared to 2004 primarily due to growth in the investment base, as well as increases in the yield of the portfolio. The growth in the investment base reflected the Company’s cash flow from operations. The Company also received a distribution associated with the unwinding of a collateral debt obligation, which resulted in a one-time benefit to investment income. In addition, the Company received investment income of $25.3 million on related to the conclusion of the independent actuarial process with WSIC.

     The Company’s total investments available for sale and cash and cash equivalents less net pending payable for investments purchased was $38.8 billion at December 31, 2005 as compared to $29.8 billion at December 31, 2004. This increase of $9.0 billion includes (i) cash flow from financing activities of $3.2 billion in the fourth quarter of

81


2005, (ii) cash flow of $2.0 billion from spread product transactions and (iii) cash flow from operations of $4.2 billion. The annualized effective yield of the total investment portfolio (excluding non-recurring items) was 4.1% for 2005 as compared to 3.8% for 2004, a 0.3% increase. The increase in the effective yield of the total investment portfolio was primarily due to general interest rate increases in the U.S.

     It is expected that net investment income in 2006 will increase due to projected increases in investments resulting from the full year effect of investing proceeds from the December 2005 capital raise, and monies received from conclusion of the independent actuarial process with WSIC, as well as anticipated increases in market yields on reinvestment of existing assets and investment of new cash flows. However, actual market changes in interest rates could offset or supplement the effects of cash flow. For a further discussion see “Liquidity and Capital Resources.”

     Net income from investment affiliates includes earnings from the Company’s investments in closed-end investment funds and partnerships and similar vehicles that are equity accounted. Net income from investment affiliates increased in 2005 as compared to 2004 primarily due to a strong result in private equity portfolios due to a series of positive liquidity events, with continued good returns on the alternative portfolios.

     Investment Performance

     The Company manages its investment grade fixed income securities using an asset/liability management framework. Due to the unique nature of the underlying liabilities, customized benchmarks are used to measure investment performance and comparison to standard market indices is not meaningful. Investment performance is not monitored for certain assets primarily consisting of operating cash and special regulatory deposits. The following is a summary of the investment portfolio returns for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 of the general account asset/liability portfolio, structured and spread product portfolio and risk asset portfolios.

    2005 (1)    2004 (1) 


          

General Account Asset/Liability Portfolio         
USD fixed income portfolio    2.2 %    3.5 % 
Non-USD fixed income portfolio    (0.5 )%    10.0 % 
 
Structured and Spread Product Portfolio         
USD fixed income portfolio    3.6 %    4.8 % 
Non-USD fixed income portfolio    10.2 %    9.1 % 
 
Risk Asset Portfolio         
Alternative portfolio    7.5 %    8.2 % 
Equity portfolio    13.9 %    18.0 % 
High-Yield fixed income portfolio    3.1 %    6.9 % 


(1)      Portfolio returns are calculated by dividing the sum of the net investment income or net income from investment affiliates, realized gains (losses) and unrealized gains (losses) by the average market value of each portfolio. Non U.S. dollar fixed income performance is measured in either the underlying currency or in U.S. dollars.
 

Net realized gains and losses on investments and other than temporary declines in the value of investments

     The Company’s investment portfolio is classified as available for sale. Realized investment gains and losses occur through the normal turnover of the Company’s investment portfolio. Realized investment losses include impairment charges relating to declines in value of securities that are considered to be other than temporary. See “– Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” for further information.

     In 2005, net realized gains on investments were $241.9 million which includes $250.8 million of gross realized losses on fixed income and $54.1 million of gross realized losses on equity securities. Gross realized losses in 2005

82


included $53.2 million of provisions for declines in fair value considered to be other than temporary. In the U.S., the general level of corporate defaults was stable. For example, Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”) reported that 31 issuers defaulted in 2005 compared with 34 issuers in 2004 and 77 issuers in 2003. The Company’s exposure to these defaults was limited in both 2005 and 2004, compared to 2003, resulting in a reduction in the write-down for other than temporary declines. As a percentage of the total fixed income portfolio, the write-down for other than temporary declines was 0.1% in 2005 as compared to a negligible amount in 2004 and 0.6% in 2003.

     In 2004, net realized gains on investments were $246.5 million which includes $265.9 million of gross realized losses on fixed income and $48.8 million of gross realized losses on equity securities. Gross realized losses in 2004 included $6.4 million of provisions for declines in fair value considered to be other than temporary.

     In 2003, net realized gains on investments were $120.2 million, which included $344.8 million of gross realized losses on fixed income and $162.5 million of gross realized losses on equity securities. Gross realized losses in 2003 included $130.7 million of provisions for declines in fair value considered to be other than temporary.

     With respect to those securities that were sold at a loss during the year ended December 31, 2005, the following is an analysis of the period of time that those securities had been in a continual unrealized loss position, the amount of the realized loss recorded in the Company’s results of operations as of the sale date and the amount of the impairment charge taken in the year:

Length of time in a continual unrealized loss position   
Fixed Income 
Equity 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Securities 
Securities 


          

Less than 6 months   
$
149,305   
$
40,903 
At least 6 months but less than 12 months   
22,049   
5,073 
At least 12 months but less than 2 years   
29,582   
1,923 
At least 2 years   
2,664   
214 




Total gross realized loss from sales   
203,600   
48,113 
Impairment charges for declines in value considered to be   
   
 
   other than temporary   
47,239   
5,968 




Total gross realized loss   
$
250,839   
$
54,081 





     With respect to those investment securities that were sold at a loss during the year ended December 31, 2004, the following is an analysis of the period of time that those securities had been in a continual unrealized loss position, the amount of the realized loss recorded in the Company’s results of operations as of the sale date and the amount of the impairment charge taken in the year:

Length of time in a continual unrealized loss position   
Fixed Income 
Equity 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Securities 
Securities 


          


Less than 6 months   
$
220,127   
$
37,893 
At least 6 months but less than 12 months   
22,686   
5,688 
At least 12 months but less than 2 years   
11,877   
3,342 
At least 2 years   
7,020   
 




Total gross realized loss from sales   
261,710   
46,923 
Impairment charges for declines in value considered to be   
   
 
   other than temporary   
4,144   
1,870 




Total gross realized loss   
$
265,854   
$
48,793 





     The Company’s process for identifying declines in the fair value of investments that are other than temporary involves consideration of several factors, as discussed under “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates.”

83


     During the year ended December 31, 2005, the Company realized losses of $250.8 million and $54.1 million upon the sale of fixed income securities and equity securities, respectively, that had been in an unrealized loss position for greater than twelve months. During the year ended December 31, 2004, the Company realized losses of $18.9 million and $3.3 million upon the sale of fixed income securities and equity securities, respectively, that had been in an unrealized loss position for greater than twelve months. The decisions to sell these securities were made by the Company’s investment managers based upon a change in market conditions and other factors (these decisions were independent of the Company’s previously stated intent and ability to hold such securities).

     Net realized and unrealized gains on investment derivatives result from the Company’s investment strategy to economically hedge against interest and foreign exchange risk within the investment portfolio. For a further discussion see Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk” and “– Liquidity and Capital Resources.”

     Unrealized losses on investments

     At December 31, 2005, there were $312.7 million of gross unrealized losses on fixed income and short-term investments, and $8.8 million of gross unrealized losses on equity securities. At December 31, 2004, there were $119.7 million of gross unrealized losses on fixed-income and short-term investments, and $7.2 million of gross unrealized losses on equity securities. These losses include securities below investment grade, as discussed below.

     The information shown below about the unrealized losses on the Company’s investments at December 31, 2005 and 2004, concerns the potential effect upon future earnings and financial position should management later conclude that some of the current declines in the fair value of these investments are other than temporary declines.

     The following is an analysis of the length of time each of those investment securities at December 31, 2005 and 2004 had been in a continual unrealized loss position:

       
Amount of 
 
Amount of 
Type of Securities    Length of time in a continual   
unrealized loss at 
 
unrealized loss at 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)    unrealized loss position   
December 31, 2005 
 
December 31, 2004 





               



Fixed Income and Short-Term    Less than six months     
$
139,130       
$
43,383   
    At least 6 months but less than 12 months     
90,448       
46,613   
    At least 12 months but less than 2 years     
75,898       
29,453   
    2 years or more     
7,245       
217   




 
    Total     
$
312,721       
$
119,666   




 
Equities    Less than six months     
$
6,545       
$
3,067   
    At least 6 months but less than 12 months     
2,275       
2,287   
    At least 12 months but less than 2 years     
       
1,862   




 
    Total     
$
8,820       
$
7,216   




 

     At December 31, 2005, the total gross unrealized losses represented approximately 9,100 fixed income securities out of a total of approximately 17,300 and approximately 400 equity securities out of a total of approximately 1,800. At December 31, 2004, the total gross unrealized losses represented approximately 5,100 fixed income securities out of a total of approximately 15,300, and approximately 200 equity securities out of a total of approximately 1,600.

     As discussed under Item 1, “Investments – Investment Structure and Strategy,” the Company operates a risk asset portfolio that includes high yield (below investment grade) fixed income securities. These securities are more sensitive to credit risk than investment grade securities. At December 31, 2005, approximately 2.4% of the Company’s fixed income investment portfolio was invested in securities that were below investment grade or not rated. Approximately 4.3% of the unrealized losses in the Company’s fixed income securities portfolio at December 31, 2005, related to securities that were below investment grade or not rated. At December 31, 2004, approximately 4.6%

84


of the Company’s fixed income investment portfolio was invested in securities that were below investment grade or not rated. Approximately 5.8% of the unrealized losses in the Company’s fixed income securities portfolio at December 31, 2004, related to securities that were below investment grade or not rated. The following is an analysis of the length of time each of those below investment grade and unrated securities had been in a continual unrealized loss position at the date indicated.

 
Amount of 
Amount of 
Length of time in a continual unrealized loss position 
unrealized loss at 
unrealized loss at 
(U.S. dollars in thousands) 
December 31, 2005 
December 31, 2004 




          



Less than six months   
$
9,471       
$
4,768   
At least 6 months but less than 12 months   
2,753       
1,764   
At least 12 months but less than 2 years   
1,086       
358   
At least 2 years but less than 3 years   
75       
106   




 
Total   
$
13,385       
$
6,996   




 

     Of the gross unrealized investment losses on the fixed income and short term investments portfolio at December 31, 2005 of $312.7 million, approximately $118.8 million related to corporate fixed income securities. Within the corporate fixed income securities, approximately 55.3% of the losses were in the financial sector, 9.8% in the communications sector, 9.4% in the consumer non-cyclical sector, and 5.6% in the consumer cyclical sector. No other sector was greater than 5%. The largest unrealized loss in the fixed income portfolio was $5.0 million. No equity securities held by the Company at December 31, 2005 were in a continual unrealized loss position for at least 12 months. The largest individual unrealized loss in the equity portfolio was $0.3 million.

     Of the $119.7 million gross unrealized investment losses on the fixed income and short term investments portfolio at December 31, 2004, approximately $45.2 million related to corporate fixed income securities. Within the corporate fixed income securities, approximately 43.8% of the losses were in the financial sector, 11.0% in the communications sector, 8.4% in the utilities sector, 8.2% in the consumer, non-cyclical sector and 7.1% in the consumer cyclical sector. No other sector was greater than 5%. The largest individual unrealized loss in the fixed income portfolio was $4.9 million. Approximately 20 equity securities held by the Company with total unrealized losses of approximately $2.0 million at December 31, 2004, were in a continual unrealized loss position for at least 12 months. The largest individual unrealized loss in the equity portfolio was $1.0 million.

     At December 31, 2005 and 2004, the following table sets forth the maturity profile of the fixed income securities (excluding short term) that were in a gross unrealized loss position:

Maturity profile in years of fixed income 
Amount of 
Amount of 
securities in a continual unrealized loss position 
unrealized loss at 
unrealized loss at 
(U.S. dollars in thousands) 
December 31, 2005 
December 31, 2004 








At least 1 year but less than 5 years remaining   
$
88,876 
     
$
35,880   
At least 5 years but less than 10 years remaining   
69,844 
     
19,220   
More than 10 years but less than 20 years remaining   
5,435 
     
11,908   
At least 20 years or more remaining   
18,358 
     
6,665   
Mortgage and asset-backed securities   
120,046 
     
41,176   




 
Total   
$
302,559 
     
$
114,849   




 

85


Other Revenues and Expenses

     The following table sets forth other revenues and expenses of the general operations of the Company for each of the three years ended December 31:

   
% Change
% Change
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
05 vs 04
2004
04 vs 03
2003 


     

     

     

     

Net income from operating affiliates    62,371     (53.6 )%    134,535     NM     27,831   
Amortization of intangible assets    10,752     (32.1 )%    15,827     NM     4,637   
Corporate operating expenses    176,909     (10.0 )%    196,648     35.5 %    145,085   
Interest expense – general operations    187,457     4.9 %    178,717     31.5 %    135,907   
Minority interest    (221 )    (31.2 )%    (321 )    NM        
Income tax expense    49,284     (46.0 )%    91,343     NM     31,455   


*NM – Not meaningful

     In 2005, net income from operating affiliates declined over 2004, which resulted from the fact that the 2004 results included proceeds from the sale of two affiliates, as described below. The results of the Company’s investment management affiliates showed good underlying growth in 2005 due to good investment performance and growth in assets managed by these minority-owned managers.

     In 2004, the increase in net income from operating affiliates included strong performance by the Company’s investment management affiliates combined with income of $66.7 million on the sale of the Company’s investment in the Admiral Group Ltd. and $35.4 million of income from the sale of the Company’s stake in Pareto Partners L.P. and its affiliated companies, as well as strong growth in assets managed by these minority-owned managers.

     Net income from operating affiliates in 2003 included an other than temporary decline of $40.9 million in the value of the Company’s investment in Annuity and Life Reinsurance Company. The investment was written down to its fair value of $2.2 million at March 31, 2003. See Item 8, Note 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion.

     Amortization of intangible assets decreased in 2005 as a result of certain intangible assets that were fully amortized during the year. Amortization of intangible assets increased in 2004 as compared to 2003 due primarily to the acquisition of a book of business related to XL Re Europe at the end of 2003.

     Corporate operating expenses in 2005 decreased by 10.0% primarily as a result of Company-wide cost reduction efforts combined with reduced compensation costs and partially offset by increased legal costs. Corporate operating expenses in 2004 increased 35.5% compared to 2003 due to the continued build-out of the Company’s global infrastructure and personnel in developing its network of shared service organizations to support operations in certain locations, costs related to compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, and adverse foreign exchange impacts.

     Interest expense includes costs related to the Company’s debt and collateral facilities as well as deposit liability accretion. The increase in interest expense primarily reflected the increase in average outstanding debt for the year ended December 31, 2005, compared to 2004. For more information on the Company’s financial structure, see “Liquidity and Capital Resources”.

     In 2004, interest expense has increased primarily as a result of the additional interest related to the senior notes issued in March, August and November of 2004, partially offset by the reduced interest as a result of the redemption of the Liquid Yield Option Notes and Zero Coupon Convertible Debentures during that year.

     The change in the Company’s income taxes in each of the three years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003 principally reflects the effects of changes in the profitability of the U.S. and European operations for each year. Income tax expense for the year ended December 31, 2005 decreased from 2004, due primarily to losses incurred in the Company’s U.S. operations as a result of the 2005 catastrophe activity. A significant proportion of the loss reserve increases are captured in non-U.S. subsidiaries where no tax relief is available.

86


     The deferral of tax losses is evaluated based upon the future profitability of the Company’s taxable entities and, under current projections, the Company anticipates using this asset. The Company’s net deferred tax asset at December 31, 2005 was $318.4 million, which consists primarily of net operating losses generated by subsidiaries in the U.S. and U.K. Should the taxable income of these entities fall below expectations, a further valuation allowance may have to be established, which could be significant. In addition, if any further losses are generated by these entities, these losses may not be tax effected. See “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” and Item 8, Note 23 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

     Investments

     The primary objective of the investment strategy is to support the liabilities arising from the operations of the Company, generate stable investment income and to build book value for the Company over the longer term. The strategy strives to maximize investment returns while taking into account market and credit risk. The Company’s overall investment portfolio is structured to take into account a number of variables including local regulatory requirements, business needs, collateral management and risk tolerance.

     At December 31, 2005 and 2004, total investments and cash and cash equivalents were $41.2 billion and $32.1 billion, respectively. The following table summarizes the composition of the Company’s invested assets at December 31, 2005 and 2004:

   
Market Value
Percent of
Market Value
Percent of
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
Total
2004
Total



     

     


     

Cash and cash equivalents    $  3,693,475     9.0 %    $  2,203,726     6.9 % 
Net payable for investments purchased      (639,034 )    (1.6 )%      (273,535 )    (0.9 )% 
Fixed maturities                     
   U.S. Government and Government agency 
  $  4,497,004     10.9 %    $  4,112,075     12.8 % 
   Corporate      13,292,892     32.2 %      11,349,847     35.4 % 
   Mortgage and asset-backed securities 
    11,652,106     28.3 %      6,928,558     21.6 % 
   U.S. States and political subdivisions 
                   
       of the States      71,193     0.2 %      63,056     0.2 % 
   Non-U.S. Sovereign Government      2,796,370     6.8 %      2,646,658     8.2 % 


 
 

 
 
       Total fixed maturities    $  32,309,565     78.4 %    $  25,100,194     78.2 % 
 
Short-term investments      2,546,073     6.2 %      1,760,714     5.5 % 
Total equity securities      868,801     2.1 %      962,920     3.0 % 
Investments in affiliates      2,046,721     5.0 %      1,936,852     6.0 % 
Other investments      399,417     0.9 %      405,737     1.3 % 


 
 

 
 
Total investments and cash and                     
   cash equivalents    $  41,225,018     100.0 %    $  32,096,608     100.0 % 


 
 

 
 

     The Company reviews on a regular basis its corporate debt concentration, credit quality and compliance with established guidelines. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, the average credit quality of the Company’s total fixed income portfolio was “AA.” At December 31, 2005 approximately 57.2% of the fixed income portfolio was rated AAA by one or more of the principal ratings agencies. Approximately 2.4% was below investment grade or not rated.

Unpaid Losses and Loss Expenses

     Unpaid losses and loss expenses include reserves on the Company’s general and financial operations and relates primarily to the casualty insurance and reinsurance business written by the Company. The balance was $23.8 billion at December 31, 2005, which is an increase of $4.0 billion from December 31, 2004. The increase was due primarily to $3.8 billion in gross losses from catastrophe activity in 2005.

87


     The table below represents a reconciliation of the Company’s general and financial operations unpaid losses and loss expenses for the year ended December 31, 2005:

   
Gross unpaid
Unpaid losses and
Net unpaid losses
 
   
losses and loss
loss expenses
and loss
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
expenses
recoverable
expenses
 


       

       

 
Balance at December 31, 2004   
$
19,837,669    
$
(6,962,131 )   
$
12,875,538  
Losses and loss expenses incurred   
9,591,539    
(2,126,538 )   
7,465,001  
Losses and loss expenses paid/recovered   
(4,839,737 )   
2,229,971    
(2,609,766 ) 
Other (including foreign exchange revaluation)   
(821,799 )   
446,050    
(375,749 ) 


 

 

 
Balance at December 31, 2005   
$
23,767,672    
$
(6,412,648 )   
$
17,355,024  


 

 

 

     While the Company reviews the adequacy of established reserves for unpaid losses and loss expenses regularly, no assurance can be given that actual claims made and payments related thereto will not be in excess of the amounts reserved. In the future, if such reserves develop adversely, such deficiency would have a negative impact on future results of operations. See Item 1, “Unpaid Losses and Loss Expenses”, “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” and Item 8, Note 9 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion.

Unpaid Losses and Loss Expenses Recoverable and Reinsurance Balances Receivable

     In the normal course of business, the Company seeks to reduce the potential amount of loss arising from claims events by reinsuring certain levels of risk assumed in various areas of exposure with other insurers or reinsurers. While reinsurance agreements are designed to limit the Company’s losses from large exposures and permit recovery of a portion of direct unpaid losses, reinsurance does not relieve the Company of its ultimate liability to the Company’s insureds. Accordingly, the losses and loss expense reserves on the balance sheet represent the Company’s total unpaid gross losses. Unpaid losses and loss expense recoverable relates to estimated reinsurance recoveries on the unpaid loss and loss expense reserves.

     Unpaid losses and loss expense recoverables were $6.4 billion and $7.0 billion at December 31, 2005, and 2004, respectively. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, reinsurance balances receivable were $1.0 and $1.1 billion, respectively. The table below presents the Company’s net reinsurance recoverable at December 31, 2005 and 2004.

   
December 31,
December 31,
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004



     


Reinsurance balances receivable   
$
1,069,402    
$
1,097,709  
Reinsurance recoverable on future policy benefits   
28,874    
8,291  
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable   
6,646,972    
7,241,774  
Bad debt reserve on unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable and   
   
 
   reinsurance balances receivable   
(260,713 )   
(280,679 ) 


 

 
Net paid and unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable and   
   
 
   reinsurance balances receivable   
$
7,484,535    
$
8,067,095  


 

 

     The Company has credit risk should any of its reinsurers be unable or unwilling to settle amounts due. Of the $7.5 billion total unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable and reinsurance balances receivable at December 31, 2005, no individual reinsurer accounted for 10% or more of the total. The Company is the beneficiary of letters of credit, trust accounts and funds withheld in the aggregate amount of $2.1 billion at December 31, 2005, collateralizing reinsurance recoverables with respect to certain reinsurers. The provision for uncollectible reinsurance is required principally due to the failure of reinsurers to indemnify the Company primarily because of disputes under reinsurance contracts and insolvencies. As at December 31, 2005 and 2004, the Company had a reserve for potential non-recoveries from reinsurers of $260.7 million and $280.7 million, respectively.

88


     Included in unpaid loss and loss expenses recoverable at December 31, 2004, was an unsecured reinsurance recoverable from WSIC of $1.45 billion, related to certain contractual arrangements in the SPA entered into in connection with the Company’s acquisition of Winterthur International in July 2001. This balance was settled in 2005 for $575 million, resulting in a loss of $808.9 million, net of interest received.

     Under the terms of the SPA, WSIC provides the Company with protection with respect to third party reinsurance receivables and recoverables related to the acquisition of certain Winterthur International insurance operations (the “Winterthur Business”), which were approximately $1.6 billion, in the aggregate, as of December 31, 2005. There are two levels of protection for these balances:

      1.      At the time of the Winterthur International acquisition, WSIC provided to the Company a liquidity facility. At the time of the payment of the net reserve seasoned amount on December 12, 2005, the Company exercised its right to repay up to the balances outstanding on this facility by assignment to WSIC of an equal amount of receivables relating to reinsurance recoverables selected by the Company. During December 2005, the Company assigned $265.4 million of receivables to WSIC under this arrangement, although WSIC has disputed the assignment of certain of these receivables.
 
  2. Under two retrocession agreements the Company has reinsurance protection on the reinsurance recoverables with respect to the Seasoned Net Reserves Amount determined as of June 30, 2004, to the extent that the Company does not receive payment of such amounts from applicable reinsurers with one agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to June 30, 2001, and the other agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to December 31, 2000.

     At December 31, 2005, certain reinsurers responsible for some portions of the reinsurance of the acquired Winterthur Business have raised issues as to whether amounts claimed are due and discussions are currently ongoing to achieve a resolution.

     Approximately 76% of the total unpaid loss and loss expense recoverable and reinsurance balances receivable (excluding collateral held) outstanding at December 31, 2005, were due from reinsurers rated “A” or better by S&P. The following is an analysis of the total recoverable and reinsurance balances receivable at December 31, 2005, by reinsurers owing more than 3% of such total:

          Standard and     
  Name of reinsurer    Poor’s rating    % of total
 



  Lloyd’s Syndicates    A/Stable    7.97 % 
  Swiss Reinsurance Co.    AA/ Watch Negative    7.11 % 
  Employers Reinsurance Corp.    A/Stable    6.76 % 
  Munich Reinsurance Co.    A+/Stable    6.53 % 
  Transatlantic Reinsurance Company    AA-/Stable    3.61 % 
  National Indemnity Co.    AAA/Stable    3.58 % 

89


     The following table sets forth the ratings profile of the reinsurers that support the unpaid loss and loss expense recoverable and reinsurance balances receivable net of security noted above.

Standard and 
   
Poor’s rating 
  % of total



AAA    6.4 % 
AA    27.4 % 
A    44.1 % 
BBB    1.1 % 
BB and below    1.0 % 
Captives    13.2 % 
Not Rated    2.4 % 
Other    4.4 % 

 
Total    100 % 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

     As a holding company, the Company’s assets consist primarily of its investments in subsidiaries, and the Company’s future cash flows depend upon the availability of dividends or other statutorily permissible payments from its subsidiaries. The ability to pay such dividends is limited by the applicable laws and regulations of the various countries in which the Company operates, including, among others, Bermuda, the United States, Ireland, Switzerland, the United Kingdom, and those of the Society of Lloyd’s and certain contractual provisions. See Item 8, Note 24 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion. No assurance can be given that the Company or its subsidiaries will be permitted to pay dividends in the future.

Liquidity

     Certain business written by the Company has loss experience generally characterized as having low frequency and high severity. This may result in volatility in both the Company’s results and operational cash flows.

     See Item 8 – “Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows.” There are three main sources of cash flows for the Company – those provided by operations, investing activities and financing activities.

     Cash Flow provided by Operations

     Cash flow from operations is derived from two main sources:

      1)      The receipt of investment income on the Company’s total investment portfolio; and
 
  2) The net receipt of premiums less claims and expenses related to its underwriting activities in general, life and annuity and financial operations.

     Cash flow from operations was $4.2 billion in 2005, as compared to $4.4 billion in 2004. The decrease in 2005 is due primarily to cash payments on catastrophe losses during 2005, partially offset by the receipt of a net lump sum payment of $575.0 million from WSIC, related to the conclusion of the independent actuarial process and an increase in the receipt of investment income in line with increasing interest rates and the growth of the investment portfolio.

     Net cash received from underwriting activities is comprised of receipt of premiums, minus payment of claims and operating and acquisition costs. Premiums and acquisition expenses are settled based on terms of trade as stipulated by an underwriting contract, and generally are received within the first year of inception of a policy when the premium is written, but can be up to three years on certain reinsurance business assumed. Operating expenses are generally paid within a year of being incurred. Claims especially for casualty business, may take a much longer time before they are reported and ultimately settled and this is why the Company establishes reserves for unpaid losses and

90


loss expenses. Therefore, the amount of claims paid in any one year is not necessarily related to the amount of net losses incurred, as reported in the consolidated statement of income.

     During 2005, 2004 and 2003, the total amounts of net losses paid for general and financial operations were $2.6 billion, $3.1 billion and $2.9 billion, respectively, whereas the amount of net losses incurred was $7.4 billion, $4.9 billion and $4.7 billion, respectively. The decrease in net paid losses in 2005, is due to the receipt of a net lump sum payment of approximately $575 million related to the conclusion of the independent actuarial process with WSIC, partially offset by payments on 2005 Atlantic hurricane losses. The payout of the Company’s casualty reserves at December 31, 2005, could be as long as a thirty year period. Property claims are generally reported and settled within a much shorter period, usually up to three years.

Cash Flow used in Investing Activities

     Generally, positive cash flow from operations and financing activities is invested in the Company’s portfolio, including affiliates or acquisition of subsidiaries. Investing activities in 2005, were primarily related to the renewal purchase and sale of portfolio investments. In 2004, in addition to purchases and sales of the Company’s total investment portfolio, the Company sold its interests in Admiral Group Ltd and Pareto Partners L.P. and its affiliated companies for $66.7 million and $45.1 million, respectively.

     In 2003, in addition to purchases and sales of the Company’s total investment portfolio, the Company had the following significant investment cash flows:

      1)      In September 2003, the Company exercised its option and settled the related Euro liability to purchase the remaining 33% ownership of Le Mans Ré, now known as XL Re Europe, for approximately $161 million.
 
    See Item 8, Note 5(a) to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.
 
  2) In December 2003, the Company received $75.4 million relating to the agreement reached with WSIC as to the final purchase price for Winterthur International. See Item 8, Note 5(b) to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.
 
  3) In July 2003, the Company acquired new offices in London for its London headquarters. The acquisition was by a purchase, sale and leaseback transaction resulting in net cash received of $45.3 million, which was recorded as a deferred liability at December 31, 2003. The Company also recorded a capitalized lease asset and liability of approximately $150.0 million related to this transaction and there were no significant capital expenditures for leasehold improvements during 2003. See Item 8, Note 18(d) to the Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
Cash Flow provided by Financing Activities

     Cash flows related to financing activities include the payment of dividends, share related transactions, the issue or repayment of debt and deposit liability transactions. In 2005 and 2004, the Company received $2.0 billion and $1.5 billion of net cash relating to new deposit liability contracts. In 2005, dividends paid were $276.7 million for ordinary shares and $40.3 million for preferred shares.

     In addition, in the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003 the Company executed a number of debt and equity transactions which affect the cash flow from financing activities described below in “Capital Resources”.

Capital Resources

     In addition to ordinary share capital, the Company depends on external sources of financing to support its underwriting activities in the form of:

      a.      ordinary share capital,
 
  b. debt,
 

91


      c.      preference shares,
 
  d. contingent capital, and
 
  e. letters of credit facilities and other sources of collateral.
 
In particular, the Company requires, among other things:
  • Sufficient capital to maintain its financial strength, claims paying and debt ratings, as issued by several ratings agencies, at levels considered necessary by management to enable the Company’s key operating subsidiaries to compete.

  • Sufficient capital to enable its underwriting subsidiaries to meet the capital adequacy tests performed by statutory agencies in the U.S., the U.K., and other key markets.

  • Letters of credit and other forms of collateral that are required by the Company’s non-U.S. operating companies that are “non-admitted” under U.S. state insurance regulations. The Company also uses letters of credit to support its operations at Lloyd’s.

  • Revolving credit to meet short-term liquidity needs.

     The Company’s principal credit facilities are multi-year transactions with maturities in 2007 and 2010, however, the Company has other credit facilities that will expire in 2006. The following risks are associated with the Company’s requirement to renew these facilities during 2006:

  • The credit available from banks may be reduced resulting in the Company’s need to pledge its investment portfolio to customers. This could result in a lower investment yield.

  • The volume of business that the Company’s non-admitted subsidiaries are able to transact could be reduced if the Company is unable to renew its letter of credit facilities at an appropriate amount.

     Continued consolidation within the banking industry may result in the aggregate amount of credit provided to the Company being reduced. The Company attempts to mitigate this risk by identifying and/or selecting additional banks that can participate in the credit facilities upon renewal.

a) Ordinary Share Capital

     In December 2005, the Company issued 38.9 million ordinary shares at a price of $65.0 per share to support capital requirements subsequent to the 2005 Atlantic hurricane losses and the loss related to the conclusion of the independent actuarial process with WSIC. The net proceeds from this issuance were $2.4 billion. See Item 8, Note 19, to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

b) Debt

     At December 31, 2005, banks and investors provided the Company and its subsidiaries with $4.6 billion of debt capacity, of which $3.4 billion was utilized by the Company. These facilities consist of:

  • Revolving credit facilities of $1.2 billion in aggregate. The Company had $45 million outstanding at December 31, 2005, under its syndicated revolving credit facilities and this borrowing was repaid in January 2006. These revolving credit facilities (and their predecessor facilities) were not utilized during 2004. Of the $1.2 billion, $1.0 billion is provided by the Company’s $2.0 billion 3-year syndicated facility that matures in June 2007, and its $2.35 billion 5-year syndicated facility that matures in June 2010. Both facilities provide letters of credit in addition to the revolving credit sublimit. In addition, at December 31, 2005, the Company had two bilateral revolving credit facilities of $100 million each, of which one facility is a 364-day facility that matures in December 2006, and the other is a 5-year facility that matures in August 2010.

92


    At December 31, 2004, the Company had a $600 million revolving credit sublimit provided by a $2.0 billion 3-year facility and a $1.0 billion 364-day facility. In addition, a further $60 million of revolving credit was provided on a bilateral basis under a 364-day facility. These facilities were provided on an unsecured basis by a syndicate of banks (the $2.0 billion and $1.0 billion facilities) and on a bilateral basis in the case of the $100 million facility.

  • Senior Unsecured Notes of approximately $3.4 billion. These notes require the Company to pay a fixed rate of interest during their lives. At December 31, 2005, there were six outstanding issues of senior unsecured notes:

  • $255 million senior notes due April 2011, with a fixed coupon of 6.58%. These notes were privately placed and are not traded on a public exchange.

  • $600 million senior notes due January 2012, with a fixed coupon of 6.5%. The security is publicly traded. The notes were issued at $99.469 and gross proceeds were $596.8 million. Related expenses of the offering amounted to $7.9 million.

  • $600 million senior notes due September 2014, with a fixed coupon of 5.25%. The security is publicly traded. The notes were issued in two tranches of $300 million aggregate principal amount each – one tranche at 99.432% and the other at 98.419%. Aggregate gross proceeds were $593.6 million. Related expenses of the offering amounted to $4 million.

  • $350 million senior notes due November 2024, with a fixed coupon of 6.375%. The security is publicly traded. The notes were issued at 100.000% and gross proceeds were $350 million. Related expenses of the offering amounted to $2 million.

  • $825 million of senior notes due May 2009, with a fixed coupon of 2.53%. These securities are a component of 6.50% Equity Security Units (the “6.50% Units”) that are publicly traded. In addition to the coupon paid on the senior notes, contract adjustment payments of 3.97% per annum are paid on forward purchase contracts for the Company’s common shares for a total distribution of 6.50% per annum. The purchase contracts mature in 2007, and the senior notes mature in 2009. In May 2007, the senior notes will be remarketed whereby the interest rate will be reset in order to generate sufficient remarketing proceeds to satisfy the 6.50% Unit holders’ obligations under the purchase contract.

  • $745 million of senior notes due February 2011 with a fixed coupon of 5.25%. These securities are a component of 7.00% Equity Security Units (the “7.00% Units”) that are publicly traded. In addition to the coupon paid on the senior notes, contract adjustment payments of 1.75% per annum are paid on forward purchase contracts for the Company’s common shares for a total distribution of 7.00% per annum. The purchase contracts mature in 2009, and the senior notes mature in 2011. In February 2009, the senior notes will be remarketed whereby the interest rate will be reset in order to generate sufficient remarketing proceeds to satisfy the 7.00% Unit holders’ obligations under the purchase contract.

93


     The following tables present the Company’s debt under outstanding securities and lenders’ commitments as at December 31, 2005:

               
Payments Due by Period









Notes Payable and Debt   
Year of 
Less than 
1 to 3
 
3 to 5
 
After 5 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Commitment 
In Use 
Expiry 
1 Year 
Years
Years
Years 


     

     
     

     

       

       

364-day revolver   
$
100,000    $     2006    $      $      $     $  
5 and 3-year revolvers   
1,000,000    45,000    2007/2010      45,000               
5-year revolver   
100,000        2010                     
2.53% Senior Notes   
825,000    825,000    2009                825,000      
5.25% Senior Notes   
745,000    745,000    2011                745,000      
6.58% Guaranteed Senior Notes   
255,000    255,000    2011                    255,000 
6.50% Guaranteed Senior Notes   
598,368    598,368    2012                    600,000 
5.25% Senior Notes   
594,330    594,330    2014                    600,000 
6.375% Senior Notes   
350,000    350,000    2024                    350,000 








 

 

Total   
$
4,567,698    $ 3,412,698        $  45,000    $     
$
1,570,000    
$
1,805,000 








 

 


     “Commitment” and “In Use” data represent December 31, 2005 accreted values. “Payments Due by Period” data represent ultimate redemption values.

c) Preferred shares

     In 2002, the Company issued preferred shares as follows:

  • Series A Preferred In August 2002, the Company issued 9.2 million of 8% Series A preference ordinary shares (“Series A preference shares”). Gross proceeds were $230.0 million and related expenses were $7.2 million. Upon dissolution of the Company, the holders of the Series A preference shares are entitled to receive a liquidation preference of $25 per share, plus accrued dividends. Dividends on the preference Shares are cumulative from the date of original issuance and are payable when declared. The Company may redeem the Series A preference shares on or after August 14, 2007, at a redemption price of $25 per share. The Company may, under certain circumstances, redeem the Series A preference shares before August 14, 2007 at specified redemption prices, plus accrued dividends. These circumstances include an amalgamation, consolidation or other similar transaction involving the Company in which the Series A preferred shares are entitled to a class vote ($26 per share redemption price), or a change in tax laws that requires the Company to pay additional amounts with respect to the Series A preference shares ($25 per share redemption price). The proceeds were used for general corporate purposes.

  • Series B Preferred In November 2002, the Company issued 11.5 million of 7 5/8% Series B preference ordinary shares (“Series B preference shares”). Gross proceeds were $287.5 million and related expenses were $9.1 million. Upon dissolution of the Company, the holders of the Series B preference shares are entitled to receive a liquidation preference of $25 per share, plus accrued dividends. Dividends on the preference shares are cumulative from the date of original issuance and are payable when declared. The Company may redeem the Series B preference ordinary shares on or after November 18, 2007, at a redemption price of $25 per share. The Company may, under certain circumstances, redeem the B preference shares before November 18, 2007 at specified redemption prices, plus accrued dividends. These circumstances include an amalgamation, consolidation or other similar transaction involving the Company in which the Series B preferred shares are entitled to a class vote ($26 per share redemption price), or a change in tax laws that requires the Company to pay additional amounts with respect to the Series B preference shares ($25 per share redemption price). The proceeds were used for general corporate purposes.

94


d) Contingent Capital

     In addition to funded debt transactions, the Company and a majority-owned subsidiary (XL Financial Assurance Ltd. (“XLFA”)) have entered into contingent capital transactions. No up-front proceeds were received by the Company or XLFA under these transactions, however, in the event that the associated irrevocable put option agreements are exercised, proceeds previously raised from investors from the issuance of pass-through trust securities would be received in return for the issuance of preferred shares.

     On December 10, 2004, XLFA entered into a put option agreement and an asset trust expense reimbursement agreement with Twin Reefs Asset Trust (the “Asset Trust”). The put option agreement provides XLFA with the irrevocable right to require the Asset Trust at any time and from time to time to purchase XLFA’s non-cumulative perpetual Series B Preferred Shares with an aggregate liquidation preference of up to $200 million. There is no limit to the number of times that XLFA may exercise the put option, redeem the Series B Preferred Shares from the Asset Trust and exercise the put option again. XLFA is obligated to reimburse the Asset Trust for certain fees and ordinary expenses. To the extent that any Series B Preferred Shares are put to the Asset Trust and remain outstanding, a corresponding portion of such fees and ordinary expenses will be payable by XLFA pursuant to the asset trust expense reimbursement agreement. The put option agreement is perpetual but would terminate on delivery of notice by XLFA on or after December 9, 2009, or under certain defined circumstances, such as the failure of XLFA to pay the put option premium when due or bankruptcy. The premium payable by XLFA is the sum of certain trustee and investment managers expenses, the distribution of income paid to holders of the pass-through trust securities, less the investment yield on the eligible assets purchased using the proceeds originally raised from the issuance of the pass-through securities.

     In July 2003, the Company entered into a contingent capital transaction with an aggregate value of $500.0 million. This transaction provides the Company with an insurance trust that provides the Company with statutory relief under state insurance regulations in the U.S. Under the terms of this facility, the Company has acquired an irrevocable put option to issue preference ordinary shares into a trust in return for proceeds raised from investors. This put option may be exercised by the Company at any time. In addition, the Company may be required to issue preference ordinary shares to the trust under certain circumstances, including, but not limited to, the non-payment of the put option premium and a ratings downgrade of the Company. In connection with this transaction, the fair value of the put premiums and other related costs, in total of $111.9 million was transferred from “Additional paid in capital” to a deferred liability which was established (included with “Other liabilities”) in the consolidated balance sheet at December 31, 2003. The Company amortizes this liability that resulted in an interest expense of approximately $3.5 million in 2004 and $2.0 million in 2003.

e) Letter of Credit Facilities and other sources of collateral

     At December 31, 2005, the Company had eight letter of credit facilities in place with total availability of $5.5 billion, of which $3.5 billion was utilized.

   
Amount of Commitment Expiration per period 


Other Commercial Commitments   
Year of 
Less than 
1 to 3
3 to 5
 
After 5 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Commitment 
In Use 
Expiry 
1 Year 
Years
Years
Years 


     


     

     


     


     


     

Letter of credit facility   
$
200,000   
$
176,736    Continuous   
$
200,000    $     $     $   
2 Letter of credit facilities   
6,132   
6,132    2006   
6,132               
Letter of credit facility (1)   
100,000   
-    2006   
100,000               
Letter of credit facility   
150,000   
150,000    2006   
150,000               
Letter of credit facility   
775,305   
681,368    2006   
775,305               
Letter of credit facility (1)   
2,000,000   
366,105    2007   
    2,000,000           
Letter of credit facility (1)   
2,250,000   
2,079,419    2010   
        2,250,000        










 

8 Letter of credit facilities   
$
5,481,437   
$
3,459,760       
$
1,231,437   
$
2,000,000    $ 2,250,000     $   










 



(1)      Of the total letter of credit facilities above, $1,000 million is also included in the revolvers under notes payable and debt.

95


     It is anticipated that the commercial facilities will be renewed on expiry but such renewals are subject to the availability of credit from banks utilized by the Company, or other financial institutions. In the event that such credit support is insufficient, the Company could be required to provide alternative security to cedents. This could take the form of insurance trusts supported by the Company’s investment portfolio or funds withheld (amounts retained by ceding companies to collateralize loss or premium reserves) using the Company’s cash resources or combinations thereof. The face amount of letters of credit required is driven by, among other things, loss development of existing reserves, the payment pattern of such reserves, the expansion of business written by the Company and the loss experience of such business. In addition to letters of credit, the Company has established insurance trusts in the U.S. that provide cedents with statutory relief required under state insurance regulation in the U.S.

     The Company reviews current and projected collateral requirements on a regular basis, as well as new sources of collateral. Management’s objective is to maintain an excess amount of collateral sources over expected uses. The Company also reviews its liquidity needs on a regular basis.

     The following letter of credit facilities were originated or renewed during 2005:

  • In December 2005, the Company created a new $100 million unsecured bilateral credit facility that was unutilized during 2005 and at December 31, 2005. The full amount of $100 million is available as both revolving credit and letters of credit, with the combined total not to exceed $100 million.

  • In September 2005, the Company renewed an unsecured bilateral credit facility of $150 million (previously $200 million) that was fully utilized at December 31, 2005.

  • In August 2005, the Company created a new unsecured bilateral credit facility of $100 million that was unutilized at December 31, 2005.

  • In June 2005, the Company replaced its $1.0 billion 364-day credit and letter of credit facility with a $2.35 billion facility with a tenor of 5 years. Of the aggregate amount of $2.35 billion, $1.0 billion is available as revolving credit and up to $2.25 billion is available in the form of letters of credit, with the combined total not to exceed $2.35 billion. As at December 31, 2005, approximately $2.1 billion of the 5-year facility was in use in the form of letters of credit.

     In addition to the letter of credit facilities described above, the Company has the following facility:

  • $500 million commercial paper-based facility. In February 2003, the Company entered into an aggregate of $300.0 million of commercial paper-based credit facilities (the “Credit Facilities”). These facilities were increased to $500.0 million in June 2003. The proceeds of advances under the Credit Facilities were used to fund a trust account to collateralize the reinsurance obligations of the Company under an inter-company quota share reinsurance agreement. The Company could face additional obligations under the Credit Facilities prior to the stated maturity of February 25, 2008, if certain events were to occur, including, but not limited to the Company’s insolvency, withdrawal of assets from the Regulation 114 trust by the ceding company, the downgrade of the Company’s credit ratings below certain specified levels, or the failure of the agent to have a first priority perfected security interest in the collateral posted by the Company. At maturity, the Company will be obligated to make payments in an amount equal to the principal and accrued interest outstanding under the Credit Facilities. The issued securities and the Company’s repayment obligations are recorded as a net balance on the Company’s balance sheet.

Cross-Default and Other Provisions in Debt Documents

     The following describes certain terms of the documents referred to below. All documents referred to below have been filed with the SEC and should be referred to for an assessment of the complete contractual obligations of the Company.

     In general, all of the Company’s bank facilities, indentures and other documents relating to the Company’s outstanding indebtedness, including the Credit Facilities discussed above (collectively, the “Company’s Debt

96


Documents”), contain cross default provisions to each other and the Company’s Debt Documents contain affirmative covenants. These covenants provide for, among other things, minimum required ratings of the Company’s insurance and reinsurance operating subsidiaries (other than its AAA financial guaranty companies) and the level of secured indebtedness in the future. In addition, generally each of the Company’s Debt Documents provide for an event of default in the event of a change of control of the Company or some events involving bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of the Company. The Company’s credit facilities and the 6.58% Guaranteed Senior Notes also contain minimum consolidated net worth covenants.

     Under the Company’s 364-day facilities, 3-year credit facility, five-year credit facilities placement notes described above, in the event that the Company XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd fail to maintain a financial strength rating of at least “A-” from A.M. Best, an event of default would occur. The Company currently has an “A+ (stable)” rating from A.M. Best.

     Under the Company’s ten-year private placement notes described above, in the event that the Company fails to maintain a financial strength rating of at least “A” from A.M. Best or XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd fail to maintain a financial strength rating of at least “A” from S&P, an event of default would occur. The Company and its subsidiaries currently has an “A+” (stable) rating from A.M. Best and “A+” (stable) S&P.

     The 6.5% Guaranteed Senior Notes indentures contains a cross default provision. In general, in the event that the Company defaults in the payment of indebtedness in the amount of $50.0 million or more, an event of default would be triggered under the Guaranteed Senior Notes indentures. Given that all of the Company’s Debt Documents contain cross default provisions, this may result in all holders declaring such debt due and payable and an acceleration of all debt due under those documents. If this were to occur, the Company may not have funds sufficient at that time to repay any or all of such indebtedness.

     In addition, the Company’s unsecured Lloyd’s letter of credit facility provides that, in the event that the Company’s insurance and reinsurance rated operating subsidiaries in Bermuda fall below a rating of “A-”, the facility would then be required to be fully secured by the Company, at which time the Company would be required to either (i) provide an amount in cash to cover an amount equal to the aggregate letters of credit outstanding at that time or (ii) deposit assets in trust securing 105% of the aggregate letters of credit outstanding at that time. If this were to occur, the Company may not be able to provide the collateral required in order to maintain this facility.

Long-Term Contractual Obligations

     The following table presents the Company’s long term contractual obligations and related payments as at December 31, 2005, due by period. This table excludes further commitments of $34.9 million to the Company’s related investment funds, certain limited partnerships, insurance affiliates, collateralized debt/equity investments and letter of credit facilities of $3.5 billion. See Item 8, Note 14 and Note 18 to the Consolidated Financial Statements. See Item 8, Note 13 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.

Contractual Obligations   
Less than 
1 to
 
3 to
 
More than 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Total 
1 year 
3 years
5 years
5 years 


     

     

       

       

Long-term debt obligations   
$
3,420,000   
$ 
45,000    $     
$
1,570,000    
$
1,805,000 
Interest on long-term debt   
1,329,353   
167,313      339,153    
298,066    
524,821 
Contingent capital facilities (4)   
100,875   
13,912      27,824    
25,059    
34,080 
Equity Units   
90,631   
44,921      42,451    
3,259    
 
Capital lease obligations   
319,540   
10,754      22,322    
23,451    
263,013 
Operating lease obligations   
243,109   
36,397      61,583    
43,555    
101,574 
Deposit liabilities (1)   
9,643,621   
2,184,893      2,900,280    
1,089,443    
3,469,005 
Future policy benefits (3)   
9,283,116   
484,186      755,935    
768,633    
7,274,362 
Unpaid losses and loss expenses (2)   
24,195,064   
7,623,467      7,837,336    
3,487,500    
5,246,761 












 
Total   
$
48,625,309   
$ 
10,610,843    $  11,986,884    
$
7,308,966    
$
18,718,616 














(1)      Deposit liabilities on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet at December 31, 2005 amounted to $8,240,987. The difference from the amount included above relates to the discount on payments due in the future. The payment related to these liabilities varies primarily based on interest rates. The ultimate payments associated with these liabilities could differ from the Company’s estimate. See Item 8, Note 11 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information.
 

97


 

(2)      The unpaid loss and loss expenses amounted to $23,767,672 on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet at December 31, 2005. The timing and amounts of actual claims payments related to these reserves vary based on many factors including large individual losses, changes in the legal environment, as well as general market conditions. The ultimate amount of the claims payments could differ materially from the Company’s estimated amounts. For information regarding the estimates for unpaid loss and loss expenses as well as factors effecting potential payment patterns of reserves for actual and potential claims related the Company’s different lines of business see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” above. Certain lines of business written by the Company, such as excess casualty, have loss experience characterized as low frequency and high severity. This may result in significant variability in loss payment patterns and, therefore, may impact the related asset/liability investment management process. In order to be in a position, if necessary, to make these payments, the Company’s liquidity requirements are supported by having revolving lines of credit facilities available to the Company and significant reinsurance programs, in addition to the Company’s general high grade fixed income investment portfolio.
(3) Future policy benefit reserves on life and annuity business amounted to $5,606,461 on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheet at December 31, 2005. Amounts included above include an allowance for future premiums in respect of contracts under which premiums are payable throughout the life of the underlying policy. The value of the discount is also included for those lines of business that have reserves where future claim payments and future premium receipts can be estimated using actuarial principles. The timing and amounts of actual claims payments and premium receipts related to these reserves vary based on the underlying experience of the portfolio. Typical elements of the experience include mortality, morbidity and persistency. The ultimate amount of the claims payments and premium receipts could differ materially from the Company’s estimated amounts.
(4) Contingent capital facilities related payments include an estimate at the payments due under the past option agreement of $200 per month. Actual payments depend on the return on certain assets and LIBOR.

Variable Interest Entities and Other Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

     The Company utilizes variable interest entities both indirectly and directly in the ordinary course of the Company’s business.

     The Company provides various forms of credit enhancement including financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance of structured transactions backed by pools of assets of specified types, municipal obligations supported by the issuers’ ability to charge fees for specified services or projects, and structured single risk-based obligations including essential infrastructure projects and obligations backed by receivables from future sales of commodities and other specified services. The obligations related to these transactions are often securitized through variable interest entities. In synthetic transactions, the Company guarantees payment obligations of counterparties including special purpose vehicles under credit derivatives referencing asset portfolios. The Company invests in collateralized debt obligations (“CDOs”), and other investment vehicles that are issued through variable interest entities as part of the Company’s risk asset portfolio.

     In 2003, the Company entered into an aggregate of $500.0 million of commercial paper-based credit facilities (the “Credit Facilities”). The proceeds of advances under the Credit Facilities were used to fund a trust account (“Trust”) to collateralize the reinsurance obligations of the Company under an intercompany quota share reinsurance agreement. The issued securities and the Company’s repayment obligations will be recorded as a net balance on the Company’s balance sheet because the Company has a contractual legal right of offset. In the event that in the future the Company were to not have the right to offset such assets (as, for example, would be the case if the assets in the Trust were withdrawn in order to satisfy the Company’s reinsurance obligations or if lender-issued securities could not be held in the Trust because they did not qualify as permitted assets under the trust agreement), then all or a portion of the assets in the Trust and the Company’s repayment obligations under the Credit Facilities would be required to be included as assets and liabilities on a gross basis, respectively, on the Company’s balance sheet. See also “Liquidity and Capital Resources” for more details regarding this off-balance sheet collateral arrangement.

     In December 2004, XLFA entered into a put option agreement and an asset trust expense reimbursement agreement with the Asset Trust. The put option agreement provides XLFA with the irrevocable right to require the Asset Trust at any time and from time to time to purchase XLFA’s non-cumulative perpetual Series B Preferred Shares with an aggregate liquidation preference of up to $200 million. XLFA is obligated to reimburse the Asset Trust for certain fees and ordinary expenses. To the extent that any Series B Preferred Shares are put to the Asset Trust and remain outstanding, a corresponding portion of such fees and ordinary expenses will be payable by XLFA pursuant to the asset trust expense reimbursement agreement. The put option agreement is perpetual but would terminate on delivery of notice by XLFA on or after December 9, 2009, or under certain defined circumstances, such as the failure of XLFA to

98


pay the put option premium when due or bankruptcy. The put option is recorded at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in earnings.

     In July 2003, the Company entered into a contingent capital transaction with an aggregate value of $500.0 million. This transaction also provides the Company with an insurance trust that provides the Company with statutory relief under state insurance regulations in the U.S. Under the terms of this facility, the Company has acquired an irrevocable put option to issue preference ordinary shares into a trust in return for proceeds raised from investors. This put option may be exercised by the Company at any time. In addition, the Company may be required to issue preference ordinary shares to the trust under certain circumstances, including, but not limited to, the non-payment of the put option premium and a ratings downgrade of the Company.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

     See Item 8, Note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for a discussion on recent accounting pronouncements.

Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements

     The Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 (“PSLRA”) provides a “safe harbor” for forward-looking statements. Any prospectus, prospectus supplement, the Company’s Annual Report to ordinary shareholders, any proxy statement, any other Form 10-K, Form 10-Q or Form 8-K of the Company or any other written or oral statements made by or on behalf of the Company may include forward-looking statements that reflect the Company’s current views with respect to future events and financial performance. Such statements include forward-looking statements both with respect to the Company in general, and to the insurance, reinsurance and financial products and services sectors in particular (both as to underwriting and investment matters). Statements that include the words “expect”, “intend”, “plan”, “believe”, “project”, “anticipate”, “will”, “may”, and similar statements of a future or forward-looking nature identify forward-looking statements for purposes of the PSLRA or otherwise.

     All forward-looking statements address matters that involve risks and uncertainties. Accordingly, there are or will be important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those indicated in such statements. The Company believes that these factors include, but are not limited to, the following: (i) the adequacy of rates and terms and conditions may not be as sustainable as the Company is currently projecting; (ii) changes to the size of the Company’s claims relating to Hurricanes Katrina, Rita and Wilma and other natural catastrophes; (iii) the Company’s ability to realize the expected benefits of the collateralized quota share reinsurance treaty that it entered into in the fourth quarter of 2005 with respect to specified portions of its property catastrophe and retrocessional lines of business; (iv) the timely and full recoverability of reinsurance placed by the Company with third parties, or other amounts due to the Company, including, without limitation, amounts due to the Company from WSIC in connection with the Company’s acquisition of the Winterthur Business; (v) the projected amount of ceded reinsurance recoverables and the ratings and creditworthiness of reinsurers may change; (vi) the size of the Company’s claims relating to the hurricane and tsunami losses described herein may change due to the preliminary nature of some of the reports and estimates of loss and damage to date; (vii) the timing of claims payments being faster or the receipt of reinsurance recoverables being slower than anticipated by the Company; (viii) ineffectiveness or obsolescence of the Company’s business strategy due to changes in current or future market conditions; (ix) increased competition on the basis of pricing, capacity, coverage terms or other factors; (x) greater frequency or severity of claims and loss activity, including as a result of natural or man-made catastrophic events, than the Company’s underwriting, reserving or investment practices anticipate based on historical experience or industry data; (viii) developments in the world’s financial and capital markets that adversely affect the performance of the Company’s investments and the Company’s access to such markets; (ix) the potential impact on the Company from government-mandated insurance coverage for acts of terrorism; (x) the potential impact of variable interest entities or other off-balance sheet arrangements on the Company; (xi) developments in bankruptcy proceedings or other developments related to bankruptcies of companies insofar as they affect property and casualty insurance and reinsurance coverages or claims that the Company may

99


have as a counterparty; (xii) availability of borrowings and letters of credit under the Company’s credit facilities; (xiii) changes in regulation or tax laws applicable to the Company or its subsidiaries, brokers or customers; (xiv) acceptance of the Company’s products and services, including new products and services; (xv) changes in the availability, cost or quality of reinsurance; (xvi) changes in the distribution or placement of risks due to increased consolidation of insurance and reinsurance brokers; (xvii) loss of key personnel; (xviii) the effects of mergers, acquisitions and divestitures; (xix) changes in ratings, rating agency policies or practices; (xx) changes in accounting policies or practices or the application thereof; (xxi) legislative or regulatory developments; (xxii) changes in general economic conditions, including inflation, foreign currency exchange rates and other factors; (xxiii) the effects of business disruption or economic contraction due to war, terrorism or other hostilities; and (xxiv) the other factors set forth in the Company’s other documents on file with the SEC. The foregoing review of important factors should not be construed as exhaustive and should be read in conjunction with the other cautionary statements that are included herein or elsewhere. The Company undertakes no obligation to update publicly or revise any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise.

ITEM 7A.      QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

     The following risk management discussion and the estimated amounts generated from the sensitivity and value-at-risk (“VaR”) analyses presented in this document are forward-looking statements of market risk assuming certain adverse market conditions occur. Actual results in the future may differ materially from these estimated results due to, among other things, actual developments in the global financial markets. The results of analysis used by the Company to assess and mitigate risk should not be considered projections of future events of losses. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.”

     The Company enters into derivatives and other financial instruments primarily for risk management purposes. The Company’s derivative transactions can expose the Company to credit derivative risk, weather and energy risk, investment market risk, and foreign currency exchange rate risk. The Company attempts to manage these risks based on guidelines established by senior management. Derivative instruments are carried at fair value with the resulting changes in fair value recognized in income in the period in which they occur.

Credit Derivative Risk

     The Company enters into swaps written under International Swaps and Derivatives Association (“ISDA”) forms as an extension of its financial guaranty business. The fair value is determined using models developed by the Company and is dependent upon a number of factors, including changes in interest rates, future default rates, changes in credit quality, future expected recovery rates and other market factors. Other elements of the change in fair value are based upon pricing established at the inception of the contract. A change in the interest, default and recovery rate assumptions indicated below would cause the fair value associated with credit derivatives to decrease as follows:

Assumptions         
(U.S. dollars in thousands)    % Change    Decrease in Fair Value 


Interest rate    1% decrease    $464 
Default rate    10% increase    $319 
Recovery rate    10% decrease    $449 

Weather and Energy Market Risk

     The Company offers weather and contingent energy risk management products in insurance or derivative form to end-users, while managing the risks in the over-the-counter and exchange traded derivatives markets or through the use of quota share or excess of loss arrangements.

100


     Fair values for the Company’s natural gas derivative contracts are determined through the use of quoted market prices. As quoted market prices are not widely available in the weather derivative market, management uses available market data and internal pricing models based upon consistent statistical methodologies to estimate fair values. Estimating fair value of instruments that do not have quoted market prices, requires management’s judgment in determining amounts that could reasonably be expected to be received from, or paid to, a third party in respect of the contracts. The amounts could be materially different from the amounts that might be realized in an actual sale transaction. Fair values are subject to change in the near-term and reflect management’s best estimate based on various factors including, but not limited to, realized and forecasted weather conditions, changes in interest rates and other market factors.

     The following table summarizes the movement in the fair value of contracts outstanding during the year ended December 31, 2005:

 
Unrealized gain
(U.S. dollars in thousands) 
(loss)




Fair value of contracts outstanding, beginning of the year   
$
7,219  
Option premiums received, net of premiums realized (1)    3,047  
Reclassification of settled contracts to realized (2)    3,620  
Other changes in fair value (3)    (18,231 ) 


 
Fair value of contracts outstanding, end of year   
$
(4,345 ) 


 


(1)      For the year ended December 31, 2005, the Company collected $26.4 million of paid premiums and realized $29.5 million of premiums on expired transactions for a net decrease in the balance sheet derivative liability of $3.1 million.
(2) The Company received $3.6 million to settle derivative positions during the year ended December 31, 2005, resulting in a reclassification of this amount from unrealized to realized and an increase in the balance sheet derivative liability.
(3) This represents the effects of changes in commodity prices, the time value of options, and other valuation adjustments of $18.2 million on the Company’s derivative positions, primarily attributable to the hedges of the positions that realized $29.5 million of premiums.

     The change in fair value of contracts outstanding at December 31, 2005, as compared to the beginning of the year is primarily due to the settlement of positive fair value positions during the first half of the year.

The following table summarizes the maturity of contracts outstanding at December 31, 2005:

   
Greater 
 
Source of Fair Value   
Less than
than 5 
Total Fair
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
1 Year
1-3 Years
3-5 Years 
Years 
Value
 


       

       

     

     

 
Prices actively quoted    $      $     $      $      $   
Prices based on models and other                             
   valuation methods      (5,293 )    (676 )      1,624            (4,345 ) 


 

 





 
Total fair value of contracts outstanding    $  (5,293 )   
$
(676 )    $  1,624    $      $  (4,345 ) 


 

 





 

Investment Market Risk

     The Company’s investment portfolio is managed by external investment professionals under the direction of the Company’s management and generally in accordance with detailed investment guidelines provided and monitored by the Company. Managers are selected directly by the Company on the basis of various criteria, including investment style, track record, performance, internal controls, operational risk, and diversification implications. The vast majority of the Company’s investment portfolio is managed by well established, large institutional investment professionals.

     The Company’s investment portfolio consists of exposures to fixed income securities, equities, alternative investments, derivatives, business and other investments and cash. These securities and investments are denominated in both U.S. dollar and foreign currencies.

101


     Through the structure of the Company’s investment portfolio, the Company’s earnings and book value are directly affected by changes in the valuations of the securities and investments held in the investment portfolio. These valuation changes reflect changes in interest rates (e.g., changes in the level, slope and curvature of yield curves, volatility of interest rates, mortgage prepayment speeds and credit spreads), credit quality, equity prices (e.g., changes in prices and volatilities of individual securities, equity baskets and equity indices) and foreign currency exchange rates (e.g., changes in spot prices, forward prices and volatilities of currency rates). Market risk therefore arises due to the uncertainty surrounding the future valuations of these different assets, the factors that impact their values and the impact that this could have on the Company’s earnings.

     The Company seeks to manage the risks of the investment portfolio through a combination of asset class, country, industry and security level diversification and investment manager allocations. These allocation decisions are made relative to the liability profile of the Company and the Company’s surplus. Further, individual security and issuer exposures are controlled and monitored at the investment portfolio level, via specific investment constraints outlined in investment guidelines and agreed with the external investment professionals. Additional constraints are generally agreed with the external investment professionals, which may address exposures to eligible securities, prohibited investments/transactions, credit quality and general concentrations limits.

     The Company’s direct use of investment derivatives includes futures, forwards, swaps and option contracts that derive their value from underlying assets, indices, reference rates or a combination of these factors. When investment guidelines allow for the use of derivatives, these can generally only be used for the purpose of managing interest rate risk, foreign exchange risk, credit risk and replicating permitted investments, provided the use of such instruments is incorporated in the overall portfolio duration, spread, convexity and other relevant portfolio metrics. The direct use of derivatives is generally not permitted to economically leverage the portfolio outside of the stated guidelines. Derivatives may also be used to add value to the investment portfolio where market inefficiencies are perceived to exist, to utilize cash holdings to purchase equity indexed derivatives and to adjust the duration of a portfolio of fixed income securities to match the duration of related deposit liabilities.

Investment Value-at-Risk

     Central to the Company’s market risk management framework is VaR. VaR is a statistical risk measure, calculating the level of potential losses that could be expected to be exceeded, over a specified holding period and at a given level of confidence, in normal market conditions, due to adverse movements in the investment portfolio’s underlying securities and investments valuations.

     The Company calculates the VaR of the investment portfolio using a one month time horizon and a 95% level of confidence. This means that, on average, the Company could expect losses greater than predicted by the VaR results 5% of the time, or once every 20 months. The calculation of VaR is performed monthly using a full valuation based on the Monte Carlo approach and it is expressed both in terms of U.S. dollars and as a percentage of the Company’s investment portfolio.

     The modeling of the risk of any portfolio, as measured by VaR, involves a number of assumptions and approximations. While the Company believes that its assumptions and approximations are appropriate, there is no uniform industry methodology for calculating VaR. The Company notes that different VaR results can be produced for the same portfolio dependent, not only on the approach used but also on the assumptions employed when implementing the approach.

     The VaR approach uses historical data to determine the sensitivity of each of the underlying securities to the risk factors incorporated into the models that are employed in the Monte Carlo simulations. In calculating these sensitivities, greater importance is placed on the more recent data points and information. Since the VaR approach is based on historical positions and market data, VaR results should not be viewed as an absolute and predictive gauge of future financial performance or as a way for the Company to predict risk. There is no assurance that the Company’s actual future losses will not exceed its VaR and the Company expects that 5% of the time the VaR will be exceeded.

102


Additionally, the Company acknowledges the fact that risks associated with abnormal market events can be significantly different from the VaR results and these are by definition not reflected or assessed in the VaR analysis.

     The VaR of the investment portfolio at December 31, 2005 was approximately $489.0 million. The VaR of all investment relative derivatives excluding investments in affiliates and other investments was $26.3 million at December 31, 2005.

     In instances where the data or time series are insufficient to determine the risk factor sensitivities, the VaR approach uses proxy time series data available for similar instruments. As at December 31, 2005, approximately $16.5 billion (41% of the Company’s investment portfolio at market value) used proxy time series data.

     Approximately $12.4 billion related to various fixed income portfolios, $2.5 billion to various cash portfolios, $1.3 billion to alternative investments, $252.2 million to private investments, $105.2 million to equity portfolios, and $4.5 million to derivatives. The Company reviews the proxies to ensure that an appropriate data and time series is being used in the calculations and that the proxies used are conservative.

     The following two tables show the Company’s average, minimum and maximum VaR in percentage and dollar terms for the total investment portfolio during the year ended December 31, 2005, based upon the VaR at quarter end dates. The two tables also include the Company’s VaR in percentage and dollar terms, respectively, for the total investment portfolio as at December 31, 2005. The Company’s investment portfolio VaR as at December 31, 2005 is not necessarily indicative of future VaR levels.

   
At December 31,
   
Average VaR
Minimum VaR
Maximum VaR
2005
   
% VaR (1)
% VaR (1)
% VaR (1)
% VaR (1)








Fixed Income    1.35 %    1.16 %    1.55 %    1.27 % 
Alternatives (2)    0.07 %    0.06 %    0.10 %    0.07 % 
Derivatives    0.06 %    0.04 %    0.08 %    0.07 % 
Equity    0.07 %    0.06 %    0.09 %    0.06 % 
Private Investments    0.04 %    0.03 %    0.06 %    0.03 % 
Cash Equivalents    0.02 %    0.01 %    0.04 %    0.01 % 
Total Undiversified VaR (3)    1.61 %    1.44 %    1.77 %    1.51 % 
Diversification VaR (4)    (0.24 )%    NA     NA     (0.30 )% 
Total Investment Portfolio VaR (5)    1.37 %    1.20 %    1.55 %    1.21 % 

NA – not applicable                 
   
VaR as at
   
Average VaR
Minimum VaR
Maximum VaR
December 31,
   
during 2005
during 2005
during 2005
2005
(U.S. dollars in millions)   
% VaR (6)
% VaR (6)
% VaR (6)
% VaR (6)


     

     

     

Total Investment Portfolio VaR (5)    480.1     409.1     559.5     489.0  


(1)      Based on a 95% confidence level with a one month holding period and expressed as a percentage of the total investment portfolio.
(2) The majority of the Company’s alternative investment portfolio is accounted for as investments in affiliates. However, for purposes of monitoring and tracking the Company’s total investment market risk, the total alternative investment portfolio is included in these calculations.
(3) Average Total Undiversified VaR for the year ended December 31, 2005 and Total Undiversified VaR at December 31, 2005 is the summation of the individual VaRs for each of the separate asset classes and, by construction, ignores any and all correlations between the different asset classes. The Total Undiversified VaR therefore ignores diversification benefits that exist in between these different asset classes. Maximum and Minimum Total Undiversified VaR is not necessarily the summation of the individual VaRs for each of the separate asset classes since the Maximum and Minimum VaRs for each of the asset classes and the Maximum and Minimum Total Undiversified VaR do not necessarily refer to the same point in time.
(4) Diversification VaR equals the difference between the Total Investment Portfolio VaR and the Total Undiversified VaR. As the former explicitly accounts for the correlations and diversification benefits that exist between the actual asset classes and the latter explicitly does not, the difference in the two VaR results is due to the “diversification benefits.” These diversification benefits arise due to the risk reduction that
 

103


  occurs when different assets, that are not perfectly correlated, are combined in a portfolio. It will vary over time dependent on: allocations changes; changes in the correlations between the different asset classes; and changes in the general asset class risks. The NA reflects the fact that, since the Minimum and Maximum VaR for the six different asset class portfolios do not refer to the same point in time, therefore it is not meaningful to calculate the Diversification VaR.
(5)      Total Investment Portfolio VaR is the Company’s investment portfolio VaR based on the prescribed methodology that explicitly accounts for the diversification benefits that occur when each of the allocations to the individual asset classes are included in the investment portfolio.
(6) Based on a 95% confidence level with a one month holding period, expressed in millions of U.S. Dollars.

     The Company’s total investment portfolio VaR is driven by: the size of the overall investment portfolio; the size of the allocations to the different asset classes and securities in the asset classes; the risks associated with each of the asset classes and securities; and the correlations and diversification benefits between each of the asset classes and securities. Changes in any of these variables will have a direct impact on the Company’s VaR.

     The Company’s total undiversified VaR, which ignores any correlation and diversification benefits, at December 31, 2005 was 1.51% compared to a maximum of 1.77% and a minimum of 1.44% during 2005. The Company’s average diversification VaR during 2005 resulted in an average reduction of the Company’s total undiversified VaR of 0.24% and as at December 31, 2005 was 0.30% .

     The Company’s total investment portfolio VaR was on average 1.37% during 2005 and as at December 31, 2005, was 1.21% . The Company’s maximum and minimum total investment portfolio VaR during 2005 were 1.55% and 1.20%, respectively. The Company’s largest VaR exposure during the year ended December 31, 2005 was to fixed income. The average VaR for fixed income was 1.35%, compared to a maximum of 1.55% and a minimum of 1.16% . As at December 31, 2005, the fixed income VaR was 1.27% .

     At December 31, 2005, the ranking for the Company’s asset class risk, based on the individual asset class VaRs, was: fixed income; alternative investments; derivatives; equity; private investments; and cash equivalents.

Stress Testing

     VaR does not provide the means to estimate the magnitude of the loss in the 5% of occurrences that the Company expects the VaR level to be exceeded. To complement the VaR analysis based on normal market environments, the Company considers the impact on the investment portfolio in several different historical stress periods to analyze the effect of unusual market conditions. The Company establishes certain historical stress test scenarios which are applied to the actual investment portfolio. As these stress tests and estimated gains and losses are based on historical events, they will not necessarily reflect future stress events or gains and losses from such events. The results of the stress test scenarios are reviewed on a regular basis to ensure they are appropriate, based on current shareholders equity, market conditions and the Company’s total risk tolerance.

     The table below shows the maximum impact on the Company’s investment portfolio if all events stress tested were to repeat themselves, given the actual investment portfolio’s allocations at the quarters ended March 31, June 30, September 30 and December 31, 2005. The Company assumes that no action is taken during the stress period to either liquidate or rebalance the portfolio. The Company believes that this fairly reflects the potential decreased liquidity that is often associated with stressed market environments.

   
March 31,
June 30,
September 30,
December 31,
Stress Test   
2005
2005
2005
2005



     

     

     

Maximum loss impact on portfolio    (5.4 %)    (5.8 %)    (5.8 %)    (5.2 %) 
Maximum gain impact on portfolio    19.3 %    19.7 %    19.3 %    17.3 % 

     From the different scenarios that the Company analyzes, the largest downside event risk exposure during 2005 was 5.8%, based on the investment portfolio as at June 30, 2005 and September 30, 2005. The largest upside risk exposure during 2005 was 19.7% as at June 30, 2005.

     Given the investment portfolio allocations as at December 31, 2005, the Company would expect to lose approximately 5.2% of the portfolio if the most damaging event stress tested was repeated, all other things held equal. Given

104


the investment portfolio allocations as at December 31, 2005, the Company would expect to gain approximately 17.3% of the portfolio if the most favorable event stress tested was repeated, all other things held equal.

Fixed Income Portfolio

     The Company’s fixed income portfolio is exposed to credit and interest rate risk through its portfolio of debt securities, and includes fixed maturities and short-term investments. The fixed income portfolio includes fixed maturities, short-term investments, cash and cash equivalents and net payable for investments purchased.

     As at December 31, 2005, the value of the Company’s fixed income portfolio including cash and cash equivalents and net payable for investments purchased was approximately $37.9 billion as compared to approximately $28.9 billion as at December 31, 2004. As at December 31, 2005, the fixed income portfolio consisted of approximately 91.1% of the total investment portfolio (including cash and cash equivalents, accrued investment income and net payable for investments purchased) as compared to approximately 89.1% as at December 31, 2004.

     The Company manages credit risk in the investment portfolio through the credit research performed by the external investment professionals and limitations on the investment portfolio’s exposure to individual credits, as set by the Company. Limits are set for each credit quality rating and are a function of the probability of default and the expected loss in the event of a default. Limits ensure that potential losses from individual defaults should not exceed predetermined levels.

     The Company reviews on a regular basis its corporate debt concentration, credit quality and compliance with established credit limits. Any obligor over its credit limits, experiencing financial difficulties, material credit quality deterioration or potentially subject to forthcoming credit quality deterioration is placed on a Watch List for closer monitoring. Where appropriate, exposures are reduced or prevented from increasing.

     The table below shows the Company’s fixed income portfolio by credit rating in percentage terms of the Company’s total fixed income exposure (including fixed maturities, short-term investments, cash and cash equivalents and net payable for investments purchased) as at December 31, 2005.

   
Total


AAA    57.2 % 
AA    13.2 % 
A    16.6 % 
BBB    10.6 % 
BB & below    2.2 % 
NR    0.2 % 


Total    100.0 % 



     At December 31, 2005 and 2004, the average credit quality of the Company’s total fixed income portfolio was “AA”.

     As at December 31, 2005, the top 10 corporate holdings, which exclude government guaranteed and government sponsored enterprises, represented approximately 3.6% of the total fixed income portfolio and approximately 19.7% of all corporate holdings. The top 10 corporate holdings listed below represent the direct exposure to the corporations listed below, including their subsidiaries, and excludes any securitized, credit enhanced and collateralized asset or mortgage backed securities, cash and cash equivalents, and excludes any reduction to this exposure through credit default swaps, if applicable.

105


    Percentage of Total
Top 10 Corporate Holdings (2)    Fixed Income Portfolio (1)



General Electric Company    0.4 % 
HSBC Holding plc    0.4 % 
Citigroup Inc    0.4 % 
Lloyd’s TSB Group plc    0.4 % 
HBOS plc    0.4 % 
Bank of America Corporation    0.4 % 
Wells Fargo & Co    0.4 % 
Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc    0.4 % 
Wal-Mart Stores Inc    0.3 % 
Wachovia Corp    0.3 % 


(1)      Including fixed maturities, short-term investments, cash and cash equivalents and net payable for investments purchased.

     The Company’s fixed income portfolio is exposed to interest rate risk. Interest rate risk is the price sensitivity of a fixed income security to changes in interest rates. The Company manages interest rate risk within the context of its overall asset liability management strategy by setting duration targets for its investment portfolio in line with the estimated duration of its liabilities, thus mitigating the overall economic effect of interest rate risk. The Company remains nevertheless exposed to accounting interest rate risk since the assets are marked to market, thus subject to market conditions, while liabilities are accrued at a static rate. The hypothetical case of an immediate 100 basis point adverse parallel shift in global bond curves as at December 31, 2005, would decrease the fair value of the Company’s fixed income portfolio by approximately 3.9% or $1.5 billion. Based on historical observations, it is unlikely that all global yield curves would shift uniformly in the same direction and at the same time.

     In addition, the Company has short-term debt and long-term debt outstanding. Interest rates on short-term debt are LIBOR-based. Accordingly, any changes in interest rates will affect interest expense.

     Equity Portfolio

     As at December 31, 2005, the Company’s equity portfolio, which for financial reporting purposes includes certain fixed income mutual fund investments that do not have the risk characteristics of equity investments, was $869 million as compared to $963 million as at December 31, 2004. As at December 31, 2005, the Company’s allocation to equity securities was approximately 2.1% of the total investment portfolio (including cash and cash equivalents, accrued investment income and net payable for investments purchased) as compared to approximately 3.0% as at December 31, 2004.

     As at December 31, 2005, approximately 53% of the equity portfolio was invested in U.S. companies as compared to approximately 60% as at December 31, 2004. As at December 31, 2005, the top ten equity holdings represented approximately 5.8% of the Company’s total equity portfolio as compared to approximately 8.0% as at December 31, 2004.

     The Company’s equity portfolio is exposed to price risk. Equity price risk is the potential loss arising from decreases in the market value of equities. An immediate hypothetical 10% change in the value of each equity position would affect the fair value of the portfolio by approximately $86.9 million as at December 31, 2005.

     Alternative Investment Portfolio

     A portion of the Company’s portfolio is invested in funds that pursue alternative investment strategies, with the investment objective of attaining high risk-adjusted total return while maintaining moderate to low level of sensitivity to movements in the traditional asset classes and realizing a low volatility. Investments within this portfolio are generally fund investments in limited partnerships or similar vehicles, with each fund pursuing absolute return investment

106


mandates, typically investing in one or more of the traditional asset classes including equities, fixed income, credit, currency and commodity markets.

     Various strategies can be pursued and the Company classifies each fund allocation into four general style categories. The four styles are: Event driven, which includes strategies that pursue merger arbitrage, distressed and special situations opportunities; Directional/tactical, which includes strategies that pursue long/short equity, managed futures and macro opportunities; Arbitrage, which includes strategies that pursue equity market neutral, fixed income arbi-trage and convertible arbitrage opportunities; and Multi-strategy, which includes strategies incorporating aspects of the above.

     The Company utilizes additional risk and portfolio management analytics and processes to enhance the overall management and assessment of the alternative investment portfolio. Central to the portfolio and risk management processes is the receipt of information on each of its allocations that is sufficient to assess risks and exposures of the fund allocations and to monitor how the portfolio and associated risk changes over time. The level and frequency of information required by the Company on each investment depends on the type of strategy that a fund pursues; the expected risk profile and types of risk that the fund and underlying securities are exposed to the liquidity of the fund and underlying securities; and the size of the allocation.

     The Company’s alternative investment portfolio had approximately 80 separate investments in different funds at December 31, 2005 with a total exposure of $1.7 billion making up approximately 4.1% of total investments compared to December 31, 2004 where the Company had over 100 separate fund investments with a total exposure of $1.7 billion representing approximately 5.2% of total investments.

     At December 31, 2005, the alternative investment style allocation was 43% in Directional/tactical strategies, 31% in Event driven strategies, 18% in Arbitrage strategies, and 8% in Multi-strategy strategies. At December 31, 2004, the Alternative investment style allocation was 42% in Directional/tactical strategies, 25% in Arbitrage strategies, 25% in Event driven strategies and 8% in Multi-strategy strategies.

     Private Investment Portfolio

     A portion of the Company’s portfolio is invested in limited partnerships and other entities which are not publicly traded. In addition to normal market risks, these positions may also be exposed to liquidity risk, risks related to distressed investments, and risks specific to startup or small companies.

     As at December 31, 2005, the Company’s exposure to private investments was approximately $252.2 million compared to $187.1 million as at December 31, 2004. As at December 31, 2005, and 2004, the Company’s exposure to private investments consisted of approximately 0.6% of the total investment portfolio (including cash and cash equivalents, accrued investment income and net payable for investments purchased).

     Bond and Stock Index Futures Exposure

     At December 31, 2005, bond and stock index futures outstanding had a net long position of $46.4 million as compared to a net long position of $1.3 billion at December 31, 2004. A 10% appreciation or depreciation of the underlying exposure to these derivative instruments would have resulted in realized gains or realized losses of $4.6 million as at December 31, 2005 and $129.5 million as at December 31, 2004, respectively. The Company may reduce its exposure to these futures through offsetting transactions, including options and forwards.

     Foreign Currency Exchange Risk

     The Company has exposure to foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations through its operations and in its investment portfolio. The Company’s net foreign currency denominated payable on foreign exchange contracts was $603 million and $3.8 million as at December 31, 2005 and 2004 respectively, with a net unrealized gain of $15.9 million and a net unrealized loss of $11.8 million as at December 31, 2004 and 2005, respectively.

107


     Foreign exchange contracts within the investment portfolio are utilized to manage individual portfolio foreign exchange exposures, subject to investment manager guidelines established by management. These contracts are not designated as specific hedges for financial reporting purposes and, therefore, realized and unrealized gains and losses on these contracts are recorded in income in the period in which they occur. These contracts generally have maturities of three months or less.

     The Company also attempts to manage the foreign exchange volatility arising on certain transactions denominated in foreign currencies. These include, but are not limited to, premium receivable, reinsurance contracts, claims payable and investments in subsidiaries.

     Credit Risk

     The Company is exposed to credit risk in the event of non-performance by the other parties to its forward contracts, however the Company does not anticipate non-performance. The difference between the notional principal amounts and the associated market value is the Company’s maximum credit exposure.

108


ITEM 8.      FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Related Notes    Page 

Consolidated Balance Sheets as at December 31, 2005 and 2004    110 
Consolidated Statements of Income and Comprehensive Income for the years ended     
   December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003    111 
Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended     
   December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003    112 
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended     
   December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003    113 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the years ended     
   December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003    115 

109


XL CAPITAL LTD

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS AS AT DECEMBER 31, 2005 AND 2004

A S S E T S
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except share amounts)   
2005
2004
 


       

 
Investments:           
   Fixed maturities at fair value (amortized cost: 2005, $31,984,076; 2004, $24,452,348) 
 
$
32,309,565     $  25,100,194  
   Equity securities, at fair value (cost: 2005, $696,858; 2004, $ 778,117)    868,801       962,920  
   Short-term investments, at fair value (amortized cost: 2005, $2,552,589; 2004, $1,738,845) 
  2,546,073       1,760,714  


 

 
                 Total investments available for sale    35,724,439       27,823,828  
   Investments in affiliates    2,046,721       1,936,852  
   Other investments (cost: 2005, $372,546; 2004, $ 404,303)    399,417       405,737  


 

 
                 Total investments    38,170,577       30,166,417  
Cash and cash equivalents    3,693,475       2,203,726  
Accrued investment income    391,660       326,510  
Deferred acquisition costs    866,200       845,422  
Prepaid reinsurance premiums    1,067,556       992,260  
Premiums receivable    3,799,041       3,838,228  
Reinsurance balances receivable    1,043,013       1,095,739  
Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable    6,441,522       6,971,356  
Goodwill and other intangible assets    1,814,544       1,827,782  
Deferred tax asset, net    318,399       288,599  
Other assets    848,914       689,430  


 

 
                 Total assets   
$
58,454,901     $  49,245,469  


 

 
 
L I A B I L I T I E S   A N D   S H A R E H O L D E R S ’   E Q U I T Y
Liabilities:           
   Unpaid losses and loss expenses   
$
23,767,672     $  19,837,669  
   Deposit liabilities    8,240,987       5,974,726  
   Future policy benefit reserves    5,606,461       4,335,056  
   Unearned premiums    5,388,996       5,191,368  
   Notes payable and debt    3,412,698       2,721,431  
   Reinsurance balances payable    1,414,752       1,565,689  
   Net payable for investments purchased    639,034       273,535  
   Other liabilities    1,438,234       1,533,860  
   Minority interest    74,256       73,440  


 

 
                 Total liabilities   
$
49,983,090     $  41,506,774  


 

 
Commitments and Contingencies           
Shareholders’ Equity:           
Series A preference ordinary shares, 9,200,000 authorized, par value $0.01           
   Issued and outstanding: (2005 and 2004 9,200,000)    $ 92     $  92  
Series B preference ordinary shares, 11,500,000 authorized, par value $0.01           
   Issued and outstanding: (2005 and 2004 11,500,000)    115       115  
Class A ordinary shares, 999,990,000 authorized, par value $0.01           
   Issued and outstanding: (2005, 179,528,593; 2004, 138,932,481)    1,795       1,389  
Additional paid in capital    6,472,839       3,950,175  
Accumulated other comprehensive income    268,243       460,273  
Deferred compensation    (95,464 )      (69,988 ) 
Retained earnings    1,824,191       3,396,639  


 

 
                 Total shareholders’ equity    $ 8,471,811     $  7,738,695  


 

 
                 Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity   
$
58,454,901     $  49,245,469  


 

 

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

110


XL CAPITAL LTD

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2005, 2004 AND 2003
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except share and per share amounts)     
2005
2004
2003
 

       
       

 
 
Revenues:                   
   Net premiums earned – general operations    $  6,873,638     $  6,987,940     $  6,089,578  
   Net premiums earned – life and annuity operations      2,237,721       1,365,176       708,994  
   Net premiums earned – financial operations      254,136       228,898       195,344  
   Net investment income      1,475,039       1,035,012       815,487  
   Net realized gains on investments      241,882       246,547       120,195  
   Net realized and unrealized gains on                   
       derivative instruments      28,858       73,493       6,073  
   Net income from investment affiliates      154,844       124,008       119,200  
   Fee income and other      19,297       35,317       41,744  


 

 

 
                 Total revenues    $  11,285,415     $  10,096,391     $  8,096,615  


 

 

 
Expenses:                   
   Net losses and loss expenses incurred – general                   
       and financial operations    $  7,465,001     $  4,911,488     $  4,696,427  
   Claims and policy benefits – life and annuity operations      2,479,364       1,480,535       791,454  
   Acquisition costs      1,195,344       1,264,864       1,167,186  
   Operating expenses      982,059       1,053,135       797,826  
   Foreign exchange losses (gains)      10,954       (40,678 )      (38,619 ) 
   Interest expense      403,849       292,234       233,929  
   Amortization of intangible assets      10,752       15,827       4,637  


 

 

 
                 Total expenses    $  12,547,323     $  8,977,405     $  7,652,840  


 

 

 
   (Loss) income before minority interest, income tax and net income                   
       from operating affiliates    $  (1,261,908 )    $  1,118,986     $  443,775  
   Minority interest in net income of subsidiary      8,210       8,387       9,264  
   Income tax expense      49,284       91,343       31,455  
   Net income from operating affiliates      67,426       147,357       8,923  


 

 

 
Net (loss) income    $  (1,251,976 )    $  1,166,613     $  411,979  


 

 

 
Preference share dividends      (40,322 )      (40,321 )      (40,321 ) 


 

 

 
Net (loss) income available to ordinary shareholders    $  (1,292,298 )    $  1,126,292     $  371,658  


 

 

 
Net (loss) income    $  (1,251,976 )    $  1,166,613     $  411,979  
Change in net unrealized appreciation (depreciation) of investments,                   
   net of tax      (314,719 )      198,912       352,719  
Derivative gain (loss) on cash flow hedge      630       (6,118 )      –-  
Net unrealized gain or loss on future policy benefit reserves 
    (46,743 )      (49,250 )      (10,487 ) 
Foreign currency translation adjustments      168,802       (173,466 )      (36,851 ) 


 

 

 
Comprehensive (loss) income    $  (1,444,006 )    $  1,136,691     $  717,360  


 

 

 
Weighted average ordinary shares and ordinary share equivalents                   
   outstanding – basic      141,406       137,903       136,906  
Weighted average ordinary shares and ordinary share equivalents                   
   outstanding – diluted      141,406       138,582       138,187  


 

 

 
(Loss) Earnings per ordinary share and ordinary share equivalent – basic 
  $  (9.14 )    $  8.17     $  2.71  


 

 

 
(Loss) Earnings per ordinary share and ordinary share equivalent – diluted 
  $  (9.14 )    $  8.13     $  2.69  


 

 

 

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

111


XL CAPITAL LTD

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2005, 2004 AND 2003
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
Series A and B Preference Ordinary Shares:                   
   Balance – beginning of year    $  207     $  207     $  207  
   Issue of shares                   


 

 

 
       Balance – end of year    $  207     $  207     $  207  


 

 

 
Ordinary Shares:                   
   Balance – beginning of year    $  1,389     $  1,373     $  1,360  
   Issue of shares      398       7       5  
   Exercise of stock options      9       10       8  
   Repurchase of shares      (1 )      (1 )       


 

 

 
       Balance – end of year    $  1,795     $  1,389     $  1,373  


 

 

 
Additional paid in capital:                   
   Balance – beginning of year    $  3,950,175     $  3,949,421     $  3,979,979  
   Issue of shares      2,504,872       59,407       34,103  
   Stock option expense      20,457       14,575       5,590  
   Exercise of stock options      36,293       34,796       42,103  
   Repurchase of shares      (2,036 )      (3,558 )      (424 ) 
   Equity units / debt value      (36,922 )      (104,466 )       
   Contingent capital costs                  (111,930 ) 


 

 

 
       Balance – end of year    $  6,472,839     $  3,950,175     $  3,949,421  


 

 

 
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss):                   
   Balance – beginning of year    $  460,273     $  490,195     $  184,814  
   Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on investment portfolio,                   
       net of tax      (340,156 )      211,933       356,137  
   Net change in unrealized (losses) gains on affiliate                   
       and other investments      25,437       (13,021 )      (3,418 ) 
   Derivative loss on cash flow hedge      630       (6,118 )       
   Net unrealized gain or loss on future policy benefit reserves      (46,743 )      (49,250 )      (10,487 ) 
   Foreign Currency translation adjustments      168,802       (173,466 )      (36,851 ) 


 

 

 
       Balance – end of year    $  268,243     $  460,273     $  490,195  


 

 

 
Deferred Compensation:                   
   Balance – beginning of year    $  (69,988 )    $  (46,124 )    $  (31,282 ) 
   Issue of restricted shares      (58,480 )      (52,257 )      (32,757 ) 
   Amortization      33,004       28,393       17,915  


 

 

 
       Balance – end of year    $  (95,464 )    $  (69,988 )    $  (46,124 ) 


 

 

 
Retained Earnings:                   
   Balance – beginning of year    $  3,396,639     $  2,541,843     $  2,434,511  
   Net (loss) income      (1,251,976 )      1,166,613       411,979  
   Dividends on Class A ordinary shares      (276,655 )      (270,452 )      (263,176 ) 
   Dividends on Series A and B preference ordinary shares      (40,322 )      (40,321 )      (40,321 ) 
   Repurchase of shares      (3,495 )      (1,044 )      (1,150 ) 


 

 

 
             Balance – end of year    $  1,824,191     $  3,396,639     $  2,541,843  


 

 

 
Total shareholders’ equity    $  8,471,811     $  7,738,695     $  6,936,915  


 

 

 

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

112


XL CAPITAL LTD

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2005, 2004 AND 2003
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
Cash Flows (used in) Provided by Operating Activities:               
 
   Net (loss) income    $  (1,251,976 )    $  1,166,613    
$
411,979  
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash               
 
   provided by operating activities:               
 
   Net realized (gains) losses on sales of investments      (241,882 )      (246,547 )   
(120,195 ) 
   Net realized and unrealized (gains) losses on derivative instruments      (28,858 )      (73,493 )   
(6,073 ) 
   Amortization of discounts on fixed maturities      50,206       80,740    
44,792  
   Amortization of intangible assets      10,752       15,827    
4,637  
   Amortization of deferred compensation      33,004       28,393    
17,915  
   Accretion of convertible debt      976       21,775    
25,512  
   Accretion of deposit liabilities      227,743       148,587    
123,750  
   Equity in net income of investment, and operating affiliates      (222,270 )      (271,365 )   
(128,123 ) 
   Unpaid losses and loss expenses      3,930,003       3,074,545    
3,430,622  
   Unearned premiums      197,628       461,379    
701,690  
   Premiums receivable      39,187       (350,906 )   
105,391  
   Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable      529,834       (926,335 )   
(935,055 ) 
   Future policy benefit reserves      1,271,405       1,284,531    
691,107  
   Prepaid reinsurance premiums      (75,296 )      (14,665 )   
(20,559 ) 
   Reinsurance balances receivable      52,726       263,747    
(119,516 ) 
   Reinsurance balances payable      (150,937 )      39,950    
(398,411 ) 
   Deferred acquisition costs      (20,778 )      (67,540 )   
(89,601 ) 
   Deferred tax asset      (29,800 )      21,478    
10,547  
   Other      (72,231 )      (212,676 )   
(374,832 ) 


 

 

 
             Total adjustments    $  5,501,412     $  3,277,425    
$ 
2,963,598  


 

 

 
   Net cash provided by operating activities    $  4,249,436     $  4,444,038    
$ 
3,375,577  


 

 

 
Cash Flows Used in Investing Activities:               
 
   Proceeds from sale of fixed maturities and short-term investments    $  22,113,395     $  23,346,159    
$ 
27,235,169  
   Proceeds from redemption of fixed maturities and               
 
       short-term investments      2,415,467       3,976,544    
11,462,093  
   Proceeds from sale of equity securities      1,125,801       771,943    
1,224,420  
   Purchases of fixed maturities and short-term investments      (32,738,114 )      (33,935,292 )   
(44,732,460 ) 
   Purchases of equity securities      (946,373 )      (805,235 )   
(909,414 ) 
   Investments in affiliates, net of dividends received      106,610       88,997    
(56,004 ) 
   Acquisition of subsidiaries, net of cash acquired               
(91,470 ) 
   Other investments      19,070       (27,666 )   
(27,847 ) 
   Fixed assets and other               
(3,338 ) 
   Net proceeds from purchase and sale of leasehold property               
45,307  


 

 

 
Net Cash Used in Investing Activities    $  (7,904,144 )    $  (6,584,550 )   
$ 
(5,853,544 ) 


 

 

 

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

113


XL CAPITAL LTD

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2005, 2004 AND 2003 (Continued)
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
 
Cash Flows Provided by Financing Activities:   
   
   
 
   Proceeds from exercise of stock options and issue of common shares 
 
$
2,478,065    
$
41,480    
$
42,113  
   Repurchase of common shares   
(5,532 )   
(4,602 )   
(1,574 ) 
   Dividends paid on common shares   
(276,655 )   
(270,452 )   
(263,176 ) 
   Dividends paid on preference shares   
(40,322 )   
(40,321 )   
(40,321 ) 
   Proceeds from notes payable and debt   
790,291    
1,742,317    
 
   Repayment of notes payable and debt   
(100,000 )   
(974,384 )   
 
   Deposit liabilities   
2,023,601    
1,452,493    
1,551,041  
   Net cash flow on securities lending   
274,582    
(324,470 )   
313,861  


 

 

 
Net cash provided by financing activities   
5,144,030    
1,622,061    
1,601,944  


 

 

 
Effects of exchange rate changes on foreign currency cash   
427    
(228 )   
2,646  
Increase (Decrease) in cash and cash equivalents   
1,489,749    
(518,679 )   
(873,377 ) 
Cash and cash equivalents – beginning of year   
2,203,726    
2,722,405    
3,595,782  


 

 

 
Cash and cash equivalents – end of year   
$
3,693,475    
$
2,203,726    
$
2,722,405  


 

 

 
Net taxes (paid) received   
$
(34,500 )   
$
(30,861 )   
$
(3,154 ) 
Interest paid   
$
(143,437 )   
$
(79,848 )   
$
(62,929 ) 

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

114


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2005, 2004 AND 2003

1. History

     XL Capital Ltd together with its subsidiaries (the “Company” or “XL”), is a holding company organized under the laws of the Cayman Islands. XL Capital Ltd was incorporated on March 16, 1998, as the successor to EXEL Limited, a Cayman Islands corporation organized in 1986, in connection with EXEL Limited’s merger with Mid Ocean Limited, a Cayman Islands corporation. XL Capital Ltd operated under the name EXEL Limited from completion of the merger until February 1, 1999, when its current name was approved by the requisite vote of the Company’s shareholders. The Company provides insurance and reinsurance coverages and financial products and services to industrial, commercial and professional service firms, insurance companies and other enterprises on a worldwide basis.

     Effective January 1, 2002, the Company increased its shareholding in Le Mans Ré from 49% to 67% in order to expand its international reinsurance operations. Due to certain contractual arrangements between the Company and Les Mutuelles du Mans Assurances Group (“MMA”), MMA did not have any economic interest in the earnings of Le Mans Ré with effect from January 1, 2002 and accordingly, no minority interest was recorded from that date. In September 2003, the Company purchased the remaining 33% and Le Mans Ré was renamed “XL Re Europe”. XL Re Europe underwrites a worldwide portfolio comprising most classes of property and casualty reinsurance business, together with a selective portfolio of life reinsurance business. See Note 5 for additional information.

     On July 25, 2001, the Company acquired certain Winterthur International insurance operations (the “Winterthur Business”) to extend its predominantly North American-based large corporate business globally. Effective July 1, 2001, the Company’s results include the Winterthur Business. See Note 5 for additional information. In 2003, the Company re-branded “XL Winterthur International” to “XL Insurance Global Risk”.

     In 1999, XL Capital Ltd merged with NAC Re Corp (“NAC”), a Delaware corporation. NAC was organized in 1985 and wrote property and casualty insurance and reinsurance in the U.S., Canada and Europe.

2. Significant Accounting Policies

     (a) Basis of Preparation and Consolidation

     These consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and all of its subsidiaries. These consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”). All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated. Certain amounts in 2004 and 2003 have been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation.

     The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amount of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. While management believes that the amounts included in the consolidated financial statements reflect the Company’s best estimates and assumptions, actual results could differ from these estimates.

     (b) Premiums and Acquisition Costs

     Insurance premiums written are recorded in accordance with the terms of the underlying policies. Reinsurance premiums written are recorded at the inception of the policy and are estimated based upon information received from ceding companies and any subsequent differences arising on such estimates are recorded in the period they are determined. Financial guaranty installment premiums are recorded as premiums written when due.

115


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (b) Premiums and Acquisition Costs (continued)

     Premiums are earned on a pro-rata basis over the period the coverage is provided. Financial guaranty insurance premiums are earned pro-rata to the amount of risk outstanding over the life of the exposure. Unearned premiums represent the portion of premiums written applicable to the unexpired terms of policies in force. Net premiums earned are presented after deductions for reinsurance ceded, as applicable.

     Reinstatement premiums are recognized and earned at the time a loss event occurs.

     Life and annuity premiums from long duration contracts that transfer significant mortality or morbidity risks are recognized as revenue and earned when due from policyholders. Life and annuity premiums from long duration contracts that do not subject the Company to risks arising from policyholder mortality or morbidity are accounted for as investment contracts and presented within deposit liabilities.

     Acquisition costs, which vary with and are directly related to the acquisition of policies, consist primarily of commissions paid to brokers and cedents and certain underwriting costs and are deferred and amortized over the period that the premiums are earned. Acquisition costs are shown net of commissions earned on reinsurance ceded. Future earned premiums, the anticipated losses and other costs (and in the case of a premium deficiency, investment income) related to those premiums, are also considered in determining the level of acquisition costs to be deferred.

     (c) Reinsurance

     In the normal course of business, the Company seeks to reduce the potential amount of loss arising from claims events by reinsuring certain levels of risk assumed in various areas of exposure with other insurers or reinsurers. Reinsurance premiums ceded are expensed (and any commissions recorded thereon are earned) on a monthly pro-rata basis over the period the reinsurance coverage is provided. Prepaid reinsurance premiums represent the portion of premiums ceded applicable to the unexpired term of policies in force. Reinstatement premiums ceded are recorded at the time a loss event occurs. Amounts recoverable from reinsurers are estimated in a manner consistent with the claim liability associated with the reinsured policy. Provisions are made for estimated unrecoverable reinsurance.

     (d) Fee Income and Other

     Fee income and other includes fees received for insurance and product structuring services provided and is earned over the service period of the contract. Any adjustments to fees earned or the service period are reflected in income in the period when determined.

     (e) Other Than Temporary Declines in Investments

     The Company reviews the fair value of its investment portfolio on a periodic basis to identify declines in fair value below the carrying value that are other than temporary. This review involves consideration of several factors including (i) the time period during which there has been a significant decline in fair value below carrying value, (ii) an analysis of the liquidity, business prospects and overall financial condition of the issuer, (iii) the significance of the decline, (iv) an analysis of the collateral structure and other credit support, as applicable, of the securities in question and (v) the Company’s intent and ability to hold the investment for a sufficient period of time for the value to recover. Where the Company concludes that declines in fair values are other than temporary, the cost of the security is written down to fair value below carrying value and the previously unrealized loss is therefore realized in the period such determination is made.

116


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (e) Other Than Temporary Declines in Investments (continued)

     With respect to securities where the decline in value is determined to be temporary and the security’s value is not written down, a subsequent decision may be made to sell that security and realize a loss. Subsequent decisions on security sales are made within the context of overall risk monitoring, changing information, market conditions generally and assessing value relative to other comparable securities.

     (f) Derivative Instruments and Weather Derivative Contracts

     The Company recognizes all derivatives as either assets or liabilities in the balance sheet and measures those instruments at fair value. Non-exchange traded weather products are recorded at fair value. The changes in fair value of derivatives are shown in the consolidated statement of income as “net realized and unrealized gains and losses on derivative instruments” unless the derivatives are designated as hedging instruments. If the derivatives qualify as hedges, depending on the nature of the hedge, changes in the fair value of the derivatives are either offset against the change in fair value of assets, liabilities or firm commitments through earnings, or recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income until the hedged item is recognized in earnings. Any ineffective portion of a derivative’s change in fair value is recognized immediately in earnings. Changes in fair value of derivatives may create volatility in the Company’s results of operations from period to period.

     The Company conducts activities in three main types of instruments: credit derivatives, weather and energy derivatives and investment related derivatives.

     Credit derivatives

     Credit derivatives are recorded at fair value, which is determined using models developed by the Company and is dependent upon a number of factors, including changes in interest rates, future default rates, credit spreads, changes in credit quality, future expected recovery rates and other market factors. The change resulting from movements in credit and credit quality spreads is unrealized as the credit derivatives are not traded to realize this resultant value.

     For all periods reported herein, the Company amended the presentation of certain credit derivative transactions (described below) in the consolidated statements of income to include certain components of the change in fair value in “gross premiums written”, “net premiums earned” and “net losses and loss expenses incurred”, and in the consolidated balance sheet, certain components of the fair value in “unearned premiums” and “unpaid loss and loss expenses.” Previously, the change in fair value of all of the Company’s derivative transactions was reflected in one line item under “net realized and unrealized gains and losses on derivative instruments”, and the fair value had been reflected in “other assets” and “other liabilities.” There was no effect on net income as a result of this change in presentation and prior period results have been reclassified to reflect this presentation. This change in presentation is applicable only to credit default swaps issued by the Company that are investment grade and that the Company intends, and has the ability, to hold to maturity, and is consistent with practices in the financial guaranty insurance industry for reporting the results of such instruments.

     Weather and Energy derivatives

     Fair values for the Company’s natural gas contracts are determined through the use of quoted market prices. As quoted market prices are not widely available in the weather and electricity derivative markets, management uses available market data and internal pricing models based upon consistent statistical methodologies to estimate fair values. Estimating the fair value of instruments which do not have quoted market prices requires management’s judgment in determining amounts which could reasonably be expected to be received from, or paid to, a third party in settlement of the contracts. The amounts could be materially different from the amounts that might be realized in an actual sale transaction. Fair values are subject to change in the near-term and reflect management’s best estimate based on various factors including, but not limited to, actual and forecasted weather conditions, changes in commodity prices, changes in interest rates and other market factors.

117


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (f) Derivative Instruments and Weather Derivative Contracts (continued)

     Investment Related derivatives

     The Company uses derivative instruments to manage duration and foreign currency exposure for its investment portfolio.

     The Company uses investment derivative instruments, primarily interest rate swaps, to manage the interest rate exposure associated with certain assets and liabilities. All interest rate swaps are recorded at fair value. Changes in the value of derivative instruments designated as fair value hedges are recorded as adjustments to the hedged items to the extent that the hedge is effective. Changes in the value of derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges are recorded in other comprehensive income to the extent that the hedge is effective. The ineffective portion of both fair value and cash flow hedges are recognized in earnings.

     The Company also has investment related derivatives embedded in certain reinsurance contracts. For a particular life reinsurance contract, the Company pays the ceding company a fixed amount equal to the estimated present value of the excess of guaranteed benefit (“GMIB”) over the account balance upon the policyholder’s election to take the income benefit. The fair value of this derivative is determined based on the present value of expected cash flows. In addition, the Company has modified coinsurance and funds withheld reinsurance agreements that provide for a return based on a portfolio of fixed income securities; as such, the agreements contain embedded derivatives. The embedded derivative is bifurcated and recorded at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in earnings.

     (g) Total Investments

     Investments Available For Sale

     Investments that are considered available for sale are carried at fair value. The fair value of investments is based upon quoted market values where available or by reference to broker or underwriter bid indications. The net unrealized appreciation or depreciation on investments, net of tax, is included in “accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)”. Any unrealized depreciation in value considered by management to be other than temporary is charged to income in the period that it is determined.

     Short-term investments comprise investments with a remaining maturity less than one year. Equity securities include investments in open end mutual funds.

     All investment transactions are recorded on a trade date basis. Realized gains and losses on sales of equities and fixed income investments are determined on the basis of average cost and amortized cost, respectively. Investment income is recognized when earned and includes interest and dividend income together with the amortization of premium and discount on fixed maturities and short-term investments.

     Investment In Affiliates

     Investments in which the Company has significant influence over the operating and financial policies of the investee are classified as investments in affiliates on the Company’s balance sheets and are accounted for under the equity method of accounting. Under this method, the Company records its proportionate share of income or loss from such investments in its results for the period. Significant influence is deemed to exist where the Company has an investment of 20% or more in the common stock of a corporation or an investment of 3% or greater in closed end funds, limited partnerships, LLC’s or similar investment vehicles. Significant influence is considered for other strategic investments on a case-by-case basis.

118


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (g) Total Investments (continued)

     The determination of whether an entity is classified as an affiliate for GAAP accounting purposes may be different from the determination of whether such entity would constitute an affiliate for any other purposes, including regulatory purposes. The income from affiliates is shown separately between net income from operating affiliates and net income from investment affiliates. Any decline in value of an affiliate investment considered by management to be other than temporary is charged to income in the period that it is determined.

     Other investments

     The Company accounts for its other investments which do not have readily determinable market values at estimated fair value as it has no significant influence over these entities. The net unrealized appreciation or depreciation on investments, net of tax, is included in “accumulated other comprehensive income (loss).” Any unrealized depreciation in value considered by management to be other than temporary is charged to income in the period that it is determined.

     Securities lending

     The Company engages in a securities lending program whereby certain securities from the Company’s portfolio are loaned to other institutions for short periods of time. The market value of the loaned securities is monitored on a daily basis, with additional collateral obtained or refunded as the market value of the loaned securities changes. The Company’s policy is to require fixed maturities and initial cash collateral equal to between 102% and 105% of the fair value of the loaned securities depending on the class of assets loaned. The Company continues to earn interest on the securities loaned. In addition, the Company shares a portion of the interest earned on the collateral with the lending agent. The securities lending collateral is included in cash and cash equivalents with a corresponding liability related to the Company’s obligation to return the collateral plus interest included in net payable for investments purchased.

     (h) Cash Equivalents

     Cash equivalents include fixed interest deposits placed with a maturity of under 90 days when purchased.

     (i) Foreign Currency Translation

     Assets and liabilities of foreign operations whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar are translated at prevailing year end exchange rates. Revenue and expenses of such foreign operations are translated at average exchange rates during the year. The net effect of the translation adjustments for foreign operations, net of applicable deferred income taxes, as well as any gains or losses on intercompany balances for which settlement is not planned or anticipated in the forseeable future, are included in “accumulated other comprehensive income (loss).”

     Other monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are revalued at the exchange rate in effect at the balance sheet date and revenues and expenses are translated at the exchange rate on the date the transaction occurs with the resulting foreign exchange gains and losses recognized in income.

     (j) Intangible Assets

     Identifiable intangible assets with finite lives are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. The Company evaluates the recoverability of its intangible assets whenever changes in circumstances warrant it. If it is determined that an impairment exists, the excess of the unamortized balance over the fair value of the intangible asset will be charged to income at that time.

119


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (j) Intangible Assets (continued)

     Intangible assets with an indefinite life and goodwill are not amortized. The Company continues to review the carrying value of goodwill related to all of its investments for any impairment at least annually. If it is determined that an impairment exists, the Company adjusts the carrying value of goodwill to fair value. The impairment charge is recorded in income in the period in which it is determined. See Note 4 for further information.

     (k) Losses and Loss Expenses

     Unpaid losses and loss expenses include reserves for reported unpaid losses and loss expenses and for losses incurred but not reported. The reserve for reported unpaid losses and loss expenses for the Company’s general and financial operations is established by management based on amounts reported from insureds or ceding companies, and represents the estimated ultimate cost of events or conditions that have been reported to or specifically identified by the Company.

     The reserve for losses incurred but not reported is estimated by management based on loss development patterns determined by reference to the Company’s underwriting practices, the policy form, type of program and historical experience. The Company’s actuaries employ a variety of generally accepted methodologies to determine estimated ultimate loss reserves, including the “Bornhuetter-Ferguson incurred loss method” and frequency and severity approaches.

     Certain workers’ compensation, long-term disability liabilities and financial guaranty case reserve contracts are considered fixed and determinable and are subject to tabular reserving. Reserves associated with these liabilities are discounted.

     For the Company’s financial guaranty reserves, a case basis reserve for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses is recorded at the net present value of an estimated loss when, in management’s opinion, the likelihood of a future loss on a particular insured obligation is probable and determinable at a balance sheet date. The Company also maintains an unallocated reserve on its financial guaranty business which is based on actuarial reserving analysis. This reserve is available to be applied to new case basis reserves that may be established for claims on current outstanding insured principal and interest in the future. This non-specific reserve is established for expected levels of losses associated with currently insured issues and is based on a portion of premiums earned to date. The Company, on an ongoing basis, monitors these reserves and may periodically adjust such reserves based on the Company’s actual loss experience, its future mix of business, and its view of future economic conditions.

     Management believes that the reserves for unpaid losses and loss expenses are sufficient to cover losses that fall within coverages assumed by the Company. However, there can be no assurance that losses will not exceed the Company’s total reserves. The methodology of estimating loss reserves is periodically reviewed to ensure that the assumptions made continue to be appropriate and any adjustments resulting there from are reflected in income of the year in which the adjustments are made.

     (l) Deposit Liabilities

     Contracts entered into by the Company with cedents which are not deemed to transfer significant underwriting and/or timing risk are accounted for as deposits, whereby liabilities are initially recorded at an amount equal to the assets received. The Company uses a portfolio rate of return of equivalent duration to the liabilities in determining risk transfer. An initial accretion rate is established based on actuarial estimates whereby the deposit liability is increased to the estimated amount payable over the term of the contract.

120


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (l) Deposit Liabilities (continued)

     The deposit accretion rate is the rate of return required to fund expected future payment obligations (this is equivalent to the “best estimate” of future cash flows), which are determined actuarially based upon the nature of the underlying indemnifiable losses. Accretion of the liability is recorded as interest expense. The Company periodically reassesses the estimated ultimate liability. Any changes to this liability are reflected as adjustments to interest expense to reflect the cumulative effect of the period the contract has been in force, and by an adjustment to the future accretion rate of the liability over the remaining estimated contract term.

     Guaranteed investment contracts are initially recorded at an amount equal to the assets received. The Company may use derivative instruments in order to hedge the Company’s exposure to fluctuations in interest rates related to these contracts. Changes in the fair value of the hedging instrument are recognized in income. The change in the fair value of the hedged item, attributable to the hedged risk, is recorded as an adjustment to the carrying amount of the hedged item and is recognized in income.

     (m) Future policy benefit reserves

     The Company estimates the present value of future policy benefits related to long duration contracts using assumptions for investment yields, mortality, and expenses, including a provision for adverse deviation.

     The assumptions used to determine future policy benefit reserves are best estimate assumptions that are determined at the inception of the contracts and are locked-in throughout the life of the contract unless a premium deficiency develops. As the experience on the contracts emerges, the assumptions are reviewed. If such review would produce reserves in excess of those currently held then the lock-in assumptions will be revised and a claim and policy benefit is recognized at that time.

     Certain life insurance and annuity contracts provide the holder with a guaranty that the benefit received upon death will be no less than a minimum prescribed amount. The contracts are accounted for in accordance with SOP 03-1 “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises for certain Long-Duration Contracts and for Separate Accounts”, which requires that the best estimate of future experience be combined with actual experience to determine the benefit ratio used to calculate the policy benefit reserve.

     (n) Income Taxes

     The Company utilizes the asset and liability method of accounting for income taxes. Under this method, deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effect of temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes. The deferral of tax losses is evaluated based upon management’s estimates of the future profitability of the Company’s taxable entities based on current forecasts and the period for which losses may be carried forward. A valuation allowance is established for any portion of a deferred tax asset that management believes will not be realized. The Company continues to evaluate income generated in future periods by its subsidiaries in jurisdictions in determining the recoverability of its deferred tax asset. If it is determined that future income generated by these subsidiaries is insufficient to cause the realization of the net operating losses within a reasonable period, a valuation allowance is established at that time.

     (o) Stock Plans

     The Company accounts for stock compensation plans in accordance with the fair value recognition provisions of FAS 123 “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation”. This method was adopted as of January 1, 2003 using the prospective method allowed under FAS 148, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation – Transition and

121


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (o) Stock Plans (continued)

Disclosure” for options and employee stock purchase Plan shares granted subsequent to January 1, 2003. Prior to 2003, the Company accounted for these plans under the disclosure-only provisions of FAS 123 and no stock-based employee compensation cost was included in net income as all options granted had an exercise price equal to the market value of the Company’s ordinary shares on the date of grant. Awards under the Company’s stock plans vest over periods ranging from three to four years. If the fair value-based method had been applied to all awards since the original effective date of FAS 123, the cost related to employee stock-based compensation included in the determination of net income would have been higher. FAS 148 amends FAS 123 by providing alternative methods of transition for a voluntary change to the fair value-based method of accounting for stock-based employee compensation. In addition, FAS 148 amends the disclosure requirements of FAS 123 to require prominent disclosures in both annual and interim financial statements about the method of accounting for stock-based employee compensation and the effect of the method used on reported results.

     The following table illustrates the net effect on net income and earnings per ordinary share if the fair value method had been applied to all outstanding and unvested awards for each of the three years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003:

(U.S. dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
Net (loss) income available to ordinary shareholders – as reported 
  $  (1,292,298 )    $  1,126,292     $  371,658  
Add: Stock-based employee compensation expense included in 
                 
   reported net income, net of related tax.      17,485       14,575       5,590  
Deduct: Total stock-based employee compensation expense                   
   determined under fair value-based method for all awards                   
   net of related tax effects      (21,513 )      (43,404 )      (49,473 ) 


 

 

 
Pro forma net (loss) income available to ordinary shareholders 
  $  (1,296,326 )    $  1,097,463     $  327,775  


 

 

 
Earnings (loss) per ordinary share:                   
   Basic – as reported    $  (9.14 )    $  8.17     $  2.71  
   Basic – pro forma    $  (9.17 )    $  7.96     $  2.39  
   Diluted – as reported    $  (9.14 )    $  8.13     $  2.69  
   Diluted – pro forma    $  (9.17 )    $  7.92     $  2.37  

     (p) Per Share Data

     Basic earnings per ordinary share is based on weighted average ordinary shares outstanding and excludes any dilutive effects of options and convertible securities. Diluted earnings per ordinary share assumes the exercise of all dilutive stock options and conversion of convertible securities where the contingency for conversion has occurred or been satisfied.

     (q) Fair Value of Financial Instruments

     Fair values of investments and derivatives are based on published market values if available, estimates of fair values of similar issues or estimates of fair values determined by the Company. See Notes 2, 6, 14 and 15 for further information on other financial instruments.

122


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (r) Recent Accounting Pronouncements

     Statement of Position (“SOP”) 03-3, Accounting for Certain Loans or Debt Securities Acquired in a Transfer (“SOP 03-3”), addresses accounting for differences between contractual cash flows and cash flows expected to be collected from an investor’s initial investment in loans or debt securities acquired in a transfer if those differences are attributable, at least in part, to credit quality. SOP 03-3 limits the yield that may be accreted (accretable yield) to the excess of the investor’s estimate of undiscounted expected principal, interest and other cash flows (cash flows expected at acquisition to be collected) over the investor’s initial investment in the debt security. SOP 03-3 is effective for loans acquired in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2004. The adoption of SOP 03-3 did not have a material effect on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

     In December 2004, the FASB issued Statement No. 123 (Revised), Share-Based Payment, which requires all share-based payments to employees, including grants of employee stock options, to be recognized in the financial statements based on their fair values. This statement is effective as of January 1, 2006. The Company adopted the fair value-based method of accounting for share-based payments effective January 1, 2003 using the prospective method described in FAS 148. FAS 123 (Revised) must be applied not only to new awards but to previously granted awards that are not fully vested on the effective date. However, had we adopted FAS 123 (Revised) in prior periods, the impact of that standard would have approximated the impact of FAS 123 as described in the disclosure of pro forma net income and earnings per share in Note 2 (o) – Stock Plans to our consolidated financial statements. Statement 123 (Revised) also requires the benefits of tax deductions in excess of recognized compensation cost to be reported as a financing cash flow, rather than as an operating cash flow as required under current literature. This requirement reduces net operating cash flows and increased net financing cash flows in periods after adoption.

     In March 2005, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position (“FSP”) FIN 46(R)-5, Implicit Variable Interests Under FASB Interpretation No. 46(R) (“FSP FIN 46(R)-5”), which requires an enterprise to consider whether it holds an implicit variable interest in a Variable Interest Entity (“VIE”) and what effect this may have on the calculation of expected losses and residual returns of the VIE and the determination of which party, if any, is considered the primary beneficiary of the VIE. FSP FIN 46(R)-5 was effective for the first reporting period beginning after March 3, 2005 and did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

     In May 2005, the FASB issued FAS No. 154, Accounting Changes and Error Corrections (“FAS 154”), which changes the requirements for the accounting for and reporting of changes in accounting principles. FAS 154 applies to all voluntary changes in accounting principles and changes the requirements for accounting for, and reporting of, changes in accounting principles. FAS 154 will be effective for fiscal years beginning after December 2005.

     In June 2005, the FASB ratified the Emerging Issues Task Force (“EITF”) Issue No. 04-5, Determining Whether a General Partner, or the General Partners as a Group, Controls a Limited Partnership or Similar Entity When the Limited Partners Have Certain Rights (“EITF 04-5”). The EITF reached a consensus that a sole general partner is presumed to control a limited partnership (or similar entity) and should consolidate the limited partnership unless (1) the limited partners possess substantive kick-out rights or (2) the limited partners possess substantive participating rights similar to the rights described in EITF Issue No. 96-16, Investor’s Accounting for an Investee When the Investor Has a Majority of the Voting Interest but the Minority Shareholders Have Certain Approval or Veto Rights. EITF 04-5 was effective for all new and modified agreements upon the FASB’s ratification in June 2005. For pre-existing agreements that are not modified, the consensus is effective as of the beginning of the first fiscal reporting period beginning after December 15, 2005 and is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

123


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (r) Recent Accounting Pronouncements (continued)

     In July 2005, the FASB issued FSP APB 18-1, Accounting by an Investor for Its Proportionate Share of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income of an Investee Accounted for under the Equity Method In Accordance With APB Opinion No. 18 upon a Loss of Significant Influence (“FSP APB 18-1”), to provide guidance on how an investor should account for its proportionate share of an investee’s equity adjustments for other comprehensive income (“OCI”) upon a loss of significant influence. The FASB believes that an investor’s proportionate share of an investee’s equity adjustments for OCI should be offset against the carrying value of the investments at the time significant influence is lost. To the extent that the offset results in a carrying value of the investment that is less than zero, an investor should (a) reduce the carrying value of the investment to zero and (b) record the remaining balance in income. FSP APB 18-1 became effective during the fourth quarter of 2005 and did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

     In August 2005, the FASB issued FSP FAS 123(R)-1, Classification and Measurement of Freestanding Financial Instruments Originally Issued in Exchange for Employee Services under FASB Statement No. 123(R) (“FSP FAS 123(R)-1”), to defer the requirement of FAS 123(R) that a freestanding financial instrument originally subject to FAS 123(R) becomes subject to the recognition and measurement requirements of other applicable GAAP when the rights conveyed by the instrument are no longer dependent on the holder being an employee of the entity. This FSP notes that these instruments should continue to be subject to the recognition and measurement provisions of FAS 123(R) throughout the life of the instrument, unless their terms are modified when the holder is no longer an employee. Following modification, recognition and measurement should be determined through reference to other applicable GAAP. FSP FAS 123(R)-1 became effective during the fourth quarter of 2005 and did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

     In November 2005, the FASB issued FSP FAS 115-1, The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its Application to Certain Investments to finalize the guidance which was initially provided in EITF 03-1, on (1) when an investment is considered impaired, (2) whether that impairment is “other-than-temporary,” (3) how to measure the impairment loss, and (4) disclosures related to impaired securities. Because of concerns about the application of EITF 03-1’s guidance that described whether an impairment is other-than-temporary, the FASB deferred the effective date of that portion of EITF 03-1’s guidance. This FSP now officially nullifies EITF 03-1’s guidance on determining whether an impairment is other-than-temporary, and effectively retains the previous guidance in this area. The FSP generally carries forward EITF 03-1’s guidance for determining when an investment is impaired, how to measure the impairment loss, and what disclosures should be made regarding impaired securities. The guidance is applicable as of January 1, 2006 and is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

     In November 2005, the FASB issued FSP FAS 123R-3, Transition Election Related to Accounting for the Tax Effects of Share-Based Payment Awards to provide a practical transition election related to accounting for the tax effects of share-based payment awards to employees. This FSP stated that either the method outlined previously in FAS 123(R) or the “Short-Cut Method” outlined in the FSP, should be followed to calculate the historical pool of windfall tax benefits upon adoption of FAS 123R. The Short-Cut Method could be used to calculate the beginning balance of the APIC pool related to employee stock options. This FSP is effective as of November 10, 2005 and the Company must decide on whether to make the one-time accounting policy election to calculate the historical pool of windfall tax benefits available using the “short-cut” method as discussed in the FSP or the “long-form” method as outlined in FAS 123R, prior to January 1, 2007. This guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial condition or results of operations.

124


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

     (r) Recent Accounting Pronouncements (continued)

     The Company is aware of the SEC’s recent review of the loss reserving practices of the financial guaranty industry. The Company recognizes that there is diversity in practice among financial guaranty insurers and reinsurers with respect to their accounting policies. Current accounting literature, specifically FASB Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 60 “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises” (“FAS 60”) does not specifically address the unique characteristics of financial guaranty insurance contracts. Consequently, the accounting principles applied by the industry have evolved over time and incorporate the concepts of both short-duration and long-duration contracts accounting under the provisions of FAS 60 and other accounting literature such as FAS 5 and EITF 85-20. In June 2005, the FASB undertook a project to review this matter and provide guidance for the accounting for financial guaranty insurance contracts under which it will consider claims liability recognition, premium recognition, and the related amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs. The Company will continue its loss reserving methodology as noted in Note 2 (k) until further guidance is provided by the SEC or FASB. The Company had reserves for financial guaranty insurance contracts of $173.7 million and $145.3 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.

3. Segment Information

     The Company operates through three business segments: Insurance, Reinsurance and Financial Products and Services. These business segments were determined in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“FAS”) No. 131, “Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information.”

     Following changes in certain executive management responsibilities in January 2005, the Company changed the reporting segments under which certain business units are reported in order to reflect these changes in responsibilities.

     The following areas have been changed for all periods presented:

  • Results of business structured by XL Financial Solutions Ltd (“XLFS”) are now included entirely within the Financial Products and Services segment whereas previously this unit was reported in all three segments, depending on the nature of individual contracts.

  • Certain blocks of U.S.-based term life mortality reinsurance business previously included in the Financial Products and Services segment are now included in the Reinsurance segment as management of these contracts was transferred to the life reinsurance business units in order to centralize the Company’s management of traditional mortality-based reinsurance business.

  • Political risk insurance business units now report to executive management of the Financial Products and Services segment and, as such, future earnings from this business are no longer reported in the Insurance segment but included with financial operations.

  • All operations of business units within the Financial Products and Services segment, including guaranteed investment contracts and funding agreements, are now reported under financial operations in order to consolidate businesses with similar operating characteristics and risks.

  • All net investment income and net income from affiliates generated by assets and interest expense incurred on liabilities of the business units within the Financial Products and Services segment is reported under financial operations. This income and expense is included in financial operations as it relates to interest on portfolios of separately identified and managed assets and deposit liabilities. Management believes this change better reflects the nature of spread focused business.

125


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Segment Information (continued)

     One way in which the Company evaluates performance of each segment is based on underwriting results (i.e., underwriting profit or loss) for general operations, net income from life and annuity operations and contribution from financial operations. Other items of revenue and expenditure of the Company are not evaluated at the segment level for general operations. In addition, the Company does not allocate assets by segment for its general operations. Investment assets related to the Company’s life and annuity, and financial operations are held in separately identified portfolios. Net investment income from these assets is included in net income from life and annuity operations and contribution from financial operations, respectively.

     Certain lines of business within general operations written by the Company have loss experience generally characterized as low frequency and high severity. This may result in volatility in both the Company’s results and operational cash flows.

     Insurance Operations

     General insurance business written includes risk management and specialty lines. Risk management products comprise global property and casualty insurance programs for large multinational companies, including umbrella liability, products recall, U.S. workers’ compensation, property catastrophe, and primary property and liability coverages. Specialty lines products include the following lines of business: professional liability, environmental liability, political risk insurance, aviation and satellite, marine and offshore energy insurance, equine and other insurance coverages including program business.

     Reinsurance Operations

     Reinsurance general business written includes treaty and facultative reinsurance to primary insurers of casualty and property risks, principally: general liability; professional liability; accident and health; automobile and workers’ compensation; commercial and personal property risks; specialty risks including fidelity and surety and ocean marine; property catastrophe; property excess of loss; property pro-rata; marine and energy; aviation and satellite; and various other reinsurance to insurers on a worldwide basis. While the Company’s life and annuity reinsurance business is primarily European term assurance, group life, critical illness cover, immediate annuities in payment and disability income business, it is developing a U.S. platform.

     Financial Products and Services

     Financial products and services businesses include insurance, reinsurance and derivative solutions for complex financial risks. These include financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance, credit enhancement swaps, other collateralized transactions, weather and energy risk management products and institutional life insurance products. While each of these is unique and is tailored for the specific needs of the insured or user, they are often multi-year contracts. Due to the nature of these types of contracts, premium volume as well as underwriting results can vary significantly from period to period. The financial products and services life business written includes funding agreements, municipal guaranteed reinvestment contracts and highly structured life co/reinsurance transactions.

126


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Segment Information (continued)

     The following is an analysis of results by segment together with a reconciliation to net income or loss:

   
Financial 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2005:   
Products and 
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except ratios)   
Insurance
Reinsurance
Services 
Total
 


       

       

     

 
General Operations:         
             
   Net premiums earned    $  4,102,697    
$
2,770,941     $      $  6,873,638  
   Fee income and other      4,223    
(278 )            3,945  
   Net losses and loss expenses      4,595,551    
2,763,378             7,358,929  
   Acquisition costs      505,636    
600,615             1,106,251  
   Operating expenses (4)      517,800    
155,095             672,895  
   Exchange gains (losses)      (25,472 )   
33,144             7,672  


 

 



 
   Underwriting (loss)    $  (1,486,595 )   
$
(781,569 )          $  (2,268,164 ) 


 

 



 
Life and Annuity Operations:         
             
   Net premiums earned         
$
2,237,721           $  2,237,721  
   Fee income and other         
320             320  
   Claims and policy benefits         
2,479,364             2,479,364  
   Acquisition costs         
59,018             59,018  
   Operating expenses (4)         
18,664             18,664  
   Exchange loss         
1,421             1,421  
   Net investment income         
290,517             290,517  


 

 



 
   Net (loss) from life and annuity operations    $     
$
(29,909 )    $      $  (29,909 ) 


 

 



 
Financial Operations:         
             
   Net premiums earned         
    $  254,136    $  254,136  
   Fee income and other         
      15,032      15,032  
   Net losses and loss expenses         
      106,072      106,072  
   Acquisition costs         
      30,075      30,075  
   Operating expenses (4)         
      70,912      70,912  
   Exchange losses         
      1,861      1,861  




 
   Underwriting profit         
    $  60,248    $  60,248  
   Net investment income – financial guarantee         
      71,781      71,781  
   Net investment income – structured product         
      313,936      313,936  
   Interest expense – structured products         
      216,392      216,392  
   Operating expenses – structured products         
      42,679      42,679  
   Net income from financial and investment affiliates         
      10,866      10,866  
   Minority interest         
      8,431      8,431  
   Net results from derivatives         
      45,433      45,433  




 
   Contribution from financial operations         
    $  234,762    $  234,762  




 

127


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Segment Information (continued)

   
Financial 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2005:   
Products and 
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except ratios)   
Insurance
Reinsurance
Services 
Total
 


     

     
     

 
Corporate and other:                   
Investment income, general operations                $  798,805  
Net realized and unrealized gains on investments and                   
   investment derivatives (1)                  225,307  
Net income from investment and operating affiliates                  211,404  
Interest expense (2)                  187,457  
Amortization of intangible assets                  10,752  
Corporate operating expenses                  176,909  
Minority interest                  (221 ) 
Income tax                  49,284  


 
Net loss                $  (1,251,976 ) 


 
Ratios – General operations (3):                   
Loss and loss expense ratio    112.0 %    99.7 %          107.1 % 
Underwriting expense ratio    25.0 %    27.3 %          25.8 % 

 
 

 
Combined ratio    137.0 %    127.0 %          132.9 % 

 
 

 


(1)      This includes net realized gains on investments of $241.9 million and net realized and unrealized losses on investment derivatives of $(16.6) million.
(2) Interest expense excludes interest expense related to life and annuity operations shown separately.
(3) Ratios are based on net premium earned from general operations excluding fee income and other. The underwriting expense ratio excludes exchange gains and losses.
(4) Operating expenses exclude corporate operating expenses, shown separately.
 

128


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Segment Information (continued)

     The following is an analysis of results by segment together with a reconciliation to net income or loss:

   
Financial
 
Year Ended December 31, 2004:   
Products and
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except ratios)   
Insurance
Reinsurance
Services
Total
 


       

       

       

 
General Operations:                       
   Net premiums earned    $  4,054,795     $ 2,933,145     $      $  6,987,940  
   Fee income and other      23,461     223             23,684  
   Net losses and loss expenses      2,859,854     1,937,001             4,796,855  
   Acquisition costs      537,106     648,430             1,185,536  
   Operating expenses (4)      531,502     190,750             722,252  
   Exchange gains      (9,907 )    (27,102 )            (37,009 ) 


 

 

 

 
   Underwriting profit    $  159,701     $ 184,289     $      $  343,990  


 

 

 

 
Life and Annuity Operations:                       
   Life premiums earned    $      $ 1,365,176     $      $  1,365,176  
   Fee income and other          293             293  
   Claims and policy benefits          $ 1,480,535             1,480,535  
   Acquisition costs          48,830             48,830  
   Operating expenses (4)          14,071             14,071  
   Exchange gains          (499 )            (499 ) 
   Net investment income          205,863             205,863  
   Interest expense          (6 )            (6 ) 


 

 

 

 
   Net income from life and annuity operations    $      $ 28,401     $      $  28,401  


 

 

 

 
Financial Operations:                       
   Net premiums earned              $  228,898     $  228,898  
   Fee income and other                11,340       11,340  
   Net losses and loss expenses                114,633       114,633  
   Acquisition costs                30,498       30,498  
   Operating expenses (4)                69,934       69,934  
   Exchange gains                (3,170 )      (3,170 ) 


 

 
   Underwriting profit              $  28,343     $  28,343  
   Net investment income – financial guarantee                40,780       40,780  
   Net investment income – structured products                174,241       174,241  
   Interest expense – structured products                113,523       113,523  
   Operating expenses – structured products (4)                50,230       50,230  
   Net income from financial affiliates                20,668       20,668  
   Minority interest                8,708       8,708  
   Net results from derivatives                49,481       49,481  


 

 
   Contribution from financial operations              $  141,052     $  141,052  


 

 

129


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Segment Information (continued)

   
Financial 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2004:   
Products and 
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except ratios)   
Insurance
Reinsurance
Services 
Total
 


     

     
     

 
Net investment income – general operations                $  614,128  
Net realized and unrealized gains on investments and                   
   derivative instruments (1)                  270,559  
Net income from investment and operating affiliates                  250,697  
Interest expense (2)                  178,717  
Amortization of intangible assets                  15,827  
Corporate operating expenses                  196,648  
Minority interest                  (321 ) 
Income tax                  91,343  


 
Net income                $  1,166,613  


 
Ratios – General operations (3):                   
Loss and loss expense ratio    70.5 %    66.0 %          68.6 % 
Underwriting expense ratio    26.4 %    28.6 %          27.3 % 

 
 

 
Combined ratio    96.9 %    94.6 %          95.9 % 

 
 

 


(1)      This includes net realized gains on investments of $246.5 million and net realized and unrealized gains on investment derivatives of $24.0 million.
(2) Interest expense excludes interest expense related to life and annuity operations shown separately.
(3) Ratios are based on net premium earned from general operations excluding fee income and other. The underwriting expense ratio excludes exchange gains and losses.
(4) Operating expenses exclude corporate operating expenses, shown separately.
 

130


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Segment Information (continued)

   
Financial 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2003:   
Products and 
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except ratios)   
Insurance
Reinsurance
Services 
Total
 


       

       

     

 
General Operations:                         
   Net premiums earned    $  3,611,444      $  2,478,134     $      $  6,089,578  
   Fee income and other      13,103       2,121             15,224  
   Net losses and loss expenses      2,371,195       2,224,797             4,595,992  
   Acquisition costs      536,293       566,873             1,103,166  
   Operating expenses (4)      409,406       147,667             557,073  
   Exchange (gains)      (8,042 )      (30,793 )            (38,835 ) 


 

 



 
   Underwriting profit (loss)    $  315,695      $  (428,289 )    $      $  (112,594 ) 


 

 



 
Life and Annuity Operations:                         
   Life premiums earned    $       $  708,994     $      $  708,994  
   Fee income and other            1,368             1,368  
   Claims and policy benefits            791,454             791,454  
   Acquisition costs            36,636             36,636  
   Operating expenses (4)            7,674             7,674  
   Exchange gains            (387 )            (387 ) 
   Net investment income            138,267             138,267  


 

 



 
   Net income from life and annuity operations    $       $  13,252     $      $  13,252  


 

 



 
Financial Operations:                         
   Net premiums earned                $  195,344    $  195,344  
   Fee income and other                  25,153      25,153  
   Net losses and loss expenses                  100,435      100,435  
   Acquisition costs                  27,384      27,384  
   Operating expenses (4)                  47,209      47,209  
   Exchange losses                  603      603  




 
   Underwriting profit                $  44,866    $  44,866  
   Net investment income – financial guarantee                $  23,273    $  23,273  
   Net investment income – structured products                  111,873      111,873  
   Interest expense – structured products                  98,022      98,022  
   Operating expenses – structured products                  40,785      40,785  
   Net income from financial and investment affiliates                  47,478      47,478  
   Minority interest                  11,424      11,424  
   Net results from derivatives                  7,983      7,983  




 
   Contribution from financial operations                $  85,242    $  85,242  




 

131


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Segment Information (continued)

   
Financial 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2003:   
Products and 
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except ratios)   
Insurance
Reinsurance
Services 
Total
 


     


     

     


 
Corporate and other:               
 
Net investment income – general operations               
$ 
542,074  
Net realized and unrealized gains on investments and               
 
   derivative instruments (1)               
118,285  
Net income from investment and operating affiliates               
80,644  
Interest expense (2)               
135,907  
Corporate operating expenses               
145,085  
Income tax and other               
33,932  


 
Net income               
$ 
411,979  


 
Ratios – General operations (3):               
 
Loss and loss expense ratio    65.7 %    89.8 %       
75.5 % 
Underwriting expense ratio    26.2 %    28.8 %       
27.3 % 

 
 

 
Combined ratio    91.9 %    118.6 %       
102.8 % 

 
 

 


(1)      This includes net realized gains on investments of $120.2 million and net realized and unrealized losses on investment derivatives of $1.9 million.
(2) Interest expense excludes interest expense related to life and annuity operations.
(3) Ratios are based on net premiums earned from general operations, excluding fee income and other. The underwriting expense ratio excludes exchange gains and losses.
(4) Operating expenses exclude corporate operating expenses, shown separately.
 

132


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Segment Information (continued)

     The following tables summarize the Company’s net premiums earned by line of business:

Insurance   
For the year ended 
   
December 31, 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005 
2004 
2003 






General Operations:   
   
   
 
     Professional liability   
$
1,451,183   
$
1,361,013   
$
937,317 
     Other casualty   
1,081,994   
1,001,376   
1,018,471 
     Property catastrophe   
57,027   
40,713   
 
     Other property   
557,080   
594,867   
505,154 
     Marine, energy, aviation and satellite   
739,841   
889,170   
784,885 
     Accident and health   
1,692   
11,235   
55,893 
     Other (1)   
213,880   
156,421   
309,724 






Total General Operations   
$
4,102,697   
$
4,054,795   
$
3,611,444 
Life and Annuity Operations   
   
   
 
Financial Operations   
   
   
 






Total   
$
4,102,697   
$
4,054,795   
$
3,611,444 
 






(1)      Other, includes political risk, surety, bonding, warranty and other lines.   
   
   
 
 
Reinsurance   
For the year ended 
   
December 31, 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005 
2004 
2003 


     

     

General Operations:   
   
   
 
     Professional liability   
$
356,937   
$
375,582   
$
213,555 
     Other casualty   
858,651   
871,155   
757,602 
     Property catastrophe   
302,291   
304,057   
245,860 
     Other property   
701,459   
783,502   
761,768 
     Marine, energy, aviation and satellite   
194,646   
204,500   
191,344 
     Accident and health   
31,399   
42,706   
30,628 
     Other (1)   
325,558   
351,643   
277,377 






Total General Operations   
$
2,770,941   
$
2,933,145   
$
2,478,134 
Life and Annuity Operations   
$
2,237,721   
$
1,365,176   
708,994 
Financial Operations   
   
   
 






Total   
$
5,008,662   
$
4,298,321   
$
3,187,128 








(1)      Other, includes workers compensation, political risk, surety, bonding, warranty and other lines.

133


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

3. Segment Information (continued)

     The following table shows an analysis of the Company’s net premiums written by geographical location of subsidiary where the premium is written for the years ended December 31:

General and financial operations:   
2005 
2004 
2003 


          

          

Bermuda   
$
1,005,017 
 
$
1,137,543 
  $  1,427,246 
United States   
3,498,113 
 
3,640,460 
    3,246,547 
Europe and other   
2,877,426 
 
2,817,393 
    2,240,255 






     Total general and financial operations 
 
$
7,380,556 
 
$
7,595,396 
  $  6,914,048 






Life and annuity operations:   
 
     
Bermuda   
$
266,433 
 
$
278,448 
  $  84,089 
Europe and other   
1,970,470 
 
1,084,683 
    618,018 






     Total life and annuity operations 
 
$
2,236,903 
 
$
1,363,131 
  $  702,107 






Total   
$
9,617,459 
 
$
8,958,527 
  $  7,616,155 







4. Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

     The following table shows an analysis of intangible assets broken down between goodwill, intangible assets with an indefinite life and intangible assets with a definite life for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003:

   
Intangible
Intangible
 
   
assets with an 
assets with a
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Goodwill
indefinite life 
definite life
Total
 


       

     

       

 
Balance at December 31, 2002 
 
$
1,598,136    
$
26,961    $  28,603    
$
1,653,700  
   Additions   
179,391    
      15,945    
195,336  
   Amortization   
   
      (4,637 )   
(4,637 ) 
   Foreign Currency Translation   
1,108    
         
1,108  


 



 

 
Balance at December 31, 2003 
 
$
1,778,635    
$
26,961    $  39,911    
$
1,845,507  
   Amortization (1)   
   
      (18,544 )   
(18,544 ) 
   Foreign Currency Translation   
819    
         
819  


 



 

 
Balance at December 31, 2004 
 
$
1,779,454    
$
26,961    $  21,367    
$
1,827,782  
   Amortization   
   
      (10,752 )   
(10,752 ) 
   Foreign Currency Translation   
(2,486 )   
         
(2,486 ) 


 



 

 
Balance at December 31, 2005 
 
$
1,776,968    
$
26,961    $  10,615    
$
1,814,544  


 



 

 


(1)      Amortization of intangible assets includes $2.7 million related to an acquired block of business expensed through acquisition costs

     As at December 31, 2005 goodwill and other intangible assets related to the insurance segment was $450.0 million, the reinsurance segment was $1.38 billion and the financial products and services segment was $4.6 million.

134


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

5. Business Combinations

     (a) Le Mans Ré

     Effective January 1, 2002, the Company consolidated its investment in Le Mans Ré after increasing its ownership from 49% to 67% in order to expand its international reinsurance operations. Le Mans Ré underwrites a worldwide portfolio comprising most classes of property and casualty reinsurance business, together with a selective portfolio of life reinsurance business. On September 3, 2003, the Company exercised its option to buy the remaining 33% ownership from Les Mutuelles du Mans Assurances Group (“MMA”) for approximately $161 million in cash and changed the name of Le Mans Ré to XL Re Europe. Due to certain contractual arrangements between the Company and MMA, MMA did not have any economic interest in the earnings of XL Re Europe with effect from January 1, 2002 and accordingly, no minority interest was recorded since that date.

     The cost of the acquisition for the increase in ownership from 49% to 67% in 2002 was approximately $188.5 million. Goodwill arising from the acquisition was approximately $52.6 million. The Company recognized goodwill in excess of the fair value of XL Re Europe’s net assets to increase its European franchise for its reinsurance operations. Cash paid, net of cash acquired, amounted to $45.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2002.

     Pro forma financial information and condensed balance sheet information are not presented for the acquisition of XL Re Europe because the results of XL Re Europe’s operations are not significant to the consolidated balance sheet or consolidated results of operations of the Company.

     (b) Winterthur International

     On July 25, 2001, the Company completed the acquisition of certain Winterthur International insurance operations (the “Winterthur Business”) primarily to extend its predominantly North American-based large corporate insurance business globally. The Company provisionally paid to Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company (“WSIC”) $405.6 million at closing for the Winterthur Business based on the audited U.S. GAAP financial statements of the Winterthur Business as at December 31, 2000 and the price was subject to final determination based on the audited U.S. GAAP financial statements of the acquired Winterthur Business operations as at June 30, 2001. In December 2003, the Company reached an agreement with WSIC as to the final purchase price, which was $330.2 million. As a result, $75.4 million in cash was returned to the Company.

     Under the terms of the Sale and Purchase Agreement, as amended, between XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and WSIC, (the “SPA”) WSIC provided the Company with post-closing protection determined as of June 30, 2004 with respect to, among other things, adverse development of reserves and premium Winterthur Business. This protection was based upon net loss experience and development over a three-year, post-closing seasoning period based on actual loss development experience, collectible reinsurance and certain other factors set forth in the SPA. The SPA included a process for determining the amount due from WSIC by an independent actuarial process whereby the Independent Actuary develops a value of the seasoned net reserves. The actual final seasoned amount is the submission that is closest to the number developed by the Independent Actuary.

     As the Company and WSIC were unable to come to an agreement, the Company submitted to WSIC notice to trigger the independent actuarial process as contemplated by the SPA. On February 3, 2005, both the Company and WSIC made submissions for the independent actuarial process. The Company’s submission would have resulted in a net payable to the Company of approximately $1.4 billion in aggregate and WSIC submission would have resulted in a net payable to the Company of $541 million in aggregate.

     On December 6, 2005 the Company received the report from the Independent Actuary in connection with the Company’s post-closing protection. The Independent Actuary’s report concluded that WSIC submitted Seasoned Net

135


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

5. Business Combinations (continued)

     (b) Winterthur International (continued)

Reserve Amount (“SNRA”) and Net Premium Receivable Amount (“NPRA”) were closest to the Independent Actuary’s determinations of SNRA and NPRA. These determinations resulted in the Company receiving a net lump sum payment in the amount of approximately $575.0 million (including interest receivable) from WSIC. As the Company had recorded $1.4 billion in unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable related to this protection, a loss of approximately $808.9 million, net of interest, was recorded in the fourth quarter of 2005.

     In addition, WSIC provides protection to the Company with respect to third party reinsurance receivables and recoverables related to the Winterthur Business, which were $1.6 billion in the aggregate as of December 31, 2005. There are two levels of protection from WSIC for these balances:

      1.      At the time of the Winterthur International acquisition, WSIC provided to the Company a liquidity facility. At the time of the payment of the net reserve seasoned amount on December 12, 2005, the Company exercised its right to repay up to the balances outstanding on this facility by assignment to WSIC of an equal amount of receivables relating to reinsurance recoverables selected by the Company. During December 2005, the Company assigned $265.4 million of receivables to WSIC under this arrangement, although WSIC has disputed the assignment of certain of these receivables.
     
  2. Under two retrocession agreements the Company has reinsurance protection on the reinsurance recoverables with respect to the SNRA determined as of June 30, 2004 to the extent that the Company does not receive payment of such amounts from applicable reinsurers with one agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to June 30, 2001 and the other agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to December 31, 2000.

     At December 31, 2005, certain reinsurers responsible for some portions of the reinsurance of the Winterthur Business have raised issues as to whether amounts claimed are due and discussions are currently ongoing to achieve a resolution.

     The acquisition was accounted for under the purchase method of accounting and, therefore, the identifiable assets and liabilities of the Winterthur Business were recorded at their estimated fair value on June 30, 2001. The process of determining the fair value of such assets and liabilities acquired, as required under purchase accounting, included management’s estimates and independent valuations. The purchase price was preliminarily allocated to the acquired assets and liabilities based upon their estimated fair value at June 30, 2001. The excess of the purchase price over acquired tangible net assets was then applied to intangible assets with finite and indefinite lives.

     This information primarily related to loss reserves, adjustment and reinstatement premiums, reinsurance balances payable and receivable and other assets and liabilities. Once the final excess purchase price was known, the Company amended the amount attributed to goodwill by $171.0 million. The agreement reached with WSIC as to the final purchase price and related adjustments represents the completion of the Company’s allocations to the fair value of net assets. Any subsequent adjustments to the carrying value will be reflected in income in the year in which the adjustments are made.

     The revised fair value of significant assets and liabilities acquired by the Company includes $89.4 million of cash, $2.2 billion of invested assets, $1.3 billion of premiums receivable, $1.5 billion of unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable, $2.8 billion of unpaid losses and loss expenses, $885 million of unearned premiums and $506

136


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

5. Business Combinations (continued)

     (b) Winterthur International (continued)

million of reinsurance balances payable. The contractual post-closing protection was considered in these fair value estimates.

     Allocation of the purchase price was as follows:

(U.S. dollars in thousands)       
Fair value of assets acquired    $  5,011,162 
Fair value of liabilities acquired      4,873,327 


Fair value of tangible net assets acquired    $  137,835 
Fair value of intangible assets acquired      29,800 
Goodwill related to the acquisition      185,023 


    $  352,658 


Revised purchase price    $  330,158 
Other costs of acquisition      22,500 


    $  352,658 



     The Company recognized goodwill in excess of the fair value of the net assets of the acquired Winterthur International insurance operations to increase its global platform for its insurance operations.

     The Company estimated the total value of intangible assets acquired at $29.8 million, including $14.7 million for insurance licenses and sales force, which have an indefinite life and are not therefore subject to amortization. The remaining $15.1 million relates to the value of business in force, which is estimated to have a finite life of up to nine years and is being amortized over that period.

6. Investments

     Net investment income is derived from the following sources:

Year Ended December 31   
   
   
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


            

            

 
Fixed maturities, short-term investments and cash equivalents   
$
1,420,557    
$
1,032,936    
$
806,656  
Equity securities and other investments   
94,974    
31,502    
21,948  
Funds withheld   
19,722    
23,196    
23,596  


 

 

 
   Total gross investment income   
1,535,253    
1,087,634    
852,200  
Investment expenses   
(60,214 )   
(52,622 )   
(36,713 ) 


 

 

 
Net investment income   
$
1,475,039    
$
1,035,012    
$
815,487  


 

 

 

137



XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

6. Investments (continued)

     The following represents an analysis of net realized gains (losses) and the change in unrealized appreciation on investments:

Year Ended December 31   
             
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
Net realized gains (losses):   
             
Fixed maturities, short-term investments, cash and cash equivalents: 
 
             
   Gross realized gains   
$
401,163    
$ 
414,918    
$ 
451,967  
   Gross realized losses   
(250,839 )      (265,854 )      (344,831 ) 


 

 

 
       Net realized gains   
150,324       149,064       107,136  
Equity securities:   
             
   Gross realized gains   
145,659       146,711       183,705  
   Gross realized losses   
(54,081 )      (48,793 )      (162,556 ) 


 

 

 
       Net realized gains   
91,578       97,918       21,149  
Write-down of other investments (see Note 8)   
(20 )      (435 )      (8,090 ) 


 

 

 
Net realized gains (losses) on investments   
241,882       246,547       120,195  
Net realized and unrealized (losses) gains    
             
   on investment derivative instruments   
(16,575 )      24,012       (1,910 ) 


 

 

 
Net realized gains (losses) on investments and net realized and   
             
   unrealized gains (losses) on investment derivative instruments   
225,307       270,559       118,285  


 

 

 
Change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation):   
             
   Fixed maturities and short-term investments   
(350,742 )      165,377       139,321  
   Equity securities   
(12,860 )      74,465       196,705  
   Affiliates and other investments   
25,437       (13,021 )      (3,418 ) 


 

 

 
Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation)   
             
   on investments, gross of tax   
(338,165 )      226,821       332,608  
   Change in deferred income tax liability (benefit)   
23,446       (27,909 )      20,111  


 

 

 
Net change in unrealized appreciation (depreciation)   
             
   on investments, net of tax   
(314,719 )      198,912       352,719  


 

 

 
Total net realized (losses) gains and change in   
             
   unrealized appreciation (depreciation) on investments   
             
   and investment derivative instruments, gross of tax   
$
(112,858 )    $  497,380     $  450,893  


 

 

 

     Net realized gains and losses in 2005 and 2004 included a loss of $53.2 million and $6.4 million, respectively, relating to certain fixed income, equity securities and other investments where the Company determined that there was an other than temporary decline in the value of those investments.

     The total amount of other than temporary declines in value in 2005 related to $47.2 million on fixed income securities and $6.0 million on equity securities.

     The total amount of other than temporary declines in value in 2004 related to $4.1 million on fixed income securities, $1.9 million on equity securities and $0.4 million on other investments.

138


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

6. Investments (continued)

     The cost (amortized cost for fixed maturities and short-term investments), market value, gross unrealized gains and gross unrealized (losses) of investments are as follows:

   
Cost or 
Gross 
Gross
December 31, 2005   
Amortized 
Unrealized 
Unrealized
Market 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Cost 
Gains 
Losses
Value 


     

     


     

Fixed maturities                       
   U.S. Government and Government agency    $  4,508,821   
$
31,042    $  (42,859 )    $  4,497,004 
   Corporate      13,036,950   
372,414      (116,472 )      13,292,892 
   Mortgage and asset-backed securities      11,744,565   
27,587      (120,046 )      11,652,106 
   U.S. States and political subdivisions of the States      71,237   
968      (1,012 )      71,193 
   Non-U.S. Sovereign Government      2,622,503   
196,037      (22,170 )      2,796,370 






 

       Total fixed maturities    $  31,984,076   
$
628,048    $  (302,559 )    $  32,309,565 






 

       Total short-term investments    $  2,552,589   
$
3,646    $  (10,162 )    $  2,546,073 






 

Total equity securities    $  696,858   
$
180,763    $  (8,820 )    $  868,801 






 

 
   
Cost or 
Gross 
Gross
December 31, 2004   
Amortized 
Unrealized 
Unrealized
Market 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Cost 
Gains 
Losses
Value 









Fixed maturities                       
   U.S. Government and Government agency    $  4,087,004   
$
52,104    $  (27,033 )    $  4,112,075 
   Corporate      10,945,675    449,437      (45,265 )      11,349,847 
   Mortgage and asset-backed securities      6,922,506    47,228      (41,176 )      6,928,558 
   U.S. States and political subdivisions of the States      61,987    1,380      (311 )      63,056 
   Non-U.S. Sovereign Government      2,435,176    212,546      (1,064 )      2,646,658 






 

       Total fixed maturities    $  24,452,348   
$
762,695    $  (114,849 )    $  25,100,194 






 

       Total short-term investments    $  1,738,845   
$
26,686    $  (4,817 )    $  1,760,714 






 

Total equity securities    $  778,117   
$
192,019    $  (7,216 )    $  962,920 






 


     The Company has gross unrealized losses which it considers to be temporary impairments. Individual security positions comprising this balance have been evaluated by management, based on specified criteria, to determine if these impairments should be considered other than temporary. These criteria include an assessment of the severity and length of time securities have been impaired, along with management’s ability and intent to hold the securities to recovery, among other factors. At December 31, 2005, there were $312.7 million of gross unrealized losses on fixed income and short-term investments, and $8.8 million of gross unrealized losses on equity securities. At December 31, 2004, there were $119.7 million of gross unrealized losses on fixed income and short-term investments, and $ 7.2 million of gross unrealized losses on equity securities. At December 31, 2005, approximately 2.4% of the Company’s fixed income investment portfolio was invested in securities which were below investment grade or not rated. At December 31, 2004, approximately 4.6% of the Company’s fixed income investment portfolio was invested in securities which were below investment grade or not rated. Approximately 4.3% of the unrealized losses in the Company’s fixed income securities portfolio at December 31, 2005 related to securities that were below investment grade or not rated. The information shown below about the unrealized losses on the Company’s investments at December 31, 2005 concerns the potential affect upon future earnings and financial position should management later conclude that some of the current declines in the fair value of these investments are other than temporary declines.

139


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

6. Investments (continued)

     The following is an analysis of how long each of those securities at December 31, 2005 had been in a continual unrealized loss position:

   
Equal to or greater 
   
Less than 12 months 
than 12 months 





   
Gross 
Gross 
December 31, 2005   
Unrealized 
Unrealized 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Market Value 
Losses 
Market Value 
Losses 


     

     

     

Fixed maturities (including short-term investments) 
 
   
   
   
   
   U.S. Government and Government agency   
$
3,298,196   
$
27,478   
$
683,317   
$
14,348 
   Corporate   
4,613,170   
97,099   
886,439   
21,716 
   Mortgage and asset-backed securities   
6,070,695   
83,077   
1,601,167   
45,340 
   U.S. States and political subdivisions of the States   
12,233   
145   
29,483   
  814 
   Non-U.S. Sovereign Government   
894,682   
21,779   
31,159   
  925 









       Total fixed maturities   
$
14,888,976   
$
229,578   
$
3,231,565   
$
83,143 








Total equity securities   
$
103,185   
$
8,820   
$
   
$
        










     The following is an analysis of how long each of those securities at December 31, 2004 had been in a continual unrealized loss position:

   
Equal to or greater 
   
Less than 12 months 
than 12 months 




   
Gross 
Gross 
December 31, 2004   
Unrealized 
Unrealized 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Market Value 
Losses 
Market Value 
Losses 


     

     

     

Fixed maturities (including short-term investments) 
 
   
   
   
 
   U.S. Government and Government agency   
$
2,633,868   
$
15,861   
$
283,225   
$
13,350 
   Corporate   
2,630,379   
38,463   
242,146   
7,753 
   Mortgage and asset backed securities   
3,458,073   
34,498   
310,427   
8,390 
   U.S. States and political subdivisions of the States   
21,888   
232   
423   
5 
   Non-U.S. Sovereign Government   
126,846   
942   
12,983   
172 








       Total fixed maturities   
$
8,871,054   
$
89,996   
$
849,204   
$
29,670 








Total equity securities   
$
86,251   
$
5,354   
$
10,531   
$
1,862 









140


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

6. Investments (continued)

     The contractual maturities of fixed maturity securities are shown below. Actual maturities may differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.

   
December 31, 2005 
December 31, 2004 




   
Amortized 
Market 
Amortized 
Market 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Cost 
Value 
Cost 
Value 


     

     

     

Due after 1 through 5 years   
$
7,479,627 
 
$
7,425,344 
 
$
6,651,255    $
6,781,511 
Due after 5 through 10 years   
5,892,285 
 
5,905,123 
 
4,948,847   
5,130,622 
Due after 10 years   
6,867,599 
 
7,326,992 
 
5,929,740   
6,259,503 
Mortgage and asset-backed securities   
11,744,565 
 
11,652,106 
 
6,922,506   
6,928,558 








   
$
31,984,076 
 
$
32,309,565 
 
$
24,452,348   
$
25,100,194 









     At December 31, 2005 and 2004, approximately $377.4 million and $109.8 million, respectively, of securities included in investments available for sale were loaned to various counter-parties through the Company’s securities lending program. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, approximately $386.5 million and $111.8 million, respectively, of cash collateral held in connection with these loans, is included in cash and cash equivalents, with a corresponding liability reflected in net payable for investments purchased.

     At December 31, 2005 and 2004, approximately $603.8 million and $463.2 million, respectively, of securities were on deposit with various U.S. state or government insurance departments in order to comply with relevant insurance regulations.

     The Company has three facilities available for the issue of letters of credit collateralized against the Company’s investment portfolio with a value of $904.9 million at December 31, 2005 and $1.3 billion at December 31, 2004. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, approximately $182.9 million and $198.5 million, respectively, of letters of credit were issued and outstanding under these facilities.

     The fair values of securities on loan at December 31, 2005 and 2004 are detailed below.

(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005 
 
2004 


          

Fixed maturities   
$
349,131   
$
100,007 
Equities   
28,307   
9,839 




Total   
$
377,438   
$
109,846 





141


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

7. Investments in Affiliates

     The Company’s investment in affiliates and equity in net income (loss) from such affiliates are summarized below:

   
December 31, 2005 
December 31, 2004 
December 31, 2003
 






 
   
Equity in 
Equity in 
Equity in
 
   
Net Income 
Net Income 
Net Income
 
   
Carrying 
(Loss) for 
Carrying 
(Loss) for 
Carrying 
(Loss) for
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Value 
the Year 
Value 
the Year 
Value 
the Year
 


     

     

     

     

     

 
Investment affiliates   
$
1,727,612   
$
154,844   
$
1,671,091   
$
124,008   
$
1,590,530   
$
119,200  
Operating affiliates:   
   
   
   
   
   
 
Financial affiliates   
122,162   
5,055   
111,987   
12,822   
147,281   
36,754  
Insurance affiliates   
22,490   
9,823   
17,471   
55,575   
42,600   
(42,533 ) 
Investment management affiliates .   
174,457   
52,548   
136,303   
78,960   
122,930   
14,702  












 
Total   
$
2,046,721   
$
222,270   
$
1,936,852   
$
271,365   
$
1,903,341   
$
128,123  












 

     The Company has invested in certain closed end funds, certain limited partnerships, LLC’s and similar investment vehicles, including funds managed by certain of its investment management affiliates. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, investments in affiliates were $1.7 billion of which $1.5 billion was included in the alternative investment portfolio and $0.2 billion consisted of private investments.

     The Company’s significant financial affiliate investments at December 31, 2005 included Primus Guaranty, Ltd. with ownership of 31%.

     The Company’s insurance affiliate investments at December 31, 2005 included American Strategic Holdings, with ownership in this entity at 48.5% .

     During 2005, the Company recorded other than temporary loss in the value of One Capital Management Partners of $2.5 million. The net income from insurance affiliates in 2004 included other than temporary declines in the values of Insurance Vianet and Venturion Noodle LLC of $19.0 million and $2.0 million, respectively. The net loss from insurance affiliates in 2003 included an other than temporary decline of $40.9 million in the first quarter of 2003 in the value of the Company’s investment in Annuity & Life Re (Holdings), Ltd. (“ANNRF”). The investment was written down to its fair market value.

     The significant investment management affiliates include Highfields Capital Management LP, a global equity investment firm, MKP Capital Management, a fixed income investment manager, specializing in mortgage-backed securities, FrontPoint Partners LLC, an integrated alternative asset firm, Stanfield Capital Partners, a credit-oriented asset management firm specializing in event-driven strategies and Clo’s, Stanfield Global Strategies, a structured investment vehicle and conduit manager, One Capital Management Partners, an alternative strategy distribution business firm, Banquo Credit Management LLC, a European credit based asset management firm, and Artemis Advisor LLC, a U.S. focused equity firm. During 2004, the Company sold its interest in Pareto Partners L.P. and its affiliated entities, a currency overlay and fixed income manager, resulting in income of $35.4 million.

     In certain investments, the carrying value is different from the share of the investee’s underlying net assets. The difference represents goodwill on acquisition. Adoption of FAS 142 with effect from January 1, 2002 has resulted in the Company ceasing to amortize goodwill and certain intangible assets.

     See Note 18(c) for further information.

142


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

8. Other Investments

     Other investments include investments over which the Company does not have significant influence and whose fair value is generally unquoted. This includes investments in limited partnerships where the Company does not participate in the management of the partnerships, and investments in non-rated collateralized debt/equity instruments. Income from other investments was $55.0 million and $16.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Unrealized gains from these limited partnerships was $7.5 million and $0.2 million as at December 31, 2005 and 2004 respectively. Income on unrated tranches of collateral debt obligations is reflected only to the extent the Company’s principal has been fully recovered. Income on alternative investments included in other investments is realized only on ultimate sale of these investments. The Company had unrealized gains of $19.3 million and $1.2 million, respectively, at December 31, 2005 and 2004, related to these alternative investments.

See Note 18(b) for further information.

     The Company regularly reviews the performance of these other investments.

     The Company recorded losses of $0.02 million, $0.4 million and $8.1 million in the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively, due to other than temporary declines in values of these other investments.

9. Losses and Loss Expenses

     Unpaid losses and loss expenses for the Company’s general and financial operations are comprised of:

Year Ended December 31             
(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005    2004    2003 


     

     

Reserve for reported losses and loss expenses   
$
10,612,878 
 
$
9,714,708 
 
$
8,606,722 
Reserve for losses incurred but not reported   
13,154,794 
 
10,122,961 
 
8,156,402 






Unpaid losses and loss expenses   
$
23,767,672 
 
$
19,837,669 
 
$
16,763,124 







     Net losses and loss expenses incurred for general and financial operations are comprised of:

Year Ended December 31                   
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
Loss and loss expenses payments   
$ 
4,839,737    
$ 
4,918,268    
$ 
3,921,985  
Change in unpaid losses and loss expenses   
4,751,802    
2,959,412    
2,940,610  
Change in unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable   
103,433    
(1,114,261 )   
(853,467 ) 
Paid loss recoveries   
(2,229,971 )   
(1,851,931 )   
(1,039,701 ) 


 

 

 
Net losses and loss expenses incurred   
$ 
7,465,001    
$ 
4,911,488    
$ 
4,969,427  


 

 

 

143


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

9. Losses and Loss Expenses (continued)

     The following table represents an analysis of paid and unpaid losses and loss expenses incurred and a reconciliation of the beginning and ending unpaid losses and loss expenses for the years indicated:

Year Ended December 31   
   
   
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005    
2004    
2003  


 

 

 
Unpaid losses and loss expenses at beginning of year   
$
19,837,669    
$
16,763,124    
$
13,332,502  
Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable   
6,962,131    
(6,042,505 )   
(5,019,311 ) 


 

 

 
Net unpaid losses and loss expenses at beginning of year   
12,875,538    
10,720,619    
8,313,191  
Increase (decrease) in net losses and loss expenses incurred in respect   
   
   
 
   of losses occurring in:   
   
   
 
   Current year   
6,351,281    
4,643,894    
3,759,142  
   Prior years   
1,113,720    
267,594    
937,285  


 

 

 
       Total net incurred losses and loss expenses   
7,465,001    
4,911,488    
4,696,427  
Exchange rate effects   
(375,749 )   
309,768    
394,121  
Net loss reserves acquired   
   
   
199,164  
Less net losses and loss expenses paid in respect of losses occurring in:   
   
   
 
   Current year   
602,153    
1,081,547    
360,767  
   Prior years   
2,007,613    
1,984,790    
2,521,517  


 

 

 
       Total net paid losses   
2,609,766    
3,066,337    
2,882,284  
Net unpaid losses and loss expenses at end of year   
17,355,024    
12,875,538    
10,720,619  
Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable   
6,412,648    
6,962,131    
6,042,505  


 

 

 
Unpaid losses and loss expenses at end of year   
$
23,767,672    
$
19,837,669    
$
16,763,124  


 

 

 

Prior year net losses incurred

     The following table presents the net adverse (favorable) development of reserves analyzed by each of the Company’s operating segments:

(U.S. dollars in millions)   
2005   
2004 
   
2003 
 




 

 
Insurance Segment   
$ 
1,020   
$ 
292    
$ 
153  
Reinsurance Segment   
94   
(24 )   
799  
Financial Products and Services Segment   
   
   
(15 ) 




 

 
Total   
$ 
1,114   
$ 
268    
$ 
937  




 

 

     The significant developments in prior year loss reserve year estimates for each the years indicated within each of the Company’s operating segments are discussed below.

     Insurance Segment

     During 2005, the insurance segment’s net adverse prior year development of $1.02 billion includes $834.2 million of incurred loss related to the conclusion of the independent actuarial process with WSIC. Excluding this development the remaining $185.8 million was driven primarily by increases in reported case reserves for excess professional liability. Strengthening of $259.5 million in professional lines was caused primarily by the establishment of case reserves on both directors’ and officers’ claims in pre-2002 business, and errors and omissions claims.

144


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

9. Losses and Loss Expenses (continued)

Strengthening of $34.7 million within other specialty lines was caused primarily by increases in reported losses for specialty lines of business currently in run-off including certain Lloyd’s business, discontinued programs business, and surety. A net release of $112.5 million for global risks lines of business was driven by the reduction in case reserves for pre-2002 claims primarily relating to casualty business written out of Europe.

     During 2004, the Company’s net adverse prior year development of $292 million was affected by increases in reported case reserves for excess professional liability, excess casualty liability and specialty lines. These increases in reported case reserves exceeded the Company’s expected losses based on historical patterns of loss development.

     Strengthening of $144 million in professional lines was caused by a few large directors’ and officers’ claims in pre-2002 business, while changes in errors and omissions reserves were caused by large accounting firms and exposure to insurance/reinsurance brokers. For specialty lines, strengthening of $135 million was caused by reported loss increased in discontinued programs business with workers’ compensation exposure environmental related coverages, and Lloyd’s; as well as high severity claims on the surety book.

     During 2003, the Company’s net adverse prior year development of $153 million was due primarily to increases in previously reported case reserves for excess professional liability lines of $143 million for the underwriting years 1997 through 2001. These increases in reported case reserves exceeded the Company’s expected losses based on historical patterns of loss development. Specifically, the increase related to reported case reserves for directors and officers and errors and omissions coverages. During 2003, there was an increase in the amount of litigation related to certain losses. In addition, there was adverse development of $37 million related to environmental business primarily for professional liability coverage underwritten in 2000 and 2001 that was offset by favorable development of $27 million primarily in aviation, property, marine and energy coverages.

     The Company did not change its methodology or key assumptions used in 2005, 2004 or 2003 to determine ultimate loss reserves for any line of insurance business written.

     There is no assurance that conditions and trends that have affected the development of liabilities in the past will continue. Accordingly, it may not be appropriate to extrapolate future redundancies or deficiencies based on the Company’s historical results.

Reinsurance Segment

     During 2005, net prior year reserves across the reinsurance segment developed adversely by $94 million. Reserve strengthening of $267 million in casualty and professional lines was partially offset by releases in other lines of business of $173 million. The casualty strengthening is primarily attributable to workers’ compensation, umbrella liability and certain professional lines of business written in the Company’s North American operations. The reserve releases relate primarily to the property line where releases of $136.0 million occurred across all business units globally in the 2002 to 2004 underwriting years. Releases also occurred in the marine and aviation classes of business across the reinsurance segment.

     The majority of the workers’ compensation reserve increase during 2005 was related to an XLRA working layer program written across multiple underwriting years with a single cedent. This program was not renewed at the end of 2001. Other than this program, XLRA has not written significant working layer workers’ compensation business. The remaining source of the Workers’ Compensation reserve strengthening relates to an update of the mortality tables used in our tabular reserving methodology.

145


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

9. Losses and Loss Expenses (continued)

     The remainder of the strengthening in the casualty and professional lines reserves was driven by a small number of increases in reported claims in the other liability and errors and omissions lines of business in the pre-1997 underwriting years as well as recently reported claims in umbrella liability, errors and omissions and directors and officers lines of business in the 1997-2001 underwriting years. The professional lines claims activity arises largely from a limited number of cedents. This reserve increase was partially offset by favorable development in the 1997-2001 underwriting years in the medical malpractice business line. Activity in the post-2001 underwriting years relates primarily to certain large individual claims affecting a number of lines, including surety, umbrella liability and errors and omissions.

     During 2004, net prior year reserves across the Reinsurance Segment developed favorably by $24 million. Releases of $144 million net in the property, aviation, marine and other lines of business were partially offset by strengthening of casualty and accident and health reserves amounted to approximately $120 million. Property catastrophe and property other reserve releases totaled approximately $95 million net related primarily to the 2002 and 2003 underwriting years where loss experience has been exceptionally good for the property line. The strengthening of casualty reserves totaled $75 million and related most significantly to professional liability reserves in the London branch which were strengthened by $32 million for Enron and Worldcom claims. The accident & health reserve strengthening of $45 million relates to a portfolio of business underwritten by certain of the Company’s Lloyd’s syndicates

     In the fourth quarter 2003, the Company reduced aviation loss reserves related to the September 11 event by $197.0 million. This reduction was due to higher than expected levels of participation (97%) in the September 11 Victim Compensation Fund, a no-fault compensation scheme funded by the U.S. Government which closed on December 22, 2003. This resulted in a reduction in the estimated ultimate losses by the Company for this event.

     During 2003, the Company increased its estimated reserves related to its reinsurance segment (excluding the September 11 event) by $996 million of which approximately $877 million related primarily to the Company’s North American reinsurance operations for casualty business underwritten during the 1997 through 2001 underwriting years. Of the $877 million, $184 million was recorded in the third quarter of 2003 and $663 million in the fourth quarter of 2003 as described below.

     The main lines of business affected by this adverse development included general liability, medical malpractice, professional and surety lines. As previously noted, the Company’s expected loss development is actuarially determined based on historical claims analysis and projected trends. Actual reported losses may vary from expected loss development from quarter to quarter. Generally, as an underwriting year matures, the level of newly reported claims decreases and typically, unless the Company receives additional reported claims that are significantly higher or lower than expected, estimated ultimate loss reserves are not adjusted prior to a full actuarial review. In the third quarter of 2003, the Company received a significant increase in reported claims that were in excess of the Company’s expected claims development. In addition, the Company completed an actuarial review for the longer-tail lines of this book of business, using data evaluated at March 31, 2003. As a result, the Company recorded an increase in loss reserves of $184.0 million in the third quarter of 2003. This adverse development has been due to several factors—competitive market pressures on pricing during these underwriting years caused premium rates for excess casualty business to decline industry wide and there has been an increase in the number and size of claims reported in recent years as a result of increases in court filings, corporate scandals, rising tort costs and settlement awards.

146


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

9. Losses and Loss Expenses (continued)

     As a result of this increase in prior period loss reserves in the third quarter of 2003, the Company completed an extensive claims audit review at the relevant ceding companies in order to obtain information to more accurately determine an estimate of the ultimate loss reserves for this book of business. The claims audit review included both internal and external resources, a comprehensive claims audit of the largest and most significant ceding companies, and a review of loss ratios and reserve analysis procedures. Additional case reserves and potential additional loss exposure were identified during the review and upon completion of the claims review, the Company recorded a further increase to net loss reserves of $663.0 million in the fourth quarter of 2003 primarily related to the Company’s North American casualty reinsurance business written in the 1997 through 2001 underwriting years. This comprised additional case reserves of $124.0 million and an increase in IBNR reserves of $539.0 million.

     As a result of the new information obtained in the claims audit review, the Company performed a supplemental analysis of its North American casualty reinsurance lines of business specific to the nature of individual cedent’s circumstances. The Company separately reviewed the historical loss development of its major cedents using several actuarial methodologies; where the analysis of a cedent’s experience concluded that the experience was worse than the Company’s historical loss development experience, the Company projected that cedent’s ultimate loss based on the cedent’s own experience. In addition, the Company assumed that the more recent experience was more indicative of future loss development by selecting development patterns that were based on the most recent experience rather than on the Company’s or cedent’s longer term historical experience.

     Prior year reserves also developed adversely on certain other casualty business written in the 1998 through 2001 underwriting years outside of North America. These exposures were affected by trends similar to those as described above for the North American casualty reinsurance operations. The casualty exposures underwritten in these entities were much less than those of the North American operations so the impact on the prior year reserves was relatively smaller.

     The Company has experienced significant adverse development in the casualty reinsurance business for the last several years and there can be no assurance that conditions and trends that have affected the development of liabilities in the past will not continue.

Financial Products and Services Segment

     The Company commenced writing financial guaranty business in 1998 and had relied entirely upon industry data to establish reserves until the end of 2001. The Company takes into account its actual historical loss experience and revised its estimated claim reporting pattern for the unallocated losses that the Company records during each loss year. The Company uses this expected loss reporting pattern, combined with changes in reported losses, to determine any prior year development amount.

Other loss information

     The Company’s net unpaid losses and loss expenses included estimates of actual and potential non-recoveries from reinsurers. As at December 31, 2005 and 2004, the reserve for potential non-recoveries from reinsurers was $260.7 million and $279.0 million, respectively.

     Except for certain workers’ compensation and long-term disability liabilities, the Company does not discount its unpaid losses and loss expenses. The Company utilizes tabular reserving for workers’ compensation and long-term disability unpaid losses that are considered fixed and determinable, and discounts such losses using an interest rate of

147


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

9. Losses and Loss Expenses (continued)

5% (2004: 5%). The interest rate approximates the average yield to maturity on specific fixed income investments that support these liabilities. The Company decreased the interest rate from 7% to 5% in 2003. The effect of the decrease in the interest rate resulted in an increase in loss reserves of approximately $35.0 million in 2003. The tabular reserving methodology results in applying uniform and consistent criteria for establishing expected future indemnity and medical payments (including an explicit factor for inflation) and the use of mortality tables to determine expected payment periods. Tabular unpaid losses and loss expenses, net of reinsurance, at December 31, 2005 and 2004 were $716.7 million and $578.6 million, respectively. The related discounted unpaid losses and loss expenses were $322.2 million and $290.0 million as of December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.

     The nature of the Company’s high excess of loss liability and catastrophe business can result in loss events that are both irregular and significant. Similarly, adjustments to reserves for individual years can be irregular and significant. Such adjustments are part of the normal course of business for the Company. Conditions and trends that have affected development of liability in the past may not continue in the future. Accordingly, it is inappropriate to extrapolate future redundancies or deficiencies based upon historical experience.

Asbestos and Environmental Related Claims

     The Company’s reserving process includes a continuing evaluation of the potential impact on unpaid liabilities from exposure to asbestos and environmental claims, including related loss adjustment expenses. Liabilities are established to cover both known and incurred but not reported claims.

     A reconciliation of the opening and closing unpaid losses and loss expenses related to asbestos and environmental exposure claims related to business written prior to 1986 for the years indicated is as follows:

Year Ended December 31,   
   
   
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
Net unpaid losses and loss expenses at beginning of year   
$
57,400    
$
60,525    
$
66,130  
Net incurred losses and loss expenses   
   
   
(1,000 ) 
Less net paid losses and loss expenses   
6,140    
3,125    
4,605  


 

 

 
Net decrease in unpaid losses and loss expenses   
(6,140 )   
(3,125 )   
(5,605 ) 
Net unpaid losses and loss expenses at end of year   
51,260    
57,400    
60,525  
Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable at end of year   
72,741    
82,922    
86,576  


 

 

 
Gross unpaid losses and loss expenses at end of year   
$
124,001    
$
140,322    
$
147,101  


 

 

 

     Incurred but not reported losses, net of reinsurance, included in the above table was $16.7 million in 2005, $22.5 million in 2004 and $27.0 million in 2003. Unpaid losses recoverable are net of potential uncollectible amounts.

     The Company utilizes industry standard asbestos and environmental claims models to estimate its ultimate liability for these exposures.

148


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
9. Losses and Loss Expenses (continued)

     As of December 31, 2005, the Company had approximately 878 open claim files for potential asbestos exposures and 414 open claim files for potential environmental exposures on business written prior to 1986. Approximately 49% of the open claim files in both 2005 and 2004 are due to precautionary claim notices. Precautionary claim notices are submitted by the ceding companies in order to preserve their right to receive coverage under the reinsurance contract. Such notices do not contain an incurred loss amount to the Company. The development of the number of open claim files for potential asbestos and environmental claims is as follows:

    Asbestos    Environmental 
    Claims    Claims 


Total number of claims outstanding at December 31, 2002    537    515 
New claims reported in 2003    205    49 
Claims resolved in 2003    38    74 


Total number of claims outstanding at December 31, 2003    704    490 
New claims reported in 2004    171    38 
Claims resolved in 2004    43    82 


Total number of claims outstanding at December 31, 2004 (1)    832    446 
New claims reported in 2005    152    31 
Claims resolved in 2005    106    63 


Total number of claims outstanding at December 31, 2005 (1)    878    414 



   
(1) Includes certain precautionary claims not considered in 2003.    

     The Company’s exposure to asbestos and environmental claims arises from policies written, both on a proportional and excess basis, after 1972. The Company discontinued writing policies with these exposures in 1985. Business written was across many different policies, each with a relatively small contract limit. The Company’s reported asbestos claims related to both traditional products and premises and operations coverage.

     The estimation of loss and loss expense liabilities for asbestos and environmental exposures is subject to much greater uncertainty than is normally associated with the establishment of liabilities for certain other exposures due to several factors, including: (i) uncertain legal interpretation and application of insurance and reinsurance coverage and liability; (ii) the lack of reliability of available historical claims data as an indicator of future claims development; (iii) an uncertain political climate which may impact, among other areas, the nature and amount of costs for remediating waste sites; and (iv) the potential of insurers and reinsurers to reach agreements in order to avoid further significant legal costs. Due to the potential significance of these uncertainties, the Company believes that no meaningful range of loss and loss expense liabilities beyond recorded reserves can be established. As the Company’s net unpaid loss and loss expense reserves related to asbestos and environmental exposures are less than 1% of the total net reserves at December 31, 2005, further adverse development is not expected to be material to the Company’s overall net loss reserves. The Company believes it has made reasonable provision for its asbestos and environmental exposures and is unaware of any specific issues that would significantly affect its estimate for loss and loss expenses.

149


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
10. Reinsurance

     The Company utilizes reinsurance and retrocession agreements principally to increase aggregate capacity and to reduce the risk of loss on business assumed. The Company’s reinsurance and retrocession agreements provide for recovery of a portion of losses and loss expenses from reinsurers and reinsurance recoverables are recorded as assets. The Company is liable if the reinsurers are unable to satisfy their obligations under the agreements. Under its reinsurance security policy, the Company seeks to cede business to reinsurers generally rated “A” or better by Standard & Poor’s (“S&P”) or, in the case of Lloyd’s syndicates, “B+” from Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”). The Company considers reinsurers that are not rated or do not fall within the above rating categories and may grant exceptions to the Company’s general policy on a case-by-case basis.

     The effect of reinsurance and retrocessional activity on premiums written and earned from general operations is shown below:

    Premiums Written      Premiums Earned  
    Year Ended December 31,     Year Ended December 31,  






(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005     2004       2003     2005     2004       2003  


















Direct    $ 5,720,536     $ 5,733,247     $  5,000,371     $ 5,446,521     $ 5,335,948     $  4,969,084  
Assumed    3,476,301     3,648,215       3,636,321     3,503,830     3,853,147       3,262,847  
Ceded    (2,172,726 )    (2,111,728 )      (2,073,489 )    (2,076,713 )    (2,201,155 )      (2,142,353 ) 


















Net    $ 7,024,111     $ 7,269,734     $  6,563,203     $ 6,873,638     $ 6,987,940     $  6,089,578  



















     The Company recorded reinsurance recoveries on losses and loss expenses incurred of $1.7 billion, $3.0 billion and $1.9 billion for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively. The Company is the beneficiary of letters of credit, trust accounts and funds withheld in the aggregate amount of $2.1 billion at December 31, 2005, collateralizing reinsurance recoverables with respect to certain reinsurers.

     The following table presents an analysis of total unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable between general, life and annuity, and financial operations for the year ended December 31:

(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005    2004 




General operations    $ 6,401,855    $ 6,952,472 
Life and annuity operations    28,874    8,291 
Financial operations    10,793    10,593 




Total unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable    $ 6,441,522    $ 6,971,356 





     At December 31, 2005, the total reinsurance assets of $7.5 billion included reinsurance recoverables for paid losses and loss expenses of $1.1 billion and $6.4 billion with respect to the ceded reserve for losses and loss expenses, including ceded losses incurred but not reported. Although the contractual obligation of individual reinsurers to pay their reinsurance obligations is based on specific contract provisions, the collectibility of such amounts requires significant estimation by management. The majority of the balance we have accrued as recoverable will not be due for collection until sometime in the future. Over this period of time, economic conditions and operational performance of a particular reinsurer may impact their ability to meet these obligations and while they may continue to acknowledge their contractual obligation to do so, they may not have the financial resources or willingness to fully meet their obligation to the Company.

150


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
10. Reinsurance (continued)

     At December 31, 2005, the provision for uncollectible reinsurance was $260.7 million. To estimate this provision, the reinsurance recoverable must first be allocated to applicable reinsurers. This determination is based on a process rather than an estimate, although an element of judgment must be applied. As part of this process, ceded IBNR is allocated by reinsurer. The allocations are generally based on historical relationships between gross and ceded losses. If actual experience varies materially from historical experience, the allocation of reinsurance recoverable by reinsurer will change.

     The Company uses a default analysis to estimate uncollectible reinsurance. The primary components of the default analysis are reinsurance recoverable balances by reinsurer, net of collateral, and default factors used to determine the portion of a reinsurer’s balance deemed uncollectible. The definition of collateral for this purpose requires some judgment and is generally limited to assets held in trust, letters of credit, and liabilities held by us with the same legal entity for which the Company believes there is a right of offset. Default factors require considerable judgment and are determined using the current rating, or rating equivalent, of each reinsurer as well as other key considerations and assumptions.

     At December 31, 2005, the use of different assumptions within the model could have a material effect on the bad debt provision reflected in the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements. To the extent the creditworthiness of the Company’s reinsurers was to deteriorate due to an adverse event affecting the reinsurance industry, such as a large number of major catastrophes, actual uncollectible amounts could be significantly greater than the Company’s bad debt provision. Such an event could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition, results of operations, and liquidity.

     Included in unpaid loss and loss expenses recoverable at December 31, 2004, was an unsecured reinsurance recoverable from Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company (the “WSIC”) of $1.45 billion, related to certain contractual arrangements in the sale and purchase agreement (“SPA”), as amended, relating to the Company’s acquisition of certain Winterthur International insurance operations (the “Winterthur Business”) in July 2001. The conclusion of the Independent actuarial process resulted in the Company receiving a net lump sum payment for 2005, in the amount of approximately $575.0 million, net of interest.

     In addition, WSIC provides protection to the Company with respect to third party reinsurance receivables and recoverables related to the Winterthur Business, which are $1.6 billion in the aggregate as of December 31, 2005. There are two levels of protection from WSIC for these balances:

  1.      At the time of the Winterthur International acquisition, WSIC provided to the Company a liquidity facil- ity. At the time of the payment of the net reserve seasoned amount on December 12, 2005, the Company exercised its right to repay up to the balances outstanding on this facility by assignment to WSIC of an equal amount of receivables relating to reinsurance recoverables selected by the Company. During December 2005, the Company assigned $265.4 million of receivables to WSIC under this arrangement, although WSIC has disputed the assignment of certain of these receivables.
 
  2.      Under two retrocession agreements the Company has reinsurance protection on the reinsurance recover- ables with respect to the Seasoned Net Reserves Amount determined as of June 30, 2004 to the extent that the Company does not receive payment of such amounts from applicable reinsurers with one agree- ment providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to June 30, 2001 and the other agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to December 31, 2000.
 

151


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
11. Deposit Liabilities

     At December 31, 2005, certain reinsurers responsible for some portions of the reinsurance of the acquired Winterthur Business have raised issues as to whether amounts claimed are due and discussions are currently ongoing to achieve a resolution.

     The Company has entered into certain contracts with cedents that transfer insufficient risk to be accounted for as insurance or reinsurance transactions. These contracts have been recorded as deposit liabilities and are matched by an equivalent amount of investments. The Company has investment risk related to its ability to generate sufficient investment income to enable the total invested assets to cover the payment of the estimated ultimate liability. The Company establishes an initial accretion rate at inception of the contract, which is reviewed and adjusted periodically based on claims activity. Guaranteed investment contracts are initially recorded at an amount equal to the assets received. The Company also has investment risk related to its ability to generate sufficient investment income to enable the total invested assets to cover the payment of the estimated ultimate liability. The Company establishes an initial accretion rate at inception of the contract, which is based on the contractual payment schedule.

Total deposit liabilities are comprised of the following:

Year ended December 31,         
(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005    2004 




Reinsurance and insurance deposit liabilities    $ 1,647,928    $ 1,744,412 
Guaranteed investment contract deposit liabilities    6,593,059    4,230,314 




Total deposit liabilities    $ 8,240,987    $ 5,974,726 





     Interest expense of $227.7 million, $143.6 million and $105.1 million was recorded related to the accretion of deposit liabilities for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively.

12. Future Policy Benefit Reserves

     During 2005 and 2004, the Company entered into long duration contracts that subject the Company to mortality and morbidity risks and which were accounted for as life premiums earned. Future policy benefit reserves were established using appropriate assumptions for investment yields, mortality, and expenses, including a provision for adverse deviation. The average interest rate used for the determination of the future policy benefits for these contracts was 4.8% and 5.1% at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Total future policy benefit reserves for the year ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 were $5.6 and $4.3 billion, respectively. Substantially all of these reserves relate to closed blocks of annuities.

13. Notes Payable and Debt and Financing Arrangements

     As at December 31, 2005, the Company had bank and loan facilities available from a variety of sources, including commercial banks, totaling $4.6 billion (2004: $3.4 billion) of which $3.4 billion (2004: $2.7 billion) of debt was outstanding. In addition, the Company has letter of credit facilities totaling $5.5 billion available of which $3.5 billion (2004: $3.0 billion) were outstanding as at December 31, 2005, 5.3% (2004: 6.6%) of which were collateralized by the Company’s investment portfolio, supporting U.S. non-admitted business and the Company’s Lloyd’s Syndicates’ capital requirements. Of these amounts, $1.0 billion is available in the form of revolving credit or letters of credit.

152


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

13. Notes Payable and Debt and Financing Arrangements (continued)

The financing structure at December 31, 2005 was as follows:

Facility            In Use/ 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)      Commitment (1)      Outstanding (1) 




Debt:             
364-day Revolver    $  100,000    $   
5 and 3-year Revolvers      1,000,000      45,000 
5-year Revolver      100,000       
2.53% Senior Notes due 2009      825,000      825,000 
6.58% Guaranteed Senior Notes due 2011      255,000      255,000 
5.25% Senior Notes due 2011      745,000      745,000 
6.50% Guaranteed Senior Notes due 2012      598,368      598,368 
5.25% Senior Notes due 2014      594,330      594,330 
6.375% Senior Notes due 2024      350,000      350,000 




Total debt    $  4,567,698    $  3,412,698 




Letters of Credit:             
8 facilities-total    $  5,481,437    $  3,459,760 





(1) “Commitment” and “In Use” data represent December 31, 2005 accreted values.             
 
           The financing structure at December 31, 2004 was as follows:             
 
Facility            In Use/ 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)      Commitment (1)      Outstanding (1) 




Debt:             
364-day Revolver    $  660,000    $   
7.15% Senior Notes due 2005      100,000      100,000 
2.53% Senior Notes due 2009      825,000      825,000 
6.58% Guaranteed Senior Notes due 2011      255,000      255,000 
6.50% Guaranteed Senior Notes due 2012      597,761      597,761 
5.25% Senior Notes due 2014      593,670      593,670 
6.375% Senior Notes due 2024      350,000      350,000 




Total debt    $  3,381,431    $  2,721,431 




Letters of Credit:             
8 facilities-total    $  4,371,167    $  2,991,676 





(1) “Commitment” and “In Use” data represent December 31, 2004 accreted values.

153


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

13. Notes Payable and Debt and Financing Arrangements (continued)

     $45 million was drawn under the syndicated revolving credit facility at December 31, 2005 at an average interest rate in 2005 of 4.5%, and this amount was repaid in January 2006. There were no borrowings or repayments under the Company’s revolving credit facilities during 2004.

     In December 2005, the Company created a new $100 million unsecured bilateral credit facility that was unutilized during 2005 and at December 31, 2005. The full amount of $100 million is available as both revolving credit and letters of credit, with the combined total not to exceed $100 million.

     In December 2005, the Company issued 29.8 million 7.0% Equity Security Units (the “7.0% Units”) in a public offering. The Company received approximately $722.7 million in net proceeds from the sale of the 7.0% Units after deducting underwriting discounts. Each 7.0% Unit has a stated amount of $25 and consists of (a) a purchase contract pursuant to which the holder agreed to purchase, for $25, a variable number of shares of the Company’s Class A Ordinary Shares on February 15, 2009 and (b) a one-fortieth, or 2.5%, ownership interest in a senior note issued by the Company due February 15, 2011 with a principal amount of $1,000. The senior notes are pledged by the holders to secure their obligations under the purchase contract. The number of shares issued under the purchase contract is contingently adjustable based on, among other things, the share price of the Company on the stock purchase date and the dividend rate of the Company. The Company will make quarterly payments at the annual rate of 1.75% and 5.25% under the purchase contracts and senior notes, respectively. The Company may defer the contract payments on the purchase contract, but not the senior notes, until the stock purchase date. In February 2009, the senior notes will be remarketed whereby the interest rate on the senior notes will be reset in order to generate sufficient remarketing proceeds to satisfy the 7.0% Unit holders’ obligations under the purchase contract. If the senior notes are not successfully remarketed, then the Company will exercise its rights as a secured party and may retain or dispose of the senior notes to satisfy, in full, the 7.0% Unit holders’ obligations to purchase its ordinary shares under the purchase contracts.

     In connection with this transaction, $36.9 million, which is the estimated fair value of the purchase contract, was charged to “Additional paid in capital” and a corresponding liability was established. Of the $23.9 million total costs associated with the issuance of the 7.0% Units, $21.1 million was charged to “Additional paid in capital” with the remainder deferred and amortized over the term of the senior debt.

     The number of ordinary shares to be issued under each purchase contract depends on, among other things, the average market price of the ordinary shares. The maximum number of ordinary shares to be issued under the purchase contracts is approximately 11.5 million. The Company accounts for the effect on the number of weighted average ordinary shares, assuming dilution, using the treasury stock method. The purchase contract component of the 7.0% Units will have no effect on the number of weighted average ordinary shares, assuming dilution, except when the average market price of the Company’s ordinary shares is above the threshold appreciation price of $80.6 per share. Because the average market price of the Company’s ordinary shares during the period the 7.0% Units were outstanding was below this price, the shares issuable under the purchase contracts were excluded from the computation of net income per ordinary share assuming dilution for the three and twelve month periods ended December 31, 2005.

     In November 2005, the Company repaid its 7.15% senior notes on maturity.

     In September 2005, the Company renewed an unsecured bilateral credit facility of $150 million (previously $200 million) that was fully utilized at December 31, 2005.

     In August 2005, the Company created a new unsecured bilateral credit facility of $100 million that was unutilized at December 31, 2005.

154


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

13. Notes Payable and Debt and Financing Arrangements (continued)

     In June 2005, the Company replaced its $1.0 billion 364-day credit and letter of credit facility with a $2.35 billion facility with a tenor of 5 years. Of the aggregate amount of $2.35 billion, $1.0 billion is available as revolving credit and up to $2.25 billion is available in the form of letters of credit, with the combined total not to exceed $2.35 billion. As at December 31, 2005, approximately $2.1 billion of the 5-year facility was in use in the form of letters of credit.

     In June 2004, the Company replaced its principal revolving credit and letter of credit facility that had amounted to $2.5 billion with two facilities – one $2.0 billion facility with a tenor of 3 years and a $1.0 billion facility with a tenor of 364 days. Of the aggregate amount of $3.0 billion, $600 million was available as revolving credit and up to $3.0 billion was available in the form of letters of credit, with the combined total not to exceed $3.0 billion. As at December 31, 2004 approximately $1.9 billion of the 3-year facility was in use in the form of letters of credit while the 364-day facility was unutilized at that date.

     In September 2004, the Company created a new $100 million unsecured bilateral credit facility that was unutilized during 2004 and at December 31, 2004. Of the aggregate amount of $100 million, $60 million was available as revolving credit and up to $100 million is available in the form of letters of credit, with the combined total not to exceed $100 million. This facility was replaced in December 2005.

     In November 2004, the Company renewed its unsecured syndicated letter of credit facility that supports its operations at Lloyd’s. The renewed facility is denominated in U.K. sterling and was £450 million (approximately $863 million) at December 31, 2004.

     In November 2004, the Company issued the second tranche of $300 million aggregate principal amount of 5.25% Senior Notes due September 2014. The bonds were issued at 98.419% and gross proceeds were $298.7 million. Related expenses of the offering amounted to approximately $2.0 million. Proceeds of these notes, together with proceeds from the issuance of the 2024 senior notes described below, were used to redeem the Zero Coupon Convertible Debentures (“CARZ”) as described below.

     In November 2004, the Company issued $350 million aggregate principal amount of 6.375% Senior Notes due November 2024. The bonds were issued at par and gross proceeds were $350 million. Related expenses of the offering amounted to approximately $2.0 million. Proceeds of these notes, together with proceeds form the issuance of the second tranche of 2014 senior notes described above, were used to redeem the CARZ as described below.

     In August 2004, the Company issued the first tranche of $300 million aggregate principal amount of 5.25% Senior Notes due September 2014. The bonds were issued at 99.432% and gross proceeds were $298.3 million. Related expenses of the offering amounted to approximately $1.7 million. Proceeds of these notes were used to redeem the Liquid Yield Option Notes (“LYONs”), as described below.

     In March 2004, the Company issued 33 million 6.5% Equity Security Units (the “6.5% Units”) in a public offering. The Company received approximately $800.2 million in net proceeds from the sale of the Units after deducting underwriting discounts. Each 6.5% Unit has a stated amount of $25 and consists of (a) a purchase contract pursuant to which the holder agreed to purchase, for $25, a variable number of shares of the Company’s Class A Ordinary Shares on May 15, 2007 and (b) a one-fortieth, or 2.5%, ownership interest in a senior note issued by the Company due May 15, 2009 with a principal amount of $1,000. The senior notes are pledged by the holders to secure their obligations under the purchase contract. The number of shares issued under the purchase contract is contingently adjustable based on, among other things, the share price of the Company on the stock purchase date and the dividend

155


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

13. Notes Payable and Debt and Financing Arrangements (continued)

rate of the Company. The Company will make quarterly payments at the annual rate of 3.97% and 2.53% under the purchase contracts and senior notes, respectively. The Company may defer the contract payments on the purchase contract, but not the senior notes, until the stock purchase date. In May 2007, the senior notes will be remarketed whereby the interest rate on the senior notes will be reset in order to generate sufficient remarketing proceeds to satisfy the 6.5% Unit holders’ obligations under the purchase contract. If the senior notes are not successfully remar-keted, then the Company will exercise its rights as a secured party and may retain or dispose of the senior notes to satisfy, in full, the 6.5% Unit holders’ obligations to purchase its ordinary shares under the purchase contracts.

     In connection with this transaction, $88.6 million, which is the estimated fair value of the purchase contract, was charged to “Additional paid in capital” and a corresponding liability was established. Of the $26.9 million total costs associated with the issuance of the 6.5% Units, $23.7 million was charged to “Additional paid in capital” with the remainder deferred and amortized over the term of the senior debt.

     The number of ordinary shares to be issued under each purchase contract depends on, among other things, the average market price of the ordinary shares. The maximum number of ordinary shares to be issued under the purchase contracts is approximately 11 million. The Company accounts for the effect on the number of weighted average ordinary shares, assuming dilution, using the treasury stock method. The purchase contract component of the 6.5% Units will have no effect on the number of weighted average ordinary shares, assuming dilution, except when the average market price of the Company’s ordinary shares is above the threshold appreciation price of $93.99 per share. Because the average market price of the Company’s ordinary shares during the period the 6.5% Units were outstanding was below this price, the shares issuable under the purchase contracts were excluded from the computation of net income per ordinary share assuming dilution for the twelve month periods ended December 31, 2004 and 2005.

     In February 2003, the Company entered into an aggregate of $300.0 million of commercial paper-based credit facilities (the “Credit Facilities”). These facilities were increased to $500.0 million in June 2003. The proceeds of advances under the Credit Facilities were used to fund a trust account to collateralize the reinsurance obligations of the Company. The Company could face additional obligations under the Credit Facilities prior to the stated maturity of February 25, 2008, if certain events were to occur, including, but not limited to the Company’s insolvency, withdrawal of assets from the Regulation 114 trust by the ceding company, the downgrade of the Company’s credit ratings below certain specified levels, or the failure of the agent to have a first priority perfected security interest in the collateral posted by the Company. At maturity, the Company will be obligated to make payments in an amount equal to the principal and accrued interest outstanding under the Credit Facilities. The issued securities and the Company’s repayment obligations are recorded as a net balance on the Company’s balance sheet.

     In July 2003, the Company entered into a contingent capital transaction with an aggregate value of $500.0 million. This transaction also provides the Company with an insurance trust that provides the Company with statutory relief under state insurance regulations in the U.S. Under the terms of this facility, the Company has acquired an irrevocable put option to issue preference ordinary shares into a trust in return for proceeds raised from investors. This put option may be exercised by the Company at any time. In addition, the Company may be required to issue preference ordinary shares to the trust under certain circumstances, including, but not limited to, the non-payment of the put option premium and a ratings downgrade of the Company. In connection with this transaction, the fair value of the put premiums and other related costs, in total of $109.9 million was charged to “Additional Paid in Capital” and a deferred liability was established (included with “Other liabilities”) of $102.5 million in the Consolidated Balance Sheet at December 31, 2003. The Company began to amortize this liability that resulted in additional interest expense

156


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

13. Notes Payable and Debt and Financing Arrangements (continued)

of approximately $3.5 million in 2004 and $2.0 million in 2003 and the liability will continue to be amortized over a ten year term.

     In December 2004, XL Financial Assurance Ltd. (“XLFA”) entered into a put option agreement and an asset trust expense reimbursement agreement with Twin Reefs Asset Trust (the “Asset Trust”). The put option agreement provides XLFA with the irrevocable right to require the Asset Trust at any time and from time to time to purchase XLFA’s non-cumulative perpetual Series B Preferred Shares with an aggregate liquidation preference of up to $200 million. XLFA is obligated to reimburse the Asset Trust for certain fees and ordinary expenses. To the extent that any Series B Preferred Shares are put to the Asset Trust and remain outstanding, a corresponding portion of such fees and ordinary expenses will be payable by XLFA pursuant to the asset trust expense reimbursement agreement. The put option agreement is perpetual but would terminate on delivery of notice by XLFA on or after December 9, 2009, or under certain defined circumstances, such as the failure of XLFA to pay the put option premium when due or bankruptcy. The put option is recorded at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in earnings.

     In January 2002, the Company issued $600.0 million par value 6.50% Guaranteed Senior Notes due January 2012. The notes were issued at $99.469 and gross proceeds were $596.8 million. Related expenses of the offering amounted to $7.9 million. Proceeds of the notes were used to pay down two 5-year revolvers of $350.0 million and for general corporate purposes. These credit facilities were subsequently cancelled.

     In April 2001, the Company issued at par $255.0 million of 6.58% Guaranteed Senior Notes due April 2011 through a private placement to institutional investors. Proceeds of the debt were used for general corporate purposes.

     In September 2001, the Company issued $508.8 million principal amount at maturity (subsequently increased to $514.6 million under the provisions of an upward interest adjustment provision) of LYONs. The accretion rate on the LYONs was originally 2.875% per annum on a semi-annual basis or 2.896% per annum on an annual basis. The accretion rate for the year to September 7, 2004, was increased by 0.645% per annum on a semi-annual basis to 3.52% on a semi-annual basis and 3.551% per annum on an annual basis as a result of the Company’s ordinary share price in the 30-day period leading up to the second put date in September 2003. On September 7, 2004, the Company redeemed the entire issue of LYONs at their accreted value of approximately $317 million, using proceeds from the issuance of the first tranche of Senior Notes due 2014, as described above.

     In May 2001, the Company issued $1,010.8 million principal amount at maturity of CARZ. On May 26, 2004, the Company made a one-time cash payment to holders of the CARZ for not exercising their put rights. On November 8, 2004, the Company redeemed the entire issue of CARZ at a total cost of approximately $657.6 million using proceeds from the issuance of the second tranche of Senior Notes due 2104 and the Senior Notes due 2024, as described above.

     The Company has several letter of credit facilities provided on a syndicated and bilateral basis from commercial banks. These facilities are utilized to support non-admitted insurance and reinsurance operations in the U.S. and capital requirements at Lloyd’s. The commercial facilities are scheduled for renewal during 2006 through 2010. In addition to letters of credit, the Company has established insurance trusts in the U.S. that provide cedents with statutory relief required under state insurance regulation in the U.S. It is anticipated that the commercial facilities will be renewed on expiry but such renewals are subject to the availability of credit from banks utilized by the Company. In the event that such credit support is insufficient, the Company could be required to provide alternative security to cedents. This could take the form of additional insurance trusts supported by the Company’s investment portfolio or funds withheld using the Company’s cash resources. The value of letters of credit required is driven by, among other

157


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

13. Notes Payable and Debt and Financing Arrangements (continued)

things, loss development of existing reserves, the payment pattern of such reserves, the expansion of business written by the Company and the loss experience of such business.

     In general, all of the Company’s bank facilities, indentures and other documents relating to the Company’s outstanding indebtedness (collectively, the “Company’s Debt Documents”), as described above, contain cross default provisions to each other and the Company’s Debt Documents (other than the 6.5% Guaranteed Senior Notes indentures) contain affirmative covenants. These covenants provide for, among other things, minimum required ratings of the Company’s insurance and reinsurance operating subsidiaries (other than its “AAA” financial guaranty companies) and the level of secured indebtedness in the future. In addition, generally each of the Company’s Debt Documents provide for an event of default in the event of a change of control of the Company or some events involving bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of the Company. The Company’s credit facilities and the 6.58% Guaranteed Senior Notes also contain minimum consolidated net worth covenants.

     Under the Company’s 364-day facilities, 3-year credit facility, five-year credit facilities placement notes described above, in the event that the Company XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd fail to maintain a financial strength rating of at least “A-” from A.M. Best, an event of default would occur. The Company currently has an “A+ (stable)” rating from A.M. Best.

     Under the Company’s ten-year private placement notes described above, in the event that the Company fails to maintain a financial strength rating of at least “A” from A.M. Best or XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd fail to maintain a financial strength rating of at least “A” from S&P, an event of default would occur. The Company and its subsidiaries currently have an “A+” (stable) rating from A.M. Best and “A+” (stable) from S&P.

     The 6.5% Guaranteed Senior Notes indentures contain a cross default provision. In general, in the event that the Company defaults in the payment of indebtedness in the amount of $50.0 million or more, an event of default would be triggered under both the 6.5% Guaranteed Senior Notes indentures.

     Given that all of the Company’s Debt Documents contain cross default provisions, this may result in all holders declaring such debt due and payable and an acceleration of all debt due under those documents. If this were to occur, the Company may not have funds sufficient at that time to repay any or all of such indebtedness.

     In addition, the Company’s unsecured Lloyd’s letter of credit facility provides that, in the event that the Company’s insurance and reinsurance rated operating subsidiaries in Bermuda fall below “A” (as measured by the financial strength rating from A.M. Best at any time), the facility would then be required to be fully secured by the Company, at which time the Company would be required to either (i) provide an amount in cash to cover an amount equal to the aggregate letters of credit outstanding at that time or (ii) deposit assets in trust securing 105% of the aggregate letters of credit outstanding at that time. If this were to occur, the Company may not be able to provide the collateral required in order to maintain this facility.

14. Derivative Instruments

     The Company enters into derivative instruments for both risk management and trading purposes. The Company is exposed to potential loss from various market risks, and manages its market risks based on guidelines established by management. These derivative instruments are carried at fair value with the resulting gains and losses recognized in income in the period in which they occur.

158


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
14. Derivative Instruments (continued)

     The following table summarizes these instruments and the effect on net income in the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003:

(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005     2004     2003  


 

 

 
Credit default swaps    $  10,522     $ 48,371     $  7,828  
Weather and energy derivatives      17,824     1,997       1,103  
Other non-investment derivatives      17,087     (887 )      (948 ) 
Investment derivatives      (16,575 )    24,012       (1,910 ) 


 

 

 
Net realized and unrealized (losses) gains on derivatives    $  28,858     $ 73,493     $  6,073  


 

 

 

(a) Credit Derivatives

     Credit derivatives are recorded at fair value. In determining the fair value of credit derivatives, management differentiates between investment and non-investment grade exposures and models them separately. Management estimates fair value for investment grade exposures by monitoring changes in credit quality and selecting appropriate market indices to determine credit spread movements over the life of the contracts. The determination of the credit spread movements is the basis for calculating the fair value. For credit derivatives that are non-investment grade appropriate market indices are not readily available. Accordingly, the Company uses an alternative fair value methodology.

     Under this methodology, the fair value is determined using a cash flow model developed by the Company which is dependent upon a number of factors, including changes in interest rates, future default rates, credit spreads, changes in credit quality, future expected recovery rates and other market factors. In general, the Company holds credit derivatives to maturity. Accordingly, changes in the fair value of such credit derivatives are unrealized. For the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003 the change in the fair value of credit derivatives issued in connection with the Company’s financial guaranty business was a gain of $10.5 million, $48.3 million and $7.8 million, respectively.

     The following table summarizes insurance activities related to credit default swap derivative instruments excluding gains and losses on credit default swaps within the investment portfolio.

Year Ended December 31,             
(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005    2004    2003 






Statement of Income:             
Net earned premiums    $  27,712    $  32,482    $  24,766 
Net losses and loss expenses    $  2,295    $  27,955    $  58,381 
Net realized and unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives    $  10,522    $  48,371    $  7,828 

159


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
14.      Derivative Instruments (continued)
 
  (a) Credit Derivatives (continued)
 
    As at    As at 
    December 31,    December 31,




(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005    2004 




Balance Sheet:         
Unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable    $            471    $  419 
Other assets    $            15,768    $  16,475 
Unpaid losses and loss expenses    $            27,562    $  26,090 
Other liabilities    $            20,142    $  28,982 

(b) Weather and Energy Derivatives

     Weather and energy derivatives are recorded at fair value, which is determined through the use of quoted market prices where available. Where quoted market prices are unavailable, the fair values are estimated using available market data and internal pricing models based upon consistent statistical methodologies. Estimating fair value of instruments that do not have quoted market prices requires management’s judgment in determining amounts that could reasonably be expected to be received from, or paid to, a third party in settlement of the contracts. The amounts could be materially different from the amounts that might be realized in an actual sale transaction. Fair values are subject to change in the near-term and reflect management’s best estimate based on various factors including, but not limited to, actual and forecasted weather conditions, changes in commodity prices, changes in interest rates and other market factors.

     The change in fair value recorded for the weather and energy derivatives was a gain of $17.8 million, $2.0 million and $1.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively.

(c) Investment Derivatives, Including Embedded Derivatives

     The Company uses foreign exchange contracts to manage its exposure to the effects of fluctuating foreign currencies on the value of certain of its foreign currency fixed maturities and equity securities investments. These contracts are not designated as specific hedges for financial reporting purposes and therefore, realized and unrealized gains and losses on these contracts are recorded in income in the period in which they occur. These contracts generally have maturities of twelve months or less. In addition, certain of the Company’s investment managers may, subject to investment guidelines, enter into forward contracts where potential gains may exist. The Company has exposure to foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations through its operations and in its investment portfolio. The Company’s net foreign currency denominated payable on foreign exchange contracts was $603.0 million and 3.8 million as at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively, with a net unrealized gain of $15.9 million as at December 31, 2005 and a net unrealized loss of $11.8 million as at December 31, 2004.

     The Company also uses foreign exchange forward contracts, in certain cases to hedge net investments in foreign operations against adverse movements in exchange rates. The Company manages its consolidated net foreign exchange exposure and from time to time hedges specific net in foreign operations. The Company measures ineffectiveness based upon the change in forward rates. For the year ended December 31, 2005, $30.3 million of net realized and unrealized losses related to these foreign exchange forward contracts and were included in the cumulative translation adjustment. As at December 31, 2005 the net unrealized gain position of these contracts was $13.4 million on a total contract value of $141.2 million. For the same period, no net losses were recorded in earnings representing the amount of the hedges’ ineffectiveness as the change in the value of the forward contract was fully offset by a corresponding change in the underlying investment.

160


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

14. Derivative Instruments (continued)

     (d) Interest Rate Exposure

     The Company utilizes a risk management strategy that incorporates the use of derivative financial instruments, primarily to reduce its exposure to interest rate risks associated with certain of its assets and liabilities. The Company uses interest rate swaps to convert certain liabilities from a fixed rate to a variable rate of interest and to convert a variable rate of interest from one basis to another. The Company is exposed to credit risk in the event of non-performance by the other parties to the forward contracts.

     The Company designates certain of its derivative instruments as fair value hedges or cash flow hedges and formally and contemporaneously documents all relationships between the hedging instruments and hedged items and links the hedge to specific assets and liabilities. The Company assesses the effectiveness of the hedge, both at inception and on an on-going basis and determines whether the hedge is highly effective in offsetting changes in fair value or cash flows of the linked hedged item.

     At December 31, 2005, contracts designated as fair value and cash flow hedges were in a $23.5 million net unrealized gain position. As a result of the fair value hedges, deposit liabilities were increased by $27.6 million at December 31, 2005. The ineffective portion of the hedge amounted to $5.0 million as part of net realized losses. The interest rate swap hedges resulted in a reduction in interest expense and a reduction in net investment income of $6.7 million and $4.5 million, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2005.

     At December 31, 2004, contracts designated as fair value and cash flow hedges were in a $13.4 million net unrealized gain position. As a result of the fair value hedges, deposit liabilities were increased by $19.9 million at December 31, 2004. The ineffective portion of the hedge amounted to $1.8 million as part of net realized losses. The interest rate swap hedges resulted in a reduction in interest expense and a reduction in net investment income of $14.8 million and $4.4 million, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2004.

     At December 31, 2003, contracts designated as fair value and cash flow hedges were in a $3.2 million net unrealized gain position. As a result of the fair value hedges, deposit liabilities were increased by $3.1 million at December 31, 2003. The ineffective portion of the hedge amounted to $0.1 million as part of net realized gains. The interest rate swap hedges resulted in a reduction in interest expense of $2.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2003.

     In August 2004, the Company entered into a treasury rate guarantee agreement in anticipation of the issuance of fixed-rate debt. This transaction, which met the requirements of a cash flow hedge of a forecasted transaction under SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities”, was entered into to mitigate the interest rate risk associated with the subsequent issuance of $300.0 million of 5.25% Senior Notes due September 15, 2014 (see Note 8 above). The loss on the settlement of the treasury rate guarantee transaction on August 18, 2004 of $6.3 million was charged to Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income and is being amortized to interest expense over the 10-year term of the related debt.

     In 2002, the Company entered into a treasury rate lock agreement with the underwriters of the 6.50% Guaranteed Senior Notes due 2012 (2001: 6.58% Guaranteed Senior Notes due 2011). The Notes were priced using a margin over the yield of a U.S. Treasury note with a similar maturity. The treasury rate lock agreement was designed to eliminate underlying pricing risk of the Company’s debt that would have resulted from an increase in the yield of the comparable U.S. Treasury issue between the initiation of the transaction and the pricing of the transaction. The total cost of the hedge was $4.2 million. In 2001, a loss of $5.6 million was recorded in net realized and unrealized

161


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

14. Derivative Instruments (continued)

     (d) Interest Rate Exposure (continued)

gains and losses related to the cancellation of the treasury lock agreement relating to the 6.58% notes due 2011 due to the September 11, 2001 event.

     (e) Financial Market Exposure

     The Company also uses bond and stock index futures to add value to the portfolio where market inefficiencies are believed to exist, to equitize cash holdings of equity managers and to adjust the duration of a portfolio of fixed income securities to match the duration of related deposit liabilities. These instruments are marked to market on a daily basis and changes in fair values are recorded through net realized and unrealized gains and losses on derivative instruments. The Company measures potential losses in fair values using various statistical techniques.

     (f) Other Derivatives

     The Company holds warrants in conjunction with certain of its other investments. These warrants are recorded at fair value based on quoted market prices.

     The Company also has investment related derivatives embedded in certain reinsurance contracts. For a particular life reinsurance contract, the Company pays the ceding company a fixed amount equal to the estimated present value of the excess of guaranteed benefit (“GMIB”) over the account balance upon the policyholder’s election to take the income benefit. The fair value of this derivative is determined based on the present value of expected cash flows. In addition, the Company has modified coinsurance and funds withheld reinsurance agreements that provide for a return based on a portfolio of fixed income securities; as such, the agreements contain embedded derivatives. The embedded derivative is bifurcated from the funds withheld balance and recorded at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in earnings.

15. Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

     In December 2004, XLFA entered into a put option agreement and an asset trust expense reimbursement agreement with the Asset Trust. The put option agreement provides XLFA with the irrevocable right to require the Asset Trust at any time and from time to time to purchase XLFA’s non-cumulative perpetual Series B Preferred Shares with an aggregate liquidation preference of up to $200 million. XLFA is obligated to reimburse the Asset Trust for certain fees and ordinary expenses. To the extent that any Series B Preferred Shares are put to the Asset Trust and remain outstanding, a corresponding portion of such fees and ordinary expenses will be payable by XLFA pursuant to the asset trust expense reimbursement agreement. The put option agreement is perpetual but would terminate on delivery of notice by XLFA on or after December 9, 2009, or under certain defined circumstances, such as the failure of XLFA to pay the put option premium when due or bankruptcy. The put option is recorded at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in earnings.

     In 2003, the Company entered into an aggregate of $500.0 million of commercial paper-based credit facilities (the “Credit Facilities”). The proceeds of advances under the Credit Facilities were used to fund a trust account (“Trust”) to collateralize the reinsurance obligations of the Company under an intercompany quota share reinsurance agreement. The issued securities and the Company’s repayment obligations are recorded as a net balance on the Company’s balance sheet because the Company has a contractual legal right of offset. In the event that in the future the Company were to not have the right to offset such assets (as, for example, would be the case if the assets in the Trust were withdrawn in order to satisfy the Company’s reinsurance obligations or if lender-issued securities could

162


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

15. Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements (continued)

not be held in the Trust because they did not qualify as permitted assets under the trust agreement), then all or a portion of the assets in the Trust and the Company’s repayment obligations under the Credit Facilities would be required to be included as assets and liabilities on a gross basis, respectively, on the Company’s balance sheet.

     In July 2003, the Company entered into a contingent capital transaction with an aggregate value of $500.0 million. This transaction also provides the Company with an insurance trust that provides the Company with statutory relief under state insurance regulations in the U.S. Under the terms of this facility, the Company has acquired an irrevocable put option to issue preference ordinary shares into a trust in return for proceeds raised from investors. This put option may be exercised by the Company at any time. In addition, the Company may be required to issue preference ordinary shares to the trust under certain circumstances, including, but not limited to, the non-payment of the put option premium and a ratings downgrade of the Company.

16. Variable Interest Entities

     The Company utilizes variable interest entities both indirectly and directly in the ordinary course of business. The Company provides various forms of credit enhancement including financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance of structured transactions backed by pools of assets of specified types, municipal obligations supported by the issuers’ ability to charge fees for specified services or projects, and structured single risk based obligations including essential infrastructure projects and obligations backed by receivables from future sales of commodities and other specified services. The obligations related to these transactions are often securitized through variable interest entities. In synthetic transactions the Company guarantees payment obligations of counterparties including special purpose vehicles under credit derivatives referencing asset portfolios. The Company invests in equity tranches (or similar instruments) of collateralized debt obligations (“CDOs”), collateralized bond obligations (“CBOs”) and other investment vehicles that are issued through variable interest entities as part of the Company’s risk asset portfolio.

17. Exposures under Guaranties

     The Company provides and reinsures financial guaranties issued to support public and private borrowing arrangements. Financial guaranties are conditional commitments that guarantee the performance of an obligor to a third party, typically the timely repayment of principal and interest. The Company’s potential liability in the event of non- payment by the issuer of the insured obligation is represented by its proportionate share of the aggregate outstanding principal and interest payable (“insurance in force”) on such insured obligation. In synthetic transactions, the Company guarantees payment obligations of counterparties under credit derivatives. The future value of installment premiums for such guarantees totaled approximately $652.0 million and $505.8 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The range of maturity of the insured obligations is one to thirty-five years. The Company does not record a carrying value for future installment premiums as they are recognized over the term of the contract.

     The Company manages its exposures to underwriting risk on these transactions through a structured process which includes but is not limited to detailed credit analysis, review of and adherence to underwriting guidelines and the use of reinsurance. The Company has also implemented surveillance policies and procedures to monitor its exposure throughout the life of the transactions. In addition, the structures of the transactions are such that the insured obligation is backed by a stream of cash flows, pools of assets or some other form of collateral. This collateral would typically become the Company’s upon the payment of a claim by the Company.

163


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
17. Exposures Under Guaranties (continued)

     The following tables presents financial guaranty aggregate insured portfolios at December 31, 2005 where the net par outstanding was $88.3 billion, which includes credit default swap exposures of $14.7 billion. The net principal and interest insured, as of December 31, 2005 and 2004 was $130.8 billion and $108.3 billion, respectively. The liability for these credit derivatives had a carrying value of $31.5 million and $38.2 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.

    Net Par     
(U.S. dollars in millions)    Outstanding    % of Total




                   Credit Quality:         
                       AAA    $ 23,548    26.7 % 
                       AA    12,071    13.7 % 
                       A    28,516    32.3 % 
                       BBB    23,286    26.3 % 
                       BB and below    847    1.0 % 




                       Total    $ 88,268    100.0 % 




 
    Net Par     
(U.S. dollars in millions)    Outstanding    % of Total




Geographic:         
                       United States    $ 74,249    84.1 % 
                       United Kingdom    6,450    7.3 % 
                       Brazil    4,733    5.5 % 
                       Mexico    744    0.8 % 
                       Other (1)    1,443    1.6 % 
                       International (2)    649    0.7 % 




                       Total    $ 88,268    100.0 % 





(1)      Other includes Canada, France, Germany, Korea, Chile, Australia, Japan, Portugal, El Salvador, Jamaica, Panama, Costa Rica, Qatar, New Zealand and Spain.
 
(2)      International includes multi-country transactions where there is no majority exposure to any single country.
 
    Net Par     
(U.S. dollars in millions)    Outstanding    % of Total




                   Sector Allocation:         
                       Collateralized Debt Obligations    $ 14,693    16.6 % 
                       Consumer Assets    9,884    11.2 % 
                       Public Finance    42,618    48.3 % 
                       Other Single Risk    14,322    16.3 % 
                       Other Structured Finance    710    0.8 % 
                       Commercial Assets    6,041    6.8 % 




                       Total    $ 88,268    100.0 % 





164


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

18. Commitments and Contingencies

     (a) Concentrations of Credit Risk

     The creditworthiness of any counterparty is evaluated by the Company, taking into account credit ratings assigned by rating agencies. The credit approval process involves an assessment of factors including, among others, the counterparty, country and industry credit exposure limits. Collateral may be required, at the discretion of the Company, on certain transactions based on the creditworthiness of the counterparty.

     The areas where significant concentrations of credit risk may exist include unpaid losses and loss expenses recoverable and reinsurance balances receivable (collectively, “reinsurance assets”), investments and cash and cash equivalent balances. The Company’s reinsurance assets at December 31, 2005 and 2004 amounted to $7.5 billion and $7.8 billion respectively and resulted from reinsurance arrangements in the course of its operations. A credit exposure exists with respect to reinsurance assets as they may be uncollectible. The Company manages its credit risk in its reinsurance relationships by transacting with reinsurers that it considers financially sound, and if necessary, the Company may hold collateral in the form of funds, trust accounts and/or irrevocable letters of credit. This collateral can be drawn on for amounts that remain unpaid beyond specified time periods on an individual reinsurer basis.

     In addition, the Company underwrites a significant amount of its general insurance and reinsurance business through brokers and a credit risk exists should any of these brokers be unable to fulfill their contractual obligations with respect to the payments of insurance and reinsurance balances to the Company. During the three years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003, approximately 21%, 22% and 24%, respectively, of the Company’s consolidated gross written premiums from general operations were generated from or placed by Marsh & McLennan Companies. During 2005, 2004 and 2003, approximately 17%, 17% and 17%, respectively, of the Company’s consolidated gross written premiums from general operations were generated from or placed by AON Corporation and its subsidiaries. Both of these companies are large, well established companies and there are no indications that either of them is financially troubled. No other broker and no one insured or reinsured accounted for more than 10% of gross premiums written from general operations in any of the three years ended December 31, 2005, 2004, or 2003.

     The Company’s available for sale investment portfolio is managed by external managers in accordance with guidelines that have been tailored to meet specific investment strategies, including standards of diversification, which limit the allowable holdings of any single issue. The Company did not have an aggregate investment in a single entity, other than the U.S. Government, in excess of 10% of the Company’s shareholders’ equity at December 31, 2005, 2004, or 2003.

     On July 25, 2001, the Company completed the acquisition of certain Winterthur International insurance operations (the “Winterthur Business”) primarily to extend its predominantly North American-based large corporate insurance business globally.

165


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

18. Commitments and Contingencies (continued)

(a) Concentrations of Credit Risk (continued)

     As a part of this transaction the WSIC provides protection to the Company with respect to third party reinsurance receivables and recoverables related to the Winterthur Business, which are $1.6 billion in the aggregate as of December 31, 2005. There are two levels of protection from WSIC for these balances:

  1.      At the time of the Winterthur International acquisition, the seller provided to the Company a liquidity facil- ity. At the time of the payment of the net reserve seasoned amount on December 12, 2005, as described above, the Company exercised its right to repay up to the balances outstanding on this facility by assign- ment to WSIC of an equal amount of receivables relating to reinsurance recoverables selected by the Company. During December 2005, the Company assigned $265.4 million of receivables to WSIC under this arrangement, although WSIC has disputed the assignment of certain of these receivables.
 
  2.      Under two retrocession agreements the Company has reinsurance protection on reinsurance recoverables with respect to the seasoned net reserved amount as of June 30, 2004 to the extent that the Company does not receive payment of such amounts from applicable reinsurers with one agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to June 30, 2001 and the other agreement providing a limit of $1.3 billion for the insurance written in the period to December 31, 2000.
 

     At December 31, 2005, certain reinsurers responsible for some portions of the reinsurance of the Winterthur Business have raised issues as to whether amounts claimed are due and discussions are currently ongoing to achieve a resolution.

     (b) Other Investments

     The Company has committed to invest in several limited partnerships as part of its overall corporate strategy. As of December 31, 2005, the Company has commitments which include potential additional add-on clauses, to invest a further $1.8 million over the next five years.

     (c) Investments in Affiliates

     The Company owns a minority interest in certain closed-end funds, certain limited partnerships and similar investment vehicles, including funds managed by those companies. The Company has commitments, which include potential additional add-on clauses, to invest a further $33.0 million over the next five years.

     (d) Properties

     The Company rents space for certain of its offices under leases that expire up to 2022. Total rent expense under operating leases for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003 was approximately $34.9 million, $31.2 million and $42.3 million, respectively. Future minimum rental commitments under existing operating leases are expected to be as follows:

Year Ended December 31,     
(U.S. dollars in thousands)     
2006    $  36,397 
2007      33,707 
2008      27,876 
2009      24,981 
2010      18,574 
2011-2022      101,574 


Total minimum future rentals  $  243,109 



166


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

18. Commitments and Contingencies (continued)

     (d) Properties (continued)

     During 2003, the Company entered into a purchase, sale and leaseback transaction to acquire new office space in London. The Company has recognized a capital lease asset of $152.9 million and $185.2 million, and deferred a gain of $46.5 million and $54.5 million related to this lease at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The gain is being amortized to income in line with the amortization of the asset. The future minimum lease payments in the aggregate are expected to be $319.5 million and annually for the next five years are as follows:

Year Ended December 31:   
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2006    $ 10,754 
2007    11,023 
2008    11,299 
2009    11,581 
2010    11,871 

     (e) Tax Matters

     The Company is a Cayman Islands corporation and, except as described below, neither it nor its non-U.S. subsidiaries have paid United States corporate income taxes (other than withholding taxes on dividend income) on the basis that they are not engaged in a trade or business or otherwise subject to taxation in the United States. However, because definitive identification of activities which constitute being engaged in a trade or business in the United States is not provided by the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, regulations or court decisions, there can be no assurance that the Internal Revenue Service will not contend that the Company or its non-U.S. subsidiaries are engaged in a trade or business or otherwise subject to taxation in the United States. If the Company or its non-U.S. subsidiaries were considered to be engaged in a trade or business in the United States (and, if the Company or such subsidiaries were to qualify for the benefits under the income tax treaty between the United States and Bermuda and other countries in which the Company operates, such businesses were attributable to a “permanent establishment” in the United States), the Company or such subsidiaries could be subject to U.S. tax at regular tax rates on its taxable income that is effectively connected with its U.S. trade or business plus an additional 30% “branch profits” tax on such income remaining after the regular tax, in which case there could be a significant adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations and financial condition.

(f) Letters of Credit

     At December 31, 2005 and 2004, $3.5 billion and $3.0 billion of letters of credit, respectively, were outstanding, 5.3% and 6.6% of which were collateralized by the Company’s investment portfolio, supporting U.S. non-admitted business and the Company’s Lloyd’s Syndicates’ capital requirements.

167


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

19. Share Capital

     (a) Authorized and Issued

     The authorized share capital is 999,990,000 ordinary shares of a par value of $0.01 each. Holders of Class A ordinary shares are entitled to one vote for each share. All ordinary shares in issue at December 31, 2005 are Class A ordinary shares.

The following table is a summary of Class A ordinary shares issued and outstanding:

Year Ended December 31             
(in thousands)    2005     2004     2003  

 
 
 
Balance – beginning of year    138,932     137,343     136,063  
Exercise of options    738     819     734  
Issue of restricted shares    896     661     500  
Issue of shares – Employee stock purchase plan    114     168     67  
Repurchase of shares    (74 )    (59 )    (21 ) 
Issue of shares    38,923          

 
 
 
Balance – end of year    179,529     138,932     137,343  

 
 
 

     In December 2005, the Company issued 38.9 million ordinary shares at a price of $65.0 per share to support capital requirements subsequent to the insured hurricane losses during the 2005 Atlantic hurricane season and the conclusion of the loss related to the independent actuarial process with Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company. The net proceeds from this issuance was $2.4 billion.

     The Company issued 9.2 million shares during November 2001 at a price of $89.00 per share to support capital requirements subsequent to the September 11 event. Net proceeds received were $787.7 million.

     In August 2002, the Company issued 9.2 million 8.00% Series A Preference Ordinary Shares at $25 per share. Gross proceeds were $230.0 million and related expenses were $7.2 million. Upon dissolution of the Company, the holders of the Preference Shares would be entitled to receive a liquidation preference of $25 per share, plus accrued and unpaid dividends. Dividends on the Preference Shares are cumulative from the date of original issuance and are payable when declared. The Company may redeem the Preference Shares on or after August 14, 2007, at a redemption price of $25 per share. The Company may, under certain circumstances, redeem the Preference Shares before August 14, 2007 at specified redemption prices, plus accrued and unpaid dividends. These circumstances include an amalgamation, consolidation or other similar transaction involving the Company in which the Preference Shares are entitled to a class vote ($26 per share redemption price), or a change in tax laws that requires the Company to pay additional amounts with respect to the Preference Shares ($25 per share redemption price). The proceeds were used for general corporate purposes.

     In November 2002, the Company issued 11.5 million 7.625% Series B Preference Ordinary Shares at $25 per share. Gross proceeds were $287.5 million and related expenses were $9.1 million. Upon dissolution of the Company, the holders of the Preference Shares would be entitled to receive a liquidation preference of $25 per share, plus accrued and unpaid dividends. Dividends on the Preference Shares are cumulative from the date of original issuance and are payable when declared. The Company may redeem the Preference Shares on or after November 18, 2007, at a redemption price of $25 per share. The Company may, under certain circumstances, redeem the Preference Shares before November, 2007 at specified redemption prices, plus accrued and unpaid dividends. These circumstances include an amalgamation, consolidation or other similar transaction involving the Company in which the Preference

168


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

19. Share Capital (continued)

     (a) Authorized and Issued (continued)

Shares are entitled to a class vote ($26 per share redemption price), or a change in tax laws that requires the Company to pay additional amounts with respect to the Preference Shares ($25 per share redemption price). The proceeds were used for general corporate purposes.

     (b) Share Repurchases

     The Company has had several stock repurchase plans as part of its capital management program. On January 9, 2000, the Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of shares up to $500.0 million. During 2001, the Company repurchased 1.5 million ordinary shares at a total cost of $116.9 million, or an average cost of $76.40 per ordinary share. During 2000, the Company repurchased 5.1 million ordinary shares at a total cost of $247.7 million, or an average cost of $48.82 per ordinary share. During 2005, 2004 and 2003 no share repurchases took place under the January 9, 2000 authorization. The Company has repurchased shares from employees and directors in relation to share swaps on option exercises and withholding tax on restricted stock.

     (c) Stock Plans

     The Company’s 1991 Performance Incentive Program, as amended and restated effective March 7, 2003, provides for grants of non-qualified or incentive stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units, performance shares, performance units and stock appreciation rights (“SARs”). The plan is administered by the Board of Directors and the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors. Stock options may be granted with or without SARs. No SARs have been granted to date. Grant prices are established at the fair market value of the Company’s common stock at the date of grant. Options and SARs have a life of not longer than ten years and vest as set forth at the time of grant. Options currently vest annually over three or four years from date of grant.

     The Company's 1999 Performance Incentive Program for Employees (the “1999 Program”) provides for grants of non-statutory stock options, restricted stock, performance shares and performance units to employees of the Company and its subsidiaries who are not subject to the reporting requirements of Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. The 1999 Program is administered by the Board of Directors of the Company or the Compensation Committee, as determined from time to time by the Board of Directors.

     Restricted stock awards issued under the 1991 and 1999 Performance Incentive Program, vest as set forth in the applicable award agreements. These shares contained certain restrictions, prior to vesting, relating to, among other things, forfeiture in the event of termination of employment and transferability. As the shares are issued, deferred compensation equivalent to the fair market value on the date of the grant is charged to shareholders’ equity and subsequently amortized over the vesting period. Restricted stock issued under these plans totaled 895,484 shares, 660,535 shares, and 500,432 shares in 2005, 2004, and 2003, respectively.

     Prior to December 31, 2003, all options granted to non-employee directors were granted under the 1991 Performance Incentive Program. In 2004, these options were granted under the Directors Stock & Option Plan. All options vest immediately on the grant date. Directors may also make an irrevocable election preceding the beginning of each fiscal year to defer cash compensation that would otherwise be payable as his or her annual retainer in increments of 10%. The deferred payments are credited in the form of ordinary share units calculated by dividing 110% of the deferred payment by the market value of the Company’s stock on the date the compensation would otherwise have been paid. These shares are distributed under the terms of the plan. Shares issued under the plan totaled 3,814, 3,819, and 3,153 in 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively.

     A second stock plan is provided for the directors that grants share units equal to their annual retainer divided by the market price of the Company’s ordinary stock on January 1 of each year. These units receive dividends in the form of additional units equal to the cash value divided by the market price on the payment date. Stock units totaling

169


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

19. Share Capital (continued)

     (c) Stock Plans (continued)

10,027, 8,351, and 8,598 were issued in 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively. Total units are granted as shares upon retirement from the Board.

     Following the merger with NAC, new option plans were created in the Company to adopt the plans. Options generally have a five or six year vesting schedule, with the majority expiring ten years from the date of grant; the remainder having no expiration. A stock plan is also maintained for non-employee directors. Options expire ten years from the date of grant and are fully exercisable six months after their grant date.

     In 1999, the Company adopted the 1999 Performance Incentive Plan under which 1,250,000 options were available for issuance to employees who were not directors or executive officers of the Company.

     The Employee Share Purchase Plan (the “ESPP”) was approved by the shareholders of the Company on May 10, 2002; however, the Company has discontinued the ESPP effective January 1, 2006. The ESPP was administered by a committee which consisted of members of the Compensation Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors. The ESPP had two offering periods a year. The first period commenced on July 1, 2002. All employees of the Company and its designated participating subsidiaries, were eligible to participate in the ESPP provided they have been employed at least one month prior to the start of the offering period and they do not hold more than 5% of the Company’s total stock, including stock acquired in the current period. Employees could invest up to 20% of their total monthly cash compensation towards the purchase of the Company’s shares up to a total market value (measured on the first day of the offering period) of U.S. $25,000. The total number of shares purchased in any offering period cannot exceed 1,000 shares. Employees who enrolled in the ESPP may purchase the Company’s shares at a 15% discount on the lesser of the market price at the beginning or at the end of the six month offering period. Once purchased, employees can sell or transfer their shares to someone else’s name only during an Open Trading Window. Participants in the ESPP are eligible to receive dividends on the Company’s shares. A total of 1,255,000 ordinary shares may be issued under the ESPP. The number of share issued during the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 were 114,177 and 167,890, respectively.

     (d) FAS 123

     The fair value of each option grant is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted average assumptions:

    2005     2004     2003  






Dividend yield    2.60 %    2.54 %    2.80 % 
Risk free interest rate    4.00 %    3.00 %    2.81 % 
Expected volatility    25.0 %    27.0 %    30.0 % 
Expected lives    5.5 years     6.0 years     5.0 years  

     Total stock-based compensation expensed, which related to amortization of restricted stock, was $33.0 million, $28.4 million, and $17.9 million in 2005, 2004, and 2003, respectively.

170


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

19. Share Capital (continued)

     (e) Options

Following is a summary of stock options and related activity:

    2005         2004         2003      











        Weighted        Weighted        Weighted 
        Average        Average        Average 
    Number of     Exercise    Number of     Exercise    Number of     Exercise 
    Shares     Price    Shares     Price    Shares     Price 











Outstanding – beginning of year    12,109,540     74.19    11,781,228     $ 72.13    11,198,066     $ 71.31 
Granted    1,894,704     75.47    1,883,072     $ 78.81    1,805,871     $ 68.85 
Exercised    (731,113 )    48.89    (821,624 )    $ 49.43    (698,895 )    $ 47.13 
Cancelled    (527,841 )    82.41    (733,136 )    $ 82.23    (523,814 )    $ 75.01 

 

 


 

Outstanding – end of year    12,745,290     75.35    12,109,540     $ 74.19    11,781,228     $ 72.13 

 

 


 

Options exercisable    9,091,308         8,443,215         7,278,812      

 
 
 
Options available for grant    4,557,447         6,866,681         8,707,681      

 
 
 

Available for grant includes shares that may be granted as either stock options or restricted stock.

     The exercise price of the Company’s options granted is the market price of the Company’s Class A ordinary shares on the grant date, except as noted below.

     During 2004, 295,000 options were granted with an exercise price of $88.00 and the market price was $77.10.

     The following table summarizes information about the Company’s stock options (including stock appreciation rights) for options outstanding as of December 31, 2005:

      Options Outstanding        Options Exercisable 





              Average         
          Weighted    Remaining        Weighted 
  Range of    Number of    Average    Contractual    Number of    Average 
  Exercise Prices    Options    Exercise Price    Life    Options    Exercise Price 







$    24.95 – $39.62    258,103    $ 37.86    0.9 years    259,783    $ 37.86 
$    41.40 – $61.50    1,855,288    $ 53.04    3.0 years    1,864,254    $ 53.64 
$    64.69 – $96.56    10,631,899    $ 80.17    6.6 years    6,967,271    $ 82.59 







$    24.95 – $96.56    12,745,290    $ 75.35    6.0 years    9,091,308    $ 75.25 








(1)      Includes 1,601 options outstanding and exercisable, with an average exercise price of $30.59 that have no expiration date. These options are not included in the calculation of the average remaining contractual life.
 
(2)      Includes 14,455 options outstanding and exercisable, with an average exercise price of $40.89 that have no expiration date. These options are not included in the calculation of the average remaining contractual life.
 

171


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

19. Share Capital (continued)

     (f) Voting

     The Company’s Articles of Association restrict the voting power of any person to less than approximately 10% of total voting power.

     (g) Share Rights Plan

     Rights to purchase Class A ordinary shares (the “Rights”) were distributed as a dividend at the rate of one Right for each Class A ordinary share held of record as of the close of business on October 31, 1998. Each Right entitles holders of Class A ordinary shares to buy one ordinary share at an exercise price of $350. The Rights would be exercisable, and would detach from the Class A ordinary shares, only if a person or group were to acquire 20% or more of the Company’s outstanding Class A ordinary shares, or were to announce a tender or exchange offer that, if consummated, would result in a person or group beneficially owning 20% or more of Class A ordinary shares. Upon a person or group without prior approval of the Board acquiring 20% or more of Class A ordinary shares, each Right would entitle the holder (other than such an acquiring person or group) to purchase Class A ordinary shares (or, in certain circumstances, Class A ordinary shares of the acquiring person) with a value of twice the Rights exercise price upon payment of the Rights exercise price. The Company will be entitled to redeem the Rights at $0.01 per Right at any time until the close of business on the tenth day after the Rights become exercisable. The Rights will expire at the close of business on September 30, 2008, and do not have a fair value. The Company has reserved 119,073,878 Class A ordinary shares being authorized and unissued for issue upon exercise of Rights.

20. Retirement Plans

     The Company maintains both defined contribution and defined benefit retirement plans, which vary for each subsidiary. Plan assets are invested principally in equity securities and fixed maturities.

     The Company has a qualified defined contribution plan which is managed externally and whereby employees and the Company contribute a certain percentage of the employee’s gross salary into the plan each month. The Company’s contribution generally vests over 5 years. The Company’s expenses for its qualified contributory defined contribution retirement plans were $40.9 million, $38.8 million and $27.5 million in the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003, respectively.

     A qualified non-contributory defined benefit pension plan exists to cover a number of its U.S. employees. This plan also includes a non-qualified supplemental defined benefit plan designed to compensate individuals to the extent their benefits under the Company’s qualified plan are curtailed due to Internal Revenue Code limitations. Benefits are based on years of service and compensation, as defined in the plan, during the highest consecutive three years of the employee’s last ten years of employment. Under these plans, the Company’s policy is to make annual contributions to the plan that are deductible for federal income tax purposes and that meet the minimum funding standards required by law. The contribution level is determined by utilizing the entry age cost method and different actuarial assumptions than those used for pension expense purposes. The projected benefit obligation, accumulated benefit obligation and fair value of the assets for this plan with accumulated benefit obligations in excess of plan assets were $29.4 million, $29.4 million and $14.2 million, respectively, as of December 31, 2005, and $27.0 million, $27.0 million and $13.8 million, respectively, as of December 31, 2004.

     In the first quarter of 2002, the Company curtailed its qualified non-contributory defined benefit plan. Under the terms of the curtailment, eligible employees will not earn additional defined benefits for future services. However,

172


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

20. Retirement Plans (continued)

future service may be counted toward vesting of benefits which accumulated based on past service. The Company recognized a benefit of $9.9 million associated with this curtailment gain.

     During 2003, all pension benefits and retirement plans for Winterthur International employees were transitioned into the Company’s defined contribution plan.

21. Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

     The related tax effects allocated to each component of the change in accumulated other comprehensive income were as follows:

    Before Tax     Tax Expense     Net of Tax  
(U.S. dollars in thousands)    Amount     (Benefit)     Amount  









Year Ended December 31, 2005:               
Unrealized gains (losses) on investments:               
   Unrealized gains (losses) arising during year 
  $ (96,343 )    $  (13,672 )    $ (82,671 ) 
   Less reclassification for gains realized in income 
  241,822       9,774     232,048  


 

 

 
Net unrealized gains (losses) on investments    (338,165 )      (23,446 )    (314,719 ) 
Derivative gain on cash flow hedge    630           630  
Impact of net unrealized gain or loss on               
Future policy benefit reserves    (46,743 )          (46,743 ) 
Foreign currency translation adjustments    198,270       29,468     168,802  


 

 

 
Change in accumulated other comprehensive income    $ (186,008 )    $  6,022     $ (192,030 ) 


 

 

 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2004:               
Unrealized gains on investments:               
   Unrealized gains arising during year    $ 473,368     $  40,921     $ 432,447  
   Less reclassification for gains realized in income 
  246,547       13,012     233,535  


 

 

 
Net unrealized gains on investments    226,821       27,909     198,912  
Derivative loss on cash flow hedge    (6,118 )          (6,118 ) 
Impact of net unrealized gain or loss on               
Future policy benefit reserves    (49,250 )          (49,250 ) 
Foreign currency translation adjustments    (203,808 )      (30,342 )    (173,466 ) 


 

 

 
Change in accumulated other comprehensive income    $ (32,355 )     $  (2,433 )    $ (29,922 ) 


 

 

 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2003:               
Unrealized gains (losses) on investments:               
   Unrealized gains (losses) arising during year 
  $ 452,804     $  (6,659 )    $ 459,463  
   Less reclassification for gains realized in income 
  120,195       13,451     106,744  


 

 

 
Net unrealized gains (losses) on investments    332,609       (20,110 )    352,719  
Impact of net unrealized gain or loss on               
Future policy benefit reserves    (10,487 )          (10,487 ) 
Foreign currency translation adjustments    (36,380 )      471     (36,851 ) 


 

 

 
Change in accumulated other comprehensive income    $ 285,742     $  (19,639 )    $ 305,381  


 

 

 

173


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
22. Dividends

     In 2005 and 2004, the Company paid dividends of $40.3 million, respectively, to Series A and Series B preference shareholders.

     In 2005, four quarterly dividends were paid at $0.50 per share to all ordinary shareholders of record as of March 10, June 9, September 8 and December 8.

     In 2004, four regular quarterly dividends were paid at $0.49 per share to ordinary shareholders of record as of March 8, June 7, September 6 and December 6.

     In 2003, four regular quarterly dividends were paid at $0.48 per share to ordinary shareholders of record as of March 10, June 9, September 8 and December 8.

23. Taxation

     The Company is not subject to any taxes in the Cayman Islands on either income or capital gains under current Cayman law. The Company has received an undertaking that the Company will be exempted from Cayman Islands income or capital gains taxes until June 2018 in the event of any such taxes being imposed.

     The Company’s Bermuda subsidiaries are not subject to any income, withholding or capital gains taxes under current Bermuda law. In the event that there is a change such that these taxes are imposed, the Bermuda subsidiaries would be exempted from any such tax until March 2016 pursuant to the Bermuda Exempted Undertakings Tax Protection Act of 1966, and Amended Act of 1987.

     The Company’s Indian subsidiary is not subject to certain income and capital gains taxes under current Indian law. This subsidiary is exempt from these taxes until March 31, 2009 pursuant to the Income Tax Act 1961.

     The Company’s U.S. subsidiaries are subject to federal, state and local corporate income taxes and other taxes applicable to U.S. corporations. The provision for federal income taxes has been determined under the principles of the consolidated tax provisions of the Internal Revenue Code and Regulations thereunder. Should the U.S. subsidiaries pay a dividend to the Company, withholding taxes will apply.

     The Company has operations in subsidiary and branch form in various other jurisdictions around the world, including but not limited to the U.K., Switzerland, Ireland, Germany, France, Luxembourg and various countries in Latin America that are subject to relevant taxes in those jurisdictions.

     The income tax provisions for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003 are as follows:

Year Ended December 31                 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005     2004     2003  


 

 

 
Current Expense:                 
   U.S.    $  30,535     $ 16,605     $  8,657  
   Non U.S.      69,072     34,678       12,372  





 

 
Total current expense    $  99,607     $ 51,283     $  21,029  


 

 

 
Deferred Expense (Benefit):                 
   U.S.    $  24,784     $ 41,673     $  (97,382 ) 
   Non U.S.      (75,107 )    (1,613 )      107,808  


 

 

 
Total deferred (benefit) expense    $  (50,323 )    $ 40,060     $  10,426  


 

 

 
   Total Tax Expense    $  49,284     $ 91,343     $  31,455  


 

 

 

174


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
23. Taxation (continued)

     The weighted average expected tax provision has been calculated using the pre-tax accounting income (loss) in each jurisdiction multiplied by that jurisdiction’s applicable statutory tax rate. Reconciliation of the difference between the provision for income taxes and the expected tax provision at the weighted average tax rate for the years December 31, 2005 and 2004 is provided below:

(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005     2004  






Expected tax provision at weighted average rate 
  $ 50,809     $ 99,420  
Permanent differences:         
   Non taxable investment income    (11,569 )    (1,619 ) 
   Non taxable income    (9,718 )    (3,260 ) 
   Prior year adjustments    (19,342 )    (7,358 ) 
   State, local and other taxes    19,090     14,051  
   Valuation allowance    66,184     50,240  
   Tax attributable to other comprehensive income    (226 )    50  
   Transfer pricing adjustments    (44,484 )    (65,513 ) 
   Stock options    (1,907 )     
   Non deductible expenses    5,361     8,630  
   Contingency reserve    3,597     (2,450 ) 
   Depreciation    (8,100 )     
   Other    (411 )    (848 ) 


 

 
Total tax expense (benefit)    $ 49,284     $ 91,343  


 

 

     Significant components of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities as of December 31, 2005 and 2004 were as follows:

(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005    2004 




Deferred Tax Asset:         
   Net unpaid loss reserve discount    $ 85,688    $ 69,555 
   Net unearned premiums    38,091    26,868 
   Compensation liabilities    3,110    2,786 
   Net operating losses    238,071    230,610 
   Alternative minimum tax credits    24,374    16,881 
   Investment adjustments    30,648    23,878 
   Deferred commission    45,317    32,528 
Pension    3,898    2,558 
Bad Debt Reserve    3,073    6,502 
Guaranty fund recoupment    3,643    3,643 
Currency translation adjustments    23,228    11,453 
   Net unrealized depreciation on investments    20,616     
Stock options    5,806     
Depreciation    7,562     
Capital losses    7,728     
Other    13,188    21,704 




Deferred tax asset, gross of valuation allowance    554,041    448,966 
Valuation allowance    154,465    68,556 




Deferred tax asset, net of valuation allowance    399,576    380,410 




Deferred Tax Liability:         
   Net unrealized appreciation on investments    9,395    25,243 
   Deferred acquisition costs    52,194    37,769 
   Currency translation adjustments    3,394    1,611 
       Other    16,194    27,188 




Deferred tax liability    81,177    91,811 




Net Deferred Tax Asset    $ 318,399    $ 288,599 





175


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
23. Taxation (continued)

     The valuation allowance at December 31, 2005 and December 31, 2004 of $154.5 million and $68.6 million, respectively, relates to net operating loss carry forwards in Switzerland and Australia and net unrealized capital losses and realized capital loss carry forwards in the U.S. that may not be realized within a reasonable period. As of December 31, 2005, the Company has net unrealized capital losses and realized capital loss carry forwards of approximately $56.2 million and $22 million respectively in the U.S., against which a valuation allowance of $23.7 million has been established. Management believes it is more likely than not that the tax benefit of the remaining net deferred tax assets will be realized.

     U.S. net operating loss carry forwards at December 31, 2005 were approximately $18.4 million and will expire in future years through 2024. As of December 31, 2005, net operating loss carry forwards in the U.K. were approximately $332 million and have no expiration. As of December 31, 2005, net operating loss carry forwards in Switzerland were approximately $554 million and will expire in future years through 2012.

     Management is required to determine if there is sufficient positive evidence to conclude that it is more likely than not that the deferred tax asset attributable to its U.S. group and UK group net operating losses would be utilized within a reasonable period. Management has reviewed historical taxable income and future taxable income projections for its U.S. group and its UK group and has determined that in its judgment, the net operating losses will more likely than not be realized as reductions of future taxable income within a reasonable period. Specifically with regard to the U.S. group, management has determined that the projected U.S. consolidated taxable income will be sufficient to utilize the net operating losses of approximately $18.4 million within a reasonable period. With regard to the UK group, management has determined that the projected UK group taxable income (using UK rules for group loss relief) will be sufficient to utilize the net operating losses of approximately $332 million. Management will continue to evaluate income generated in future periods by the U.S. group and the UK group in determining the reasonableness of its position. If management determines that future income generated by the U.S. group or UK group is insufficient to cause the realization of the net operating losses within a reasonable period, a valuation allowance would be required for the U.S. portion of the net deferred tax asset, in the amount of $6.4 million and for the UK portion of the net deferred tax asset, in the amount of $99.6 million.

     Effective as of January 1, 2004, XL Re America Inc (“XLRA”), a member of the U.S. group, entered into an adverse development reinsurance treaty with another non U.S. reinsurance subsidiary of the Company. The treaty related to the 1985 through (and including) 2000 underwriting years covering any adverse development on reserves calculated as of December 31, 2003 between January 1, 2004 and December 31, 2005. The treaty has a limit of $500 million and will limit future loss development at XLRA relating to these underwriting years. Any commutation of this treaty requires the prior approval of the New York Department of Insurance. There is no impact of this treaty on the consolidated financial statements of the Company; however as part of management’s continuing evaluation of its deferred tax asset, the treaty is critical in evaluating the future income position of the U.S. group of companies. Management believes that the treaty will protect the U.S. group from unexpected prior loss development. Absent unexpected loss development from the 2000 and prior underwriting years, management has concluded that there is sufficient positive evidence of future profitability in the U.S. and that a valuation allowance as a charge against the deferred tax asset is not required at this time.

     Shareholders’ equity at December 31, 2005 and 2004 reflected tax benefits of $1.8 million and $3.6 million, respectively, related to compensation expense deductions for stock options exercised by the Company’s U.S. subsidiaries.

176


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
24. Statutory Financial Data

     The Company’s ability to pay dividends is subject to certain regulatory restrictions on the payment of dividends by its subsidiaries. The payment of such dividends is limited by applicable laws and statutory requirements of the various countries the Company operates in, including Bermuda, the U.S. and the U.K., among others. Statutory capital and surplus, based on draft unaudited filings for the principal operating subsidiaries of the Company for the year ended December 31, 2005 was as follows. The comparative figures at December 31, 2004 are the final audited figures submitted to the regulators.

    Bermuda    U.S. (1)    U.K., Europe and Other 






(U.S. dollars in thousands)    2005    2004    2005    2004    2005    2004 












Required statutory capital and surplus    $ 3,078,127    $ 2,912,713    $ 634,747    $ 569,193    $  397,248    $ 375,675 
Actual statutory capital and surplus    $ 11,032,266    $ 8,306,039    $ 1,943,034    $ 1,861,928    $  950,549    $ 1,150,441 

(1) Required statutory capital and surplus represents 100% RBC level for principle U.S. operating subsidiaries.

     The difference between statutory financial statements and statements prepared in accordance with GAAP vary by jurisdiction however the primary difference is that statutory financial statements do not reflect deferred policy acquisition costs, deferred income tax net assets, intangible assets, unrealized appreciation on investments and any unauthorized/authorized reinsurance charges.

     Except as noted below, there are no statutory restrictions on the payment of dividends from retained earnings by any of the Company’s subsidiaries as applicable minimum levels of solvency and liquidity have been met and all regulatory requirements and licensing rules complied with. At December 31, 2005, and 2004 (XLRA), the Company’s lead property and casualty subsidiary in the United States, had a statutory deficit of $3.6 million and $84.4 million, respectively. As a result, XLRA cannot declare or distribute any dividends to shareholders during any twelve month period that exceeds the lesser of 10% of surplus of 100% of net investment income, without obtaining prior approval of the New York Insurance Department. Similarly, three of the seven property and casualty subsidiaries directly or indirectly owned by XLRA also had statutory deficits ranging from $13.2 million to $46.9 million at December 31, 2005 and four of the seven had statutory deficits ranging from $0.2 million to $57.4 million at December 31, 2004. As a result, these subsidiaries are similarly unable to currently make a dividend distribution under the insurance law of their respective states of domicile without obtaining prior approval from the domicile insurance department, which include Delaware, New York and North Dakota. At December 31, 2005 and 2004, XL Insurance Company Limited (previously known as Winterthur International Insurance Company Limited) had a statutory earned deficit and is restricted from making a dividend distribution at this time under U.K. Company law.

177


XL CAPITAL LTD
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
25. Earnings Per Share

The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted earnings per share:

Year Ended December 31                 
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)    2005     2004    2003 







Basic Earnings Per Ordinary Share:                 
Net (loss) income available to ordinary shareholders    $  (1,292,298 )    $  1,126,292    $ 371,658 
Weighted average ordinary shares outstanding      141,406       137,903    136,906 
Basic (loss) earnings per ordinary share    $  (9.14 )    $  8.17    $ 2.71 


 



Diluted Earnings Per Ordinary Share:                 
Net (loss) income available to ordinary shareholders    $  (1,292,298 )    $  1,126,292    $ 371,658 


 



Weighted average ordinary shares outstanding – basic      141,406       137,903    136,906 
Average stock options outstanding (1)            679    1,281 


 



Weighted average ordinary shares outstanding – diluted      141,406       138,582    138,187 


 



Diluted (loss) earnings per ordinary share    $  (9.14 )    $  8.13    $ 2.69 


 




(1) Net of shares repurchased under the treasury stock method.

26. Related Party Transactions

     At December 31, 2005, the Company owned minority stakes in eight independent investment management companies (“Investment Management Affiliates”). These ownership stakes are part of the Company’s asset management strategy, pursuant to which the Company seeks to develop relationships with specialty investment management organizations, generally acquiring an equity interest in the business. The Company also invests in certain of the funds and limited partnerships and other legal entities managed by these affiliates and through these funds and partnerships pay management and performance fees to the Company’s Investment Management Affiliates.

     On August 5, 2003, the Company, under the terms of its 50% quota share reinsurance contract (the “quota share contract”) with Annuity and Life Reinsurance, Ltd. (“ALRE”), notified ALRE of its intention to elect to automatically terminate the quota share contract and recapture the business previously ceded to ALRE. Following this notice and with effect from June 30, 2003, the Company entered into a comprehensive settlement with ALRE, which in addition to the quota share contract, commuted or otherwise terminated all reinsurance relationships that the Company had with ALRE. As settlement of the quota share contract and the other insurance and reinsurance relationships, the Company received proceeds of $6.0 million.

27. XL Capital Finance (Europe) plc

     XL Capital Finance (Europe) plc (“XLFE”) is a wholly owned finance subsidiary of the Company. In January 2002, XLFE issued $600 million par value 6.5% Guaranteed Senior Notes due January 2012. These Notes are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the Company. The Company’s ability to obtain funds from its subsidiaries to satisfy any of its obligations under this guarantee is subject to certain contractual restrictions, applicable laws and statutory requirements of the various countries in which the Company operates including Bermuda, the U.S. and the U.K., among others. Required statutory capital and surplus for the principal operating subsidiaries of the Company was $4.1 billion as of December 31, 2005.

178


XL CAPITAL LTD

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

28. Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data

     The following is a summary of the unaudited quarterly financial data for 2005 and 2004:

     
First 
Second 
Third
Fourth
 
(U.S. dollars in thousands, except per share amount)     
Quarter 
Quarter 
Quarter
Quarter
 


     

     

       

 
2005               
   
 
   Net premiums earned – general operations (1)    $  1,766,269    $  1,727,561   
$ 
1,655,329    
$ 
1,724,479  
   Net premiums earned – life operations      81,471      1,933,215   
87,964    
135,071  
   Net premiums earned – financial operations      51,695      51,992   
56,761    
93,688  
   Underwriting profit (loss) – general operations (1)      175,440      45,368   
(1,363,809 )   
(1,125,082 ) 
   Net income (loss) available to ordinary shareholders      442,945      135,895   
(1,049,201 )   
(821,937 ) 
   Net income (loss) per ordinary share and               
   
 
       ordinary share equivalent – basic    $  3.21    $  0.98   
$ 
(7.53 )   
$ 
(5.51 ) 
   Net income (loss) per ordinary share and               
   
 
       ordinary share equivalent – diluted    $  3.18    $  0.97   
$ 
(7.53 )   
$ 
(5.51 ) 
2004               
   
 
   Net premiums earned – general operations (1)    $  1,593,246    $  1,826,215   
$ 
1,862,748    
$ 
1,705,732  
   Net premiums earned – life operations      91,808      986,930   
93,111    
193,326  
   Net premiums earned – financial operations      47,748      56,970   
70,383    
53,797  
   Underwriting profit (loss) – general operations (1)      191,190      222,518   
(162,440 )   
92,973  
   Net income available to ordinary shareholders      452,169      363,604   
22,471    
288,048  
   Net income per ordinary share and               
   
 
       ordinary share equivalent – basic    $  3.29    $  2.64   
$ 
0.16    
$ 
2.08  
   Net income per ordinary share and               
   
 
       ordinary share equivalent – diluted    $  3.25    $  2.62   
$ 
0.16    
$ 
2.07  


(1)      Certain reclassifications have been made relating to the Company’s change in presentation of financial operations. There was no effect on net income from this change in presentation.
(2) Average stock options outstanding have been excluded where anti-dilutive to earnings per share. Consequently, where there is a net loss, basic weighted average ordinary shares outstanding are used to calculate net loss per share.

     In the third quarter of 2005, the Company recorded net loss and loss expenses of $1.5 billion in relation to Hurricanes Katrina and Rita and other natural catastrophes. In the fourth quarter of 2005 that loss estimate was increased by $165.1 million. In addition a loss of $808.9 million was recorded in the fourth quarter of 2005 in relation to the conclusion of the independent actuarial process with Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company.

     In the third quarter at 2004, the Company recorded net loss and loss expenses of $446.8 million in relation to the 2004 Atlantic hurricane season, which resulted in four insured hurricanes aggregating to the largest seasonal loss in history. In the fourth quarter of 2004 that loss estimate was increased by $69.8 million. In addition, the Company incurred net loss and loss expenses of $74.6 million in relation to the tsunami in South Asia in December of 2004.

179


ITEM 9.     CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

     There have been no changes in or any disagreements with accountants regarding accounting and financial disclosure within the twenty-four months ending December 31, 2005.

ITEM 9A.      CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

     Conclusion Regarding the Effectiveness of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

     The Company carried out an evaluation, under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of disclosure controls and procedures pursuant to Rules 13a-15 and 15d-15 promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, as of the end of the period covered by this report. Based on that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the disclosure controls and procedures are effective to provide reasonable assurance that all material information relating to the Company required to be filed in this report has been made known to them in a timely fashion.

     Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

     The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

     The Company’s internal control system was designed to provide reasonable assurance to the Company’s management and board of directors regarding the preparation and fair presentation of published financial statements.

     The Company’s management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2005. In making this assessment, it used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (the “Framework”). Based on its assessment, management concluded that, as of December 31, 2005, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective based on the Framework criteria.

     PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm, have issued an audit report on the Company’s assessment of its internal control over financial reporting. This report appears on page 191. See Item 8, “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

     Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

     There have been no changes in internal control over financial reporting identified in connection with the Company’s evaluation required pursuant to Rules 13a-15 and 15d-15 promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, that occurred during the most recent fiscal quarter that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

ITEM 9B.      OTHER INFORMATION

     None.

180


PART III

ITEM 10.      DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT

     Certain of the information required by this item relating to the executive officers of the Company may be found under Item 4, “Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders – Executive Officers of the Company.” The balance of the information required by this item is omitted because a definitive proxy statement that involves the election of directors will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to Regulation 14A, which proxy statement is incorporated by reference.

ITEM 11.      EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

     This item is omitted because a definitive proxy statement that involves the election of directors will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to Regulation 14A, which proxy statement is incorporated by reference.

ITEM 12.     SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

     The following table summarizes the Company’s equity compensation plan information as of December 31, 2005:

 
Number of securities remaining
 
 
Number of securities to be 
available for future issuance
 
 
issued upon exercise of 
Weighted-average exercise 
under equity compensation
 
 
outstanding options, 
price of outstanding 
plans (excluding securities
 
 
warrants and rights 
options, warrants and rights 
reflected in column a)
 





Plan Category  (a)  (b)  (c)  





Equity compensation plans        
approved by security holders   12,291,908  $76.31  14,994,117 (1)  





Equity compensation plans not       
approved by security holders (2) 316,353  $50.00  100,783  





Total  12,608,261    15,004,900  






(1) Of such maximum number of ordinary shares 3.9 million can be issued as stock options or SARs, 100,000 can be issued as Restricted Stock, Restricted Stock Units or Performance Shares, and the remaining 10.5 million ordinary shares can be issued as any form of Award, except that, in the case of Awards granted out of such 10.5 million ordinary shares allotment for each Restricted Stock, Restricted Stock Unit, Stock Appreciation Right, or Performance Share Award issued, the number of ordinary shares available under the Program will be reduced by three ordinary shares.

(2) The Company’s 1999 Performance Incentive Program for Employees (the “1999 Program”) provides for grants of non-statutory stock options, restricted stock, performance shares and performance units to employees of the Company and its subsidiaries who are not subject to the reporting requirements of Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. The 1999 Program is administered by the Board of Directors of the Company or the Compensation Committee, as determined from time to time by the Board of Directors.

     The remaining information required by this Item is omitted because a definitive proxy statement that involves the election of directors will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to Regulation 14A, which information is incorporated by reference.

181


ITEM 13.      CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS

     This item is omitted because a definitive proxy statement that involves the election of directors will be filed the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to Regulation 14A, which proxy statement is incorporated by reference.

ITEM 14.      PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

     This item is omitted because a definitive proxy statement that involves the election of directors will be filed the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to Regulation 14A, which proxy statement is incorporated by reference.

PART IV

ITEM 15.      EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

Financial Statements, Financial Statement Schedules and Exhibits.

        Page 

Report of Independent Auditors        192 
         
1. Financial Statements         
         
Included in Part II – See Item 8 of this report.         
         
2. Financial Statement Schedules         
         
Included in Part IV of this report:         
    Schedule     
    Number    Page 


Consolidated Summary of Investments – Other than Investments in         
     Related Parties, as at December 31, 2005    I    194 
         
Condensed Financial Information of Registrant, as at December 31, 2005         
     and for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004, and 2003    II    195 
         
Reinsurance, for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004, and 2003    IV    198 
         
Supplementary Information Concerning Property/Casualty Insurance         
     Operations for the years ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003    VI    199 
         
Other Schedules have been omitted as they are not applicable to the Company         

182


     3. Exhibits

Exhibit             Description 
   
3.1    Memorandum of Association of the Company, incorporated by reference to Appendix G to the Joint Proxy 
    Statement of EXEL Limited and Mid Ocean Limited on Schedule 14A filed on July 2, 1998. 
     
3.2    Articles of Association of the Company, incorporated by reference to Appendix G to the Joint Proxy Statement 
    of EXEL Limited and Mid Ocean Limited on Schedule 14A filed on July 2, 1998. 
     
4.1    Rights Agreement, dated as of September 11, 1998, between EXEL Limited and ChaseMellon Shareholder 
    Services, L.L.C., as Rights Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report 
    on Form 8-K filed on October 21, 1998. 
     
4.2    Indenture, dated as of January 10, 2002, among XL Capital Finance (Europe) plc, XL Capital Ltd and State 
    Street Bank and Trust Company, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.16(a) to the Company’s Current Report 
    on Form 8-K filed on January 14, 2002. 
     
4.3    Form of XL Capital Finance (Europe) plc Debt Security, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.14 to the 
    Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 14, 2002. 
     
4.4    Excerpts from the Authorizing Resolutions of the Board of Directors of XL Capital Finance (Europe) plc, 
    dated January 7, 2002, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.16(b) to the Company’s Current Report on Form 
    8-K filed on January 14, 2002. 
     
4.5    Form of Note Purchase Agreement, dated as of April 12, 2001, relating to the 6.58% Guaranteed Senior Notes 
    due April 12, 2011 of X.L. America, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.14.43 to the Company’s 
    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2001. 
     
4.6    Form of Indenture between NAC Re Corp. and Shawmut Bank Connecticut, National Association, relating to 
    the 7.15% Notes due November 15, 2005 of NAC Re Corp., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to 
    Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-3 of NAC Re Corp. (No. 33-97878) filed on 
    November 3, 1995. 
     
4.7    Excerpts from the Authorizing Resolutions of the Special Finance Committee of XL Capital Ltd, dated July 29, 
    2002, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.16(c) to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on 
    August 14, 2002. 
     
4.8    Excerpts from the Authorizing Resolutions of the Special Finance Committee of XL Capital Ltd, dated 
    November 6, 2002, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.18 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K 
    filed on November 14, 2002. 
     
4.9    Indenture, dated as of January 23, 2003, between XL Capital Ltd and U.S. Bank National Association, as 
    Trustee, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration 
    Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-101288) filed on January 23, 2003. 
     
4.10    First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of March 23, 2004, to the Indenture, dated as of January 23, 2003, 
    between XL Capital Ltd and U.S. Bank National Association, as Trustee, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    4.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 24, 2004. 
     
4.11    Purchase Contract Agreement, dated as of March 23, 2004, between XL Capital Ltd and U.S. Bank National 
    Association, as Purchase Contract Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to the Company’s Current 
    Report on Form 8-K filed on March 24, 2004. 
     
4.12    Pledge Agreement, dated as of March 23, 2004, among XL Capital Ltd and U.S. Bank Trust National 
    Association, as Collateral Agent, Custodial Agent and Securities Intermediary, and U.S. Bank National 
    Association, as Purchase Contract Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to the Company’s Current 
    Report on Form 8-K filed on March 24, 2004. 

183


Exhibit             Description 
   
4.13    Form of Normal Units Certificate (included in Exhibit 4.11 hereto), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to 
    the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 24, 2004. 
     
4.14    Form of Stripped Units Certificate (included in Exhibit 4.11 hereto), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to 
    the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 24, 2004. 
     
4.15    Form of 2.53% Senior Note due 2009 (included in Exhibit 4.10 hereto), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    4.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 24, 2004. 
     
4.16    Indenture, dated as of June 2, 2004, between XL Capital Ltd and The Bank of New York, as Trustee, incorpo- 
    rated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-116245) filed 
    on June 7, 2004. 
     
4.17    First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of August 23, 2004, to the Indenture, dated as of June 2, 2004, between 
    XL Capital Ltd and The Bank of New York, as Trustee, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the 
    Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 23, 2004. 
     
4.18    Form of 5.25% Senior Note due 2014 (included in Exhibit 4.17 hereto), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 23, 2004. 
     
4.19    Second Supplemental Indenture, dated as of November 12, 2004, to the Indenture, dated as of June 2, 2004, 
    between XL Capital Ltd and The Bank of New York, as Trustee, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the 
    Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on November 15, 2004. 
     
4.20    Form of 6.375% Senior Note due 2024 (included in Exhibit 4.19 hereto), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on November 15, 2004. 
     
4.21    Third Supplemental Indenture, dated as of December 9, 2005, to the Indenture, dated as of June 2, 2004, 
    between XL Capital Ltd and The Bank of New York, as trustee, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the 
    Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 12, 2005. 
     
4.22    Purchase Contract Agreement, dated as of December 9, 2005, between XL Capital Ltd and The Bank of New 
    York, as Purchase Contract Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to the Company’s Current Report 
    on Form 8-K filed on December 12, 2005. 
     
4.23    Pledge Agreement, dated as of December 9, 2005, by and among XL Capital Ltd and The Bank of New York, 
    as Collateral Agent, Custodial Agent and Securities Intermediary, and The Bank of New York, as Purchase 
    Contract Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed 
    on December 12, 2005. 
     
4.24    Form of Normal Units Certificate (included in Exhibit 4.22 hereto), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.6 to 
    the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 12, 2005. 
     
4.25    Form of Stripped Units Certificate (included in Exhibit 4.22 hereto), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.7 to 
    the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 12, 2005. 
     
4.26    Form of 5.25% Senior Note due 2011 (included in Exhibit 4.21 hereto), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    4.8 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 12, 2005. 
     
10.1    1991 Performance Incentive Plan (as amended and restated effective March 7, 2003), incorporated by reference 
    to Appendix B to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on April 4, 2003. 
     
10.2    1991 Performance Incentive Program (as amended and restated effective April 29, 2005), incorporated by ref- 
    erence to Appendix C to the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on March 24, 2005. 
     
10.3    Retirement Plan for Nonemployee Directors, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to the Company’s 
    Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 1996. 

184


Exhibit             Description 
   
10.4    Amended and Restated Directors Stock & Option Plan, incorporated by reference to Appendix C to the 
    Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on April 4, 2003. 
     
10.5    Stock Plan for Nonemployee Directors, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to the Company’s Annual 
    Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 1996. 
     
10.6    Mid Ocean Limited 1993 Long Term Incentive and Share Award Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    10.9.1 to the Company’s Annual Report on form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 1998. 
     
10.7    Amendment to Mid Ocean Limited 1993 Long Term Incentive and Share Award Plan, incorporated by refer- 
    ence to Exhibit 10.9.2 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 1998. 
     
10.8    Mid Ocean Limited Stock & Deferred Compensation Plan for Nonemployee Directors, incorporated by refer- 
    ence to Exhibit 10.10 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended November 30, 1998. 
     
10.9    NAC Re Corp. 1993 Stock Option Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to the Company’s Annual 
    Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003. 
     
10.10    First Amendment to NAC Re Corp. 1993 Stock Option Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 to the 
    Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003. 
     
10.11    Dividend Reinvestment and Share Purchase Plan, incorporated by reference to the Company’s Registration 
    Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-76988) filed on January 18, 2002. 
     
10.12    Dividend Reinvestment and Share Purchase Plan, incorporated by reference to the Company’s Registration 
    Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-130537) filed on December 21, 2005. 
     
10.13    Ronald L. Bornhuetter Consulting Agreement, dated July 1, 1999, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13.2 
    to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1999. 
     
10.14    Nicholas M. Brown, Jr. Employment Agreement, dated April 1, 2002, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    10.58 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2002. 
     
10.15    Nicholas M. Brown, Jr. Retirement Agreement, dated April 1, 2002, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.59 
    to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2002. 
     
10.16    Nicholas M. Brown, Jr. Supplemental Retirement Benefit Agreement, dated March 26, 2004, incorporated by 
    reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 
    2004. 
     
10.17    Jerry de St. Paer Employment Agreement, dated March 1, 2001, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.14.37 
    to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2001. 
     
10.18    Form of Employment Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report 
    on Form 8-K filed on March 8, 2005. 
     
10.19    Employment Agreement, dated as of January 1, 2005, between XL Capital Ltd and Paul S. Giordano, incorpo- 
    rated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended 
    March 31, 2005. 
     
10.20    First Amendment to the Employment Agreement, dated as of January 1, 2005, between XL Capital Ltd and 
    Paul S. Giordano, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K 
    filed on September 14, 2005. 
     
10.21    Employment Agreement, dated as of January 1, 2005, between XL Capital Ltd and Henry C.V. Keeling, incor- 
    porated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended 
    March 31, 2005. 

185


Exhibit             Description 
   
10.22    Employment Agreement, dated as of January 1, 2005, between XL Capital Ltd and Fiona E. Luck, incorpo- 
    rated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended 
    March 31, 2005. 
     
10.23    Employment Agreement, dated as of January 1, 2005, between XL Capital Ltd and Clive Tobin, incorporated 
    by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 
    2005. 
     
10.24    Form of Non-Statutory Stock Option Agreement (One-Time Vesting), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    10.4 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.25    Form of Non-Statutory Stock Option Agreement (Incremental Vesting), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    10.5 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.26    Form of Incentive Stock Option Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to the Company’s 
    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.27    Form of Restricted Stock Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to the Company’s Quarterly 
    Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.28    Form of Non-Statutory Stock Option Agreement (Renewal Form), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to 
    the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.29    Form of Non-Statutory Stock Option Agreement (Non-Employee Director Renewal Form), incorporated by 
    reference to Exhibit 10.9 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 
    2004. 
     
10.30    Form of Directors Restricted Stock Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to the Company’s 
    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.31    Form of Performance Restricted Stock Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 to the 
    Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.32    Form of Performance Restricted Stock Unit Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to the 
    Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.33    Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to the Company’s 
    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.34    Form of Director Stock Option Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.14 to the Company’s 
    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.35    Insurance Letters of Credit — Master Agreement between XL Mid Ocean Reinsurance Ltd and Citibank, N.A., 
    dated May 19, 1993, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 to Amendment No. 2 to the Registration 
    Statement on Form S-1 of Mid Ocean Limited (No. 333-63298) filed on June 25, 1993. 
     
10.36    Sellers Retrocession Agreement (in respect of the period to 31 December 2000), dated July 24, 2001, between 
    Winterthur International, as Principal Reinsured, and Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company, as Reinsurer, 
    incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 10, 
    2005. 
     
10.37    Amended and Restated Sellers Retrocession Agreement (in respect of the period to 30 June 2001), dated 
    February 8, 2002, between XL Winterthur International Re, as Principal Reinsured, and Winterthur Swiss 
    Insurance Company, as Reinsurer, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Current Report 
    on Form 8-K filed on February 10, 2005. 

186


Exhibit             Description 
   
10.38    SRA Amendment Letter, dated December 24, 2003, between XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd, Vitodurum 
    Reinsurance Company and Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to 
    the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 10, 2005. 
     
10.39    Limited Recourse Receivables Financing Facility Agreement, dated July 24, 2001, between Winterthur Swiss 
    Insurance Company and Winterthur International, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s 
    Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 10, 2005. 
     
10.40    Agreement, dated December 24, 2003, between Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company and XL Insurance 
    (Bermuda) Ltd (including the Schedules thereto), relating to the Second Amended and Restated Agreement for 
    the Sale and Purchase of Winterthur International, dated February 15, 2001, incorporated by reference to 
    Exhibit 10.5 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 10, 2005. 
     
10.41    Second Amended and Restated Agreement for the Sale and Purchase of Winterthur International, dated as of 
    February 15, 2001, between Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company and XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd (formerly 
    XL Insurance Ltd), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99(a) to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K 
    filed August 9, 2001. 
     
10.42    Amendment Agreement, dated July 27, 2004, between Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company and XL 
    Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd, relating to the Second Amended and Restated Agreement for the Sale and Purchase 
    of Winterthur International, dated as of February 15, 2001, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to the 
    Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.43    Amendment Agreement, dated July 19, 2002, between Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company and XL 
    Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.58 to the Company’s Annual Report on 
    Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002. 
     
10.44    Agreement, dated December 24, 2003, between Winterthur Swiss Insurance Company and XL Insurance 
    (Bermuda) Ltd (including Schedule B thereto), relating to the Second Amended and Restated Agreement for 
    the Sale and Purchase of Winterthur International, dated as of February 15, 2001, incorporated by reference to 
    Exhibit 10.15 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.45    Letter of Credit Facility and Reimbursement Agreement, dated as of December 29, 2003, by and between XL 
    Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd, XL Capital Ltd, XL Re Ltd, and X.L. America, Inc. and Mellon Bank, N.A., as 
    Bank, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the 
    period ended March 31, 2004. 
     
10.46    Pledge Agreement, dated as of December 18, 2001, made by XL Investments Ltd, XL Re Ltd, XL Insurance 
    (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Europe Ltd, as Grantors, in favor of Citibank, N.A., as Bank, incorporated by reference 
    to Exhibit 10.54 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001. 
     
10.47    Amendment No. 1, dated as of July 1, 2003, to the Pledge Agreement, dated December 18, 2001, made by XL 
    Investments Ltd, XL Re Ltd, XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd, and XL Europe Ltd, as Grantors, in favour of 
    Citibank, N.A., as Bank, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.67 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on 
    Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2003. 
     
10.48    Limited Liability Company Agreement of XL Capital Principal Partners I, L.L.C., dated June 26, 2001, incor- 
    porated by reference to Exhibit 10.55 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended 
    December 31, 2001. 
     
10.49    Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of XL Capital Partners I, L.P., dated as of May 31, 
    2001, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.56 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year 
    ended December 31, 2001. 

187


Exhibit             Description 
   
10.50    First Amendment, dated as of October 30, 2002, to the Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited 
    Partnership, dated as of May 31, 2001, of XL Capital Partners I, L.P., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    10.50 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002. 
     
10.51    Second Amendment, dated as of March 6, 2003, to the Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited 
    Partnership, dated as of May 31, 2001 of XL Capital Partners I, L.P., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    10.51 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002. 
     
10.52    Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of XL Principal Partners I, L.P., dated June 28, 
    2001, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.57 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year 
    ended December 31, 2001. 
     
10.53    First Amendment, dated as of October 30, 2002, to the Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited 
    Partnership, dated as of June 28, 2001, of XL Principal Partners I, L.P., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    10.53 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002. 
     
10.54    Second Amendment, dated as of March 6, 2003, to the Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited 
    Partnership, dated as of June 28, 2001, of XL Principal Partners I, L.P., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    10.54 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002. 
     
10.55    364-Day Credit Agreement, dated as of June 25, 2003, between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL 
    Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd, XL Europe Ltd and XL Re Ltd. as Account Parties and as Guarantors, the Lenders 
    party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Administrative Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.64 
    to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2003. 
     
10.56    364-Day Credit Agreement, dated as of June 23, 2004, between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL 
    Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties and Guarantors, the Lenders party thereto, and 
    JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Administrative Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s 
    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.57    Letter of Credit Facility and Reimbursement Agreement, dated November 14, 2003, between XL Capital Ltd, 
    as Account Party, XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as 
    Guarantors, the Lenders party thereto and Citibank International plc, as Agent and Security Trustee, incorpo- 
    rated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended 
    December 31, 2003. 
     
10.58    Letter of Credit Facility and Reimbursement Agreement, dated November 17, 2004, between XL Capital Ltd, 
    as Account Party, XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as 
    Guarantors, the Lenders party thereto and Citibank International plc, as Agent and Security Trustee, incorpo- 
    rated by reference to Exhibit 10.5% to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended 
    December 31, 2004. 
     
10.59    Amendment No. 1, dated as of December 23, 2005, to the Letter of Credit Facility and Reimbursement 
    Agreement, dated as of November 17, 2004, between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance 
    (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Obligors, the Lenders party thereto, and Citibank International plc, as Agent 
    and Security Trustee, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K 
    filed on December 23, 2005. 
     
10.60    Standby Letter of Credit Agreement, dated January 31, 2003, between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL 
    Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd, XL Europe Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Applicant, and National Australia Bank Limited, 
    New York Branch, as Bank, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.59 to the Company’s Annual Report on 
    Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002. 

188


Exhibit             Description 
   
10.61    Master Standby Letter of Credit and Reimbursement Agreement, dated as of September 30, 2005, by and 
    among XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties, 
    and National Australia Bank Limited, New York Branch, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 
    Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 5, 2005. 
     
10.62    Amendment Agreement, dated as of December 30, 2005, to the Master Standby Letter of Credit and 
    Reimbursement Agreement dated as of September 30, 2005, by and among XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, 
    Inc., XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties, and National Australia Bank Limited, 
    New York Branch, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K 
    filed on January 18, 2006. 
     
10.63    Standby Letter of Credit Agreement, dated July 25, 2003, between National Australia Bank Limited, New York 
    Branch, as Bank, and XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd, XL Europe Ltd and 
    XL Re Ltd as Applicants, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.66 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on 
    Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2003. 
     
10.64    Standby Letter of Credit Agreement, dated February 27, 2004, by and among Keybank National Association, 
    as Bank, and XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Applicants, 
    incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.41 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended 
    December 31, 2003. 
     
10.65    Amended and Restated Standby Letter of Credit Agreement, dated June 30, 2004, between XL Capital Ltd, 
    X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties, and National Australia 
    Bank Limited, New York Branch, as Bank, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.58 to the Company’s 
    Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2004. 
     
10.66    Revolving Credit and Security Agreement, dated as of February 25, 2003, among XL Re Ltd, as Borrower, 
    Corporate Asset Funding Company, Inc., Corporate Receivables Corporation, Charta Corporation and Ciesco, 
    L.P., as Lenders, and Citibank, N.A. and the other Secondary Lenders from time to time parties thereto, as 
    Secondary Lenders, and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.60 to 
    the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002. 
     
10.67    Agreement of Amendment, dated as of February 23, 2004, to the Revolving Credit and Security Agreement, 
    dated as of February 25, 2003, among XL Re Ltd, as Borrower, CAFCO, LLC (formerly Corporate Asset 
    Funding Company, Inc.), CRC Funding, LLC (formerly Corporate Receivables Corporation), CHARTA, LLC 
    (formerly CHARTA Corporation) and CIESCO, LLC (formerly CIESCO, L.P.), as Lenders, Citibank, N.A. 
    and the other Secondary Lenders from time to time parties thereto, as Secondary Lenders, and Citicorp North 
    America, Inc., as Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 
    8-K filed on February 23, 2005. 
     
10.68    Agreement of Amendment, dated as of May 10, 2004, to (i) the Revolving Credit and Security Agreement, 
    dated as of February 25, 2003, among XL Re Ltd, as Borrower, CAFCO, LLC (formerly Corporate Asset 
    Funding Company, Inc.), CRC Funding, LLC (formerly Corporate Receivables Corporation), CHARTA, LLC 
    (formerly CHARTA Corporation) and CIESCO, LLC (formerly CIESCO, L.P.), as Lenders, Citibank, N.A. 
    and the other Secondary Lenders from time to time parties thereto, as Secondary Lenders, and Citicorp North 
    America, Inc., as Agent, and (ii) the Control Agreement, dated as of February 25, 2003, among XL Re Ltd, as 
    Borrower, Citicorp North America, Inc., as Agent, and Mellon Bank, N.A., as Securities Intermediary, incorpo- 
    rated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended 
    June 30, 2004. 

189


Exhibit             Description 
   
10.69    Agreement of Amendment, dated as of February 18, 2005, to the Revolving Credit and Security Agreement, 
    dated as of February 25, 2003, among XL Re Ltd, as Borrower, CAFCO, LLC (formerly Corporate Asset 
    Funding Company, Inc.), CRC Funding, LLC (formerly Corporate Receivables Corporation), CHARTA, LLC 
    (formerly CHARTA Corporation) and CIESCO, LLC (formerly CIESCO, L.P.), as Lenders, Citibank, N.A. 
    and the other Secondary Lenders from time to time parties thereto, as Secondary Lenders, and Citicorp North 
    America, Inc., as Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 
    8-K filed on February 23, 2005. 
     
10.70    Service Agreement Relative to Sureties, Letters of Guarantees and International Stand-By Letters of Credit, 
    dated April 25, 2003, between Société Le Mans Re and Credit Lyonnais, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
    10.62 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2003. 
     
10.71    First Renewal, dated November 27, 2000, between Le Mans Re and BNP Paribas, to the Reinsurance Stand-By 
    Letter of Credit Agreement, dated October 7, 1999, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.63 to the 
    Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2003. 
     
10.72    Control Agreement, dated as of February 25, 2003, between XL Re Ltd and Citicorp North America, Inc., as 
    Agent, and Mellon Bank, N.A., as Securities Intermediary, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.61 to the 
    Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002. 
     
10.73    Offer Letter, dated as of April 12, 2004, for a U.S.$50,000,000 Committed Line of Credit between Credit 
    Lyonnais, New York Branch, as Lender, and XL Capital Ltd, X.L., America, Inc., XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd 
    and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Quarterly 
    Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2004. 
     
10.74    Three-Year Credit Agreement, dated as of June 23, 2004, between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL 
    Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties and Guarantors, the Lenders party thereto, and 
    JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Administrative Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s 
    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004. 
     
10.75    Amendment No. 1, dated as of June 22, 2005, to the Three-Year Credit Agreement, dated as of June 23, 2004, 
    between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties 
    and Guarantors, the lenders party thereto, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent, incorpo- 
    rated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 27, 2005. 
     
10.76    364-Day Credit Agreement, dated as of September 30, 2004, between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL 
    Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties and Guarantors, and Deutsche Bank AG, New 
    York Branch, as Lender, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 
    10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2004. 
     
10.77    364-Day Credit Agreement, dated as of December 23, 2005, between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL 
    Insurance (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties and Guarantors, and Deutsche Bank AG, New 
    York Branch, as Lender, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 
    8-K filed on December 23, 2005. 
     
10.78    Put Option Agreement, dated as of December 10, 2004, between XL Financial Assurance Ltd. and Twin Reefs 
    Asset Trust, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on 
    December 14, 2004. 
     
10.79    Asset Trust Expense Reimbursement Agreement, dated as of December 10, 2004, between XL Financial 
    Assurance Ltd. and Twin Reefs Asset Trust, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s 
    Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 14, 2004. 

190


Exhibit              Description 
     
10.80     Credit Agreement, dated as of June 22, 2005, between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance 
    (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Account Parties and Guarantors, the lenders party thereto and JPMorgan 
    Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s 
    Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 27, 2005. 
10.81     Credit Agreement, dated as of August 3, 2005, between XL Capital Ltd, X.L. America, Inc., XL Insurance 
    (Bermuda) Ltd and XL Re Ltd, as Borrowers and Guarantors, the Lenders party thereto and Bear Stearns 
    Corporate Lending Inc., as Administrative Agent, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s 
    Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2005. 
12 *    Statements regarding computation of ratios. 
21 *    List of subsidiaries of the Registrant. 
23 *    Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP. 
31 *    Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certifications. 
32 *    Section 1350 Certifications. 
99.1 *    XL Capital Assurance Inc. audited consolidated financial statements as at and for the years ended 
    December 31, 2005 and 2004. 
99.2 *    XL Financial Assurance Ltd. audited financial statements as at and for the years ended December 31, 2005 
    and 2004. 


*Filed herewith

191


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of XL Capital Ltd:

     We have completed integrated audits of XL Capital Ltd’s 2005 and 2004 consolidated financial statements and of its internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2005, and an audit of its 2003 consolidated financial statements in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Our opinions, based on our audits, are presented below.

     Consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedules

     In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements listed in the index appearing under Item 8, present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of XL Capital Ltd and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2005 and 2004, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2005 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. In addition, in our opinion, the financial statement schedules listed in the index appearing under Item 15 (2) present fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein when read in conjunction with the related consolidated financial statements. These financial statements and financial statement schedules are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and financial statement schedules based on our audits. We conducted our audits of these statements in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit of financial statements includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Internal control over financial reporting

     Also, in our opinion, management’s assessment, included in Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting appearing under Item 9A, that the Company maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2005 based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), is fairly stated, in all material respects, based on those criteria. Furthermore, in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2005, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by COSO. The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting. Our responsibility is to express opinions on management’s assessment and on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We conducted our audit of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. An audit of internal control over financial reporting includes obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, evaluating management’s assessment, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control, and performing such other procedures as we consider necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinions.

     A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assur-

192


ance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

     Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
New York, New York
March 7, 2006

193


XL CAPITAL LTD

SUPPLEMENTAL SCHEDULE I
CONSOLIDATED SUMMARY OF INVESTMENTS – OTHER THAN
INVESTMENTS IN RELATED PARTIES

As at December 31, 2005

   
Amount 
   
Presented 
   
Cost or
in the 
Type of Investment   
Amortized
Market 
Balance 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Cost (1)
 
Value 
Sheet 



        

      

Fixed Maturities:               
 
   Bonds and notes:               
 
   U.S. Government and Government agency 
  $  4,508,821     $  4,497,004   
$
4,497,004 
   Corporate      13,036,950       13,292,892   
13,292,892 
   Mortgage and asset-backed securities      11,744,565       11,652,106   
11,652,106 
   U.S. States and political subdivisions of the States 
    71,237       71,193   
71,193 
   Non-U.S. Sovereign Government      2,622,503       2,796,370   
2,796,370 


 



             Total fixed maturities    $  31,984,076     $  32,309,565   
$
32,309,565 


 



Equity Securities    $  696,858     $  868,801   
$
868,801 


 



Short-term investments    $  2,552,589     $  2,546,073   
$
2,546,073 


 



Other investments    $  372,546     $  399,417   
$
399,417 


 



Total investments other than related parties    $  35,606,069     $  36,123,856   
$
36,123,856 


 





(1)      Investments in fixed maturities and short-term investments are shown at amortized cost.

194


XL CAPITAL LTD SCHEDULE II

CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF REGISTRANT
CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS – PARENT COMPANY ONLY

As at December 31, 2005 and 2004

(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
 


       

 
Assets             
Investments available for sale:             
     Fixed maturities at fair value (amortized cost: 2005, $275,723; 2004, $99,781) 
  $  275,437     $  99,639  
     Equity securities at fair value (cost: 2005, $238; 2004, $237)      1,652       1,073  
     Short-term investments at fair value             
         (amortized cost: 2005, $314,051: 2004, $82,647)      313,982       82,648  


 

 
         Total investments available for sale      591,071       183,360  
Cash and cash equivalents      833,431       43,961  
Investments in subsidiaries on an equity basis      11,964,365       10,340,355  
Investment in affiliates      2,280       6,723  
Investments in limited partnerships      23,644       21,782  
Accrued investment income      3,242       1,988  
Other assets      83,594       72,266  


 

 
         Total assets    $  13,501,627     $  10,670,435  


 

 
Liabilities             
Amount due to subsidiaries    $  2,227,320     $  918,599  
Notes payable and debt      2,514,329       1,768,678  
Net payable for investments purchased      68,931       325  
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities      219,236       244,138  


 

 
         Total liabilities    $  5,029,816     $  2,931,740  


 

 
Shareholders’ Equity             
Ordinary shares    $  1,795     $  1,389  
Preference shares      207       207  
Additional paid in capital      6,472,839       3,950,175  
Accumulated other comprehensive income      268,243       460,273  
Deferred compensation      (95,464 )      (69,988 ) 
Retained earnings      1,824,191       3,396,639  


 

 
         Total shareholders’ equity    $  8,471,811     $  7,738,695  


 

 
         Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity    $  13,501,627     $  10,670,435  


 

 

195


XL CAPITAL LTD

SCHEDULE II

     CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF REGISTRANT (CONTINUED) STATEMENT OF INCOME AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME – PARENT COMPANY ONLY

For the Years Ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
Net investment income   
$
4,944    
$
3,329    
$
1,883  
Net realized gains on investments and derivative instruments   
5,980    
6,010    
7,016  
Equity in net (losses) earnings of subsidiaries   
   
   
 
   (Dividends were nil in 2005, $217,327 in 2004   
   
   
 
   and $157,837 in 2003)   
(1,015,592 )   
1,436,389    
528,914  
Equity in net earnings of affiliates   
854    
526    
(13,877 ) 
Income from limited partnerships   
   
2    
268  


 

 

 
Total revenues   
(1,003,814 )   
1,446,256    
524,204  


 

 

 
Operating expenses   
166,902    
208,974    
85,182  
Interest expense   
86,849    
70,669    
27,043  


 

 

 
Total expenses   
253,751    
279,643    
112,225  


 

 

 
(Loss) income before income tax   
(1,257,565 )   
1,166,613    
411,979  
Tax expense   
(5,589 )   
   
 


 

 

 
Net (loss) income   
(1,251,976 )   
1,166,613    
411,979  
Preference dividend   
(40,322 )   
(40,321 )   
(40,321 ) 


 

 

 
Net (loss) income available to ordinary shareholders   
$
(1,292,298 )   
$
1,126,292    
$
371,658  


 

 

 
Net (loss) income   
$
(1,251,976 )   
$
1,166,613    
$
411,979  
Change in net unrealized (depreciation) appreciation on investments, net of tax   
(314,719 )   
198,912    
352,719  
Derivative gain (loss) on cash flow hedge   
630    
(6,118 )   
 
Impact of net unrealized gain or loss on                        
   future policy benefit reserves   
(46,743 )   
(49,250 )   
(10,487 ) 
Foreign currency translation adjustments   
168,802    
(173,466 )   
(36,851 ) 


 

 

 
Comprehensive (loss) income   
$
(1,444,006 )   
$
1,136,691    
$
717,360  


 

 

 

196


XL CAPITAL LTD SCHEDULE II

CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF REGISTRANT (CONTINUED)
STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS – PARENT COMPANY ONLY

For the Years Ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003

(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
2005
2004
2003
 


       

       

 
Cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities:   
   
   
 
   Net (loss) income   
$
(1,251,976 )   
$
1,166,613    
$
411,979  
   Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided   
   
   
 
       by operating activities:   
   
   
 
       Net realized (gains) losses on investments and derivative instruments 
 
4,027    
(6,010 )   
(7,016 ) 
       Net realized (losses) gains on MTM and derivatives   
(10,007 )   
   
 
       Equity in net earnings of subsidiaries, net of dividends   
1,019,200    
(1,434,919 )   
(532,339 ) 
       Equity in net loss (income) of affiliates, net of dividends   
(854 )   
(526 )   
13,877  
       Amortization of deferred compensation   
33,004    
28,393    
17,915  
       Amortization of discounts on fixed maturities   
(3,224 )   
(1,509 )   
(999 ) 
       Accretion of notes payable and debt   
651    
21,457    
25,196  
       Accrued investment income   
(1,254 )   
55    
1,728  
       Accounts payable and accrued liabilities   
(58,726 )   
(15,804 )   
(7,873 ) 
       Other   
16,471    
16,009    
(15,604 ) 


 

 

 
   Total adjustments   
999,288    
(1,392,854 )   
(505,115 ) 


 

 

 
   Net cash used in operating activities   
(252,688 )   
(226,241 )   
(93,136 ) 


 

 

 
Cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities:   
   
   
 
   Proceeds from sale of fixed maturities and short-term investments   
307,386    
136,652    
88,321  
   Proceeds from redemption of fixed maturities and   
   
   
 
       short-term investments   
258,473    
275,430    
393,555  
   Purchases of fixed maturities and short term investments   
(902,520 )   
(411,583 )   
(414,760 ) 
   Investment in subsidiaries   
(2,841,000 )   
(718,195 )   
(1,153,515 ) 
   Investment in affiliates   
5,297    
8,371    
(7,658 ) 
   Investment in limited partnerships   
5,245    
3,390    
6,484  


 

 

 
       Net cash used in investing activities   
(3,167,119 )   
(705,935 )   
(1,087,573 ) 


 

 

 
Cash flows provided by financing activities:   
   
   
 
   Proceeds from exercise of options and issuance of common shares   
2,478,065    
41,480    
42,113  
   Dividends paid   
(316,977 )   
(310,773 )   
(303,497 ) 
   Amount due to from subsidiaries   
1,308,721    
201,920    
1,062,597  
   Repurchase of shares   
(5,532 )   
(4,602 )   
(1,574 ) 
   Dividends received from subsidiaries   
   
217,327    
157,837  
   Proceeds from loans   
745,000    
1,742,317    
 
   Repayment of loans   
   
(974,384 )   
 


 

 

 
       Net cash provided by financing activities   
4,209,277    
913,285    
957,476  


 

 

 
       Net change in cash and cash equivalents   
789,470    
(18,891 )   
(223,233 ) 


 

 

 
Cash and cash equivalents – beginning of year   
43,961    
62,852    
286,085  


 

 

 
Cash and cash equivalents – end of year   
$
833,431    
$
43,961    
$
62,852  


 

 

 

197


     XL CAPITAL LTD

SCHEDULE IV – REINSURANCE

For the Years Ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003

   
Ceded 
Assumed 
   
Gross 
to Other 
from Other 
Net 
(U.S. dollars in thousands)   
Amount 
Companies 
Companies 
Amount 


     

     

     

2005   
   
   
   
 
Property and casualty   
$
5,720,536   
$
2,172,726   
$
3,476,301   
$
7,024,111 
Life and annuity   
   
37,617   
2,274,520   
2,236,903 
Financial products & services   
290,250   
21,695   
87,890   
356,445 








   
$
6,010,786   
$
2,232,038   
$
5,838,711   
$
9,617,459 








2004   
   
   
   
 
Property and casualty   
$
5,733,247   
$
2,111,728   
$
3,648,215   
$
7,269,734 
Life and annuity   
   
34,385   
1,397,516   
1,363,131 
Financial products & services   
296,520   
19,573   
48,715   
325,662 








   
$
6,029,767   
$
2,165,686   
$
5,094,446   
$
8,958,527 








2003   
   
   
   
 
Property and casualty   
$
5,000,371   
$
2,073,489   
$
3,636,321   
$
6,563,203 
Life and annuity   
   
31,542   
733,649   
702,107 
Financial products & services   
301,939   
9,664   
58,570   
350,845 








   
$
5,302,310   
$
2,114,695   
$
4,428,540   
$
7,616,155 









198


XL CAPITAL LTD SCHEDULE VI

SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
CONCERNING PROPERTY/CASUALTY INSURANCE OPERATIONS

For the Years Ended December 31, 2005, 2004 and 2003

                     
Losses and Loss Expenses 
           
(U.S.
     
Reserves 
               
incurred related to 
 
Net Paid 
 
Amortization 
   
dollars
  Deferred 
For Losses  
Reserves for
Net


Losses and 
 
of Deferred 
 
Net 
in
 
Acquisition 
 
and Loss 
 
Unearned 
 
Net Earned 
 
Investment 
 
Current 
Prior 
Loss 
Acquisition 
Premiums 
thousands) 
 
Costs 
 
Expenses 
 
Premiums 
 
Premiums 
 
Income 
 
Year 
Year 
Expenses 
Costs 
Written 




















2005 (1)    .    $
795,190 
$
 
23,767,672 
$
5,385,901 
$
7,127,774 
$
1,184,522 
$
6,351,281 
$
1,113,720 
$
2,609,766 
$
1,136,326 
$
7,380,556 




















2004 (1)    .    $
760,597 
$
 
19,837,669 
$
5,188,845 
$
7,216,838 
$
829,149 
$
4,643,894 
$
267,594 
$
3,066,337 
$
1,216,034 
$
7,595,396 




















2003 (1)    .    $
718,998 
$
 
16,763,124 
$
4,724,005 
$
6,284,922 
$
677,220 
$
3,759,142 
$
937,285 
$
2,882,284 
$
1,130,550 
$
6,914,048 






















(1)      The information presented above includes balances from the general and financial operations. The life and annuity operations have been excluded.
 

199


SIGNATURES

     Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

Date: March 7, 2006

  XL CAPITAL LTD 
  (Registrant) 
     
  By                     /s/ BRIAN M. O’HARA 

    Name: Brian M. O’Hara 
    Title: President and Chief Executive Officer 

200


POWER OF ATTORNEY

     We, the undersigned directors and executive officers of XL Capital Ltd, hereby severally constitute Michael P. Esposito, Jr., Brian M. O’Hara, Charles F. Barr and Kirstin Romann Gould, and each of them singly, our true and lawful attorneys with full power to them and each of them to sign for us, and in our names in the capacities indicated below, any and all amendments to the Annual Report on Form 10-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission, hereby ratifying and confirming our signatures as they may be signed by our said attorneys to any and all amendments to said Annual Report on Form 10-K.

     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

Signatures    Title    Date 
     
/s/ BRIAN M. O’HARA    President, Chief Executive Officer and Director    March 7, 2006 

(Principal Executive Officer) 
Brian M. O’Hara         
         
/s/ JERRY M. DE ST. PAER    Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer    March 7, 2006 

(Principal Financial Officer and Principal 
Jerry M. de St Paer    Accounting Officer)     
         
/s/ MICHAEL P. ESPOSITO JR.    Director and Chairman of the Board of Directors    March 7, 2006 

Michael P. Esposito, Jr.         
         
/s/ DALE R. COMEY    Director    March 7, 2006 

Dale R. Comey         
         
/s/ JOSEPH MAURIELLO    Director    March 7, 2006 

Joseph Mauriello         
         
/s/ EUGENE M. MCQUADE    Director    March 7, 2006 

Eugene M. McQuade         
         
/s/ ROBERT S. PARKER    Director    March 7, 2006 

Robert S. Parker         
         
/s/ CYRIL E. RANCE    Director    March 7, 2006 

Cyril E. Rance         
         
/s/ ALAN Z. SENTER    Director    March 7, 2006 

Alan Z. Senter         
         
/s/ JOHN T. THORNTON    Director    March 7, 2006 

John T. Thornton         
         
/s/ ELLEN E. THROWER    Director    March 7, 2006 

Ellen E. Thrower         
         
/s/ JOHN W. WEISER    Director    March 7, 2006 

John W. Weiser         

201